Navistar, Inc.: Diagnostic Manual 2010 Maxxforce DT, 9 and 10 Engine Diagnostic Manual
Navistar, Inc.: Diagnostic Manual 2010 Maxxforce DT, 9 and 10 Engine Diagnostic Manual
0000001624
Navistar, Inc.
January 2021
Revision 33
© 2021 Navistar, Inc. All rights reserved. All marks are trademarks of their respective owners.
DIAGNOSTIC MANUAL I
TABLE OF CONTENTS
Foreword. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1
Service Diagnosis . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2
Safety Information. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3
Terminology. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1851
II DIAGNOSTIC MANUAL
DIAGNOSTIC MANUAL 1
Foreword
Navistar®, Inc. is committed to continuous research and development to improve products and introduce
technological advances. Procedures, specifications, and parts defined in published technical service literature
may be altered.
NOTE: Photo illustrations identify specific parts or assemblies that support text and procedures; other areas in
a photo illustration may not be exact.
This manual includes necessary information and specifications for technicians to maintain MaxxForce® diesel
engines. See vehicle manuals and Technical Service Information (TSI) bulletins for additional information.
Technical Service Literature is revised periodically. If a technical publication is ordered, the latest revision will
be supplied.
NOTE: To order technical service literature, contact your International® dealer.
2 DIAGNOSTIC MANUAL
Service Diagnosis
Service diagnosis is an investigative procedure that must be followed to find and correct an engine application
problem or an engine problem.
If the problem is engine application, see specific vehicle manuals for further diagnostic information.
If the problem is the engine, see specific Engine Diagnostic Manual for further diagnostic information.
Prerequisites for Effective Diagnosis
• Availability of gauges and diagnostic test equipment
• Availability of current information for engine application and engine systems
• Knowledge of the principles of operation for engine application and engine systems
• Knowledge to understand and do procedures in diagnostic and service publications
Technical Service Literature required for Effective Diagnosis
• Engine Service Manual
• Engine Diagnostic Manual
• Electronic Control Systems Diagnostics Forms
• Service Bulletins
DIAGNOSTIC MANUAL 3
Safety Information
This manual provides general and specific maintenance procedures essential for reliable engine operation and
your safety. Since many variations in procedures, tools, and service parts are involved, advice for all possible
safety conditions and hazards cannot be stated.
Read safety instructions before doing any service and test procedures for the engine or vehicle. See related
application manuals for more information.
Disregard for Safety Instructions, Warnings, Cautions, and Notes in this manual can lead to injury, death or
damage to the engine or vehicle.
Safety Terminology
Three terms are used to stress your safety and safe operation of the engine: Warning, Caution, and Note.
Warning: A warning describes actions necessary to prevent or eliminate conditions, hazards, and unsafe
practices that can cause personal injury or death.
Caution: A caution describes actions necessary to prevent or eliminate conditions that can cause damage to
the engine or vehicle.
Note: A note describes actions necessary for correct, efficient engine operation.
Safety Instructions
Work Area
• Keep work area clean, dry, and organized.
• Keep tools and parts off the floor.
• Make sure the work area is ventilated and well lit.
• Make sure a First Aid Kit is available.
Safety Equipment
• Use correct lifting devices.
• Use safety blocks and stands.
Protective Measures
• Wear protective safety glasses and shoes.
• Wear correct hearing protection.
• Wear cotton work clothing.
• Wear sleeved heat protective gloves.
• Do not wear rings, watches or other jewelry.
• Restrain long hair.
Vehicle
• Make sure the vehicle is in neutral, the parking brake is set, and the wheels are blocked before servicing
engine.
4 DIAGNOSTIC MANUAL
Table of Contents
Step 7 Verify Engine Control Module (ECM) communicates with Electronic Service Decision
Tool (EST), obtain vehicle health report, and check for current ECM calibration.
A. Connect EST with Navistar® Engine Diagnostics and log-in. Yes: Go to Step 8.
B. Perform Obtain Vehicle Health Report (page 1324). No, ECM calibration not
current: Ensure vehicle has
Is EST communicating with the ECM, and is ECM calibration current?
latest ECM calibration. After
repairs are complete, retest
for original problem.
No, EST not communicating
with ECM: Go to 11.0 ECM
Loss of Communication
(page 40).
22 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Step 8 Review results from previous steps, Repair Order (RO), vehicle history, and operator complaint.
Go to operational checkout procedure for specific symptom:
• 2.0 Engine Does Not Start Operational Checkout Procedure (page 23)
• 3.0 Engine Hard to Start Operational Checkout Procedure (page 26)
• 4.0 Engine Running, Engine Not Under Load Operational Checkout Procedure (page 29)
• 5.0 Engine Running, Engine Under Load Operational Checkout Procedure (page 31)
Overview
The following steps direct technicians to systematically troubleshoot engine no start conditions and avoid
unnecessary repairs.
Step 2 Determine if injector buzz test will identify a failed fuel injector. Decision
Perform Injector Test (page 1365). Yes: Go to Step 3.
Is an audible buzz sound heard from each injector? No: Do injector circuit
diagnostics (SPN
651-656 FMI 4, 5;
SPN 2797; 2798 FMI
3, 4; SPN 3659-3664
FMI 4, 5) for specific
failed injector(s). If circuit
diagnostics passes,
replace failed injector(s).
Step 3 Check for no start related Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC). Decision
®
Using Electronic Service Tool (EST) with Navistar Engine Diagnostics, check DTC list for: Yes: Go to Fault Code
Diagnostics for no start
• SPN 94 Fuel Delivery Pressure (FDP)
related SPN.
• SPN 931 Electric Fuel Pump (EFP)
No: Go to Step 4.
• SPN 164, 3055 Injection Control Pressure (ICP)
• SPN 679 Injection Pressure Regulator (IPR)
• SPN 636 Camshaft Position (CMP)
• SPN 637 Crankshaft Position (CKP)
• SPN 108, 158, 628, 629, 1136, 1387 Engine Control Module (ECM)
Step 4 Record snapshot of no start related Key-On Engine-Off (KOEO) data. Decision
A. Perform Record Snapshot of KOEO Data (page 1330). Yes: Go to Step 5.
B. Wiggle the ICP harness, IPR harness, UVC connector (for ICP); 24-pin, 42-pin (IP), No: Battery voltage
and 36-pin ECM connectors. out of specification:
Repair battery, starting
system, charging system,
or ECM PWR circuit
problem. After repairs
are complete, retest for
original problem.
No, FDP out of
specification: Go to 8.1
Fuel Delivery Pressure
(page 119).
No, ICP out of
specification: Go to
SPN 164 FMI 0 Fault
Code Diagnostics (page
360).
Are battery voltage, FDP, ICP, and engine temperature sensor values within KOEO No, One or more engine
specifications? temperature sensors
not within 20°F (11°C)
of others after cold
soak: Go to (Fault
Code Diagnostics, page
129) for sensor out of
specification.
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 25
Overview
The following steps direct technicians to systematically troubleshoot engine hard to start conditions and avoid
unnecessary repairs.
Step 2 Check for hard to start related Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC). Decision
Using Electronic Service Tool (EST) with Navistar® Engine Diagnostics, check DTC list for: Yes: Go to Fault Code
Diagnostics for hard to
• SPN 94 Fuel Delivery Pressure (FDP)
start related SPN.
• SPN 931 Electric Fuel Pump (EFP)
• SPN 164 Injection Control Pressure (ICP)
• SPN 679 Injection Pressure Regulator (IPR)
• SPN 636 Camshaft Position (CMP)
• SPN 637 Crankshaft Position (CKP)
• SPN 108, 158, 628, 629, 1136, 1387 Engine Control Module (ECM)
• SPN 27, 2791 Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR)
• SPN 110, 1659 Engine Coolant Temperature 1 (ECT1)
• SPN 175 Engine Oil Temperature (EOT)
• SPN 1209 Exhaust Back Pressure (EBP)
• SPN 3251 Diesel Particulate Filter Differential Pressure (DPFDP)
• SPN 5541, 5543 Exhaust Back Pressure Valve (EBPV)
• SPN 51, 3464 Engine Throttle Valve (ETV)
• SPN 102 Intake Manifold Pressure (IMP)
Step 3 Record snapshot of hard to start related Key-On Engine-Off (KOEO) data. Decision
A. Perform Record Snapshot of KOEO Data (page 1330). Yes: Go to Step 4.
B. Wiggle the ICP harness, IPR harness, UVC connector (for ICP); 24-pin, 42-pin (IP), No, battery voltage
and 36-pin ECM connectors. out of specification:
Repair battery, starting
Are battery voltage, Fuel Delivery Pressure (FDP), Injection Control Pressure (ICP), and
system, charging system,
engine temperature sensor values within Key-On Engine-Off specifications?
or ECM PWR circuit
problem. After repairs
are complete, retest for
original problem.
No, FDP out of
specification: Go to 8.1
-Fuel Delivery Pressure
(page 119).
No, ICP out of
specification: Go to
SPN 164 FMI 0 Fault
Code Diagnostics (page
360).
No, one or more engine
temperature sensors
Not within 20°F (11°C)
of others after cold
soak: Go to Fault Code
Diagnostics for sensor
out of specification.
Step 5 Determine if engine will not start specifically during cold ambient Decision
temperatures.
Attempt to start engine. Yes: Go to 3.1 Engine
Hard to Start, Cold
Is engine hard to start, specifically during cold ambient temperatures?
Ambient Temperature
(page 58).
No: Go to Step 6.
Step 6 Determine if engine is hard to re-start after being run to operating Decision
temperature.
A. Run engine to operating temperature. Yes: Go to 3.2 Engine at
Operating Temperature,
B. Attempt to re-start engine at operating temperature.
Hard to Re-Start (page
Is engine hard to re-start specifically after being run to operating temperature? 60).
No: Go to Step 7.
4.0 - Engine Running, Engine Not Under Load Operational Checkout Procedure
Overview
The following steps direct technicians to systematically troubleshoot engine running problems while engine is
not under a load.
Step 3 Record snapshot of engine running data and determine if engine idles properly. Decision
A. Perform Record Snapshot of Engine Running Data (page 1464) while symptom Yes: Go to 4.1 Rough Idle
is occurring. (page 64).
B. Wiggle the ICP harness, IPR harness, UVC connector (for ICP); 24-pin, 42-pin (IP), No: Go to Step 4.
and 36-pin ECM connectors.
Step 5 Determine if a popping noise is coming from engine air intake. Decision
A. Start engine. Yes: Go to 4.3 Popping
Noise from Intake (page
B. Listen for popping noise from engine air intake.
69).
C. Increase engine rpm to rated speed and return to idle.
No: Review operator
Is popping noise heard from engine air intake? complaint.
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 31
Overview
The following steps direct technicians to systematically troubleshoot engine running problems while under a
load.
Step 3 Record snapshot of engine running data and determine if engine has a misfire.
Perform 0 to 60 MPH Test (page 1514). Yes: Go to 5.2 Misfire
(Stumble/Surge/Runs
Does engine speed vary by 50 rpm or more while symptom is occurring?
Rough) (page 81).
No: Go to Step 4.
Step 5 Determine if engine is able to reach desired speed during PTO operation.
A. Start engine. Yes: Review operator
complaint.
B. Operate PTO.
No: Go to 5.3 Engine Unable
C. If vehicle is equipped with a manual PTO, increase engine rpm to desired
to Reach Desired Speed
operating speed.
During PTO Operation (page
Does engine reach desired speed during PTO operation? 84).
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 33
Overview
The following steps direct technicians to systematically troubleshoot engine cooling system problems and avoid
unnecessary work and repairs.
WARNING:
To prevent personal injury or death, wear safety glasses with side shields.
Step 2 Determine if air flow thru cooling package is restricted or cooling system Decision
components are damaged.
A. Inspect for restrictions and debris in front of and between radiators and other Yes: Clear restrictions and
cooling package components. clean debris from cooling
package. Repair damaged
B. Inspect cooling fan blades, fan shroud, accessory drive belt(s), drive belt
cooling system components.
tensioner(s), cooling package, and other cooling system components for
After repairs are complete,
damage.
retest for original problem.
Were restrictions or debris found, or are cooling system components damaged?
No: Go to Step 3.
Step 4 Determine if engine or cooling system components are leaking externally Decision
or internally.
Perform Coolant Leak Visual Inspection (page 1643). Yes: Go to Step 5.
Does cooling system holding pressure for 15 minutes?
No, external leaks: Repair
external cooling system
leaks. After repairs are
complete, retest for original
problem.
No, internal leaks: Go to
Step 8.
Step 5 Determine if cooling system will not get up to proper operating temperature. Decision
®
A. Connect Electronic Service Tool (EST) with Navistar Engine Diagnostics and Yes: Go to Step 6.
log in.
No: Go to 6.3 Engine
B. Run engine to operating temperature while monitoring Engine Coolant Unable to Reach Operating
Temperature (ECT). Temperature (page 93).
Step 7 Determine if vehicle cooling system goes over temperature or overheats. Decision
NOTE: Do not run vehicle on a dynamometer to duplicate over temperature or over-heat Yes: Go to 6.2 Coolant Over
concern. False results will occur due to lack of proper air flow across the cooling package. Temperature (page 90).
Does vehicle cooling system go over temperature 220°F (104°C) or overheat?
No: Go to Step 8.
NOTE: Some moisture and streaking inside the intake system is normal.
Is coolant present in the engine intake?
No: Go to Step 10.
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 35
WARNING:
To prevent personal injury or death, allow engine to cool before working with
components.
Overview
The following steps direct technicians to systematically troubleshoot engine oil system problems and avoid
unnecessary work and repairs.
Step 2 Check for engine oil related Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC). Decision
Using Electronic Service Tool (EST) with Navistar® Engine Diagnostics, check DTC list for: Yes: Go to Fault Code
Diagnostics for engine oil
• SPN 100 Engine Oil Pressure (EOP)
related SPN.
• SPN 110 Engine Coolant Temperature 1 (ECT1)
• SPN 111 Engine Coolant Level (ECL)
• SPN 175 Engine Oil Temperature (EOT)
Does EST DTC list have any of the fault codes listed above?
No: Go to Step 3.
Step 4 Verify engine oil quality, and determine if oil is aerated. Decision
Review results from Engine Oil Level and Quality Inspection (page 1635). Yes, fuel is in engine oil:
Go to 8.2 Fuel in Engine Oil
(page 123).
Yes, engine oil
contaminated: Go to 7.1
Engine Oil Contamination
(page 100).
Yes, engine oil aerated: Go
to 7.6 Engine Oil Aeration
(page 115).
Is engine oil contaminated or aerated? No: Go to Step 5.
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 37
Step 5 Determine if engine oil is leaking into the cooling system. Decision
A. Allow engine to cool for 15 minutes or more. Yes: Go to 7.7 - Engine Oil
in Coolant (page 117).
B. Remove deaeration tank cap.
C. Inspect deaeration tank for engine oil.
Is engine oil in the deaeration tank? No: Go to Step 6.
Step
Perform preliminary operational checkout procedure. Decision
1
Yes: Go to Step 2
Did a symptom Fault Code Action Plan (FCAP) bring you here or does the No: Go to 1.0 Preliminary Vehicle
customers complaint align with this operational checkout procedure? Operational Checkout Procedure
(page 20).
Step
Check for related Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC). Decision
2
Using Electronic Service Tool (EST) with Navistar® Engine Diagnostics, check Yes: Go to Fault Code Diagnostics
DTC list for: for appropriate SPN.
• SPN 191 Transmission Output Shaft Speed (TOSS) / Vehicle Speed Sensor
(VSS)
• SPN 597 Engine compression brake switch
• SPN 4287 Engine Compression Brake Pressure (ECBP)
Does EST DTC list have any of the above listed SPN?
No: Go to Step 3.
Overview
Diagnose Engine Control Module (ECM) not communicating with the Electronic Service Tool (EST).
Possible Causes
• Theft deterrent system
• Public Controller Area Network (CAN) circuit (terminating resistor, etc.)
• Any failed module on Public CAN
• Power and / or ground circuits to Diagnostic Connector
• Engine Control Module (ECM) power circuit (ECM fuse, ECM PWR Relay, etc.)
• ECM ground circuit
• Low battery voltage
• Faulty ECM
Test Procedure
Step
Perform preliminary operational checkout procedure. Decision
1
Yes: Go to Step 2.
Did a symptom Fault Code Action Plan (FCAP) bring you here or does the No: Go to 1.0 Preliminary Vehicle
customers complaint align with this operational checkout procedure? Operational Checkout Procedure
(page 20).
Step
Determine if Electronic Service Tool (EST) is working properly. Decision
2
A. Key-On Engine-Off (KOEO) Yes: Go to Step 3.
B. Connect EST with Navistar® Engine Diagnostics to a second vehicle
and log in.
Does EST communicate properly with second vehicle? No: Repair EST. After repairs
are complete, retest for original
problem.
Step
Determine if EST communicates with other modules. Decision
3
A. Key-On Engine-Off (KOEO). Yes: Go to Step 4.
®
B. Connect EST with Navistar Engine Diagnostics to initial vehicle and
log in.
C. Under the Connection (Sniffer) tab verify equipped modules are listed
under Module Name and Count is actively changing.
Does EST communicate with modules other than the Engine Control Module No: Go to Step 15.
(ECM)?
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 41
NOTE: See latest version of Engine and Aftertreatment Wiring Schematic Form for additional circuit
information.
Step
Determine if ECM ground circuits are working properly. Decision
4
A. Key Off. Yes: Go to Step 5.
B. Connect Breakout Harness 00-00959-01 to ECM 76-pin gray chassis
connector and leave ECM disconnected.
C. Connect Breakout Harness 00-00959-01 to 180-pin Breakout Box
00-00956-08.
D. Key-On Engine-Off (KOEO).
E. Measure voltage between battery positive and pins C-2, 4, and 6.
Are ECM ground circuits between pins C-2, 4, 6 and battery positive within 0.5V No: Repair ground circuits. After
of battery voltage? repairs are complete, retest for
original problem.
Step
Determine if ECM is receiving ignition switch power. Decision
5
A. KOEO. Yes: Go to Step 8.
B. Measure SWBAT circuit voltage between battery ground and pin C-31.
Is voltage between pin C-31 and battery negative within 0.5V of battery voltage? No: Go to Step 6.
Step
Determine if vehicle has an anti-theft system installed. Decision
6
Look for anti-theft password switch panel on vehicle center panel. Yes: See Electrical System
troubleshooting Guide for anti-theft
system checks. After repairs
are complete, retest for original
problem.
If anti-theft system is operating
correctly, and problem remains, go
to Step 7.
Does vehicle have an anti-theft system installed? No: Go to Step 7.
Step
Determine if IPR PWR circuit has proper voltage. Decision
7
A. Inspect F1-A ( 5A or 10A) fuse for loose terminals or corrosion (see Yes: Repair Open or high resistance
appropriate Truck Circuit Diagram). between F1-A fuse and ECM pin
C-31. After repairs are complete,
B. Key-On Engine-Off (KOEO).
retest for original problem.
C. Measure voltage between ground and each side of the F1-A fuse.
No, voltage is within 0.5V of battery
voltage only on one side of F1-A
fuse: Replace blown fuse and / or
repair loose terminals or corrosion.
42 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Step
Determine if ECM MPR ground circuit is operating properly. Decision
8
A. KOEO. Yes: Go to Step 10.
B. Remove ECM PWR Relay.
C. Measure voltage between battery positive and ECM PWR relay pin-85.
Is voltage between pin–85 and battery positive within 0.5V of battery voltage? No: Go to Step 9.
Step
Determine if ECM MPR ground circuit is Open. Decision
9
A. KOEO. Yes: Go to Step 10.
B. Measure voltage between battery positive and pin C-70.
Is voltage between pin C-70 and battery positive within 0.5V of battery voltage? No: Replace Engine Control Module
(ECM). After repairs are complete,
retest for original problem.
Step
Determine if power circuits to the ECM are working properly. Decision
10
A. Key-On Engine-Off (KOEO). Yes: Go to Step 11.
Step Determine if Public CAN circuits between ECM and Diagnostic Connector
Decision
11 are Open or have high resistance.
A. Key Off. Yes: Go to Step 12.
B. Disconnect batteries.
Step
Measure resistance between Public CAN circuits. Decision
12
Measure resistance between Diagnostic Connector pin-C and pin-D. Yes: Go to Step 14.
Is resistance between Diagnostic Connector pin-C and pin-D approximately 60 No: Go to Step 13.
ohms?
Step
Measure terminating resistors. Decision
13
A. Remove both 120 ohm Public CAN terminating resistors. Yes: Repair Public CAN circuit
wiring. After repairs are complete,
B. Measure resistance of each terminating resistor.
retest for original problem.
Is resistance of each terminating resistor approximately 120 ohms? No: Replace defective terminating
resistor(s). After repairs are
complete, retest for original
problem.
Step
Determine if Public CAN J1939 data link is operating properly. Decision
14
A. Connect vehicle batteries. Yes: Replace Engine Control
Module (ECM). After repairs
B. Key-On Engine-Off (KOEO).
are complete, retest for original
C. Measure voltage between 9-pin Diagnostic Connector pin-C (CAN-H) problem.
and ground. Record measurement.
D. Measure voltage between Diagnostic Connector pin-D (CAN-L) and
ground. Record measurement.
NOTE: The sum of CAN-H and CAN-L voltage measurements should add up to
approximately 5V, and CAN-H voltage should be greater than CAN-L.
Is the sum of CAN-H and CAN-L voltage measurements approximately 5V, and No: Repair Public CAN circuit
is CAN-H 2.7V (+-0.5V) and CAN-L 2.3V (+-0.5V)? wiring. After repairs are complete,
retest for original problem.
44 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Step
Determine if Diagnostic Connector has proper voltage and ground. Decision
15
A. Measure voltage between 9-pin Diagnostic Connector pin-B and battery Yes: Go to Step 16.
negative.
B. Measure voltage between Diagnostic Connector pin-A and battery
positive.
Is power circuit between pin-B and battery ground within 0.5V of battery voltage; No: Repair power and/or ground
and is voltage between ground circuit pin-A and battery positive within 0.5V of circuit(s) to the Diagnostic
battery voltage? Connector. After repairs are
complete, retest for original
problem.
Step
Determine if Public CAN J1939 data link is operating properly. Decision
16
A. KOEO. Yes: Go to Step 17.
B. Measure voltage between 9-pin Diagnostic Connector pin-C (CAN-H)
and ground. Record measurement.
C. Measure voltage between Diagnostic Connector pin-D (CAN-L) and
ground. Record measurement.
NOTE: The sum of CAN-H and CAN-L voltage measurements should add up to
approximately 5V, and CAN-H should be greater than CAN-L.
Is the sum of CAN-H and CAN-L voltage measurements approximately 5V, and No: repair Public CAN circuit wiring.
is CAN-H 2.7V (+-0.5V) and CAN-L 2.3V (+-0.5V)? After repairs are complete, retest
for original problem.
Step
Determine what module is causing communication failure. Decision
17
Unplug one Public CAN module at a time, and check when EST CAN Yes: Replace faulty module with a
communication returns. Verify only one module is unplugged at any time. known good module. After repairs
are complete, retest for original
problem.
Does EST CAN communication return when a specific module is unplugged? No: End Diagnostic Steps.
Overview
Diagnose reason for soot buildup at exhaust manifold. Exhaust manifold gasket damage and position are key
to determine required steps.
Some cold start exhaust leaks / soot accumulation at exhaust joints is normal, and does Not require exhaust
manifold and gasket replacement. Examples:
• Exhaust manifold slip joint between ports 2 and 3
• EGR cooler to exhaust manifold slip joint (goose neck)
Exhaust manifold gasket condition and position must be checked.
NOTE: Do not remove exhaust manifold to measure warpage.
NOTE: Minor exhaust leaks will not cause engine performance or frequent exhaust regeneration problems.
Possible Causes
• Exhaust manifold gasket out of position / failed
• Exhaust manifold slip joint leaking (blow by)
• Cracked exhaust manifold (likely near cylinder 4)
• Leaking exhaust downpipe gasket(s), loose V-band clamps, etc.
Test Procedure
NOTE: Do not remove exhaust manifold for cuff seal installation.
Step
Determine if soot is accumulating near the exhaust manifold. Decision
1
Inspect entire exhaust manifold / gasket area for soot accumulation. Yes: Go to Step 2.
Is soot accumulation present? No: Do not remove exhaust
manifold. Inspect cuff seal slip joint
between ports 2 and 3. Repair if
needed. After repairs are complete,
retest for original problem.
Figure 2
A. Acceptable Gasket Position Between Cylinders 2 and 3
Figure 3
A. Unacceptable Gasket Position Between Cylinders 2 and 3
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 47
Figure 4
A. Acceptable Gasket Protrusion at Cylinder 6
Figure 5
A. Unacceptable Gasket Protrusion at Cylinder 6
48 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Step
Determine if exhaust manifold gasket is out of position. Decision
3
A. Inspect top and bottom of exhaust manifold gasket. Yes: Install new exhaust manifold
and gasket kit. Inspect cuff seal on
B. Determine if exhaust manifold gasket holes are aligned halfway or
exhaust manifold slip joint between
better with respect to bolt hole in the cylinder head. See (Figure 2) and
ports 2 and 3. Repair if needed.
(Figure 3).
After repairs are complete, retest
C. Determine if exhaust manifold gasket protrudes from manifold flange for original problem.
more then 3/8 inch (0.95 cm) at cylinder 6 exhaust port. See (Figure 4)
and (Figure 5) .
Is exhaust manifold gasket out of proper position? No: Go to Step 4.
Step Determine if soot has accumulated in other areas near the exhaust
Decision
4 manifold.
Inspect for soot accumulation at the following areas: Yes: Inspect exhaust downpipe
gasket(s) for leaks or loose v-band
• Turbocharger housings
clamps. Repair as necessary.
• Top of EGR cooler housing Inspect cuff seal on exhaust
manifold slip joint between ports
• EGR crossover pipe
2 and 3. Repair if needed. After
• Exhaust downpipe connections repairs are complete, retest for
original problem.
Is soot buildup present in these locations? No: Go to Step 5.
Step
Determine if exhaust manifold is cracked. Decision
5
Inspect exhaust manifold for cracks, especially near cylinder 4. Yes: Install new exhaust manifold
and gasket kit. Inspect cuff seal on
exhaust manifold slip joint between
ports 2 and 3. Repair if needed.
After repairs are complete, retest
for original problem.
Is exhaust manifold cracked? No: End Diagnostic Steps.
Overview
Determine reason engine will not crank or will not crank fast enough to start the engine.
Possible Causes
• Failed batteries or low charge
• Corroded or loose battery cables
• Master battery switch turned Off, or Open battery cable circuit
• Starting system faults
• Crank inhibit fault
• Charging system faults
• Internal engine damage (hydro lock due to Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) cooler or fuel injector tip failure,
etc.)
• Starter or flywheel gear binding or not engaging properly
• Power Take Off (PTO) or engine drive engaged
NOTE: See appropriate Truck Electrical System Troubleshooting Guide for additional starting and charging
system information.
Test Procedure
WARNING:
To prevent personal injury or death when working with batteries, always wear face or eye
protection, have water supply available, ensure good ventilation, and be sure no flames
or sparks are present.
Step 3 Determine if master battery switch is Off or battery cable circuit has high Decision
resistance.
Turn ignition key to the Run position and observe instrument panel lights and listen for Yes: Go to Step 4.
injector pre-cycle.
No: Turn master battery
Do instrument panel lights come On and did injectors pre-cycle? switch On or fix battery
cable circuit. After repairs
are complete, retest for
original problem.
CAUTION:
Step 4 Determine if batteries are able to deliver appropriate current to start engine. Decision
Perform Electrical System Test (page 1577). Yes: Go to Step 5.
Do batteries pass test? No: Slow charge or replace
each battery that fails test.
After repairs are complete,
retest for original problem.
Step 6 Determine if engine has internal damage or starter / flywheel gears are binding. Decision
Using Engine Rotation Tool ZTSE6072, rotate crankshaft by hand to determine if Yes: Go to Step 7.
starter/flywheel gears are binding or engine has internal damage.
Does crankshaft rotate appropriately? No: Go to Step 8.
Overview
Diagnose engine no start in cold ambient conditions (40°F {4°C} or colder).
Possible Causes
• Engine Coolant Temperature 1 (ECT1) sensor or circuit fault
• Engine Oil Temperature (EOT) sensor or circuit fault
• Low cylinder compression
• Failed intake air grid heater
• Open or shorted IAH grid heater wiring (high current)
• Failed Intake Air Heater Relay
• Intake Air Heater Control (IAHC) circuit fault (relay control)
• Open or shorted IAH relay wiring (high current)
• Failed engine coolant heater
• Failed oil pan heater
Test Procedure
Step 2 Check for Intake Air Heater Control (IAHC) Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC). Decision
Using Electronic Service Tool (EST), check DTC list for SPN 729 Intake Air Heater Yes: Go to Fault Code
Control (IAHC) fault codes. Diagnostics for SPN 729
fault codes.
Are any SPN 729 fault codes active? No: Go to Step 3.
Overview
Engine will not re-start, after being run to operating temperature.
Possible Causes
• Injection Control Pressure (ICP) leak
• ICP circuit fault
• Combustion leak to low-pressure fuel system (injector)
Test Procedure
Step 3 With engine at operating temperature, check Injection– Control Pressure (ICP) Decision
at Key-On Engine-Off (KOEO).
A. Do not crank or run engine for 3 minutes or more, to allow ICP to bleed off. Yes: Go to SPN 164 FMI
0 (page 360) Fault Code
B. Using Electronic Service Tool (EST) with Navistar® Engine Diagnostics, check
Diagnostics.
ICP at KOEO.
Step 4 With engine at operating temperature, record snapshot of engine cranking Decision
data.
Perform Engine Cranking Test (page 1374). Yes: Go to Step 5.
Are ICP and Injection Pressure Regulator (IPR) within cranking specification?
No: Go to CPA
High-Pressure Oil Pump
(HPOP) Test (page 1440).
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 55
Step 6 Measure fuel pressure to determine if combustion pressure is leaking into Decision
the fuel system.
Perform Fuel Delivery Pressure (FDP) Test (page 1554). Yes: Remove each fuel
injector and inspect injector
Is fuel pressure greater than specification and/or erratic?
seals and bottom of injector
for burning. After repairs are
complete, retest for original
problem.
No: End Diagnostic Steps.
Overview
Determine reason engine cranks but will not start.
Possible Causes
• Engine Control Module (ECM) fault
• No Start related Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC)
• Air intake restriction
• Exhaust restriction
• Low Injection Control Pressure (ICP) or ICP leaks
• Injection Pressure Regulator (IPR) fault
• Low Fuel Delivery Pressure (FDP)
• Engine compression loss or mechanical problems
• Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) system fault
• Combustion into fuel system
Test Procedure
Step 4 Determine if engine is able to build Injection Control Pressure (ICP). Decision
Review Engine Cranking Test (page 1374) data. Yes: Go to Step 5.
Are ICP and Injection Pressure Regulator (IPR) both in specification?
No: Go to CPA
High-Pressure Oil Pump
(HPOP) Test (page 1440).
Step 5 Determine if engine is able to build Fuel Delivery Pressure (FDP). Decision
Record Snapshot of KOEO Data (page 1330) and review Engine Cranking Test (page Yes: Go to Step 6.
1374).
Is FDP in specification during KOEO and cranking tests?
No: Go to 8.1 Fuel Delivery
Pressure (page 119).
Step 7 Measure fuel pressure to determine if combustion pressure is leaking into Decision
the fuel system.
Perform Fuel Delivery Pressure (FDP) Test (page 1554). Yes: Inspect fuel injector
seals and bottom of each
Is fuel pressure greater then specification and/or erratic?
injector for burning. After
repairs are complete, retest
for original problem.
No: End Diagnostic Steps.
Overview
Diagnose engine hard to start in cold ambient conditions (40°F {4°C} or colder).
Possible Causes
• Engine Coolant Temperature 1 (ECT1) sensor or circuit fault
• Engine Oil Temperature (EOT) sensor or circuit fault
• Low cylinder compression
• Failed intake air grid heater
• Open or shorted Intake Air Heater (IAH) grid heater wiring (high current)
• Failed intake air heater relay
• Intake Air Heater Control (IAHC) circuit fault (relay control)
• Open or shorted IAH relay wiring (high current)
• Failed engine coolant heater
• Failed oil pan heater
Test Procedure
Step 2 Check for Intake Air Heater Control (IAHC) Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC). Decision
Using Electronic Service Tool (EST), check DTC list for SPN 729 IAHC fault codes. Yes: Go to Fault Code
Diagnostics for SPN 729
fault code.
Are any SPN 729 fault codes pending or active? No: Go to Step 3.
Overview
Diagnose engine hard to re-start after being run up to operating temperature.
NOTE: Do not replace Injection Control Pressure (ICP) sensor unless directed by diagnostic procedure.
Possible Causes
• Injection Control Pressure (ICP) leak
• ICP circuit fault
• Combustion leak to low-pressure fuel system (injector)
Test Procedure
Step 3 With engine at operating temperature, check Key-On Engine-Off (KOEO) Decision
Injection Control Pressure (ICP).
A. Do not crank or run engine for 3 minutes or more, to allow Injection Control Yes: Go to SPN 164 FMI
Pressure (ICP) to bleed off. 0 (page 360) Fault Code
Diagnostics.
B. Using Electronic Service Tool (EST), check ICP at KOEO.
Is ICP above KOEO specification?
No: Go to Step 4.
Step 4 Determine if ICP and Injection Pressure Regulator (IPR) are within cranking Decision
specification.
With engine at operating temperature, perform Engine Cranking Test (page 1374). Yes: Go to Step 5.
Are ICP and Injection Pressure Regulator (IPR) within cranking specification?
No: Go to CPA
High-Pressure Oil Pump
(HPOP) Test (page 1440).
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 61
Step 6 Measure fuel pressure to determine if combustion pressure is leaking into Decision
fuel system.
Perform Fuel Delivery Pressure (FDP) Test (page 1554). Yes: Remove each fuel
injector and inspect injector
Is fuel pressure greater than specification and/or erratic?
seals and bottom of injector
for burning. After repairs are
complete, retest for original
problem.
No: End Diagnostic Steps.
Overview
Engine is able to start (possibly briefly), but is not able to continue to run.
Possible Causes
• Damaged or restricted intake: Change Air Cooler (CAC), Engine Throttle Valve (ETV), Mass Air Flow (MAF),
air filter, intake piping, clamps, connections, etc.
• Damaged or restricted exhaust: Diesel Oxidation Catalyst (DOC), Diesel Particulate Filter (DPF), Exhaust
Back Pressure Valve (EBPV), exhaust piping, etc.
• Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) valve (stuck or sticking open)
• Combustion gasses in fuel (injector)
Test Procedure
Step 4 Determine if Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) valve is stuck or sticking open. Decision
Perform EGRV Operational Test (page 1543). Yes: Go to Step 5.
Does EGR system pass EGRV Operational Test?
No: Repair EGR system
problem. After repairs are
complete, retest for original
problem.
Step 6 Measure fuel pressure to determine if combustion pressure is leaking into Decision
the fuel system.
Perform Fuel Delivery Pressure (FDP) Test (page 1554). Yes: Inspect fuel injector
seals and bottom of each
Is fuel pressure greater then specification and / or erratic?
injector for burning. After
repairs are complete, retest
for original problem.
No: End Diagnostic Steps.
Overview
Diagnose cause of engine running rough or surging at idle. It is normal for engine to idle rough until engine
coolant temperature reaches approximately 141°F (61°C) or more.
NOTE: Do not replace Injection Control Pressure (ICP) sensor unless directed by diagnostic procedure.
Possible Causes
• Injection Control Pressure (ICP)
• Injection Pressure Regulator (IPR)
• Fuel Delivery Pressure (FDP) (low pressure, aerated fuel, etc.)
• Injector circuit or mechanical failure
• Engine compression loss in one or more cylinders
• Engine air intake leaks (unmetered air entering engine air intake)
• Engine accessory dragging or locking up (A/C compressor, belt tensioner, fan drive, etc.)
Test Procedure
Step 5 Determine if injectors and injector circuits are operating properly. Decision
Perform CPA Cold Idle Test (page 1407) and CPA Hot Idle Test (page 1421). Yes, injector fault: Check
resistance of suspect injector
Does CPA Cold Idle Test and / or CPA Hot Idle Test determine a fault?
circuit. Repair circuit problem(s).
If circuit checks are good, replace
injector. Perform Injector Coil
End of Motion (CEOM) Reset
Procedure (page 1334) and
Injector Coking Accumulation
Reset Procedure (page 1338).
After repairs are complete, retest
for original problem.
Yes, high-speed fluctuation: Check
resistance in injector circuits
through the UVC gasket. Repair
circuit problem(s). If UVC checks
are good, go to CPA High-Pressure
Oil Pump (HPOP) Test (page
1440).
No: Go to Step 6.
CAUTION:
To prevent engine damage, do not run engine more than 2 minutes with accessory drive
belts disconnected.
Overview
Engine without a load, is not able to increase rpm up to rated speed.
NOTE: Do not replace Injection Control Pressure (ICP) sensor unless directed by diagnostic procedure.
Possible Causes
• Accelerator Pedal Position (APP)
• Injection Control Pressure (ICP)
• Injection Pressure Regulator (IPR)
• Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR)
• Exhaust restriction
• Engine air restriction
• Fuel Delivery Pressure (FDP)
Test Procedure
Step 2 Determine if Accelerator Pedal Position (APP) meets full range %. Decision
Review engine running snapshot: Verify APP % at idle and at full throttle. Yes: Go to Step 3.
Is Accelerator Pedal Position: 0% at idle, and 99% or greater at full throttle?
No: Repair APP sensor
or circuit problem. After
repairs are complete,
retest for original problem.
Step 3 Determine if Injection Control Pressure (ICP) system is operating properly. Decision
Review engine running snapshot: Verify Injection Control Pressure is approximately the Yes: Go to Step 4.
same as ICP Desired.
Step 4 Determine if Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) system is operating properly. Decision
Review engine running snapshot: Verify EGR valve remains closed (35%). Yes: Go to Step 5.
Is EGR Position 35%?
No: Go to SPN 2791 FMI
7 (page 817) Fault Code
Diagnostics. After repairs
are complete, retest for
original problem.
Overview
Engine cylinder compression popping back through the intake.
Possible Causes
• Sticking, damaged, or leaking intake or exhaust valve(s)
• Damaged pushrod(s)
• Damaged rocker arm or shaft
• Failed roller tappet assembly
• Failed camshaft
Test Procedure
Step 3 Inspect valve train for loose or damaged rocker arm assembly, or valve Decision
lash out of adjustment.
A. Remove valve cover. See Engine Service Manual . Yes, damaged rocker arm
assembly: Replace damaged
B. Inspect valve train for loose or damaged rocker arms, or valve lash out of
valve train components. After
adjustment (focusing on any cylinders with low compression from Step 1).
repairs are complete, retest for
C. Measure valve lash. original problem.
Is valve train for any cylinders loose, damaged, or valve lash out of adjustment?
Yes, valve lash out of
adjustment: Perform Cleaning
and Inspection of Push rods,
and Measure Camshaft Lobe
Lift in the Engine Service
Manual. If camshaft lobe lift
is out of specification, replace
camshaft.
No: End Diagnostic Steps.
70 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Overview
Vehicle or engine is not able to accelerate properly while under a load.
NOTE: Perform a MAF Sensor Calibration after doing repairs that change engine air intake, exhaust, or Exhaust
Gas Recirculation (EGR) flow characteristics.
NOTE: Do not replace Injection Control Pressure (ICP) sensor unless directed by diagnostic procedure.
Possible Causes
• Vehicle overloaded (load higher then engine designed for)
• Road speed governor programmable parameter set too low
• Injection Control Pressure (ICP)
• Injection Pressure Regulator (IPR)
• Engine Control Module (ECM) barometric pressure error
• Exhaust restriction
• Boost control system fault
• Fuel Delivery Pressure (FDP)
• Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) valve stuck or sticking Open
• Intake restriction
• Turbocharger coking or damage
• Failed high-pressure turbocharger
• Failed low-pressure turbocharger
• Low compression
• Engine compression brake engaged when not commanded.
Test Procedure
Step 3 Verify Road Speed Governor programmable parameter is set above desired Decision
vehicle speed.
A. Key-On Engine-Off (KOEO). Yes: Go to Step 4.
B. Connect Electronic Service Tool (EST) and log-in.
C. Select: Sessions > Parameters > Max Vehicle Speed with Road Speed Limiting
On, OR Road Speed Limiting Secondary Vehicle Speed Limit.
Are Road Speed Limiting programmable parameters set above desired vehicle speed? No: Set Road Speed
Limiting programmable
parameters to maximum
desired vehicle speed. After
repairs are complete, retest
for original problem.
Step 4 Determine if engine compression brake is operating properly (if equipped). Decision
Review 0 to 60 snapshot: verify BCP actual is approximately the same as BCP desired. Yes: Go to Step 5.
Is BCP actual approximately the same as BCP desired; and when desired is 0, actual No: Go to 9.2 Engine
is below 100 psi? Compression Brake
Engaged when Not
Commanded (page 127).
Step 5 Determine if Injection Control Pressure (ICP) system is operating properly. Decision
Review 0 to 60 snapshot: verify Injection Control Pressure is approximately the same as Yes: Go to Step 6.
ICP Desired.
Is Injection Control Pressure approximately the same as ICP Desired? No: Go to CPA
High-Pressure Oil Pump
(HPOP) Test (page 1440).
Step 6 Determine if Injection Pressure Regulator (IPR) system is operating properly. Decision
Review 0 to 60 snapshot: verify IPR Ctrl is less than 80%. Yes: Go to CPA
High-Pressure Oil Pump
(HPOP) Test (page 1440).
Is IPR Ctrl 80% or greater? No: Go to Step 7.
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 73
Step 7 Verify Engine Control Module (ECM) is reading proper Barometric Absolute Decision
Pressure for local elevation and barometric pressure.
A. Review 0 to 60 snapshot: determine recorded Barometric Absolute Pressure. Yes: Go to Step 8.
B. Determine local elevation and barometric pressure. (Examples: 14.7 psia at sea
level, 13.2 psia at 3000 ft., 11.8 psia at 6000 ft., 10.1 psia at 10,000 ft.)
Step 11 Determine if Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) valve is operating properly. Decision
Review 0 to 60 snapshot: verify EGR Position is approximately the same as EGR Valve Yes: Go to Step 12.
CTL.
Is EGR Position approximately the same as EGR Valve CTL? No: Go to SPN 2791 FMI
7 (page 817) Fault Code
Diagnostics. After repairs
are complete, retest for
original problem.
Step 13 Determine if Intake Manifold Pressure (IMP) during acceleration is reasonable. Decision
Review 0 to 60 snapshot: verify IMP is at Full Load specification or higher for specific Yes: Go to Step 23.
rating of engine. IMP can vary based on ECM calibration (engine rating) and vehicle
weight.
Is IMP at Full Load specification or higher, for specific rating? No: Go to Step 14.
Step 14 Inspect for engine air intake (boost) leaks or restrictions. Decision
A. Perform Intake Air Inspection (page 1648). Yes: Go to Step 15.
B. Perform High-Pressure Charge Air Cooler (HPCAC) Pressure Test (page 1545).
Overview
Engine power or speed (rpm) varies unexpectedly by more than 50 rpm under a load.
NOTE: Perform a MAF Sensor Calibration after doing repairs that change engine air intake, exhaust, or Exhaust
Gas Recirculation (EGR) flow characteristics.
NOTE: Do not replace Injection Control Pressure (ICP) sensor unless directed by diagnostic procedure.
Possible Causes
• Accelerator Pedal Position (APP) sensor or circuit
• Exhaust Back Pressure Valve (EBPV)
• Engine Throttle Valve (ETV)
• Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) valve stuck or sticking
• Injection Control Pressure (ICP) system
• Injection Pressure Regulator (IPR)
• Fuel Delivery Pressure (FDP)
• Air intake (boost) leaks
• Engine compression loss of one or more cylinders
• Injector circuit or mechanical problem
Test Procedure
Step 2 Determine if Accelerator Pedal Position (APP) signal is correct and stable. Decision
Review 0 to 60 Test data: Verify APP signal moves smoothly as the throttle is depressed Yes: Go to Step 3.
and does not jump unexpectedly.
Is APP signal stable and not jumping unexpectedly, 0% at idle, and 99% or greater at full No: Repair APP sensor or
throttle? circuit problem. After repairs
are complete, retest for
original problem.
82 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Step 3 Determine if Exhaust Back Pressure Valve (EBPV) is operating properly. Decision
A. Start engine. Yes: Go to Step 4.
B. Visually verify if EBPV is fully open and not moving (unless in regen mode).
Look at valve and verify rod is fully retracted and not moving.
C. Verify if EBPV cycles opened and closed three times after engine shutdown.
Some engines will only cycle the EBPV if Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT)
is 140°F (60° C).
Is EBPV fully open and not moving (unless in regen mode), and does EBPV cycle after No: Diagnose and repair
shutdown? EBPV system. After repairs
are complete, retest for
original problem.
Step 5 Determine if Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) system is operating properly. Decision
Review 0 to 60 Test data: verify if EGR Position is approximately the same as EGR Yes: Go to Step 6.
Valve CTL.
Is EGR Position approximately the same as EGR Valve CTL? No: Go to SPN 2791 FMI
7 (page 817) Fault Code
Diagnostics. After repairs
are complete, retest for
original problem.
Step 6 Determine if Injection Control Pressure (ICP) system is operating properly. Decision
Review 0 to 60 Test data: verify Injection Control Pressure is approximately the same as Yes: Go to Step 7.
ICP Desired.
Is Injection Control Pressure approximately the same as ICP Desired? No: Go to CPA
High-Pressure Oil Pump
(HPOP) Test (page 1440).
Step 7 Determine if Injection Pressure Regulator (IPR) system is operating properly. Decision
Review 0 to 60 Test data: verify if IPR Ctrl is less than 80% while under load or less Yes: Go to CPA
than 35% when stationary. High-Pressure Oil Pump
(HPOP) Test (page 1440).
Is IPR Ctrl 80% or greater under load, or greater than 35% when stationary? No: Go to Step 8.
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 83
Overview
Engine is not able to increase rpm up to desired speed during Power Take Off (PTO) operation.
NOTE: Perform a MAF Sensor Calibration after doing repairs that change engine air intake, exhaust, or Exhaust
Gas Recirculation (EGR) flow characteristics.
NOTE: Do not replace Injection Control Pressure (ICP) sensor unless directed by diagnostic procedure.
Possible Causes
• PTO circuit or system fault
• Auxiliary Engine Speed Control (AESC) set speed (not set high enough or not set correctly)
• Accelerator Pedal Position (APP)
• Injection Control Pressure (ICP)
• Injection Pressure Regulator (IPR)
• Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR)
• Exhaust restriction
• Intake restriction
• Fuel Delivery Pressure (FDP)
Test Procedure
NOTE: See CT-471 Body Builder books for additional PTO and AESC information.
Step 3 Verify if Auxiliary Engine Speed Control (AESC) / remote engine throttle Decision
programmable parameters are set above desired speed.
A. Key-On Engine-Off (KOEO). Yes: Go to Step 4.
B. Connect Electronic Service Tool (EST) (page 1345) with Navistar® Engine
Diagnostics and log in.
Step 4 Determine if Accelerator Pedal Position (APP) meets full range percent. Decision
Review 0 to 60 Test data: Verify APP % at idle and full throttle. Yes: Go to Step 5.
Is Accelerator Peddle Position: 0% at idle, and 99% or greater at full throttle?
No: Repair APP sensor
or circuit problem. After
repairs are complete,
retest for original
problem.
Step 5 Determine if Injection Control Pressure (ICP) system is operating properly. Decision
Review 0 to 60 Test data: Verify if Injection Control Pressure is approximately the same Yes: Go to Step 6.
as ICP Desired.
Is Injection Control Pressure approximately the same as ICP Desired?
No: Go to CPA
High-Pressure Oil Pump
(HPOP) Test (page
1440).
Step 6 Determine if Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) system is operating properly. Decision
Review 0 to 60 Test data: Verify if EGR Position is approximately the same as EGR Valve Yes: Go to Step 7.
CTL.
Is EGR Position approximately the same as EGR Valve CTL?
No: Go to SPN 2791 FMI
7 Fault Code Diagnostics
(page 817). After repairs
are complete, retest for
original problem.
86 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Overview
Determine reason coolant overflows out of deaeration tank with the deaeration tank cap installed.
Possible Causes
• Air compressor
• Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) cooler
• Cracked cylinder sleeve
• Cylinder head gasket
• Incorrect cylinder sleeve protrusion
Test Procedure
WARNING:
To prevent personal injury or death, wear safety glasses with side shields.
Step 2 Verify coolant overflow occurs before coolant over temperature. Decision
Does coolant overflow occur before cooling system goes over temperature? Yes: Go to Step 3.
No: Go to 6.2 Coolant Over
Temperature (page 90).
CAUTION:
Do not run engine for more than 2 minutes with air compressor
coolant hoses pinched off.
Are air bubbles present in test beaker with air compressor coolant hoses pinched off? No: Replace air compressor.
After repairs are complete,
retest for original problem.
CAUTION:
To prevent engine damage, when replacing cylinder sleeves inspect piston cooling tubes
for damage or obstructions.
Step 6 Inspect underside of crankcase and cylinder sleeves seals for cooling system Decision
leaks.
A. Remove Oil Pan (see Engine Service Manual). Yes: Repair crankcase or
cylinder liner crevice seal.
B. Perform Cooling System Pressure Test (page 1603) while inspecting inside of
After repairs are complete,
crankcase for cooling system leaks.
retest for original problem.
Were any cylinder liner crevice seals or cooling system leaks found? No: Go to Step 7.
Step 7 Inspect cylinder sleeves for leaks, staining, pinholes, and cracks. Decision
NOTE: Cylinder head will need to be removed to perform this test. Yes: Go to Step 8.
Step 8 Determine if cylinder sleeve protrusion is in specification for each cylinder. Decision
Measure cylinder sleeve protrusion using Sleeve Protrusion Hold Down Clamps Yes: Go to Step 9.
ZTSE4825 and a dial indicator with magnetic base. See Engine Service Manual.
Is Sleeve protrusion in specification for all 6 cylinders? No: Go to Engine
Service Manual for
counterbore and cylinder
sleeve measurement and
resurfacing.
Overview
Determine reason engine cooling system goes over temperature or over heats.
Possible Causes
• Cooling package debris clogging
• Accessory belt / tensioner failure
• Inoperative / slipping fan clutch
• Inoperative / damaged cooling fan or shroud
• Damaged water pump impeller
• Stuck closed thermostat
Test Procedure
WARNING:
To prevent personal injury or death, wear safety glasses with side shields.
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 91
Step 4 Determine if coolant is flowing properly in the deaeration tank and coolant lines. Decision
A. Fill deaeration tank with coolant to proper level. Yes: Go to Step 5.
B. Run engine.
C. Observe deaeration tank and coolant lines for coolant flow.
Is coolant circulating in the deaeration tank?
No: Go to Step 8.
Step 8 Remove water pump and inspect water pump and front cover for damage Decision
or cavitation.
Does water pump and/or front cover have damage or cavitation? Yes: Replace damaged
components. After repairs
are complete, retest for
original problem.
No: End Diagnostic Steps.
Overview
Diagnosis reason engine will not get up to operating temperature.
Possible Causes
• Thermostat stuck Open
• Winterfront not installed during cold ambient temperatures
• Cooling fan stuck On
WARNING:
To prevent personal injury or death, wear safety glasses with side shields.
NOTE: In cold ambient temperatures, and low engine loads, engine will take longer to heat up.
NOTE: Minimum engine operating temperature is approximately 180°F (82°C).
Test Procedure
Step 2 Determine if engine cooling fan stays On while engine temperature is below Decision
fan engagement temperature.
A. Run engine at high idle for 10 minutes. Yes: Repair cooling fan or
fan controls. After repairs
B. Attempt to run engine up to operating temperature.
are complete, retest for
NOTE: Viscous fan may be engaged while engine is cold. original problem.
Does engine cooling fan stay engaged before operating temperature is reached?
No: Go to Step 3
Step 3 Determine if proper winter front is installed during cold ambient temperature. Decision
Is proper winterfront installed during cold ambient temperatures? Yes: Replace thermostat.
After repairs are complete,
retest for original problem.
No: Install proper winter
front on vehicle during cold
ambient temperatures. After
repairs are complete, retest
for original problem.
94 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Overview
Determine reason engine coolant is leaking into exhaust system.
Possible Causes
• Failed Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) cooler
• Interstage Cooler (ISC) leaking
• Aftertreatment Fuel Injector (AFTFI) cracked
• Head gasket leaking
Test Procedure
Overview
Determine what component is causing engine coolant to leak into the engine air intake.
Possible Causes
• Failed Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) cooler
• Failed Interstage Cooler (ISC)
Test Procedure
Overview
Determine component causing coolant to leak into the engine oil.
Possible Causes
• Cracked cylinder liner
• Leaking cylinder liner o-ring(s)
• Failed air compressor
NOTE: White condensation under the oil filler cap and on dipstick is normal.
Test Procedure
Step 2 Determine if coolant is leaking into air compressor oil return. Decision
Perform Air Compressor Coolant Leak Test (page 1611). Yes: Repair or replace air
compressor. After repairs
Does coolant come out of air compressor oil return line?
are complete, retest for
original problem. Change
engine oil and filter.
No: Go to Step 3.
Overview
Determine reason fluid or solid debris are in engine oil. Some fine metal residue is normal in engine oil.
Possible Causes
• Leaking cylinder liners
• External debris
• Valve train failure / internal engine damage
• Wrong fluid added during servicing
Test Procedure
Step 4 Determine if valve train damage is causing ferrous metal contamination in Decision
engine oil.
A. Remove valve cover (see Engine Service Manual). Yes: Repair loose or
damaged valve train
B. Inspect push tubes, rocker arms, valve bridges for damage and loose
components. Change
components.
engine oil and filter. After
C. Verify valve lash is set correctly. repairs are complete, retest
for original problem.
Is valve train loose or damaged?
No: Remove oil pan.
Inspect rotating assembly
and crankcase for damage.
Repair damage. Change
engine oil and filter. After
repairs are complete, retest
for original problem.
Step 6 Determine if camshaft bearings are causing non-ferrous metal contamination Decision
in engine oil.
A. Remove oil pan (see Engine Service Manual). Yes: Replace camshaft
bearings. Change engine oil
B. Inspect camshaft bearings for damage.
and filter. After repairs are
Are camshaft bearings damaged? complete, retest for original
problem.
No: Go to Step 7.
102 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Step 7 Determine if connecting rod or main bearings are causing non-ferrous metal Decision
contamination in engine oil.
A. Remove three connecting rod caps and three main bearing caps (see Engine Yes, bearing damage only:
Service Manual). Replace worn bearings.
Repair root cause of failure.
B. Inspect bearings for excessive wear.
Change engine oil and filter.
Do connecting rod and / or main bearings have excessive wear? After repairs are complete,
retest for original problem.
Yes, crankshaft damage:
Replace engine. After
repairs are complete, retest
for original problem.
No: Review complaint.
Overview
Determine reason engine oil is leaking into air intake. Some oil film or residue in air intake system is normal.
If required, IK1201117 may provide additional details about selecting correct crankcase breather kit for specific
engines.
Possible Causes
• Restricted air intake / air filter
• Crankcase breather failed
• Failed high-pressure turbocharger
• Failed low-pressure turbocharger
Test Procedure
NOTE: If air inlet is restricted, oil can be drawn from air compressor clean air supply.
Overview
Determine reason engine oil is leaking into exhaust.
Possible Causes
• High-pressure turbocharger
• Low-pressure turbocharger
• Internal engine damage
Test Procedure
Overview
Determine reason engine oil pressure is low and / or oil pressure gauge reads low.
Possible Causes
• Engine oil pressure gauge or circuit
• Engine Oil Pressure (EOP) sensor
• Incorrect oil viscosity
• Oil suction tube or gasket
• Piston cooling tubes
• Connecting rod and / or main bearings
• Oil pressure regulator
• Loose rocker arm bolts / worn rocker arms or rocker arm shaft
• Oil pump
Test Procedure
Step 2 Determine if instrument panel oil pressure gauge is working properly. Decision
®
A. Connect Electronic Service Tool (EST) with Navistar Engine Diagnostics and log-in. Yes: Go to Step 3.
B. Select: Pressure tab. No: Repair instrument
panel oil pressure gauge
C. Monitor Engine Oil Pressure.
or circuit. After repairs
Does Engine Oil Pressure match oil pressure shown on instrument panel oil pressure gauge? are complete, retest for
original problem.
Step 3 Determine if Engine Oil Pressure (EOP) sensor is operating properly. Decision
Perform Oil Pressure Verification Test (page 1625). Yes: Replace EOP
sensor. After repairs
Does pressure gauge read engine oil pressure in specification?
are complete, retest for
original problem.
No: Go to Step 4.
110 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
CAUTION:
Low viscosity engine oil will cause lower engine oil pressure in hot ambient temperatures
and high engine loads.
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 111
Step 4 Determine if engine has correct oil viscosity for current ambient temperatures Decision
and operating conditions.
A. Review oil change records. Yes: Go to Step 5.
B. See Engine Operation and Maintenance Manual “SAE Oil Viscosity Grades and No: Change engine oil.
Temperature Ranges” for correct oil viscosity for ambient temperatures and Add correct viscosity
operating conditions. oil for conditions. After
repairs are complete,
Does engine have the correct oil viscosity for current ambient temperatures and operating
retest for original
conditions?
problem.
Step 6 Determine if oil suction tube, piston cooling tubes, main or connecting rod Decision
bearings are causing low oil pressure.
A. Perform Oil and Crankcase Inspection (page 1662). Yes, oil suction tube
or gasket damaged or
B. Remove three connecting rod caps, and three main bearing caps.
restricted: Install new
C. Measure connecting rod, and main bearing clearances (see Engine Service oil suction tube and
Manual). gasket. After repairs
are complete, retest for
Is oil suction tube or piston cooling tubes cracked, damaged, or restricted; or are connecting
original problem.
rod or main bearings out of specification?
Yes, piston cooling
tube(s) damaged or
restricted: Install new
piston cooling tubes
(see Engine Service
Manual). After repairs
are complete, retest for
original problem.
Yes, connecting rod or
main bearings out of
specification: Install new
connecting rod and/or
main bearings. After
repairs are complete,
retest for original
problem.
No: Go to Step 7.
112 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Step 7 Determine if loose or worn valve train components are causing low oil pressure. Decision
A. Remove valve cover (see Engine Service Manual). Yes: Repair loose
or worn valve train
B. Inspect for loose rocker arm bolts, worn rocker arms, or worn rocker arm shaft.
components. After
Are rocker arm bolts loose, or are rocker arms or rocker shaft worn excessively? repairs are complete,
retest for original
problem.
No: Go to Step 8.
Step 8 Determine if oil pump, oil pump housing, or front cover are causing low oil Decision
pressure.
A. Remove drive belts (see Engine Service Manual). Yes: Replace damaged
or excessively worn
B. Remove vibration damper.
components. After
C. Remove damper hub. repairs are complete,
retest for original
D. Remove oil pump housing.
problem.
E. Inspect oil pump housing, front cover, inner and outer rotor for damage and
No: End Diagnostic
excessive wear.
Steps.
F. Perform Oil Pump Side Clearance, and Oil Pump End Clearance measurements
(see Engine Service Manual).
Does oil pump, oil pump housing, or front cover have excessive wear, or are oil pump
clearances out of specification?
Overview
Determine reason engine oil pressure is high and / or oil pressure gauge reads high.
Possible Causes
• Engine oil pressure gauge or circuit
• Engine Oil Pressure (EOP) sensor
• Incorrect oil viscosity
• Oil pressure regulator
Test Procedure
Step 2 Determine if instrument panel oil pressure gauge is working properly. Decision
A. Connect Electronic Service Tool (EST) with Navistar® Engine Diagnostics and log-in. Yes: Go to Step 3.
B. Select: Pressure tab. No: Repair instrument
panel oil pressure gauge
C. Monitor Engine Oil Pressure.
or circuit. After repairs
Does Engine Oil Pressure match oil pressure shown on instrument panel oil pressure gauge? are complete, retest for
original problem.
Step 3 Determine if Engine Oil Pressure (EOP) sensor is operating properly. Decision
Perform Oil Pressure Verification Test (page 1625). Yes: Replace EOP
sensor. After repairs
Does pressure gauge read engine oil pressure in specification?
are complete, retest for
original problem.
No: Go to Step 4.
CAUTION:
High viscosity engine oil will cause higher engine oil pressure in cold ambient
temperatures.
114 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Step 4 Determine if engine has correct oil viscosity for current ambient temperatures Decision
and operating conditions.
A. Review oil change records. Yes: Go to Step 5.
B. See Engine Operation and Maintenance Manual “SAE Oil Viscosity Grades and No: Change engine oil.
Temperature Ranges” for correct oil viscosity for ambient temperatures and Add correct viscosity
operating conditions. oil for conditions. After
repairs are complete,
Does engine have the correct oil viscosity for current ambient temperatures and operating
retest for original
conditions?
problem.
Overview
Determine reason engine oil is aerated (air bubbles in oil).
Possible Causes
• Overfilled engine oil
• Oil suction tube or gasket
• Cracked or leaking front cover
• Damaged oil pump gasket or housing
Test Procedure
Step 2 Determine if oil suction tube or gasket is causing oil aeration. Decision
A. Adjust engine oil level to proper level, if not already done. Yes: Go to Step 3.
B. Add two gallons of extra engine oil. No: Replace oil suction
tube and gasket. After
C. Start engine and run for 10 minutes.
repairs are complete,
D. Turn Off engine. retest for original
problem.
E. Check dipstick for oil aeration.
Is engine oil aerated?
Step 3 Determine if oil pump, oil pump housing, or front cover is leaking, cracked Decision
or damaged.
A. Remove drive belts (see Engine Service Manual). Yes: Replace leaking,
cracked or damaged
B. Remove vibration damper.
components. After
C. Remove damper hub. repairs are complete,
retest for original
D. Remove oil pump housing.
problem.
E. Inspect oil pump housing, front cover, inner and outer rotor for leaks, cracks, or
No: Go to Step 4.
damage.
Does oil pump, oil pump housing, or front cover have leaks, cracks, or damage?
116 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Step 4 Determine if front cover and / or oil suction tube is cracked or damaged. Decision
A. Remove oil pan (see Engine Service Manual). Yes: Replace cracked or
damaged components.
B. Inspect front cover and oil suction tube for cracks and damage.
After repairs are
Is front cover or oil suction tube cracked or damaged? complete, retest for
original problem.
No: End Diagnostic
Steps.
Overview
Determine reason Coolant contaminated with lube oil will have oil in the deaeration tank.
Possible Causes
• Failed oil cooler
Required Tools
• Oil Cooler Pressure Test Plate ZTSE4939
• Pressure Test Kit ZTSE4409
• Regulated compressed air
WARNING:
To prevent personal injury or death, do not smoke and keep fuel away from flames and
sparks.
WARNING:
To prevent personal injury or death, wear safety glasses with side shields.
WARNING:
To prevent personal injury or death, do the following when removing the radiator cap or
deaeration cap:
• Allow engine to cool for 15 minutes or more.
• Wrap a thick cloth around the radiator cap or deaeration cap.
• Loosen cap slowly a quarter to half turn to vent pressure.
• Pause for a moment to avoid being scalded by steam.
• Continue to turn cap counterclockwise to remove.
118 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Test Procedure
Step 2 Check for coolant contamination by inspecting deaeration tank for presence Decision
of oil.
A. Place a coolant drain pan under the oil cooler module. Yes: Replace Oil Cooler.
After repairs are made,
B. Remove the coolant drain plug installed in the bottom of the oil cooler module.
perform Cooling Flush
Drain coolant. This procedure will drain the entire cooling system.
Procedure (see iKNow
C. Remove the oil cooler following the procedure in Engine Service Manual. article IK1201248).
D. Perform Oil Cooler Pressure Test (page 1621). No: End diagnostic
steps.
Is there a noticeable leak?
Overview
Diagnosis fuel delivery pressure low or high problem.
Possible Causes
• Low / no fuel in fuel tank(s)
• Restricted fuel strainer
• Fuel filter restriction
• Fuel gelling in cold weather
• Fuel inlet restriction or leak (supply line, tank, pickup, optional primary fuel filter)
• Restricted fuel return line
• Electric fuel pump power, ground, or relay circuits
• Failed fuel pressure regulator
• Leaking or damaged fuel supply or return fittings
• Incorrect fuel pump O-rings
• Failed fuel pump
WARNING:
To prevent personal injury or death, keep fuel away from flame and sparks.
Test Procedure
Step 3 Inspect fuel filter, fuel strainer, and fuel pump O-rings. Decision
A. Disconnect fuel inlet from engine mounted fuel filter module. Yes: Go to Step 4.
B. Inspect and clean fuel inlet fitting of debris. No: Install International®
approved fuel filter.
C. Turn Key On for 20 seconds (to reduce fuel in filter module).
Clean or replace fuel
D. Turn Key OFF.
strainer.
E. Remove and inspect engine mounted fuel filter.
Install proper brown O-rings
F. Remove and inspect fuel pump, strainer, and O-rings. on fuel pump.
NOTE: Low fuel delivery pressure, hard to start, or no start can be caused by non-Original After repairs are complete,
Equipment Manufacturer (OEM) fuel filters and/or wrong O-rings installed on the fuel pump. retest for original problem.
Is fuel filter made by an International® approved manufacturer? Is fuel filter and strainer
clean, and are fuel pump O-rings brown?
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 121
Step 4 Determine if fuel pump will run when provided power and ground. Decision
Yes: Reinstall fuel pump. Go
CAUTION:
to Step 5.
No: Replace electric fuel
Use a 10 amp fuse in the circuit, in case pump is shorted.
pump. After repairs are
With fuel pump removed from engine, provide power and ground to the pump: complete, retest for original
problem.
A. Install Fuel Pump Breakout Harness ZTSE6023 on fuel pump connector, leave
engine harness disconnected.
B. Install power circuit with 10 amp fuse to Pins-4 and 6.
C. Ground Pin-1.
D. Listen for pump running. Let pump run for 30 seconds.
Does pump run?
Step 5 Determine if electric fuel pump power and ground circuits are operating Decision
properly.
Perform Fuel Pump Voltage Test (page 1557). Key must be Off for 10 seconds, or Yes: Go to Step 7.
more, and then cycled On for the Electronic Control Module (ECM) to command the
fuel pump On.
Is voltage reading between Pin-6 and Pin-1, and between Pin-4 and Pin-1 within 0.5 volt No: Leave Breakout
of battery voltage when the fuel pump is energized? Harness connected. Go
to Step 6.
122 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Step 6 Determine if electric fuel pump power circuit is operating properly. Decision
Using a Digital Multimeter (DMM) measure voltage between Pin-4 and ground, and Yes: Repair electric fuel
between Pin-6 and ground, when fuel pump is commanded On. pump ground circuit. After
repairs are complete, retest
for original problem.
Is voltage at pins 4 and 6 within 0.5 volts of battery voltage? No: Repair electric fuel
pump power circuit. After
repairs are complete, retest
for original problem.
Overview
Determine cause of fuel getting into the engine oil.
NOTE: Some fuel in engine oil is normal. Depending on engine drive cycles.
Possible Causes
• Worn piston rings
• Broken fuel injector tip
• Loose fuel injector hold downs
• Leaking fuel injector O-rings
• Extended engine oil service intervals
• Engine misfire
Test Procedure
Step 2 Check for Diagnostics Trouble Codes (DTC) related to excessive fueling. Decision
®
Using Electronic Service Tool (EST) with Navistar Engine Diagnostics, check DTC list for: Yes: Go to Fault
Code Diagnostics for
• SPN 1322 -1328, 4257 Injector (INJ)
appropriate SPN/FMI.
Does EST DTC list have any of the above SPN?
No: Go to Step 3.
Step 5 Determine if engine oil has been changed according to maintenance schedule. Decision
A. Examine last three oil service interval records. Yes: Go to Step 6.
B. Compare oil change records to Operators Operation and Maintenance Manual No: Change engine oil
schedule. and filter. Recommend
customer change
Has oil been changed according to Maintenance Schedule?
engine oil according to
Maintenance Schedule.
Step 6 Determine if fuel injectors are loose or injector seals are leaking. Decision
A. Remove valve cover (see Engine Service Manual). Yes: Remove injectors
and inspect injector
B. Remove high-pressure oil manifold.
O-rings and combustion
C. Re-torque injector hold down clamp bolts. seals. Look for doubled
combustion seals, burned
Is one or more injector hold down loose?
injectors, or burned
O-rings. Repair as
needed. After repairs
are complete, retest for
original problem. Change
engine oil and filter.
No: Change engine oil
and filter. Monitor for fuel
in engine oil: Operate
vehicle for 1/3 of normal
oil change interval and
inspect for fuel in engine
oil.
Overview
Engine compression brake will not activate when commanded On.
Possible Causes
• Incorrect brake lash adjustment
• Brake (oil) pressure relief valve stuck Open
• Brake Control Pressure (BCP) leak (worn brake piston seals, etc.)
• Failed Engine Compression Brake 1 (ECB1) valve
• Engine compression brake switch or circuit inoperative (switch, circuit, or body controller could not enable
brake due to not receiving required signals)
• Engine compression brake control system entry conditions not met
Test Procedure
Step
Perform operational checkout procedure. Decision
1
Did a symptom Fault Code Action Plan (FCAP) bring you here or does the Yes: Go to Step 2.
customers complaint align with this specific symptom procedure?
No: Go to 9.0 Engine Compression
Brake Operational Checkout
Procedure (page 39).
Step Check for Accelerator Pedal Position (APP) or Transmission Output Shaft
Decision
3 Speed (TOSS) Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC).
Using Electronic Service Tool (EST) with Navistar® Engine Diagnostics, check Yes: Got to Fault Code Diagnostics
DTC list for: for SPN 91,191 or 2623.
Step
Verify operator controls are set properly to allow engine brake operation. Decision
4
Verify the following are true: Yes: Go to Step 5.
• Traction Control is not active No: Bring operator controls to
proper condition to allow engine
• Clutch pedal is released
compression brake operation. After
• Cab mounted engine brake ON/OFF switch is set to ON repairs are complete, retest for
original problem.
• Accelerator pedal is not depressed
• Vehicle transmission is in gear (driveline engaged)
• Torque convertor lockup engaged
• Engine Oil temperature is greater than 25°C (77°F)
• Anti-lock Brake System (ABS) not active
• Engine speed is greater than 1000 rpm
Are all the above conditions true?
Step
Determine if Injection Control Pressure (ICP) system is operating properly. Decision
6
Review 0 to 60 snapshot: verify Injection Control Pressure is approximately the Yes: Go to Step 7.
same as ICP Desired.
No: Go to CPA High-Pressure Oil
Is Injection Control Pressure approximately the same as ICP Desired? Pump (HPOP) Test (page 1440).
Step
Determine if ICP system is operating properly. Decision
7
Review 0 to 60 snapshot: Verify ICP Ctrl is less than 80% Yes: Go to CPA High-Pressure Oil
Pump (HPOP) Test (page 1440).
Is ICP Ctrl 80% or greater?
No: Check and adjust brake lash
(see Engine Service Manual). After
repairs are complete, retest for
original problem.
Overview
Engine compression brake activate when Not commanded On.
Possible Causes
• Failed high-pressure oil manifold
• Brake pressure relief valve stuck closed
• Engine Compression Brake 1 (ECB1) solenoid stuck Open or leaking
• ECB1 circuit fault
• Incorrect brake lash adjustment
• Brake Control Pressure (BCP) sensor or circuit fault
Test Procedure
Step
Perform operational checkout procedure. Decision
1
Did a symptom Fault Code Action Plan (FCAP) bring you here or does the Yes: Go to Step 2.
customers complaint align with this specific symptom procedure?
No: Go to 9.0 Engine Compression
Brake Operational Checkout
Procedure (page 39).
NOTE: See latest version of Engine and Aftertreatment Wiring Schematic Form for additional circuit
information.
Step
Determine if ECB1 actuator or O-rings are leaking or damaged. Decision
3
A. Remove ECB1 actuator. See Engine Service Manual. Yes: Replace O-rings and reinstall
original ECB1 (if undamaged). After
B. Check ECB1 actuator and O-rings for leaks or damage.
repairs are complete, retest for
Is ECB1 actuator or O-rings leaking or damaged? original problem.
No: Go to Step 4.
128 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Step
Determine if ECB1 actuator, or high-pressure oil manifold have failed. Decision
4
A. Install new ECB1 actuator. Yes: End Diagnostic Steps.
B. After repairs are complete, retest for original problem. No: Install a new high-pressure
oil manifold. Adjust engine brake
Is engine compression brake engaged when not commanded problem repaired?
lash (see Engine Service Manual).
After repairs are complete, retest
for original problem.
Fault Overview
Fault sets when the Engine Control Module (ECM) senses Exhaust Gas Recirculation Valve Position (EGRP)
temperature is too high.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two trips.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
None
Fault Overview
This fault sets when Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) valve receives a voltage supply of greater than 18 volts
for 5 seconds.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
This is not an EGR valve problem; it is a voltage supply problem.
This fault may set if vehicle has been jump-started or charged using a 24V power supply.
Test 1
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect EGRV connector.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4948 to vehicle harness and leave EGRV disconnected.
Fault Overview
This fault sets when Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) valve receives a voltage supply of less than 8 volts for
13 seconds.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
This is not an EGR valve problem; it is a voltage supply problem.
Test 1
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect EGRV connector.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4948 to vehicle harness, leave EGRV disconnected.
D. Key ON.
138 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Fault Overview
Fault code sets when Engine Control Module (ECM) determines Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) valve is Not
functioning properly when commanded.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
• SPN 27 FMI 0, 3, and 4 • SPN 2791 FMI 2, 3, and 4
(EGR) (EGR)
Fault Facts
This fault is also used to detect EGR valve positive and negative deviation faults.
Step 3 Test for proper Exhaust Gas Recirculation Valve (EGRV) operation. Decision
Perform Exhaust Gas Recirculation Valve (EGRV) Operational Test (page 1543). Yes: Replace EGR valve. After
repairs are complete, retest for
SPN 27 FMI 7.
Is SPN 2791 FMI 7 or SPN 27 FMI 7 Pending or Active in DTC list after running test? No: Fault no longer present at this
time. After repairs are complete,
retest for SPN 27 FMI 7.
Fault Overview
Fault sets when Engine Control Module (ECM) determines Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) valve is not
functioning properly when initialized.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
• SPN 27 FMI 3, 4, and 7 • SPN 2791 FMI 2, 3, 4 and
(EGR) 7 (EGR)
Fault Facts
None
Fault Overview
Fault sets when Engine Control Module (ECM) determines Engine Throttle Position (ETP) signal is erratic.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
SPN 2630 FMI 16
Fault Facts
None
Step 3 Inspect Engine Throttle Valve (ETV) sensor and connector. Decision
A. Key OFF. Yes: Go to Step 4.
B. Disconnect ETV sensor.
C. Check ETV sensor and connector terminals for: damaged or pinched
wires; wet or corroded terminals; loose, bent, or broken pins; or broken
connector housing.
Are ETV sensor connector, harness, and terminals clean and undamaged? No: Repair connector, harness,
or terminal damage. After repairs
are complete, retest for SPN 51
FMI 0.
Step 7 Decision
Check engine fan, fan shroud, and air dams for damage and proper operation. Yes: Go to Step 8.
Are engine fan, fan shroud, and air dams intact and operating properly? No: Repair or replace engine fan,
fan shroud, and/or air dams. After
repairs are complete, retest for
SPN 51 FMI 0.
Fault Overview
Fault sets when Engine Control Module (ECM) determines Engine Throttle Position (ETP) signal does not agree
with Engine Throttle Valve Control (ETV CTL).
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
• SPN 51 FMI 3 and 4 (ETV) • SPN 3464 FMI 3 and 4
(ETV)
Fault Facts
Drive Cycles
Continuous
Possible Causes
• Open ETP Signal Return
• Frozen gears (water ingestion that turned to ice)
• Failed ETV
146 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Step Decision
A. Perform Test 1 (page 147). Yes: Replace ETV. After repairs
are complete, retest for SPN 51
B. Use DMM, measure voltage between Breakout Harness ZTSE4735A
FMI 2.
pin-3 and PWR.
Is voltage B+ ± 0.5 volts? No: Repair Open between ETV
pin-3 and ECM pin E-28. After
repairs are complete, retest for
SPN 51 FMI 2.
See latest version of MaxxForce® DT, 9 and 10 Engine and Aftertreatment Wiring Schematic Form 0000003221
for additional circuit information.
Tools
• Breakout Harness ZTSE4735A (ETV)
• Digital Multimeter (DMM)
Test 1
A. Key OFF.
Fault Overview
Fault code sets when Electronic Control Module (ECM) detects Engine Throttle Position (ETP) signal is greater
than 4.902 volts.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
SPN 3509 FMI 3 and 4
(VREF 1)
Fault Facts
None
Drive Cycles
Key ON
Possible Causes
• ETP circuit short to PWR
• Failed ETV sensor
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 149
Fault Overview
Fault code sets when Electronic Control Module (ECM) detects that Engine Throttle Position (ETP) circuit reading
is less than 0.352 volts.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
SPN 3509 FMI 3 and 4
(VREF 1)
Fault Facts
None
See latest version of MaxxForce® DT, 9, and 10 Engine and Aftertreatment Wiring Schematic Form 0000003221
for additional circuit information.
Tools Required
• Breakout Harness ZTSE4735A
• Breakout Harness ZTSE4498
• Digital Multimeter (DMM)
• Electronic Service Tool (EST) with Navistar® Engine Diagnostics
• Interface cable (RP-1210B-compliant supporting J1939 and J1708)
154 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Test 1
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect Engine Throttle Valve (ETV)
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4735A to vehicle harness connector and leave ETV disconnected.
D. Key ON Engine OFF (KOEO).
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 155
Test 2
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect Engine Throttle Valve (ETV)
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4735A to vehicle harness connector and leave ETV disconnected.
D. Use Breakout Harness ZTSE4498, short Breakout Harness ZTSE4735A pin-1 and pin-5 together.
E. Connect Electronic Service Tool (EST) to vehicle Diagnostic Connector (page 1345).
F. Key ON Engine OFF (KOEO). Log in to Navistar® Engine Diagnostics.
156 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Test 3
A. Key OFF.
B. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4735A to Engine Throttle Valve Position (ETP) vehicle harness connector
and leave ETP disconnected.
C. Use Breakout Harness ZTSE4498, short pin-1 and pin-5 of Breakout Harness ZTSE4735A together.
D. Connect EST to vehicle Diagnostic Connector (page 1345).
E. Key ON Engine OFF (KOEO). Log in to Navistar® Engine Diagnostics.
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 157
Fault Overview
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
None
Step 3 Determine if Engine Throttle Position (ETP) sensor is operating within Decision
specification.
A. Key OFF. Yes: After doing all diagnostic
Steps, if SPN 51 FMI 5 remains,
B. Connect breakout harness ZTSE4735A between ETV and ETV connector.
verify each step was completed
C. Connect EST to vehicle Diagnostic Connector. (page 1345). correctly and proper decision
was made. Notify supervisor for
D. Key ON Engine OFF (KOEO). Log in to Navistar® Engine Diagnostics.
further action.
E. Do Key On Engine Off (KOEO) Output State High or Low Test (page 1359).
Is voltage within specification (page 1677)? No: Replace ETV. After repairs
are complete, retest for SPN 51
FMI 5.
Fault Overview
The Engine Control Module (ECM) senses a positive or negative error in Engine Throttle Position (ETP) sensor
based on actual throttle position minus throttle position set point after 25 seconds. ETP must be in closed loop
control.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
SPN 51 FMI 3 and 4 (ETV) SPN 3464 FMI 3 and 4
(ETV)
Fault Facts
Vehicles that chronically experience this fault condition in cold weather may require use of winter fronts to help
with issue. Note that an open ETP Signal Return (SRTN) does NOT set a circuit fault (Type 2 error) and does
set a mechanically sticking fault (Type 1 error). voltage is approximately constant 4 volts with an open SRTN.
See latest version of MaxxForce® DT, 9, and 10 Engine and Aftertreatment Wiring Schematic Form 0000003221
for additional circuit information.
Tools Required
• Breakout Harness ZTSE4735A
• Digital Multimeter (DMM)
Test 1
A. Key-Off.
SPN 51 FMI 11 - ETP operation fault - underVolt, overAmp, overTemp/ETP H-bridge Electrical Check
Fault Overview
Fault sets when Engine Control Module (ECM) detects short circuit on Engine Throttle Valve (ETV)
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
None
See latest version of MaxxForce® DT, 9 and 10 Engine and Aftertreatment Wiring Schematic Form 0000003221
for additional circuit information.
Tools Required
• Breakout Harness ZTSE4735A
• Digital Multimeter (DMM)
Test 1
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect Engine Throttle Valve (ETV) connector.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4735A to vehicle harness and leave ETV connector disconnected.
166 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Test 2
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect Engine Throttle Valve (ETV) connector.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4735A to vehicle harness and leave ETV connector disconnected.
Test 3
A. Key OFF.
Test 4
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect Engine Throttle Valve (ETV) connector.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4735A to vehicle harness and leave ETV connector disconnected.
Test 5
A. Key OFF.
Fault Overview
Fault code sets when Engine Control Module (ECM) detects difference between Accelerator Pedal Position 1
(APP1) signal and Accelerator Pedal Position 2 (APP2) signal is greater than 0.14 volts at 1.1 volts and greater
than 0.52 volts at 4.1 volts.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
• SPN 91 FMI 3 and 4 • SPN 2623 FMI 3 and 4 • SPN 3510 FMI 3 and 4 • SPN 3511 FMI 3 and 4
(APP1) (APP2) (VREF 2) (VREF 3)
Fault Facts
None
Step 3 Inspect Accelerator Pedal Position 1 (APP1) sensor and connector. Decision
A. Key OFF. Yes: Go to Step 4
B. Disconnect APP sensor.
C. Check APP sensor and connector terminals for: damaged or pinched
wires; wet or corroded terminals; loose, bent, or broken pins; or broken
connector housing.
Are APP sensor connector, harness, and terminals clean and undamaged? No: Repair connector, harness,
or terminal damage. After repairs
are complete, retest for SPN 91
FMI 2.
Step 4 Check for high resistance in Accelerator Pedal Position 1 (APP1). Decision
A. Perform Test 1 (page 171). Yes: Go to Step 6.
B. Use DMM, measure voltage between Breakout Harness ZTSE4485A
pin-A and pin-B.
Is voltage 1.15 ± 0.25 volts? No: Go to Step 5.
Step 5 Check for high resistance in Accelerator Pedal Position 1 (APP1). Decision
A. Perform Test 2 (page 171). Yes: Repair Open or high
resistance in SIG GND circuit
B. Use DMM, measure voltage between Breakout Harness ZTSE4485A pin-A
between APP connector pin-B
and known good GND.
and ECM pin C-34. After repairs
are complete, retest for SPN 91
FMI 2.
Is voltage 1.15 ± 0.25 volts? No: Repair Open or high
resistance in SIG circuit between
APP connector pin-A and ECM
pin C-33. After repairs are
complete, retest for SPN 91 FMI
2.
Step 7 Check for high resistance in Accelerator Pedal Position 2 (APP2). Decision
A. Perform Test 4 (page 173). Yes: Go to Step 9.
B. Use DMM, measure voltage between Breakout Harness ZTSE4485A
pin-E and pin-F.
Is voltage 0.60 ± 0.25 volts? No: Go to Step 8.
Step 8 Check for high resistance in Accelerator Pedal Position 2 (APP2). Decision
A. Perform Test 5 (page 174). Yes: Repair Open or high
resistance in SIG GND circuit
B. Use DMM, measure voltage between Breakout Harness ZTSE4485A pin-F
between APP connector pin-E
and known good GND.
and ECM pin C-36. After repairs
are complete, retest for SPN 91
FMI 2.
Is voltage 0.60 ± 0.25 volts? No: Repair Open or high
resistance in SIG circuit between
APP connector pin-F and ECM pin
C-48. After repairs are complete,
retest for SPN 91 FMI 2.
See latest version of MaxxForce® DT, 9, and 10 Engine and Aftertreatment Wiring Schematic Form 0000003221
for additional circuit information.
Tools Required
• Breakout Harness ZTSE4485A
• Electronic Service Tool (EST) with Navistar® Engine Diagnostics
• Interface cable (RP1210B-compliant supporting J1939 and J1708)
Test 1
A. Key OFF.
Test 2
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect Accelerator Pedal Position (APP) sensor.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4485A between vehicle harness connector and APP sensor.
D. Key ON Engine OFF (KOEO).
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 173
Test 3
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect Accelerator Pedal Position (APP) sensor.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4485A to vehicle harness connector and leave APP sensor disconnected.
D. Key ON Engine OFF (KOEO).
174 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Test 4
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect Accelerator Pedal Position (APP) sensor.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4485A between vehicle harness connector and APP sensor.
D. Key ON Engine OFF (KOEO).
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 175
Test 5
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect Accelerator Pedal Position (APP) sensor.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4485A between vehicle harness connector and APP sensor.
D. Key ON Engine OFF (KOEO).
176 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Test 6
A. Key-Off.
B. Disconnect Accelerator Pedal Position (APP) sensor.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4485A to vehicle harness connector and leave APP sensor disconnected.
D. Key ON Engine OFF (KOEO).
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 177
Fault Overview
Fault code sets when Engine Control Module (ECM) detects Accelerator Pedal Position 1 (APP1) signal is
greater than 4.575 volts.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
SPN 3510 FMI 3 and 4
(VREF 2)
Fault Facts
None
Step 4 Decision
A. Key OFF. Yes: Repair short to PWR
between APP sensor connector
B. Disconnect Accelerator Pedal Position (APP) sensor.
pin-A and ECM pin C-33.
C. Connect EST to vehicle Diagnostic Connector. (page 1345).
D. Key ON Engine OFF (KOEO), log in to Navistar® Engine Diagnostics.
E. Use EST with Navistar® Engine Diagnostics, clear DTC list.
Does SPN 91 FMI 3 set after DTC list is cleared? No: Go to Step 5.
Step 4 Decision
A. Perform Test 1(page 180). Yes: Replace APP sensor. After
repairs are complete, retest for
B. Use Digital Multimeter (DMM), measure voltage between Breakout
SPN 91 FMI 3.
Harness ZTSE4485A pin-B and PWR.
Is voltage B+ ± 0.5 volt? No: Repair Open between APP
pin-B and ECM pin C-34. After
repairs are complete, retest for
SPN 91 FMI 3.
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 179
See latest version of MaxxForce® DT, 9, and 10 Engine and Aftertreatment Wiring Schematic Form 0000003221
for additional circuit information.
Tools Required
• Breakout Harness ZTSE4485A
• Digital Multimeter (DMM)
• Electronic Service Tool (EST) with Navistar® Engine Diagnostics
• Interface cable (RP1210B-compliant supporting J1939 and J1708)
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 181
Test 1
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect Accelerator Pedal Position (APP) sensor.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4485A to vehicle harness and leave APP sensor disconnected.
D. Key ON Engine OFF (KOEO).
182 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Fault Overview
Fault code sets when Engine Control Module (ECM) detects Accelerator Pedal Position 1 (APP1) signal is less
than 0.825 volts.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
SPN 3510 FMI 3 and 4
(VREF 2)
Fault Facts
None
See latest version of MaxxForce® DT, 9, and 10 Engine and Aftertreatment Wiring Schematic Form 0000003221
for additional circuit information.
Tools Required
• Breakout Harness ZTSE4485A
• Breakout Harness ZTSE4498
• Digital Multimeter (DMM)
• Electronic Service Tool (EST) with Navistar® Engine Diagnostics
• Interface cable (RP1210B-compliant supporting J1939 and J1708)
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 185
Test 1
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect Accelerator Pedal Position (APP) sensor.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4485A to APP and leave sensor disconnected.
D. Key ON Engine OFF (KOEO).
186 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Test 2
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect Accelerator Pedal Position (APP) sensor.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4485A to APP and leave sensor disconnected.
D. Use Breakout Harness ZTSE4498, short Breakout Harness ZTSE4485A pin-A to pin-C together.
E. Connect Electronic Service Tool (EST) to vehicle Diagnostic Connector (page 1345).
F. Key ON Engine OFF (KOEO). Log in to Navistar® Engine Diagnostics.
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 187
Test 3
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect Accelerator Pedal Position (APP) sensor.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4485A to APP and leave sensor disconnected.
D. Use Breakout Harness ZTSE4498, short Breakout Harness ZTSE4485A pin-A to pin-C together.
E. Connect EST to vehicle Diagnostic Connector (page 1345).
F. Key ON Engine OFF (KOEO) Engine OFF (KOEO). Log in to Navistar® Engine Diagnostics.
188 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Fault Overview
Fault code sets when Fuel Delivery Pressure (FDP) is greater than 134 psi (924 kPa).
Lamp Reaction
No Lamp
Associated Faults
SPN 94 FMI 3 and 4 (FDP)
Fault Facts
None
Step 2 Inspect Fuel Delivery Pressure (FDP) sensor and connector. Decision
A. Key OFF. Yes: Go to Step 3.
B. Disconnect FDP sensor.
C. Check FDP sensor and connector terminals for: damaged or pinched
wires; wet or corroded terminals; loose, bent, or broken pins; or broken
connector housing.
Are FDP sensor connector, harness, and terminals clean and undamaged? No: Repair connector, harness,
or terminal damage. After repairs
are complete, retest for SPN 94
FMI 0.
Fault Overview
Fault code sets when Electronic Control Module (ECM) detects that Fuel Delivery Pressure (FDP) is below 30
psi (207 kPa).
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during one drive cycle.
Associated Faults
• SPN 931 FMI 4 (EFP) • SPN 94 FMI 18 (FDP)
Fault Facts
None.
Fault Overview
Fault sets when Engine Control Module (ECM) determines Fuel Delivery Pressure (FDP) signal value is incorrect
when compared to other sensor values.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
SPN 94 FMI 3 and 4
Step 2 Inspect Fuel Delivery Pressure (FDP) sensor and connector. Decision
A. Key OFF. Yes: Go to Step 3.
B. Disconnect FDP sensor.
C. Check FDP sensor and connector terminals for: damaged or pinched
wires; wet or corroded terminals; loose, bent, or broken pins; or broken
connector housing.
Are FDP sensor connector, harness, and terminals clean and undamaged? No: Repair connector, harness, or
terminal damage. After repairs are
complete, retest for SPN 94 FMI 2.
Fault Overview
Fault sets when Fuel Delivery Pressure (FDP) sensor signal voltage is greater than 4.912 volts (152 psi {1049
kPa}) for 5 seconds.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
SPN 3509 FMI 3 and 4
(VREF 1)
Fault Facts
None
Drive Cycle
Key ON
Possible Causes
• FDP signal circuit short to PWR
• SIG GND circuit Open
• Failed FDP sensor
Step 4 Decision
A. Key OFF. Yes: Repair short to PWR between
FDP pin-3 and ECM pin E-32.
B. Disconnect Fuel Delivery Pressure (FDP) sensor vehicle harness
After repairs are complete, retest
connector.
for SPN 94 FMI 3.
C. Connect EST to vehicle Diagnostic Connector (page 1345).
D. Key ON Engine OFF (KOEO). Log in to Navistar® Engine Diagnostics.
E. Use EST with Navistar® Engine Diagnostics, clear DTC list.
Does SPN 94 FMI 3 set after DTC list is cleared? No: Go to Step 5.
Step Decision
A. Perform Test 1 (page 196). Yes: Replace FDP sensor. After
repairs are complete, retest for
B. Use DMM, measure voltage between Breakout Harness ZTSE4850 pin-1
SPN 94 FMI 3.
and PWR
Is voltage 12 ± 0.5 volts? No: Repair Open between FDP
pin-1 and ECM pin E-28. After
repairs are complete, retest for
SPN 94 FMI 3.
See latest version of MaxxForce® DT, 9, and 10 Engine and Aftertreatment Wiring Schematic Form 0000003221
for additional circuit information.
Tools Required
• Breakout Harness ZTSE4850
• Digital Multimeter (DMM)
• Electronic Service Tool (EST) with Navistar® Engine Diagnostics
• Interface cable (RP1210B-compliant supporting J1939 and J1708)
Test 2
A. Key OFF.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4850 to vehicle harness connector and leave FDP sensor disconnected.
Fault Overview
Fault sets when Fuel Delivery Pressure (FDP) sensor signal voltage is less than 0.093 volts for five seconds.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
SPN 3509 FMI 3 and 4
(VREF 1)
Fault Facts
None
See latest version of MaxxForce® DT, 9, and 10 Engine and Aftertreatment Wiring Schematic Form 0000003221
for additional circuit information.
Tools Required
• Breakout Harness ZTSE4850
• Breakout Harness ZTSE4498
• Digital Multimeter (DMM)
• Electronic Service Tool (EST) with Navistar® Engine Diagnostics
• Interface cable (RP1210B-compliant supporting J1939 and J1708)
Test 1
A. Key OFF.
Test 2
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect Fuel Delivery Pressure (FDP) sensor.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4850 to vehicle harness connector and leave FDP sensor disconnected.
D. Use Breakout Harness ZTSE4498, short Breakout Harness ZTSE4850 pin-2 and pin-3 together.
E. Connect EST to vehicle Diagnostic Connector. (page 1345).
F. Key ON Engine OFF (KOEO). Log in to Navistar® Engine Diagnostics.
202 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Test 3
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect Fuel Delivery Pressure (FDP) sensor.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4850 to vehicle harness connector and leave FDP sensor disconnected.
D. Use Breakout Harness ZTSE4498, short Breakout Harness ZTSE4850 pin-2 and pin-3 together.
E. Connect EST to vehicle Diagnostic Connector. (page 1345).
F. Key ON Engine OFF (KOEO). Log in to Navistar® Engine Diagnostics.
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 203
Fault Overview
Fault code sets when Fuel Delivery Pressure (FDP) is below 60 psi (414 kPa) for 45 seconds.
Lamp Reaction
Wrench lamp will illuminate when this fault is active.
Associated Faults
• SPN 94 FMI 1 (EFP) • SPN 94 FMI 18 (FDP) • SPN 931 FMI 4 (EFP)
Fault Facts
Fault is normally caused by fuel filter needing to be changed.
Fault Overview
Fault code sets when Fuel Delivery Pressure (FDP) is below 45 psi for 8 seconds while engine is cranking.
Lamp Reaction
No Lamp
Associated Faults
SPN 931 FMI 4 (EFP)
Fault Facts
This fault may set due to fuel gelling, low fuel level, or recent engine service.
Drive Cycles
Engine Cranking
Possible Causes
• Recent fuel system service that required priming
• Diesel fuel waxing or icing in cold temperatures
• Low fuel level in either fuel tank
• Vehicle unused for long period of time
• Unseated fuel filter that causes fuel to drain back to tank
• High resistance in fuel pump circuits
• High resistance in FP GND circuit
• Stuck Open fuel pressure regulator
• Damaged fuel filter
• Completely plugged strainer
• Failed fuel pump
206 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Fault Overview
Fault sets when Engine Control Module (ECM) senses Engine Oil Pressure (EOP) is below Critical Pressure.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
SPN 100 FMI 3 and 4
(EOP)
Fault Facts
This fault sets when Engine Warning Protection System (EWPS) detects Engine Oil Pressure (EOP) has fallen
below a critical set point. This fault may be caused by actual low oil pressure or by a fault in EOP sensor circuit.
Insure engine oil level and quality are appropriate.
Fault Overview
None
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during one drive cycle.
Associated Faults
SPN 3509 FMI 3 and 4
(VREF 1)
Fault Facts
None
Step Decision
A. Perform Test 1 (page 211). Yes: Replace EOP sensor. After
repairs are complete, retest for
B. Use DMM, measure voltage between Breakout Harness ZTSE4850 pin-1
SPN 100 FMI 3.
and PWR.
Is voltage B+ ± 0.5 volts. No: Repair Open between EOP
sensor pin-1 and ECM pin E-28.
After repairs are complete, retest
for SPN 100 FMI 3
210 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
See latest version of MaxxForce® DT, 9, and 10 Engine and Aftertreatment Wiring Schematic Form 0000003221
for additional circuit information.
Tools Required
• Breakout Harness ZTSE4850
• Digital Multimeter (DMM)
Test 1
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect Engine Oil Pressure (EOP) sensor.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4850 to vehicle harness connector and leave EOP sensor disconnected.
Fault Overview
Fault code sets when Engine Control Module (ECM) detects Engine Oil Pressure (EOP) signal is out of range
low.
Lamp Reaction
No Lamp
Associated Faults
SPN 3509 FMI 3 and 4
(VREF 1)
Fault Facts
None
See latest version of MaxxForce® DT, 9, and 10 Engine and Aftertreatment Wiring Schematic Form 0000003221
for additional circuit information.
Tools Required
• Breakout Harness ZTSE4850
• 3-Banana Plug Harness ZTSE4498
• Digital Multimeter (DMM)
• Electronic Service Tool (EST) with Navistar® Engine Diagnostics
• Interface cable (RP1210B-compliant supporting J1939 and J1708)
Test 1
A. Key OFF.
Test 2
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect Engine Oil Pressure (EOP) sensor.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4850 to vehicle harness and leave EOP sensor disconnected.
D. Use Breakout Harness ZTSE4498, short Breakout Harness ZTSE4850 pin-2 and pin-3 together.
E. Connect EST to vehicle Diagnostic Connector. (page 1345).
F. Key ON Engine OFF (KOEO). Log in to Navistar® Engine Diagnostics.
216 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Test 3
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect Engine Oil Pressure (EOP) sensor.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4850 to vehicle harness and leave EOP sensor disconnected.
D. Use Breakout Harness ZTSE4498, short Breakout Harness ZTSE4850 pin-2 and pin-3 together.
E. Connect EST to vehicle Diagnostic Connector. (page 1345).
F. Key-On Engine-Off (KOEO). Log in to Navistar® Engine Diagnostics.
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 217
Fault Overview
Fault sets when Engine Control Module (ECM) senses Engine Oil Pressure (EOP) is below Warning Pressure.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
• SPN 100 FMI 1 (EWPS) • SPN 100 FMI 3 and 4
(EOP)
Fault Facts
RPM values can be found in PP 77031, 77041, and 77051.
Insure engine oil level and quality are appropriate.
Fault Overview
Fault code sets when the Key-On Engine-Off (KOEO) absolute pressure difference between Intake Manifold
Pressure (IMP) and Barometric Absolute Pressure (BARO), IMP and Exhaust Back Pressure (EBP), and EBP
and BARO is greater than 4.4 psi (30 kPa) for two seconds with the Wastegate Actuator Position Command less
than 100%.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
• SPN 102 FMI 3 and 4 (IMP) • SPN 108 FMI 3 and 4 • SPN 1209 FMI 3 and 4 • SPN 3509 FMI 3 and 4
(BARO) (EBP) (VREF 1)
Fault Facts
Intake Manifold Pressure (IMP) sensor cannot be compared to other similar sensors in Navistar® Engine
Diagnostics, because IMP values cannot be negative, and IMP value is in gauge units.
Fault Overview
Fault code sets when Intake Manifold Pressure (IMP) is greater than 4.8 volts (89 psi {613.3 kPa}) for 2.55
seconds.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
SPN 3509 FMI 3 and 4
(VREF 1)
Fault Facts
None
Step 3 Check IMP sensor signal circuit for short to PWR. Decision
A. Key OFF. Yes: Repair short to PWR
between IMP pin-3 and ECM pin
B. Disconnect Intake Manifold Pressure (IMP) vehicle harness connector.
E-48. After repairs are complete,
C. Connect Electronic Service Tool (EST) to vehicle Diagnostic Connector retest for SPN 102 FMI 3.
(page 1345).
D. Key ON Engine OFF (KOEO). Log in to Navistar® Engine Diagnostics.
E. Use EST with Navistar® Engine Diagnostics, clear DTC list.
Does SPN 102 FMI 3 set after DTC list is cleared? No: Go to Step 4.
See latest version of MaxxForce® DT, 9, and 10 Engine and Aftertreatment Wiring Schematic Form 0000003221
for additional circuit information.
Tools Required
• Breakout Harness ZTSE4850
• Breakout Harness ZTSE4498
• Digital Multimeter (DMM)
• Electronic Service Tool (EST) with Navistar® Engine Diagnostics
• Interface cable (RP1210B-compliant supporting J1939 and J1708)
Test 1
A. Key OFF.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4850 to IMP vehicle harness connector, leave IMP sensor disconnected.
D. Key-On Engine-Off (KOEO).
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 223
Fault Overview
Fault sets when Intake Manifold Pressure (IMP) voltage is less than 0.1899 volts (4 psi {31 kPa}) for 2.55
seconds.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
SPN 3509 FMI 3 and 4
(VREF 1)
Fault Facts
None
Step 3 Check IMP signal circuit for Open or high resistance. Decision
A. Perform Test 1 (page 225). Yes: Go to Step 4
B. Use DMM, measure voltage between Breakout Harness ZTSE4850 pin-2
and known good GND.
Is voltage 5.0 ± 1.0 volts? No: Repair Open or high
resistance between IMP pin-2 and
ECM pin E-35. After repairs are
complete, retest for SPN 102 FMI
4.
See latest version of MaxxForce® DT, 9, and 10 Engine and Aftertreatment Wiring Schematic Form 0000003221
for additional circuit information.
Tools Required
• Breakout Harness ZTSE4850
• Breakout Harness ZTSE4498
• Digital Multimeter (DMM)
• Electronic Service Tool (EST) with Navistar® Engine Diagnostics
• Interface cable (RP1210B-compliant supporting J1939 and J1708)
Test 1
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect Intake Manifold Pressure (IMP) sensor.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4850 to IMP vehicle harness connector, leave IMP sensor disconnected.
Test 2
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect Intake Manifold Pressure (IMP) sensor.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4850 to IMP vehicle harness connector, leave IMP sensor disconnected.
D. Use Breakout Harness ZTSE4498, short Breakout Harness ZTSE4850 pin-2 and pin-3 together.
E. Connect Electronic Service Tool (EST) to vehicle Diagnostic Connector (page 1345).
F. Key-On Engine-Off (KOEO). Log in to Navistar® Engine Diagnostics.
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 227
Test 3
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect Intake Manifold Pressure (IMP) sensor.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4850 to IMP vehicle harness connector, leave IMP sensor disconnected.
D. Use Breakout Harness ZTSE4498, short Breakout Harness ZTSE4850 pin-2 and pin-3 together.
E. Connect EST to vehicle Diagnostic Connector (page 1345).
F. Key-On Engine-Off (KOEO). Log in to Navistar® Engine Diagnostics.
228 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Fault Overview
Fault sets when the Engine Control Module (ECM) detects Intake Manifold Pressure (IMP) is stuck in range.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
• SPN 102 FMI 3 and 4 • SPN 108 FMI 3 and 4
(IMP) (BARO)
Fault Facts
None
Fault Overview
Fault sets when Engine Control Module (ECM) determines Intake Manifold Pressure (IMP) does not maintain
pressure.
Associated Faults
• SPN 94 (FDP) • SPN 1209 (EBP) • SPN 164 (ICP)
Fault Facts
Perform MAF Sensor Calibration after doing repairs that change engine air intake, exhaust, or Exhaust Gas
Recirculation (EGR) flow characteristics.
Step 4 Check intake and exhaust systems for leaks and / or damage. Decisions
• Perform Intake Air Inspection (page 1648), Yes: Go to Step 5.
• Charge Air Cooler Inspection (page 1646),
• and Exhaust and Aftertreatment System Inspection (page 1651).
Are all inspections checked in good condition and clear of leaks and damage? No: Repair leaks or damage to
intake and exhaust. After repairs
are complete, Perform MAF
Sensor Calibration (page 1539)
and retest for SPN 102 FMI 10.
Step 6 Determine if leaks are present in Charge Air Cooler (CAC) system. Decision
Perform High-Pressure Charge Air Cooler (HPCAC) Pressure Test. (page 1545) Yes: Go to Step 7.
Does CAC system pass test? No: Repair CAC leaks. After
repairs are complete, Perform
MAF Sensor Calibration (page
1539) and retest for SPN 102 FMI
10.
Step 7 Inspect Intake Manifold Pressure (IMP), Intake Manifold Temperature Decision
(IMT) and Exhaust Back Pressure (EBP) sensors and bores.
A. Remove IMP, IMT, and EBP sensors. See Engine Service Manual. Yes: Clean sensors and sensor
bores. Replace damaged
B. Inspect IMP, IMT, and EBP sensors and bores for carbon build up, coking,
sensors. After repairs are
restrictions, and damage.
complete, Perform MAF Sensor
Calibration (page 1539) and retest
for SPN 102 FMI 10.
Do sensors or sensor bores have carbon build up, coking, restrictions, or damage? No: Go to Step 8.
Step 17 Identify cylinders that may have valve train issues or other mechanical Decision
problems.
Perform Relative Compression Test Plus (RCT+) (page 1465). Yes: Repair as directed by
test results. After repairs are
complete, Perform MAF Sensor
Calibration (page 1539) and retest
for SPN 102 FMI 10.
Does CPA Tool indicate a problem or generate a warranty authorization code No: End diagnostics. Perform
(WAC)? MAF Sensor Calibration (page
1539) and retest for SPN 102 FMI
10.
Fault Overview
Fault sets when Engine Control Module (ECM) determines Intake Manifold Pressure (IMP) is too high.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
• SPN 94 • SPN 1209 • SPN 164 • 1322 - 1328 FMI 31
• SPN 651-656 • SPN 2797-2728 • SPN 3659 – 3664 • SPN 4257
Fault Facts
Perform MAF Sensor Calibration after doing repairs that change engine air intake, exhaust, or Exhaust Gas
Recirculation (EGR) flow characteristics.
Step 4 Check intake and exhaust systems for leaks and / or damage. Decisions
• Perform Intake Air Inspection (page 1648), Yes: Go to Step 5.
• Charge Air Cooler Inspection (page 1646),
• and Exhaust and Aftertreatment System Inspection (page 1651).
Are all items checked in good condition and clear of leaks and damage? No: Repair leaks or damage
to intake and exhaust. After
repair are complete, perform MAF
Sensor Calibration (page 1539)
and retest for SPN 102 FMI 16.
Step 6 Inspect Intake Manifold Pressure (IMP), Intake Manifold Temperature Decision
(IMT) and Exhaust Back Pressure (EBP) sensors and bores.
A. Remove IMP, IMT, and EBP sensors. See Engine Service Manual. Yes: Clean sensors and sensor
bores. Replace damaged
B. Inspect IMP, IMT, and EBP sensors and bores for carbon build up, coking,
sensors. After repair are
restrictions, and damage.
complete, perform MAF Sensor
Calibration (page 1539) and retest
for SPN 102 FMI 16.
Do sensors or sensor bores have carbon build up, coking, restrictions, or damage? No: Go to Step 7.
Fault Overview
Fault sets when Engine Control Module (ECM) determines engine intake manifold pressure is too Low.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
• SPN 94 (FDP) • SPN 1209 (EBP) • SPN 164 (ICP)
Fault Facts
Perform MAF Sensor Calibration after doing repairs that change engine air intake, exhaust, or Exhaust Gas
Recirculation (EGR) flow characteristics.
Step 4 Check intake and exhaust systems for leaks and / or damage. Decisions
• Perform Intake Air Inspection (page 1648), Yes: Go to Step 5.
• Charge Air Cooler Inspection (page 1646),
• and Exhaust and Aftertreatment System Inspection (page 1651).
Are all items checked in good condition and clear of leaks and damage? No: Repair leaks or damage
to intake and exhaust. After
repairs are complete, perform
MAF Sensor Calibration (page
1539)and retest for SPN 102 FMI
18.
Step 6 Determine if leaks are present in Charge Air Cooler (CAC) system. Decision
Perform High-Pressure Charge Air Cooler (HPCAC) Pressure Test. (page 1545) Yes: Go to Step 7.
Does CAC system pass test? No: Repair CAC leaks. After
repairs are complete, perform
MAF Sensor Calibration (page
1539)and retest for SPN 102 FMI
18.
Step 7 Inspect Intake Manifold Temperature (IMT) and Exhaust Back Pressure Decision
(EBP) sensors and bores.
A. Remove IMP and EBP sensors. See Engine Service Manual. Yes: Clean sensors and sensor
bores. Replace damaged
B. Inspect IMP and EBP sensors and bores for carbon build up, coking,
sensors. After repairs are
restrictions, and damage.
complete, perform MAF Sensor
Calibration (page 1539)and retest
for SPN 102 FMI 18.
Do sensors or sensor bores have carbon build up, coking, restrictions, or damage? No: Go to Step 8.
240 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Step 11 Determine if KOEO IMP is within specification, and IMP sensor bore Decision
is not restricted.
A. Key-On Engine-Off (KOEO), log in to Navistar® Engine Diagnostics. Yes: Go to Step 12.
®
B. Use EST with Navistar Engine Diagnostics, select: Pressure tab.
C. Compare Navistar® Engine Diagnostics Intake Manifold Pressure value to
KOEO specification.
Is IMP within KOEO specification? No: Replace IMP sensor. After
repairs are complete, perform
MAF Sensor Calibration (page
1539)and retest for SPN 102 FMI
18.
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 241
Step 15 Identify cylinders that may have valve train issues or other mechanical Decision
problems.
Perform Relative Compression Test Plus (RCT+) (page 1465). Yes: Repair as directed by test
results. After repairs are complete,
Perform MAF Sensor Calibration
(page 1539) and retest for SPN
102 FMI 18.
Does CPA Tool indicate a problem or generate a warranty authorization code No: End diagnostics. Perform
(WAC)? MAF Sensor Calibration (page
1539) and retest for SPN 102 FMI
18.
Fault Overview
Engine Control Module (ECM) Compares Intake Manifold Temperature (IMT) sensor to Intake Air Temperature
(IAT), Turbocharger 2 Compressor Intake Temperature (TC2CIT), Charge Air Cooler Outlet Temperature
(CACOT), Engine Coolant Temperature 1 (ECT1), and Engine Oil Temperature (EOT) sensors at initial Key
ON after an 8-hour cold soak.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
SPN 105 FMI 3 and 4 (IMT)
Fault Facts
None
See latest version of MaxxForce® DT, 9, and 10 Engine and Aftertreatment Wiring Schematic Form 0000003221
for additional circuit information.
Tools Required
• Breakout Harness ZTSE4993
• 500-ohm Resistor Harness ZTSE4497
• Electronic Service Tool (EST) with Navistar® Engine Diagnostics
• Interface cable (RP1210B-compliant supporting J1939 and J1708)
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 245
Test 1
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect Intake Manifold Temperature (IMT) sensor.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4993 to vehicle harness connector and leave IMT sensor disconnected.
D. Connect Resistor Harness ZTSE4497 between Breakout Harness ZTSE4993 pin-1 and pin-2.
E. Connect EST to vehicle Diagnostic Connector. (page 1345).
F. Key ON Engine OFF (KOEO). Log in to Navistar® Engine Diagnostics.
246 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Test 2
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect Intake Manifold Temperature (IMT) sensor.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4993 to vehicle harness connector and leave IMT sensor disconnected.
D. Connect Resistor Harness ZTSE4497 between Breakout Harness ZTSE4993 pin-2 and known good GND.
E. Connect EST to vehicle Diagnostic Connector. (page 1345).
F. Key ON Engine OFF (KOEO). Log in to Navistar® Engine Diagnostics.
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 247
Fault Overview
Fault Code sets when Engine Control Module (ECM) detects that Intake Manifold Temperature (IMT) signal is
greater than 4.80 volts.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
None
See latest version of MaxxForce® DT, 9, and 10 Engine and Aftertreatment Wiring Schematic Form 0000003221
for additional circuit information.
Tools Required
• Breakout Harness ZTSE4993
• Breakout Harness 3-Banana Plug ZTSE4498
• Digital Multimeter (DMM)
• Electronic Service Tool (EST) with Navistar® Engine Diagnostics
• Interface cable (RP1210B-compliant supporting J1939 and J1708)
Test 1
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect Intake Manifold Temperature (IMT) sensor.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4993 to vehicle harness connector and leave IMT sensor disconnected.
Test 2
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect Intake Manifold Temperature (IMT) sensor.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4993 to vehicle harness and leave IMT sensor disconnected.
D. Use Breakout Harness ZTSE4498, short Breakout Harness ZTSE4993 pin-1 and pin-2 together.
E. Connect Electronic Service Tool (EST) to vehicle Diagnostic Connector (page 1345).
F. Key ON Engine OFF (KOEO). Log in to Navistar® Engine Diagnostics.
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 251
Test 3
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect Intake Manifold Temperature (IMT) sensor.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4993 to vehicle harness and leave IMT sensor disconnected.
D. Use Breakout Harness ZTSE4498, short Breakout Harness ZTSE4993 pin-2 circuit to known good GND.
E. Connect Electronic Service Tool (EST) to vehicle Diagnostic Connector (page 1345).
F. Key ON Engine OFF (KOEO). Log in to Navistar® Engine Diagnostics.
252 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Fault Overview
Fault Code sets when Engine Control Module (ECM) detects Intake Manifold Temperature (IMT) signal is less
than 0.16 volts.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
None
Fault Overview
Fault code sets when Electronic Control Module (ECM) detects that Barometric Absolute Pressure (BARO)
sensor signal is erratic intermittent or incorrect
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
BARO sensor is located inside Engine Control Module (ECM). If there is a confirmed BARO failure, ECM must
be replaced.
Drive Cycles
Initial Key ON
Possible Cause
• Failed ECM
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 255
Step 1 Obtain vehicle health report and check for current Engine Control Decision
Module (ECM) calibration.
Perform Obtain Vehicle Health Report(page 1324). Yes: Go to Step 2.
Is ECM calibration current? No: Ensure vehicle has latest
ECM calibration. After repairs are
complete, retest for SPN 108 FMI
2.
Fault Overview
Fault Code sets when Barometric Pressure (BARO) sensor is above maximum threshold.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
BARO sensor is installed inside Engine Control Module (ECM).
Step 1 Obtain vehicle health report and check for current Engine Control Decision
Module (ECM) calibration.
Perform Obtain Vehicle Health Report(page 1324). Yes: Go to Step 2.
Is ECM calibration current? No: Ensure vehicle has latest
ECM calibration. After repairs are
complete, retest for SPN 108 FMI
3.
Fault Overview
Determines if Barometric Pressure (BARO) sensor is below minimum threshold.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
BARO sensor is installed inside Engine Control Module (ECM).
Step 1 Obtain vehicle health report and check for current Engine Control Decision
Module (ECM) calibration.
Perform Obtain Vehicle Health Report(page 1324). Yes: Go to Step 2.
Is ECM calibration current? No: Ensure vehicle has latest
ECM calibration. After repairs are
complete, retest for SPN 108 FMI
4.
Fault Overview
Fault is set by Engine Control Module (ECM) when Engine Coolant Temperature 1 (ECT1) exceeds value of
Programmable Parameter (PP) 77021.
Lamp Reaction
Engine shutdown is commanded and Red Stop Lamp (RSL) active if feature is enabled.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
None
Fault Overview
Engine Control Module (ECM) compares Engine Coolant Temperature 1 (ECT1) sensor to Intake Air
Temperature (IAT), Turbocharger 2 Compressor Intake Temperature (TC2CIT), Charge Air Cooler Outlet
Temperature (CACOT), Intake Manifold Temperature (IMT), and Engine Oil Temperature (EOT) sensors at Key
ON, Engine OFF (KOEO) with engine cold.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
SPN 110 FMI 3 and 4
(ECT1)
Fault Facts
ECT1 sensor shares a common ground circuit with multiple sensors and actuators. If multiple sensor and
actuator fault codes are present, suspect a ground circuit failure.
See latest version of MaxxForce® DT, 9, and 10 Engine and Aftertreatment Wiring Schematic Form 0000003221
for additional circuit information.
Tools Required
• Breakout Harness ZTSE4602
• 3-Banana Plug Harness ZTSE4498
• EST with Navistar® Engine Diagnostics
• Interface cable (RP1210B-compliant supporting J1939 and J1708)
Test 1
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect ECT1 sensor.
C. Connect Electronic Service Tool (EST) to vehicle Diagnostic Connector (page 1345).
D. Key ON, Engine OFF (KOEO). Log into Navistar® Engine Diagnostics.
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 265
Test 2
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect ECT1 sensor.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4602 to vehicle harness connector and leave ECT1 sensor disconnected.
D. Connect Resistor Harness ZTSE4498 between Breakout Harness ZTSE4602 pin-1 and pin-2.
E. Connect Electronic Service Tool (EST) to vehicle Diagnostic Connector (page 1345).
F. Key ON, Engine OFF (KOEO). Log into Navistar® Engine Diagnostics.
266 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Test 3
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect ECT1 sensor.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4602 to vehicle harness connector and leave ECT1 sensor disconnected.
D. Connect Resistor Harness ZTSE4498 between Breakout Harness ZTSE4602 pin-2 and known good GND.
E. Connect Electronic Service Tool (EST) to vehicle Diagnostic Connector (page 1345).
F. Key ON, Engine OFF (KOEO). Log into Navistar® Engine Diagnostics.
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 267
Fault Overview
Fault code sets when Engine Control Module (ECM) detects Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT1) signal is
greater than 4.80 volts.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
None
Step 5 Check ECT1 signal and SIG GND circuits for Opens. Decision
A. Perform Test 3(page 271). Yes: Repair Open between ECT1
pin-1 and ECM pin E-28. After
B. Use EST with Navistar® Engine Diagnostics, clear DTC list.
repairs are complete, retest for
SPN 110 FMI 3.
Does SPN 110 FMI 4 set after DTC list is cleared? No: Repair Open between ECT1
pin-2 and ECM pin E-33. After
repairs are complete, retest for
SPN 110 FMI 3.
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 269
See latest version of MaxxForce® DT, 9, and 10 Engine and Aftertreatment Wiring Schematic Form 0000003221
for additional circuit information.
Tools Required
• Breakout Harness ZTSE4602
• Breakout Harness ZTSE4498
• Digital Multimeter (DMM)
• Electronic Service Tool (EST) with Navistar® Engine Diagnostics
• Interface cable (RP1210B-compliant supporting J1939 and J1708)
Test 1
A. Key OFF.
Test 2
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect Engine Coolant Temperature 1 (ECT1) sensor.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4602 to vehicle harness and leave ECT1 sensor disconnected.
D. Use Breakout Harness ZTSE4498, short Breakout Harness ZTSE4602 pin-1 and pin-2 together.
E. Connect Electronic Service Tool (EST) to vehicle Diagnostic Connector (page 1345).
F. Key ON Engine OFF (KOEO). Log in to Navistar® Engine Diagnostics.
272 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Test 3
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect Engine Coolant Temperature 1 (ECT1) sensor.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4602 to vehicle harness and leave ECT1 sensor disconnected.
D. Use Breakout Harness ZTSE4498, short Breakout Harness ZTSE4602 pin-2 to known good GND.
E. Connect EST to vehicle Diagnostic Connector (page 1345).
F. Key ON Engine OFF (KOEO). Log in to Navistar® Engine Diagnostics.
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 273
Fault Overview
Fault code sets when Engine Control Module (ECM) detects that Engine Coolant Temperature 1 (ECT1) sensor
signal voltage is less than 0.17 volts.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
SPN 3509 FMI 3 and 4
(VREF 1)
Fault Facts
None
Fault Overview
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
• SPN 110 FMI 2, 3 and 4 • SPN 175 FMI 2, 3 and 4
(ECT1) (EOT)
Fault Facts
None
Step 8 Check engine fan, fan shroud, and air dams. Decision
Check engine fan, fan shroud, and air dams for damage and proper operation. Yes: Go to Step 9.
Are engine fan, fan shroud, and air dams intact and operating properly? No: Repair or replace engine fan,
fan shroud, and/or air dams. After
repairs are complete, retest for
SPN 110 FMI 7.
Fault Overview
Fault code sets when Electronic Control Module (ECM) detects Engine Coolant Temperature 1 (ECT1) is above
Programmable Parameter (PP) 77011.
Lamp Reaction
Red Stop Lamp and Warning buzzer turned ON.
Associated Faults
SPN 110 FMI 2, 3, and 4
(ECT1)
Fault Facts
Fault may set by incorrect value in programmable parameters in Navistar® Engine Diagnostics.
SPN 110 FMI 16 - Engine Coolant System Above OBD Maximum Temperature
Fault Overview
Fault sets when ECT1 signal is stuck in range high.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
SPN 110 FMI 2, 3, and 4
Fault Facts
This fault sets when the Engine Warning Protection System (EWPS) detects Engine Coolant Temperature 1
(ECT1) has risen above a critical set point. Fault may be caused by actual high coolant temperature or by a
fault in ECT1 sensor circuit.
Fault Overview
Fault sets when Engine Control Module (ECM) determines Engine Coolant Temperature 1 (ECT1) signal is in
range, but lower then expected.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
SPN 110 FMI 2, 3, and 4
(ECT1)
Fault Facts
None
SPN 110 FMI 18 - Engine Coolant System below closed loop minimum Temperature
Fault Overview
Fault sets when minimum closed-loop coolant temperature of < 68°F (20°C) is not reached.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
SPN 110 FMI 2, 3, and 4
(ECT1)
Fault Facts
None
Fault Overview
Fault code sets when Engine Control Module (ECM) detects coolant level is below minimum level.
Lamp Reaction
Red Stop Lamp will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
This fault sets when Engine Warning Protection System (EWPS) detects Engine Coolant Level (ECL) has fallen
below a minimum level. Fault may be caused by actual low coolant level or by a fault in Engine Coolant Level
(ECL) sensor circuit. SPN 111 FMI 1 fault also sets RSL.
Step 5 Check if SPN 111 FMI 1 is active with ECL disconnected. Decision
A. Key OFF. Disconnect ECL sensor. Yes: Repair short between
ECL sensor pin-A and ECM
B. Key ON, clear codes.
pin C-42. After repairs are
C. Key OFF. complete, retest for fault.
D. Key ON, check Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC) list for SPN 111 FMI 1.
Is EST DTC list SPN 111 FMI 1 still active? No: Replace ECL sensor.
After repairs are complete,
retest for fault.
288 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
A
A
D
E
0000433250
0000431421
0000431420
A
B
E
B A
0000433249
0000433248
B. Drain coolant below ECL sensor and remove sensor from tank.
Fault Overview
The Engine control Module (ECM) will set this fault when Engine Coolant Level (ECL) signal is greater than 3.5
volts or less than 4.4 volts.
Lamp Reaction
Amber Warning Lamp (AWL) will illuminate when this fault is detected.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
This fault code can only set on vehicles equipped with the Coolant Level Module (CLM) and probe level sensors.
The float style sensors will not set this fault code.
A
A
D
E
0000433250
0000431421
0000431420
A
B
E
B A
0000433249
0000433248
B. Drain coolant below ECL sensor and remove sensor from tank.
SPN 132 FMI 0 - Engine Inlet Air Mass Flow Rate High
Fault Overview
Fault sets when Engine Control Module (ECM) determines difference between desired Mass Air Flow (MAF)
rate and measured MAF rate is incorrect and/or erratic.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
SPN 27 FMI 0 and 14 SPN 132 FMI 3 and 4 SPN 2791 FMI 2, 7, 8, and
14
Fault Facts
None
Step 3 Inspect air intake system and air filter for restrictions, air leaks, or Decision
physical damage.
Perform Intake Air Inspection (page 1648) and Charge Air Cooler Inspection (page Yes: Go to Step 4.
1646).
Is air intake system and air filter free of restrictions, leaks, and physical damage? No: Repair intake air system or
replace air filter. After repairs are
complete, retest for SPN 132 FMI
0.
Step 4 Inspect connections at Mass Air Flow/Inlet Air Temperature (MAF/IAT) Decision
sensor.
A. Key OFF. Yes: Go to Step 5.
B. Disconnect MAF/IAT connector.
C. Inspect MAF/IAT and connector for: damaged or pinched wires; wet or
corroded terminals; loose, bent, or broken pins; or broken connector
housing.
Are MAF/IAT connector, harness, and terminals clean and undamaged? No: Repair connector, harness,
or terminal damage. After repairs
are complete, retest for SPN 132
FMI 0
SPN 132 FMI 1 - Engine Inlet Air Mass Flow Rate Low
Fault Overview
Fault sets when Engine Control Module (ECM) determines deviation between Mass Air Flow (MAF) rate and
measured MAF rate is below threshold.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
• SPN 27 (EGR) • SPN 132 FMI 3, 4, and 13 • SPN 164 (ICP) • SPN 651 - 656 (INJ)
(MAF)
• SPN 2791 (EGR) • SPN 2797 (INJ) • SPN 2798 (INJ) • SPN 3659 - 3664 (INJ)
• SPN 4257 (INJ Perf.)
Fault Facts
None
Step 3 Inspect air intake system and air filter for restrictions, air leaks, and Decision
physical damage.
Perform Intake Air Inspection (page 1648) and Charge Air Cooler Inspection (page Yes: Go to Step 4.
1646).
Is air intake system and air filter free of restrictions, leaks, and physical damage? No: Repair intake air system or
replace air filter. After repairs are
complete, retest for SPN 132 FMI
1.
Step 4 Inspect connections at Mass Air Flow (MAF)/Inlet Air Temperature Decision
(IAT) sensor.
A. Key OFF. Yes: Go to Step 5.
B. Disconnect MAF/IAT sensor.
C. Check MAF/IAT sensor and connector terminals for: damaged or pinched
wires; wet or corroded terminals; loose, bent, or broken pins; or broken
connector housing.
Are MAF/IAT sensor connector, harness, and terminals clean and undamaged? No: Repair connector, harness,
or terminal damage. After repairs
are complete, retest for SPN 132
FMI 1
Fault Overview
Fault sets when Mass Air Flow (MAF) frequency is out of range.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
None
Test 1
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect MAF sensor.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4960 to vehicle harness and leave MAF sensor disconnected.
Test 2
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect MAF sensor.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4960 to vehicle harness and leave MAF sensor disconnected.
D. Key ON, Engine OFF (KOEO).
Test 3
A. Key OFF.
Fault Overview
Fault sets when Mass Air Flow (MAF) frequency is out of range.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
None
Step 3 Inspect air intake system, CAC, and MAF sensor for air leaks or Decision
physical damage.
Perform Intake Air Inspection (page 1648) and Charge Air Cooler (page 1646) Yes: Go to Step 4.
Inspection. Also check MAF sensor for damage, oil contamination, or debris.
Is air intake system and CAC free of leaks and physical damage? No: Repair intake air system or
CAC system as required. Replace
MAF if damage or contamination
is present. After repairs are
complete, retest for SPN 132 FMI
4.
See latest version of MaxxForce® DT, 9 and 10 Engine and Aftertreatment Wiring Schematic Form 0000003221
for additional circuit information.
Required Tools
• Breakout Harness ZTSE4960
• Digital Multimeter (DMM)
Test 1
A. Key-Off.
Test 2
A. Key-Off.
B. Disconnect Mass Air Flow (MAF) sensor.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4960 to vehicle harness and leave MAF sensor disconnected.
D. Key-On Engine-Off (KOEO).
324 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Test 3
A. Key-Off.
B. Disconnect Mass Air Flow (MAF) sensor.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4960 to vehicle harness and leave MAF sensor disconnected.
D. Key-On Engine-Off (KOEO).
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 325
SPN 132 FMI 11 - MAF Sensor Calibration - Insufficient number of data points
Fault Overview
Fault code sets when Mass Air Flow (MAF) sensor calibration fails due to entry criteria not being met.
Lamp Reaction
Amber Warning Lamp (AWL) illuminates when fault is active.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
Engine Coolant Temperature (EOT) and Engine Oil Temperature (EOT) must be at or above 176°F (80°C) during
entire MAF calibration procedure.
Step 5 Determine if air filter and intake air system are leaking, damage or Decision
restricted.
Perform Intake Air Inspection (page 1648) and Charge Air Cooler Inspection (page Yes, minor leak: Repair air
1646). intake system leaks, damage or
restrictions. Go to Step 6.
Are intake air system components leaking, damaged or restricted? Yes, major leak: Repair air
intake system leaks, damage
or restrictions. Rerun MAF
calibration.
No: Go to Step 6.
Step 7 Determine if MAF sensor, connector, wiring, and/or terminals are Decision
damaged or corroded.
A. Turn ignition Key-Off. Yes: Repair connector, wiring,
terminal, pin damage or corrosion.
B. Disconnect MAF sensor connector.
After repairs are complete. Retest
C. Inspect MAF sensor, connector, wiring and terminals for: for SPN 132 FMI 11.
Step 8 Determine if KOEO Intake Manifold Pressure (IMP), Intake Manifold Decision
Temperature (IMT), and Exhaust Back Pressure (EBP) are within
specification.
A. Turn ignition Key-On, Engine-Off (KOEO). Yes: Go to Step 9.
B. Use EST with Navistar® Engine Diagnostics Select: Pressure tab.
C. Determine Intake Manifold Pressure, and Exhaust Back Pressure Value.
Step 9 Determine if IMP and IMT sensors or bores are coked, restricted, or Decision
damaged.
A. Remove IMP and IMT sensors. See Engine Service Manual. Yes: Clean sensors and sensor
bores. Replace damaged
B. Inspect IMP and IMT sensors and bores for carbon build up, coking,
sensors. After repairs are
restrictions and damage.
complete, retest for SPN 132 FMI
11.
Do sensors or sensor bores have carbon build up, coking, restrictions, or damage? No: Go to Step 10.
Step 10 Determine if vehicle is a Monaco RV with Rated Power of 350 hp. Decision
Use EST with Navistar® Engine Diagnostics, determine vehicles Rated Power listed Yes: Go to Step 11.
in Vehicle Information tab on default page.
Is this a Monaco RV with Rated Power of 350 hp? No: Go to Step 12.
Step 12 Determine if MAF Mean Value maximum was greater than 1500 mg Decision
during MAF Sensor Calibration.
A. Use EST with Navistar® Engine Diagnostics select: File > Open Snapshot Yes: Go to Step 14.
Recording File.
B. Select and Open MAF Sensor Calibration previously recorded.
C. Select Graph box (3) for: Engine Speed (1) and MAF Mean Value (Figure
97).
Is MAF Mean Value maximum (2) greater than 1500 mg? No: Go to Step 13.
Step 14 Determine if Charge Air Cooler (CAC) or hoses are restricted. Decision
A. Remove CAC hoses. Yes: Clean or replace restricted
component(s). After repairs are
B. Inspect CAC hoses for internal damage.
complete, retest for SPN 132 FMI
C. Inspect CAC for carbon buildup and restrictions. 11.
Is CAC and/or CAC hoses restricted? No: Go to Step 15.
Step 20 Determine if leaks are present in Charge Air Cooler (CAC) system. Decision
Perform High-Pressure Charge Air Cooler (HPCAC) Pressure Test. (page 1545) Yes: Go to Step 21.
Does CAC system pass test? No: Repair CAC leaks. After
repairs are complete, retest for
SPN 132 FMI 11.
Fault Overview
Fault code sets when Engine Control Module (ECM) has been programmed and Mass Air Flow (MAF) sensor
needs to be calibrated.
Lamp Reaction
Amber Warning Lamp (AWL) illuminates when this fault is active.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
None
Fault Overview
Fault code sets when Mass Air Flow (MAF) sensor calibration fails.
Lamp Reaction
Amber Warning Lamp (AWL) illuminates when fault is active.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
Engine Coolant Temperature (EOT) and Engine Oil Temperature (EOT) must be at or above 176°F (80°C) during
entire MAF calibration procedure.
Fault Overview
Fault sets when Engine Control Module (ECM) detects a short to PWR, short to GND, or an Open circuit in Mass
Air Flow (MAF) sensor circuits.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
None
See latest version of Navistar® N9 and N10 Engine and Aftertreatment Wiring Schematic Form 0000003481 for
additional circuit information.
Tools Required
• Breakout Harness ZTSE4960
• Breakout Harness ZTSE6020
• Digital Multimeter (DMM)
342 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Test 1
A. Key-Off.
B. Disconnect Mass Air Flow (MAF) sensor.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4960 to vehicle harness and leave MAF sensor disconnected.
D. Key-On Engine-Off (KOEO).
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 343
Test 2
A. Key-Off.
B. Disconnect Mass Air Flow (MAF) sensor.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4960 to vehicle harness and leave MAF sensor disconnected.
D. Key-On Engine-Off (KOEO).
Test 3
A. Key-Off.
Test 4
A. Key-Off.
B. Disconnect Mass Air Flow (MAF) sensor.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4960 to vehicle harness and leave MAF sensor disconnected.
D. Key-On Engine-Off (KOEO).
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 345
Test 5
A. Key-Off.
B. Disconnect Mass Air Flow (MAF) sensor.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4960 to vehicle harness and leave MAF sensor disconnected.
D. Key-On Engine-Off (KOEO).
346 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Test 6
A. Key-Off.
B. Disconnect 24-pin Engine to Chassis connector.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE6020 to engine harness and leave chassis harness disconnected.
D. Key-On Engine-Off (KOEO).
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 347
Test 7
A. Key-Off.
B. Disconnect Mass Air Flow (MAF) sensor.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4960 to vehicle harness and leave MAF sensor disconnected.
D. Key-On Engine-Off (KOEO).
Test 8
A. Key-Off.
Test 9
A. Key-Off.
B. Disconnect 24-pin Engine to Chassis connector.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE6020 to engine harness and leave chassis harness disconnected.
D. Key-On Engine-Off (KOEO).
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 349
Fault Overview
Fault sets when Engine Control Module (ECM) switched voltage is too high.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two trips.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
This fault may set if vehicle has been jump-started or charged using a 24V power supply.
Fault Overview
Fault sets when Engine Control Module (ECM) switched voltage is too low with battery voltage within normal
operating range.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
None
WARNING:
To prevent property damage, personal injury, or death, keep flames or sparks away from
vehicle and do not smoke while servicing vehicle’s batteries.
To prevent property damage, personal injury, or death, wear eye protection when working
near batteries.
352 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Test 1
A. Key-Off.
B. Disconnect Engine Control Module (ECM) PWR relay connector.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4674 between vehicle harness and ECM PWR relay.
D. Key-On Engine-Off (KOEO).
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 355
Test 2
A. Key-Off.
B. Disconnect ECM PWR relay connector.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4674 between vehicle harness and ECM PWR relay, leave ECM PWR
relay connector disconnected.
D. Key-On Engine-Off (KOEO).
356 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Test 3
A. Key-Off.
B. Disconnect ECM PWR relay connector.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4674 between vehicle harness and ECM PWR relay, leave ECM PWR
relay connector disconnected.
D. Key-On Engine-Off (KOEO).
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 357
Test 4
A. Key-Off.
B. Disconnect ECM PWR relay connector.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4674 between vehicle harness and ECM PWR relay, leave ECM PWR
relay connector disconnected.
D. Key-On Engine-Off (KOEO).
358 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Test 5
A. Key-Off.
B. Disconnect 9260 connector.
C. Use Terminal Test Kit ZTSE4435C, insert correct terminal into connector 9260 pin-C battery side and leave
connector 9260 ECM side disconnected.
D. Key-On Engine-Off (KOEO).
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 359
Test 6
A. Key-Off.
B. Disconnect 9260 connector.
C. Use Terminal Test Kit ZTSE4435C, insert correct terminal into connector 9260 pin-A battery side and leave
connector 9260 ECM side disconnected.
D. Key-On Engine-Off (KOEO).
360 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Fault Overview
Fault sets when Engine Control Module (ECM) detects Injection Control Pressure (ICP) sensor voltage is offset
during check at Key OFF.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
Do not replace Injection Control Pressure (ICP) sensor unless directed by diagnostic procedure.
Step 2 Determine if ICP voltage is out of range high during Continuous Decision
Monitor Test.
Perform Continuous Monitor Test (page 1361)while monitoring ICP voltage. Yes: Replace ICP sensor. After
repairs are complete, retest for
SPN 164 FMI 0.
Is ICP Voltage greater than 0.55 volts? No, voltage displays “ERROR”:
Go to Step 3.
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 361
Step 3 Determine if ICP circuit between UVC #1 connector and 36-Pin ECM Decision
Driver connector is shorted or has high resistance.
A. Key OFF. Disconnect UVC #1 connector at the valve cover front left. Yes: Go to Step 4.
B. Key ON. Using EST, clear codes by clicking the Clear DTCs button.
Step 4 Determine if ICP circuit between UVC harness ICP connector and Decision
UVC #1 connector is shorted or has high resistance.
A. Key OFF. Reconnect engine harness to UVC #1 connector. Yes: Replace ICP sensor. After
repairs are complete, retest for
B. Remove valve cover. See Engine Service Manual for additional information.
SPN 164 FMI 0.
C. Disconnect ICP sensor connector.
D. Key ON. Using EST, clear codes by clicking the Clear DTCs button.
E. Check Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) list.
Is SPN 164 FMI 3 Pending or Active? No: Repair ICP circuit between
UVC ICP harness connector pin-3
and UVC #1 connector pin-6.
After repairs are complete, retest
for SPN 164 FMI 0.
Fault Overview
Fault code sets when Injection Control Pressure (ICP) is lower than 3.5 MPa while engine is cranking for 2.5
seconds.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
• SPN 164 FMI 3 and 4 • SPN 679 FMI 3 and 4
(ICP) (IPR)
Fault Facts
Do not replace Injection Control Pressure (ICP) sensor unless directed by diagnostic procedure. If High-Pressure
Oil Pump (HPOP) is replaced due to pump failure, remove and clean High-Pressure (HP) oil rail, HP oil hose
and fittings to remove contamination or debris.
Fault Overview
Update calibration to prevent this fault code from falsely setting.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
Do not replace Injection Control Pressure (ICP) sensor unless directed by diagnostic procedure.
Fault Overview
Fault code sets when Engine Control Module (ECM) detects Injection Control Pressure (ICP) signal greater than
4.9 volts.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
SPN 3509 FMI 3 and 4
(VREF 1)
Fault Facts
Do not replace Injection Control Pressure (ICP) sensor unless directed by diagnostic procedure.
Step 7 Check SIG GND circuit for Open or high resistance. Decision
A. Perform Test 4 (page 370). Yes: Repair Open between UVC
pin-7 and ECM pin D-14. After
B. Use EST with Navistar® Engine Diagnostics, clear DTC list.
repairs are complete, retest for
SPN 164 FMI 3.
Does SPN 164 FMI 4 set after DTC list is cleared? No: Repair Open between UVC
pin-6 and ECM pin D-15. After
repairs are complete, retest for
SPN 164 FMI 3.
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 367
Step 8 Check for broken locking tab on or damage to harness connector. Decision
A. Perform Test 5 (page 371). Yes: Go to Step 9.
B. Use DMM, measure resistance between Breakout Harness ZTSE4952
pin-6 and Breakout Harness ZTSE4686 pin-3.
Is resistance less than 5 ohms? No: Replace UVC harness. After
repairs are complete, retest for
SPN 164 FMI 3.
Step 9 Check for broken Locking tab on or damage to harness connector. Decision
A. Perform Test 6 (page 372). Yes: Go to Step 10.
B. Use DMM, measure resistance between Breakout Harness ZTSE4952
pin-8 and Breakout Harness ZTSE4686 pin-2.
Is resistance less than 5 ohms? No: Replace UVC harness. After
repairs are complete, retest for
SPN 164 FMI 3.
See latest version of MaxxForce® DT, 9, and 10 Engine and Aftertreatment Wiring Schematic Form 0000003221
for additional circuit information.
Tools Required
• Breakout Harness ZTSE4498
• Breakout Harness ZTSE4686
• Breakout Harness ZTSE4952
• Digital Multimeter (DMM)
Test 1
A. Key OFF.
Test 2
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect Under Valve Cover (UVC) harness.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4952 to engine harness and leave UVC harness disconnected.
D. Key ON Engine OFF (KOEO).
370 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Test 3
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect Under Valve Cover (UVC) harness.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4952 to engine harness and leave UVC harness disconnected.
D. Use Breakout Harness ZTSE4498, short Breakout Harness ZTSE4952 pin-6 and pin-7 together.
E. Connect EST to vehicle Diagnostic Connector (page 1345)
F. Key ON Engine OFF (KOEO), log in to Navistar® Engine Diagnostics.
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 371
Test 4
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect Under Valve Cover (UVC) harness.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4952 to engine harness and leave UVC harness disconnected.
D. Use Breakout Harness ZTSE4498, short Breakout Harness ZTSE4952 pin-6 to known good GND.
E. Connect EST to vehicle Diagnostic Connector (page 1345)
F. Key ON Engine OFF (KOEO), log in to Navistar® Engine Diagnostics.
372 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Test 5
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect Under Valve Cover (UVC) harness.
C. Remove valve cover (See Engine Service Manual).
D. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4952 to UVC harness and leave engine harness disconnected.
E. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4686 to UVC harness leave Injection Control Pressure (ICP) sensor
disconnected.
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 373
Test 6
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect Under Valve Cover (UVC) harness.
C. Remove valve cover (SeeEngine Service Manual).
D. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4952 to UVC harness and leave engine harness disconnected.
E. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4686 to UVC harness and leave Injection Control Pressure (ICP) sensor
disconnected.
374 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Test 7
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect Under Valve Cover (UVC) harness.
C. Remove valve cover (See Engine Service Manual).
D. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4952 to UVC harness and leave engine harness disconnected.
E. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4686 to UVC harness leave Injection Control Pressure (ICP) sensor
disconnected.
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 375
Fault Overview
Fault code sets when Injection Control Pressure (ICP) sensor signal is less than 0.1 volts.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
SPN 3509 FMI 3 and 4
(VREF 1)
Fault Facts
Do not replace Injection Control Pressure (ICP) sensor unless directed by diagnostic procedure.
Step 3 Inspect connections at Under Valve Cover (UVC) harness connector Decision
for ICP sensor.
A. Key OFF. No: Go to Step 4.
See latest version of MaxxForce® DT, 9, and 10 Engine and Aftertreatment Wiring Schematic Form 0000003221
for additional circuit information.
Tools Required
• Breakout Harness ZTSE4793 (UVC)
• Digital Multimeter (DMM)
• Electronic Service Tool (EST) with Navistar® Engine Diagnostics
• Interface cable (RP1210B-compliant supporting J1939 and J1708)
Test 1
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect UVC engine harness connector that leads under valve cover.
C. Connect Breakout harness ZTSE4793 to UVC engine harness connector that leads under valve cover and
leave vehicle harness disconnected.
378 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Fault Overview
Update calibration to prevent this fault code from falsely setting.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
Do not replace Injection Control Pressure (ICP) sensor unless directed by diagnostic procedure.
Fault Overview
Update calibration to prevent this fault code from falsely setting.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
None
Fault facts
Do not replace Injection Control Pressure (ICP) sensor unless directed by diagnostic procedure.
Fault Overview
Fault sets when Engine Control Module (ECM) detects Injection Control Pressure (ICP) exceeds set point by
threshold value for current engine speed and torque.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
• SPN 164 FMI 1, 3, and • SPN 679 FMI 3 and 4 (IPR) • SPN 3055 FMI 2 (INJ)
4 (ICP)
Fault Facts
Do not replace Injection Control Pressure (ICP) sensor unless directed by diagnostic procedure.
Step 1 Inspect vehicle history for high-pressure oil system repairs Decision
Determine if vehicle history included high-pressure oil system repairs. Yes: Perform Fuel Pressure
Adaptation Reset (page 1341).
Retest for SPN 164 FMI 17.
Were high-pressure oil system repairs recently performed? No: Go to Step 2.
Fault Overview
Fault sets when Engine Control Module (ECM) detects Injection Control Pressure (ICP) exceeds set point by
threshold value for current engine speed and torque.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
• SPN 164 FMI 0, 1, 3, and • SPN 679 FMI 3 and 4
4 (ICP) (IPR)
Fault Facts
Do not replace Injection Control Pressure (ICP) sensor unless directed by diagnostic procedure.
Step 2 Inspect vehicle history for High-Pressure (HP) oil system repairs Decision
Determine if vehicle history included HP oil system repairs. Yes: Perform Fuel Pressure
Adaptation Reset (page 1341).
Retest for SPN 164 FMI 16.
Were HP oil system repairs recently performed? No: Go to Step 3.
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 383
Step 4 Test HPOP Injection Pressure Regulator (IPR) electrical circuit. Decision
Perform CPA High-Pressure Oil Pump (HPOP) Test (page 1440). Yes: Repair IPR circuit. After
repairs are complete, retest for
SPN 164 FMI 16.
Does HPOP Test detect a problem with IPR valve electrical circuit? No: Go to Step 5.
Fault Overview
Fault sets when Engine Control Module (ECM) detects Injection Control Pressure (ICP) value remains below
set point by threshold value for current engine speed and torque.
Lamp Reaction
No Lamp
Associated Faults
• SPN 164 FMI 1, 3, and 4 • SPN 679 FMI 3 and 4 • SPN 3055 FMI 2 (INJ)
(ICP) (IPR)
Fault Facts
Do not replace Injection Control Pressure (ICP) sensor unless directed by diagnostic procedure.
Fault Overview
Fault sets when Engine Control Module (ECM) detects Injection Control Pressure (ICP) value remains below
set point by threshold value for current engine speed and torque.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
• SPN 164 FMI 1, 3, and 4 • SPN 679 FMI 3 and 4 • SPN 3055 FMI 2 (INJ)
(ICP) (IPR)
Fault Facts
Do not replace Injection Control Pressure (ICP) sensor unless directed by diagnostic procedure.
Step 2 Inspect vehicle history for High-Pressure (HP) oil system repairs Decision
Determine if vehicle history included HP oil system repairs. Yes: Perform Fuel Pressure
Adaptation Reset (page 1341)
procedure. Retest for SPN 164
FMI 18.
Were HP oil system repairs recently performed? No: Go to Step 3.
Step 5 Test HPOP Injection Pressure Regulator (IPR) electrical circuit. Decision
Perform CPA High-Pressure Oil Pump (HPOP) Test (page 1440). Yes: Repair IPR circuit. After
repairs are complete, retest for
SPN 164 FMI 18.
Does CPA HPOP Test detect a problem with IPR valve electrical circuit? No: Go to Step 6.
388 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Fault Overview
Fault sets when the Engine Control Module (ECM) detects Injection Control Pressure (ICP) exceeds maximum
pressure for current operating conditions.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
Do not replace Injection Control Pressure (ICP) sensor unless directed by diagnostic procedure.
Step 2 Inspect Injection Pressure Regulator (IPR) valve and connector. Decision
A. Key OFF. Yes: Go to Step 3.
B. Disconnect IPR valve.
C. Check IPR valve and connector terminals for: damaged or pinched wires;
wet or corroded terminals; loose, bent, or broken pins; or broken connector
housing.
Are IPR valve connector, harness, and terminals clean and undamaged? No: Repair connector, harness,
or terminal damage. After repairs
are complete, retest for SPN 164
FMI 20.
Fault Overview
Fault code sets when Engine Control Module (ECM) detects that difference between Intake Air Temperature
(IAT) sensor reading and other temperature sensor reading is greater than 27°F (-3°C)
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
SPN 172 FMI 3 and 4 (IAT)
Fault Facts
None
See latest version of MaxxForce® DT, 9, and 10 Engine and Aftertreatment Wiring Schematic Form 0000003221
for additional circuit information.
Tools Required
• Breakout Harness ZTSE4960
• 500-ohm Resistor Harness ZTSE4497
• Electronic Service Tool (EST) with Navistar® Engine Diagnostics
• Interface cable (RP1210B-compliant supporting J1939 and J1708)
394 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Test 1
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect Intake Air Temperature (IAT) sensor.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4960 to vehicle harness connector and leave IAT sensor disconnected.
D. Connect Resistor Harness ZTSE4497 between Breakout Harness ZTSE4960 pin-A and pin-B.
E. Connect Electronic Service Tool (EST) to vehicle Diagnostic Connector (page 1345).
F. Key ON Engine OFF (KOEO). Log in to Navistar® Engine Diagnostics.
Test 2
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect Intake Air Temperature (IAT) sensor.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4960 to vehicle harness connector and leave IAT sensor disconnected.
D. Connect Resistor Harness ZTSE4497 between Breakout Harness ZTSE4960 pin-A and known good GND.
E. Connect Electronic Service Tool (EST) to vehicle Diagnostic Connector (page 1345).
F. Key ON Engine OFF (KOEO). Log in to Navistar® Engine Diagnostics.
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 395
Fault Overview
Fault code sets when Electronic Control Module (ECM) detects Intake Air Temperature (IAT) sensor voltage is
greater than 4.8 volts for 2.5 seconds.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
None
Step 2 Inspect Mass Air Flow (MAF) sensor connector for damage. Decision
A. Key-On Key-Off (KOEO). Yes: Go to Step 3.
See latest version of MaxxForce® DT, 9, and 10 Engine and Aftertreatment Wiring Schematic Form 0000003221
for additional circuit information.
Tools Required
• Breakout Harness ZTSE4498
• Breakout Harness ZTSE4960
• Digital Multimeter (DMM)
• Electronic Service Tool (EST) with Navistar® Engine Diagnostics
• Interface cable (RP1210B-compliant supporting J1939 and J1708)
398 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Test 1
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect Mass Air Flow (MAF) sensor.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4960 to vehicle harness and leave MAF sensor disconnected.
D. Key ON Engine OFF (KOEO).
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 399
Test 2
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect Mass Air Flow (MAF) sensor.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4960 to vehicle harness and leave MAF sensor disconnected.
D. Use Breakout Harness ZTSE4498, short Breakout Harness ZTSE4960 pin-A and pin-B together.
E. Connect Electronic Service Tool (EST) to Vehicle Diagnostic Connector (page 1345).
F. Key ON Engine OFF (KOEO). Log in to Navistar® Engine Diagnostics.
400 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Test 3
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect Mass Air Flow (MAF) sensor.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4960 to vehicle harness and leave MAF sensor disconnected.
D. Use Breakout Harness ZTSE4498, short Breakout Harness ZTSE4960 pin-A to known good GND.
E. Connect EST to Vehicle Diagnostic Connector (page 1345).
F. Key ON Engine OFF (KOEO). Log in to Navistar® Engine Diagnostics.
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 401
Fault Overview
Fault code sets when Electronic Control Module detects Intake Air Temperature (IAT) sensor voltage signal is
less than expected.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
None
Fault Overview
Fault sets when Engine Control Module (ECM) detects difference between estimated Exhaust Gas Temperature
(EGT) and actual EGT is greater than 540°F (300°C) for 25.5 seconds.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
SPN 173 FMI 3 and 4 (EGT)
Fault Facts
ECM estimates EGT based on engine speed and torque, engine coolant temperature, and barometric pressure.
See latest version of MaxxForce® DT, 9, and 10 Engine and Aftertreatment Wiring Schematic Form 0000003221
for additional circuit information.
Tools Required
• Breakout Harness ZTSE4946
• 500-ohm Resistor Harness ZTSE4497
• Electronic Service Tool (EST) with Navistar® Engine Diagnostics
• Interface cable (RP1210B-compliant supporting J1939 and J1708)
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 407
Test 1
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect Exhaust Gas Temperature (EGT) sensor.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4946 to vehicle harness connector and leave EGT sensor disconnected.
D. Connect Resistor Harness ZTSE4497 between Breakout Harness ZTSE4946 pin-1 and pin-2.
E. Connect Electronic Service Tool (EST) to vehicle Diagnostic Connector (page 1345).
F. Key ON Engine OFF (KOEO). Log in to Navistar® Engine Diagnostics.
408 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Test 2
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect Exhaust Gas Temperature (EGT) sensor.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4946 to vehicle harness connector and leave EGT sensor disconnected.
D. Connect Resistor Harness ZTSE4497 between Breakout Harness ZTSE4946 pin-2 and known good GND.
E. Connect Electronic Service Tool (EST) to vehicle Diagnostic Connector (page 1345).
F. Key ON Engine OFF (KOEO). Log in to Navistar® Engine Diagnostics.
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 409
Fault Overview
Fault code sets when Engine Control Module (ECM) detects Exhaust Gas Temperature (EGT) is above maximum
threshold.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
SPN 5742 FMI 19
Fault Facts
None
Step 3 Inspect for Exhaust Gas Temperature (EGT) sensor for damage. Decision
A. Key OFF. Yes: Go to Step 4.
B. Disconnect EGT sensor connector.
C. Inspect EGT connector for: damage, pinched wires, corroded terminals,
loose, bent or broken pins, or broken connector housing.
Is EGT connector, harness, and terminals clean and undamaged? No: Repair connector, harness,
or terminal damage. After repairs
are complete, retest for SPN 173
FMI 3.
See latest version of MaxxForce® DT, 9, and 10 Engine and Aftertreatment Wiring Schematic Form 0000003221
for additional circuit information.
Tools Required
• Breakout Harness ZTSE4498
• Breakout Harness ZTSE4946
• Digital Multimeter (DMM)
• Electronic Service Tool (EST) with Navistar® Engine Diagnostics
• Interface cable (RP1210B-compliant supporting J1939 and J1708)
Test 1
A. Key-Off.
B. Disconnect Exhaust Gas Temperature (EGT) sensor.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4946 to vehicle harness and leave EGT sensor disconnected.
Test 2
A. Key-Off.
B. Disconnect Exhaust Gas Temperature (EGT) sensor.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4946 to EGT sensor connector and leave EGT sensor disconnected.
D. Use Breakout Harness ZTSE4498, short Breakout Harness ZTSE4946 pin-1 and pin-2 together.
E. Connect EST to vehicle Diagnostic Connector (page 1345).
F. Key-On Engine-Off (KOEO), log in to Navistar® Engine Diagnostics.
414 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Test 3 Setup
A. Key-Off.
B. Disconnect Exhaust Gas Temperature (EGT) sensor.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4946 to EGT sensor connector and leave EGT sensor disconnected.
D. Use Breakout Harness ZTSE4498, short Breakout Harness ZTSE4946 pin-2 to known good GND.
E. Connect EST to vehicle Diagnostic Connector (page 1345).
F. Key-On Engine-Off (KOEO), log in to Navistar® Engine Diagnostics.
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 415
Fault Overview
Fault sets when Engine Control Module (ECM) determines Exhaust Gas Temperature (EGT) is below minimum
allowable threshold for a predetermined amount of time.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
None
Fault Overview
At Key-On Engine-Off (KOEO) after a cold soak, the Engine Control Module (ECM) compares the Engine Oil
Temperature (EOT) sensor to Intake Manifold Temperature (IMT), Intake Air Temperature (IAT), Turbocharger
2 Compressor Intake Temperature (TC2CIT), Charge Air Cooler Outlet Temperature (CACOT), and Engine
Coolant Temperature 1 (ECT1) sensors.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
SPN 175 FMI 3 and 4 (EOT)
Fault Facts
None
See latest version of MaxxForce® DT, 9, and 10 Engine and Aftertreatment Wiring Schematic Form 0000003221
for additional circuit information.
Tools Required
• Breakout Harness ZTSE4602
• 500 Ohm Resistor Harness ZTSE4497
• Electronic Service Tool (EST) with Navistar® Engine Diagnostics
• Interface cable (RP1210B-compliant supporting J1939 and J1708)
420 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Test 1
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect Engine Oil Temperature (EOT) sensor.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4602 to vehicle harness connector and leave EOT sensor disconnected.
D. Connect Resistor Harness ZTSE4497 between Breakout Harness ZTSE4602 pin-1 and pin-2.
E. Connect Electronic Service Tool (EST) to vehicle Diagnostic Connector (page 1345).
F. Key ON Engine OFF (KOEO). Log in to Navistar® Engine Diagnostics.
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 421
Test 2
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect Engine Oil Temperature (EOT) sensor.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4602 to vehicle harness connector and leave EOT sensor disconnected.
D. Connect Resistor Harness ZTSE4497 between Breakout Harness ZTSE4602 pin-2 and known good GND.
E. Connect Electronic Service Tool (EST) to vehicle Diagnostic Connector (page 1345).
F. Key ON Engine OFF (KOEO). Log in to Navistar® Engine Diagnostics.
422 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Fault Overview
None
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
None
See latest version of MaxxForce® DT, 9, and 10 Engine and Aftertreatment Wiring Schematic Form 0000003221
for additional circuit information.
Tools Required
• 180-pin Breakout Box 00-00956-08
• Breakout Harness ZTSE4602
• Breakout Harness ZTSE4498
• Digital Multimeter (DMM)
• Electronic Service Tool (EST) with Navistar® Engine Diagnostics
• Interface cable (RP1210B-compliant supporting J1939 and J1708)
Test 1
A. Key OFF.
Test 2
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect Engine Oil Temperature (EOT) sensor.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4602 to vehicle harness connector and leave EOT sensor disconnected.
D. Use Breakout Harness ZTSE4498 to short Breakout Harness ZTSE4602 pin-1 to pin-2.
E. Connect Electronic Service Tool (EST) to vehicle Diagnostic Connector (page 1345).
F. Key ON Engine OFF (KOEO), log in to Navistar® Engine Diagnostics.
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 427
Test 3
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect Engine Oil Temperature (EOT) sensor.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4602 to vehicle harness connector and leave EOT sensor disconnected.
D. Use Breakout Harness ZTSE4498 to short Breakout Harness ZTSE4602 pin-2 to known good GND.
E. Connect EST to vehicle Diagnostic Connector (page 1345).
F. Key ON Engine OFF (KOEO), log in to Navistar® Engine Diagnostics.
428 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Fault Overview
Fault code sets when Engine Control Module (ECM) detects Engine Oil Temperature (EOT) signal is lower than
expected.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two trips.
Associated Faults
SPN 3509 FMI 3 and 4
(VREF 1)
Fault Facts
None
Drive Cycles
Key ON
Possible Causes
• EOT signal circuit short to GND
• Failed EOT sensor
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 429
Fault Overview
Fault code sets when Engine Control Module (ECM) detects difference between Engine Oil Temperature (EOT)
and Engine Coolant Temperature 1 (ECT1) sensors is greater than 27°F (15°C) after a cold soak.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
None
See latest version of MaxxForce® DT, 9, and 10 Engine and Aftertreatment Wiring Schematic Form 0000003221
for additional circuit information.
Tools Required
• Breakout Harness ZTSE4602
• 500 Ohm Resistor Harness ZTSE4497
• Digital Multimeter (DMM)
• Electronic Service Tool (EST) with Navistar® Engine Diagnostics
• Interface cable (RP1210B-compliant supporting J1939 and J1708)
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 435
Test 1
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect Engine Oil Temperature (EOT) sensor.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4602 to vehicle harness connector and leave EOT sensor disconnected.
D. Connect Resistor Harness ZTSE4497 between Breakout Harness ZTSE4602 pin-1 and pin-2.
E. Connect Electronic Service Tool (EST) to vehicle Diagnostic Connector (page 1345).
F. Key ON Engine OFF (KOEO). Log in to Navistar® Engine Diagnostics.
436 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Test 2
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect Engine Oil Temperature (EOT) sensor.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4602 to vehicle harness connector and leave EOT sensor disconnected.
D. Connect Resistor Harness ZTSE4497 between Breakout Harness ZTSE4602 pin-2 and known good GND.
E. Connect Electronic Service Tool (EST) to vehicle Diagnostic Connector (page 1345).
F. Key ON Engine OFF (KOEO). Log in to Navistar® Engine Diagnostics.
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 437
Test 3
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect EOT sensor.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4602 to EOT sensor and leave vehicle harness disconnected.
438 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Fault Overview
This fault is set by Engine Control Module (ECM) when Engine Oil Temperature (EOT) is above 261°F (127°C).
ECM illuminates red lamp (OWL). When temperature drops below 261°F (127°C) SPN/FMI will become not
active.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
This fault sets when Engine Warning Protection System (EWPS) detects Engine Oil Temperature (EOT) has
risen above a desired set point. Fault may be caused by actual high oil temperature or by a fault in EOT sensor
circuit.
Step 5 Check for failed oil system module thermal valve assembly. Decision
A. Perform Test 3 (page 443). Yes: Replace oil system module
thermal valve assembly. After
B. Use DMM, measure resistance between Breakout Harness ZTSE4602
repairs are complete, retest for
pin-1 and pin-2.
SPN 175 FMI 15.
Is resistance greater than 1000 ohms? No: Replace EOT sensor. After
repairs are complete, retest for
SPN 175 FMI 15.
See latest version of MaxxForce® DT, 9, and 10 Engine and Aftertreatment Wiring Schematic Form 0000003221
for additional circuit information.
Tools Required
• Breakout Harness ZTSE4602
• 500-ohm Resistor Harness ZTSE4497
• Electronic Service Tool (EST) with Navistar® Engine Diagnostics
• Interface cable (RP1210B-compliant supporting J1939 and J1708)
442 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Test 1
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect Engine Oil Temperature (EOT) sensor.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4602 to vehicle harness connector and leave EOT sensor disconnected.
D. Connect Resistor Harness ZTSE4497 between Breakout Harness ZTSE4602 pin-1 and pin-2.
E. Connect Electronic Service Tool (EST) to vehicle Diagnostic Connector (page 1345).
F. Key ON Engine OFF (KOEO). Log in to Navistar® Engine Diagnostics.
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 443
Test 2
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect Engine Oil Temperature (EOT) sensor.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4602 to vehicle harness connector and leave EOT sensor disconnected.
D. Connect Resistor Harness ZTSE4497 between Breakout Harness ZTSE4602 pin-2 and known good GND.
E. Connect Electronic Service Tool (EST) to vehicle Diagnostic Connector (page 1345).
F. Key ON Engine OFF (KOEO). Log in to Navistar® Engine Diagnostics.
444 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Test 3
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect Engine Oil Temperature (EOT) sensor.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4602 to vehicle harness connector and leave EOT sensor disconnected.
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 445
SPN 188 FMI 0 - Engine unable to achieve desired idle speed (too high)
Fault Overview
Fault code sets when vehicle is stationary and engine speed is greater than what is requested by Engine Control
Module (ECM).
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
• SPN 110 FMI 2 (ECT1)
Fault Facts
None
Step 2 Inspect for airborne combustibles (such as propane saturated air or Decision
ether) near engine.
Inspect air filter and intake system for stains, concentrations of contaminants, Yes: Go to Step 3.
odors/smells from external fuel sources, and modifications.
Is engine intake system intact and free from external fuel sources? No: Repair source of airborne
combustibles. After repairs are
complete, retest for SPN 188 FMI
0.
446 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Step 3 Inspect for engine oil leaking into air intake. Decision
Remove Charge Air Cooler (CAC) piping from Engine Throttle Valve (ETV), see Yes: Go to 7.2 Engine Oil Leak to
Engine Service Manual. Intake (page 103).
Is excessive engine oil leaking to intake? No: Go to Step 4.
Step 4 Inspect for contaminated fuel (alternate fuels other than diesel fuel). Decision
Perform Fuel Quality Inspection (page 1632). Yes: End Diagnostic steps. After
repairs are complete, retest for
SPN 188 FMI 0.
Is diesel fuel in good condition and not contaminated? No: Drain fuel tank, and fill with
clean and/or known good diesel
fuel. After repairs are complete,
retest for SPN 188 FMI 0.
SPN 188 FMI 1 - Engine unable to achieve desired idle speed (too low)
Fault Overview
Fault sets when vehicle is stationary and engine speed is less than what is requested by Engine Control Module
(ECM).
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
SPN 651 - 656 SPN 1322 - 1328 FMI 31
Fault Facts
None
Step 2 Check air intake, exhaust, and fuel systems for restrictions, leaks Decision
or damage.
• Perform Intake Air Inspection(page 1648), inspect for restrictions, leaks, or Yes: Go to Step 3.
physical damage.
• Perform Fuel System Inspection(page 1631), from fuel tank to Down Stream
Injection (DSI) assembly for leaks, physical damage, or contamination.
Are air intake system, exhaust system, fuel system, and air filter free of restrictions, No: Repair restrictions, leaks,
leaks, physical damage, and contamination? or physical damage. Replace
contaminated fluids as required.
After repairs are complete, retest
for SPN 188 FMI 1
448 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Step 3 Check that Fuel Delivery Pressure (FDP) is within specification. Decision
A. Key OFF. Yes: Go to Step 4.
B. Connect Electronic Service Tool (EST) to vehicle Diagnostic Connector
(page 1345).
Step 5 Check for Power Take Off (PTO) engagement without command. Decision
Key-On Engine-Running (KOER), monitor PTO output shaft rotation. Yes: Repair PTO unit. After
repairs are complete, retest for
SPN 188 FMI 1.
Is PTO output shaft rotating without throttle? No: Go to Step 6.
Fault Overview
Fault sets only when a vehicle is stationary and engine speed reaches 2,600 rpm with no fuel being requested
by Engine Control Module (ECM). Once conditions are met, ECM will initiate a protection strategy.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) and Red Stop Lamp (RSL) will illuminate when this fault is detected.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
Before beginning diagnosis:
• Take pictures of all damage/failure evidence.
• Do not replace any parts until a full inspection has been completed.
Step 1 Check for excessive oil in turbocharger outlet and Charge Air Cooler Decision
(CAC) piping.
A. Remove high-pressure turbocharger outlet pipe and CAC piping (see Yes: Go to 7.2 - Engine Oil Leak
Engine Service Manual). to Intake (page 103) step 2 to
repair oil leak to intake. After
B. Inspect outlets for excessive oil.
repairs are complete, clean CAC
using procedure in appropriate
Technician Manual and retest for
SPN 190 FMI 0.
Is there excessive oil in high-pressure turbocharger outlet pipe or CAC piping? No: Go to Step 2.
C. Key ON, Engine OFF (KOEO), log into Navistar® Engine Diagnostics.
D. Check ECM calibration for updates.
Is there an ECM calibration update available? No: End diagnostics. Retest for
SPN 190 FMI 0.
Fault Overview
Fault code sets when Electronic Control Module (ECM) detects Transmission Output Shaft Speed (TOSS) sensor
signal is out of range high.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
None
Step 2 Transmission Output Shaft Speed (TOSS) sensor and connector Decision
inspection
A. Key OFF. Yes: Go to Step 3.
B. Disconnect TOSS sensor.
C. Check TOSS sensor and connector terminals for: damaged or pinched
wires; wet or corroded terminals; loose, bent, or broken pins; or broken
connector housing.
Are TOSS sensor connector, harness, and terminals clean and undamaged? No: Repair connector, harness, or
terminal damage. After repairs are
complete, retest for SPN 191 FMI
3.
Fault Overview
Fault code sets when Electronic Control Module (ECM) detects Transmission Output Shaft Speed (TOSS) sensor
signal is out of range low.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
None
Step 2 Transmission Output Shaft Speed (TOSS) sensor and connector Decision
inspection
A. Key OFF. Yes: Go to Step 3.
B. Disconnect TOSS sensor.
C. Check TOSS sensor and connector terminals for: damaged or pinched
wires; wet or corroded terminals; loose, bent, or broken pins; or broken
connector housing.
Are TOSS sensor connector, harness, and terminals clean and undamaged? No: Repair connector, harness,
or terminal damage. After repairs
are complete, retest for SPN 191
FMI 4.
Fault Overview
Fault code sets when the Electronic Control Module (ECM) detects the Transmission Output Shaft Speed (TOSS)
sensor has an open circuit.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
None
E. Use DMM, measure voltage between TOSS vehicle harness pin-1 and
known good GND.
Is voltage between 1.2 and 1.7 volts? No: Repair open in TOSS-H
circuit. After repairs are complete,
retest for SPN 191 FMI 4.
Fault Overview
Fault code sets when the Electronic Control Module (ECM) detects an invalid vehicle speed value from the
Transmission Output Shaft Speed (TOSS) sensor.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
None
Step 2 Inspect Transmission Output Shaft Speed (TOSS) sensor and Decision
connector.
A. Key OFF. Yes: Go to Step 3.
B. Disconnect TOSS sensor.
C. Check TOSS sensor and connector terminals for: damaged or pinched
wires; wet or corroded terminals; loose, bent, or broken pins; or broken
connector housing.
Are TOSS sensor connector, harness, and terminals clean and undamaged? No: Repair connector, harness, or
terminal damage. After repairs are
complete, retest for SPN 191 FMI
14.
Fault Overview
Fault sets when Engine Control Module (ECM) determines engine cooling system is too hot.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
None
Step 2 Decision
Inspect vehicle grille for obstructions that may reduce air flow to Charge Air Cooler Yes: Go to Step 3.
(CAC).
Is vehicle grille free of obstructions? No: Repair or remove obstruction
from grille. After repairs are
complete, retest for SPN 518 FMI
2.
Step 3 Decision
Check engine fan, fan shroud, and air dams for damage and proper operation. Yes: Go to Step 4.
Are engine fan, fan shroud, and air dams intact and operating properly? No: Repair or replace engine fan,
fan shroud, and/or air dams. After
repairs are complete, retest for
SPN 518 FMI 2.
Step 4 Decision
Check CAC for oil, dirt, or other debris. Do CAC checks (page 1646). Yes: Go to Step 5.
Is CAC system free of dirt, debris, or oil? No: Clean CAC. After repairs are
complete, retest for SPN 518 FMI
2.
Step 5 Decision
Allow engine to cool for 8 hours. Compare ECT1 to Engine Oil Temperature (EOT), Yes: Go to Step 6.
Intake Manifold Temperature (IMT), Inlet Air Temperature (IAT), Charge Air Cooler
Outlet Temperature (CACOT), and Aftertreatment Fuel Inlet Temperature (AFTFIT)
sensors. All temperature sensors should be within 59°F (33°C) of each other.
Are all temperature sensors within 59°F (33°C) other sensors? No: Replace failed temperature
sensor. After repairs are
complete, retest for SPN 518 FMI
2.
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 463
Fault Overview
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
None
Fault Overview
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
None
Engine Idle Shutdown Timer (IST) for California ESS Compliant Engines
MaxxForce® engines certified for sale in state of California (CA) conform to mandatory California Air Resources
Board (CARB) Engine Shutdown System (ESS) regulations. Prior function of IST is available on CA ESS-exempt
and federally-certified engines (school buses, emergency, and military vehicles).
Engine idle duration is limited for ESS-compliant engines as follows:
• When vehicle parking brake is set, idle shutdown time is limited to CARB requirement of 5 minutes.
• When vehicle parking brake is released, idle shutdown time is limited to CARB requirement of 15 minutes.
Duration of CARB-mandated values can be reduced by programming customer IST programmable parameter
to value lower than 15 minutes. Adjusting this parameter reduces overall system shutdown time as follows:
• Adjusting parameter value between 5 and 15 minutes reduces idle shutdown time with vehicle parking brake
released. Default value of 5 minutes for vehicle parking brake set condition remains unaffected.
• Adjusting parameter value between 2 and 5 minutes reduces idle time for both vehicle parking brake released
and set conditions.
While IST is installed, idle shutdown time is factory-defaulted to 60 minutes and cannot be adjusted. If IST is
enabled, Cold Ambient Protection (CAP) will not function.
CARB IST feature is factory-programmed. Customers cannot turn IST off for ESS-compliant engines.
SPN 596 FMI 19 - Cruise Control Enable Switch not detected on J1939
Fault Overview
Fault code sets when Engine Control Module (ECM) does not receive cruise control switch messages from Body
Controller.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
• SPN 597 FMI 19 (Body) • SPN 639 FMI 14 (J1939)
Fault Facts
Cruise control switches are wired to Body Controller (BC). Switch state is communicated to ECM through J1939
Data Link Network.
Step 4 Verify Cruise Control activates and controls vehicle speed. Decision
Yes: End diagnostics. Retest for
WARNING:
SPN 596 FMI 19.
Fault Overview
Fault code sets when Brake status is missing on J1939 CAN Bus network.
Lamp Reaction
No Lamp
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
None
Step 1 Check for active Source Address 33 Body Control Module (BCM) fault codes. Decision
Using EST with Key ON, check DTC list for SPN 597 fault codes coming from Source Yes: See appropriate
Address 33, the BCM. vehicle Technician
Manual > Electrical /
Software > Exterior
Lighting > Brake
Switch for diagnostic
overview and step based
diagnostics. After repair
are complete, retest for
SPN 597 FMI 2.
Is EST DTC list free of SPN 597 fault codes coming from the BCM? No: Diagnose and
repair BCM brake
switch fault codes.
See appropriate vehicle
Technician Manual >
Electrical / Software >
Exterior Lighting > Brake
Switch for diagnostic
overview and step based
diagnostics. After repair
are complete, retest for
SPN 597 FMI 2.
Fault Overview
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
None
Step 1 Check for active Source Address 33 Body Control Module (BCM) fault codes. Decision
Using EST with Key ON, check DTC list for SPN 597 fault codes coming from Source Yes: See appropriate
Address 33, the BCM. vehicle Technician
Manual > Electrical /
Software > Exterior
Lighting > Brake
Switch for diagnostic
overview and step based
diagnostics. After repair
are complete, retest for
SPN 597 FMI 19.
Is EST DTC list free of SPN 597 fault codes coming from the BCM? No: Diagnose and
repair BCM brake
switch fault codes.
See appropriate vehicle
Technician Manual >
Electrical / Software >
Exterior Lighting > Brake
Switch for diagnostic
overview and step based
diagnostics. After repair
are complete, retest for
SPN 597 FMI 19.
Fault Overview
Fault is set when voltage supply to Doser Control Unit (DCU) is higher than normal or voltage at output of DCU
voltage divider is higher than normal
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two trips.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
Jump-starting from a vehicle or booster pack using greater than 16 volts can also cause this fault to set.
Fault Overview
Fault is set when voltage supply to Doser Control Unit (DCU) is lower than normal or voltage at output of DCU
voltage divider is lower than normal.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
None
WARNING:
To prevent property damage, personal injury, and/or death, keep flames or sparks away
from vehicle and do not smoke while servicing vehicle’s batteries. Batteries may expel
explosive gases.
To prevent property damage, personal injury, and/or death, wear eye protection.
WARNING:
To prevent property damage, personal injury, and/or death, always disconnect ground
battery terminal first, then positive cable. When reconnecting battery cables, connect
positive cables first, and then reconnect negative cables. Failure to follow this warning
may result in a direct battery short, which is a fire or explosion hazard.
Step 4 Inspect connections at Doser Control Unit (DCU) Module 53-pin and Decision
86-pin connectors.
A. Key OFF. Yes: Go to Step 5.
B. Disconnect DCU Module connectors.
Fault Overview
The fault sets when the ECM detects that the Aftertreatment Control Module (ACM) has an internal chip error.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
SPN 609 FMI 3, 4 and 19
Fault Facts
None
Step 3 Check for Doser Control Unit (DCU) current calibration. Decision
Use NavKal or calibration scorecard, check if DCU calibration is current. Yes: Go to Step 4.
Is DCU calibration current? No: Update DCU calibration and
retest for SPN 609 FMI 12.
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 485
E. Key OFF for 30 seconds or until Engine Control Module (ECM) powers
down.
F. Key ON Engine OFF (KOEO).
Did SPN 609 FMI 12 set after codes were cleared? No: End diagnostics. Retest for
SPN 609 FMI 12.
Fault Overview
Fault set when CAN communication link (J1939) between Engine Control Module (ECM) and Doser Control Unit
(DCU) is not detected.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
None
Step 2 Inspect connections at Doser Control Unit (DCU) Module 53-pin and Decision
86-pin connectors.
A. Key OFF. Yes: Go to Step 3.
B. Disconnect DCU Module connectors.
C. Check DCU Module connectors and terminals for: damaged or pinched
wires; moist or corroded terminals; loose, bent, or broken pins; or broken
connector housing.
Are DCU Module connectors, harnesses, and terminals clean and undamaged? No: Repair connector, harness,
or terminal damage. After repairs
are complete, retest for SPN 609
FMI 19.
Step 5 Check DCU SWBAT circuit for Open or short to GND. Decision
A. Key OFF. Yes: Go to Step 6.
E. Use DMM, measure voltage between DCU 53-pin connector pin-14 and
known good GND.
Is voltage greater than 1 volt? No: Repair Open or short to GND
in CAN-H circuit. After repairs are
complete, retest for SPN 609 FMI
19.
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 489
C. Insert applicable terminal test pins from Terminal Test Kit ZTSE4435C, into
DCU Module 53-pin connector pin-15 and leave DCU Module disconnected.
D. Key ON Engine OFF (KOEO).
E. Use DMM, measure voltage between DCU 53-pin connector pin-15 and
known good GND.
Is voltage less than 4 volts? No: Repair CAN-L short to PWR
After repairs are complete, retest
for SPN 609 FMI 19.
490 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Step 10 Check for short between CAN-H and CAN-L circuits. Decision
A. Key OFF. Yes: The fault code is not present
at the moment. Go to Intermittent
B. Disconnect DCU Module 53-pin connector.
or Inactive Fault Diagnostic
C. Insert applicable terminal test pins from Terminal Test Kit ZTSE4435C, into Procedure (page 1344) to isolate
DCU Module 53-pin connector pin-15 and pin-14 and leave DCU Module and repair the intermittent circuit
disconnected. failure. After repairs are complete,
retest for SPN 609 FMI 19.
D. Use DMM, measure resistance between DCU 53-pin connector pin-15
and pin-14.
Is resistance greater than 50 ohms? No: Repair Short between CAN-H
and CAN-L. After repairs are
complete, retest for SPN 609 FMI
19.
Fault Overview
Fault code sets when Engine Control Module (ECM) detects an internal memory error within ECM.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
None
Fault Overview
Fault code sets when the Engine Control Module (ECM) detects Central Processing Unit (CPU) load is
excessively high.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
None
Fault Overview
Fault code sets when Engine Control Module (ECM) detects engine OFF timer is not reading as expected.
Problem with Keep Alive Power (KAPWR) circuit.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
ECM Timer Fuse may be an in-line fuse in engine compartment, see Truck Wiring Diagram for more information.
Step 2 Check for active fault code after Engine Control Module (ECM) reset. Decision
A. Key OFF. Yes: Go to Step 3.
F. Key ON Engine OFF (KOEO), check DTC list for SPN 629 FMI 8.
Is EST DTC list SPN 629 FMI 8 active or pending? No: Repair is complete. Retest
for SPN 629 FMI 8.
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 495
Step 4 Inspect connections at Keep Alive Power (KAPWR) fuse holder. Decision
A. Key OFF. Yes: Go to Step 5.
B. Disconnect KAPWR fuse holder harness connector.
C. Check KAPWR fuse holder connector terminals for damaged or pinched
wires; wet or corroded terminals; loose, bent, or broken pins; or broken
connector housing.
Are KAPWR fuse holder connector, harness and terminals clean and undamaged? No: Repair connector, connector,
harness, or terminal damage.
After repairs are complete, retest
for SPN 629 FMI 8
Fault Overview
Fault code sets when Engine Control Module (ECM) detects an internal chip error within ECM.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
None
C. Key ON, Engine OFF (KOEO), log into Navistar® Engine Diagnostics.
D. Use EST with Navistar® Engine Diagnostics, clear codes.
E. Key OFF, wait until ECM powers down or EST communication stops.
F. Key ON, Engine OFF (KOEO), check Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) list
for SPN 629 FMI 12.
Is SPN 629 FMI 12 active or pending after codes were cleared? No: End diagnostics. Retest for
SPN 629 FMI 12.
Fault Overview
Fault sets when the Engine Control Module (ECM) determines the comparison of Engine Timing Sensor signal
to modeled value is incorrect.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
None
See latest version of MaxxForce® DT, 9, and 10 Engine and Aftertreatment Wiring Schematic Form 0000003221
for additional circuit information.
Tools Required
• Breakout Harness ZTSE4951
• 180-pin Breakout Box 00-0956-08
• Digital Multimeter (DMM)
• Electronic Service Tool (EST) with Navistar® Engine Diagnostics
• Interface cable (RP1210B-compliant supporting J1939 and J1708)
Test 1
A. Key OFF.
Test 2
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect Camshaft Position (CMP).
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4951 to vehicle harness connector and leave CMP disconnected.
D. Key ON Engine OFF (KOEO).
Test 3
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect Camshaft Position (CMP) sensor.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4951 to vehicle harness connector and leave CMP sensor disconnected.
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 505
Test 4
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect Camshaft Position (CMP) sensor.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4951 to CMP sensor and leave engine harness disconnected.
506 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Fault Overview
Fault sets when Engine Control Module (ECM) detects comparison of Crankshaft and Camshaft signals are
incorrect.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during one drive cycle.
Associated Faults
SPN 636 FMI 2 (CMP)
Fault Facts
None
Fault Overview
Fault sets when Engine Control Module (ECM) detects synchronization on crankshaft signal is not achieved.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during one drive cycle.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
None
See latest version of MaxxForce® DT, 9, and 10 Engine and Aftertreatment Wiring Schematic Form 0000003221
for additional circuit information.
Tools Required
• Breakout Harness ZTSE4950
• Electronic Service Tool (EST) with Navistar® Engine Diagnostics
• Interface cable (RP1210B-compliant supporting J1939 and J1708)
Test 1
A. Key OFF.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4950 to vehicle harness connector and leave CKP sensor disconnected.
Test 2
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect CKP sensor.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4950 to vehicle harness connector and leave CKP sensor disconnected.
D. Key ON Engine OFF (KOEO).
Test 3
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect CKP sensor.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4950 to CKP sensor and leave vehicle harness disconnected.
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 513
Fault Overview
Fault sets when Engine Control Module detects crankshaft sensor has a short or open.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during one drive cycle.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
None
B. Disconnect CKP.
C. Check CKP connection terminals for: damaged or pinched wires; wet
or corroded terminals; loose, bent, or broken pins; or broken connector
housing.
Are CKP connections, harness, and terminals clean and undamaged? No: Repair connector, harness,
or terminal damage. After repairs
are complete, retest for SPN 637
FMI 10.
514 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
See latest version of MaxxForce® DT, 9, and 10 Engine and Aftertreatment Wiring Schematic Form 0000003221
for additional circuit information.
Tools Required
• Breakout Harness ZTSE4950
• Electronic Service Tool (EST) with Navistar® Engine Diagnostics
• Interface cable (RP1210B-compliant supporting J1939 and J1708)
Test 1
A. Key OFF.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4950 to vehicle harness connector and leave CKP sensor disconnected.
Test 2
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect Crankshaft Position (CKP) sensor.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4950 to vehicle harness connector and leave CKP sensor disconnected.
D. Key ON Engine OFF (KOEO).
518 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
SPN 639 FMI 14 - J1939 Data Link Error (ECM unable to transmit)
Fault Overview
Fault sets when the Engine Control Module (ECM) is unable to transmit; J1939 data link error.
Lamp Reaction
The Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive
cycles.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
None
Step 1 Check if Engine Control Module (ECM) will communicate with the Decision
Electronic Service Tool (EST).
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Intermittent or Inactive
Fault Diagnostic Procedure(page
B. Connect Electronic Service Tool (EST) to vehicle Diagnostic Connector
1344).
(page 1345).
Step 2 Decision
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 3.
B. Disconnect ECM 76-pin Chassis connector.
C. Connect chassis Breakout Harness 00-00959-01 between vehicle chassis
harness and ECM.
D. Connect Breakout Harness 00-00959-01 to 180-pin Breakout Box
00-00956-08.
E. Key-On Engine-Off (KOEO).
F. Use Digital Multimeter (DMM), measure voltage from ECM pins C-1, 3,
and 5 to known good GND.
Is voltage B+ ± 0.5 volts? No: Repair Open or short to GND
in ECM PWR circuit. After repairs
are complete, retest for SPN 639
FMI 14.
Step 3 Decision
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 4.
B. Disconnect ECM 76-pin Chassis connector.
C. Connect chassis Breakout Harness 00-00959-01 between vehicle chassis
harness and ECM.
F. Use DMM, measure voltage from ECM pins C-2, 4, and 6 to PWR.
Is voltage B+ ± 0.5 volts? No: Repair Open in ECM
GND circuits. After repairs are
complete, retest for SPN 639 FMI
14.
520 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Step 4 Decision
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 5.
B. Disconnect ECM 76-pin Chassis connector.
C. Connect chassis Breakout Harness 00-00959-01 between vehicle chassis
harness and ECM.
Step 5 Decision
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 6.
B. Disconnect ECM 76-pin Chassis connector.
C. Connect chassis Breakout Harness 00-00959-01 between vehicle chassis
harness and ECM.
D. Connect Breakout Harness 00-00959-01 to 180-pin Breakout Box
00-00956-08.
E. Key-On Engine-Off (KOEO).
F. Use DMM, measure voltage from ECM pin C-61 to known good GND.
Is voltage greater than 1 volt? No: Repair short to GND between
ECM pin C-61 and other modules.
After repairs are complete, retest
for SPN 639 FMI 14.
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 521
Step 6 Decision
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 7.
B. Disconnect ECM 76-pin Chassis connector.
C. Connect chassis Breakout Harness 00-00959-01 between vehicle chassis
harness and ECM.
Step 7 Decision
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 8.
B. Disconnect ECM 76-pin Chassis connector.
C. Connect chassis Breakout Harness 00-00959-01 between vehicle chassis
harness and ECM.
D. Connect Breakout Harness 00-00959-01 to 180-pin Breakout Box
00-00956-08.
E. Key-On Engine-Off (KOEO).
F. Use DMM, measure voltage from ECM pin C-62 to known good GND.
Is voltage greater than 1 volt? No: Repair short to GND between
ECM pin C-62 and other modules.
After repairs are complete, retest
for SPN 639 FMI 14.
522 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Step 8 Decision
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 9.
B. Disconnect ECM 76-pin Chassis connector.
C. Connect chassis Breakout Harness 00-00959-01 between vehicle chassis
harness and ECM.
Step 9 Decision
A. Key-Off. Yes: End diagnostics. Retest for
SPN 639 FMI 14.
B. Disconnect ECM 76-pin Chassis connector.
C. Connect chassis Breakout Harness 00-00959-01 to vehicle chassis
harness and leave ECM disconnected.
D. Connect Breakout Harness 00-00959-01 to 180-pin Breakout Box
00-00956-08.
E. Use DMM, measure resistance from ECM pin C-62 to ECM pin C-61.
Is resistance between 55 and 65 ohms? No: Repair short between ECM
pin C-62 and ECM pin C-61. After
repairs are complete, retest for
SPN 639 FMI 14.
Fault Overview
Fault code sets when Engine Control Module (ECM) detects a short circuit on injector 1 Open coil.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate immediately when this fault is detected.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
Final number of SPN identifies affected injector, and name in Navistar® Engine Diagnostics identifies cylinder in
which injector is installed.
It may be necessary to perform the pin point circuit diagnostics tests with the engine at or near normal operating
temperature.
See latest version of MaxxForce® DT, 9 and 10 Engine and Aftertreatment Wiring Schematic Form 0000003221
for additional circuit information.
WARNING:
To prevent personal injury or death, shut engine down before doing voltage checks
for injector solenoids. When engine is running, injector circuits have high voltage and
amperage.
CAUTION:
To prevent engine damage, turn ignition switch OFF before disconnecting connectors.
Failure to turn ignition switch OFF will cause a voltage spike and damage to electrical
components.
D. Use DMM, measure resistance between Injector 1 pin-2 and known good
GND.
Is resistance greater than 1000 ohms? No: Replace Injector 1 and
perform Injector Coil End of
Motion (CEOM) Reset Procedure
(page 1334) and Injector Coking
Accumulation Reset Procedure
(page 1338). After repairs are
complete, retest for SPN 651 FMI
4.
Step 6 Check Injector 1 Open Coil H Circuit for short to GND. Decision
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 7.
B. Disconnect Injector 1 connector from UVC harness..
C. Disconnect ECM - Driver 36-pin connector.
D. Use Engine Terminal Test Kit ZTSE4435C, insert proper terminal into ECM
- Driver 36-pin connector pin D-2, leave ECM disconnected.
E. Use DMM, measure resistance between ECM - Driver 36-pin connector
pin D-2 and known good GND.
Is resistance greater than 1000 ohms? No: Repair short to GND between
ECM - Driver 36-pin connector pin
D-2 and Injector 1. After repairs
are complete, retest for SPN 651
FMI 4.
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 527
Step 7 Check Injector 1 Open Coil L Circuit for short to GND. Decision
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 8.
B. Disconnect Injector 1 connector from UVC harness.
C. Disconnect ECM - Driver 36-pin connector.
D. Use Engine Terminal Test Kit ZTSE4435C, insert proper terminal into ECM
- Driver 36-pin connector pin D-1, leave ECM disconnected.
Step 8 Check for short between Open H and Open L circuits in UVC harness. Decision
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 9.
B. Disconnect Injector 1 connector from UVC harness.
C. Disconnect UVC harness connector 2 from engine harness.
D. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4793 to UVC harness connector 2, leave
engine harness disconnected.
E. Use DMM, measure resistance between Breakout Harness ZTSE4793
pin-3 and pin-4.
Is resistance greater than 1000 ohms? No: Replace UVC Harness. After
repairs are complete, retest for
SPN 651 FMI 4.
Step 9 Check for short between Open H and Open L circuits in Engine Decision
Harness.
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 10.
E. Check Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) list for SPN 651 FMI 4.
Has original concern been resolved? No: Reinstall original ECM. Verify
each step was completed correctly
and proper decision were made.
Fault Overview
Fault code sets when Engine Control Module (ECM) detects an Open circuit on Injector 1 Open coil circuit.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during one drive cycle.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
Final number of SPN identifies affected injector, and name in Navistar® Engine Diagnostics identifies cylinder in
which injector is installed.
It may be necessary to perform the pin point circuit diagnostics tests with the engine at or near normal operating
temperature.
See latest version of MaxxForce® DT, 9 and 10 Engine and Aftertreatment Wiring Schematic Form 0000003221
for additional circuit information.
E. Check Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) list for SPN 651 FMI 5.
Has original concern been resolved? No: Reinstall original ECM. Verify
each step was completed correctly
and proper decisions were made.
SPN 651 FMI 7 - Injector 1 Spool Motion Compensation Max Authority Reached
Fault Overview
Fault code sets when Engine Control Module (ECM) determines injector spool motion compensation has reached
its maximum allowable time limit.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
Final number of SPN identifies affected injector, and name in Navistar® Engine Diagnostics identifies cylinder in
which injector is installed.
Fault Overview
Fault sets when Engine Control Module (ECM) determines injector timing is off when comparing cylinder balance
difference between two consecutive cylinders.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
• SPN 27 FMI 14 (EGR) • SPN 51 FMI 3, 4, and 7 • SPN 94 (FDP) • SPN 108 FMI 3 and 4
(ETV) (BARO)
• SPN 110 FMI 2, 3, and 4 • SPN 132 (MAF) • SPN 164 (ICP) • SPN 175 FMI 2, 3, and 4
(ECT1) (EOT)
• SPN 191 FMI 3 and 4 • SPN 636 FMI 2 and 7 • SPN 651 FMI 4, 5, and 7 • SPN 1322 - 1328 FMI 31
(TOSS) (CMP) (INJ) (INJ)
• SPN 1189 FMI 3 and 4 • SPN 2659 FMI 20 (AMS) • SPN 2791 FMI 2, 3, 4, 7, • SPN 3055 FMI 2 (INJ)
(TC2WC) 8, and 14 (EGR)
• SPN 3464 FMI 31 (ETV) • SPN 4257 FMI 7 (INJ) • SPN 5543 FMI 3, 4, and
5 (EBPV)
Fault Facts
None
Step 3 Inspect connections at injector circuits outside valve cover connector. Decision
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 4.
B. Disconnect injector circuits outside valve cover connector.
C. Check injector circuits outside valve cover and connector terminals for:
damaged or pinched wires; moist or corroded terminals; loose, bent, or
broken pins; or broken connector housing.
Are injector circuits outside valve cover connector, harness, and terminals clean No: Repair connector, harness, or
and undamaged? terminal damage. After repairs are
complete, retest for SPN 651 FMI
14.
Step 7 Inspect fuel system, fuel level, and fuel quality. Decision
• Perform Fuel Level Inspection(page 1634), Yes: Go to Step 8.
• Fuel Quality Inspection(page 1632), and
• Fuel System Inspection(page 1631).
Is there sufficient supply of good quality fuel? No: Drain dirty or aerated fuel, fill
with good quality fuel. Repair any
other fuel system discrepancies.
After repairs are complete, retest
for SPN 651 FMI 14.
Step 8 Inspect air intake and exhaust systems for restrictions, leaks, or Decision
physical damage.
• Perform Intake Air Inspection(page 1648) and Yes: Go to Step 9.
• Exhaust and Aftertreatment System Inspection(page 1651).
Are air intake system and exhaust system clear of restrictions, leaks, and physical No: Repair restrictions, leaks, or
damage? physical damage. After repairs are
complete, retest for SPN 651 FMI
14.
Fault Overview
Fault code sets when Engine Control Module (ECM) detects a short circuit on Injector 2 Open coil.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate immediately when this fault is detected.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
Final number of SPN identifies affected injector, and name in Navistar® Engine Diagnostics identifies cylinder in
which injector is installed.
It may be necessary to perform the pin point circuit diagnostics tests with the engine at or near normal operating
temperature.
See latest version of MaxxForce® DT, 9 and 10 Engine and Aftertreatment Wiring Schematic Form 0000003221
for additional circuit information.
WARNING:
To prevent personal injury or death, shut engine down before doing voltage checks
for injector solenoids. When engine is running, injector circuits have high voltage and
amperage.
CAUTION:
To prevent engine damage, turn ignition switch OFF before disconnecting connectors.
Failure to turn ignition switch OFF will cause a voltage spike and damage to electrical
components.
D. Use DMM, measure resistance between Injector 2 pin-2 and known good
GND.
Is resistance greater than 1000 ohms? No: Replace Injector 2 and
Perform Injector Coil End of
Motion (CEOM) Reset Procedure
(page 1334) and Injector Coking
Accumulation Reset Procedure
(page 1338). After repairs are
complete, retest for SPN 652 FMI
4.
Step 6 Check Injector 2 Open Coil H Circuit for short to GND. Decision
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 7.
B. Disconnect Injector 2 connector from UVC harness.
C. Disconnect ECM - Driver 36-pin connector.
D. Use Engine Terminal Test Kit ZTSE4435C, insert proper terminal into ECM
- Driver 36-pin connector pin D-6, leave ECM disconnected.
E. Use DMM, measure resistance between ECM - Driver 36-pin connector
pin D-6 and known good GND.
Is resistance greater than 1000 ohms? No: Repair short to GND between
ECM - Driver 36-pin connector pin
D-6 and Injector 2. After repairs
are complete, retest for SPN 652
FMI 4.
544 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Step 7 Check Injector 2 Open Coil L Circuit for short to GND. Decision
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 8.
B. Disconnect Injector 2 connector from UVC harness.
C. Disconnect ECM - Driver 36-pin connector.
D. Use Engine Terminal Test Kit ZTSE4435C, insert proper terminal into ECM
- Driver 36-pin connector pin D-5, leave ECM disconnected.
Step 8 Check for short between Open H and Open L circuits in UVC harness. Decision
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 9.
B. Disconnect Injector 2 connector from UVC harness.
C. Disconnect UVC harness connector 2 from engine harness.
D. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4793 to UVC harness connector 2, leave
engine harness disconnected.
E. Use DMM, measure resistance between Breakout Harness ZTSE4793
pin-7 and pin-8.
Is resistance greater than 1000 ohms? No: Replace UVC Harness. After
repairs are complete, retest for
SPN 652 FMI 4.
Step 9 Check for short between Open H and Open L circuits in Engine Decision
Harness.
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 10.
E. Check Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) list for SPN 652 FMI 4.
Has original concern been resolved? No: Reinstall original ECM. Verify
each step was completed correctly
and proper decision were made.
Fault Overview
Fault code sets when Engine Control Module (ECM) detects an Open circuit on Injector 2 Open coil circuit.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during one drive cycle.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
Final number of SPN identifies affected injector, and name in Navistar® Engine Diagnostics identifies cylinder in
which injector is installed.
It may be necessary to perform the pin point circuit diagnostics tests with the engine at or near normal operating
temperature.
See latest version of MaxxForce® DT, 9 and 10 Engine and Aftertreatment Wiring Schematic Form 0000003221
for additional circuit information.
E. Check Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) list for SPN 652 FMI 5.
Has original concern been resolved? No: Reinstall original ECM. Verify
each step was completed correctly
and proper decisions were made.
SPN 652 FMI 7 - Injector 2 Spool Motion Compensation Max Authority Reached
Fault Overview
Fault code sets when Engine Control Module (ECM) determines injector spool motion compensation has reached
its maximum allowable time limit.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
Final number of SPN identifies affected injector, and name in Navistar® Engine Diagnostics identifies cylinder in
which injector is installed.
Fault Overview
Fault sets when Engine Control Module (ECM) determines injector timing is off when comparing cylinder balance
difference between two consecutive cylinders.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
• SPN 27 FMI 14 (EGR) • SPN 51 FMI 3, 4, and 7 • SPN 94 (FDP) • SPN 108 FMI 3 and 4
(ETV) (BARO)
• SPN 110 FMI 2, 3, and 4 • SPN 132 (MAF) • SPN 164 (ICP) • SPN 175 FMI 2, 3, and 4
(ECT1) (EOT)
• SPN 191 FMI 3 and 4 • SPN 636 FMI 2 and 7 • SPN 652 FMI 4, 5, and 7 • SPN 1322 - 1328 FMI 31
(TOSS) (CMP) (INJ) (INJ)
• SPN 1189 FMI 3 and 4 • SPN 2659 FMI 20 (AMS) • SPN 2791 FMI 2, 3, 4, 7, • SPN 3055 FMI 2 (INJ)
(TC2WC) 8, and 14 (EGR)
• SPN 3464 FMI 31 (ETV) • SPN 4257 FMI 7 (INJ) • SPN 5543 FMI 3, 4, and
5 (EBPV)
Fault Facts
None
Step 3 Inspect connections at injector circuits outside valve cover connector. Decision
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 4.
B. Disconnect injector circuits outside valve cover connector.
C. Check injector circuits outside valve cover and connector terminals for:
damaged or pinched wires; moisture or corroded terminals; loose, bent, or
broken pins; or broken connector housing.
Are injector circuits outside valve cover connector, harness, and terminals clean No: Repair connector, harness,
and undamaged? or terminal damage. After repairs
are complete, retest for SPN 652
FMI 14.
Step 7 Inspect fuel system, fuel level, and fuel quality. Decision
• Perform Fuel Level Inspection(page 1634), Yes: Go to Step 8.
• Fuel Quality Inspection(page 1632), and
• Fuel System Inspection(page 1631).
Is there sufficient supply of good quality fuel? No: Drain dirty or aerated fuel, fill
with good quality fuel. Repair any
other fuel system discrepancies.
After repairs are complete, retest
for SPN 652 FMI 14.
Step 8 Inspect air intake and exhaust systems for restrictions, leaks, or Decision
physical damage.
• Perform Intake Air Inspection(page 1648) and Yes: Go to Step 9.
• Exhaust and Aftertreatment System Inspection(page 1651).
Are air intake system and exhaust system clear of restrictions, leaks, and physical No: Repair restrictions, leaks, or
damage? physical damage. After repairs are
complete, retest for SPN 652 FMI
14.
Fault Overview
Fault code sets when Engine Control Module (ECM) detects a short circuit on Injector 3 Open coil.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate immediately when this fault is detected.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
Final number of SPN identifies affected injector, and name in Navistar® Engine Diagnostics identifies cylinder in
which injector is installed.
It may be necessary to perform the pin point circuit diagnostics tests with the engine at or near normal operating
temperature.
See latest version of MaxxForce® DT, 9 and 10 Engine and Aftertreatment Wiring Schematic Form 0000003221
for additional circuit information.
WARNING:
To prevent personal injury or death, shut engine down before doing voltage checks
for injector solenoids. When engine is running, injector circuits have high voltage and
amperage.
CAUTION:
To prevent engine damage, turn ignition switch OFF before disconnecting connectors.
Failure to turn ignition switch OFF will cause a voltage spike and damage to electrical
components.
D. Use DMM, measure resistance between Injector 3 pin-2 and known good
GND.
Is resistance greater than 1000 ohms? No: Replace Injector 3 and
perform Injector Coil End of
Motion (CEOM) Reset Procedure
(page 1334) and Injector Coking
Accumulation Reset Procedure
(page 1338). After repairs are
complete, retest for SPN 653 FMI
4.
Step 6 Check Injector 3 Open Coil H Circuit for short to GND. Decision
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 7.
B. Disconnect Injector 3 connector from UVC harness.
C. Disconnect ECM - Driver 36-pin connector.
D. Use Engine Terminal Test Kit ZTSE4435C, insert proper terminal into ECM
- Driver 36-pin connector pin D-4, leave ECM disconnected.
E. Use DMM, measure resistance between ECM - Driver 36-pin connector
pin D-4 and known good GND.
Is resistance greater than 1000 ohms? No: Repair short to GND between
ECM - Driver 36-pin connector pin
D-4 and Injector 3. After repairs
are complete, retest for SPN 653
FMI 4.
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 561
Step 7 Check Injector 3 Open Coil L Circuit for short to GND. Decision
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 8.
B. Disconnect Injector 3 connector from UVC harness.
C. Disconnect ECM - Driver 36-pin connector.
D. Use Engine Terminal Test Kit ZTSE4435C, insert proper terminal into ECM
- Driver 36-pin connector pin D-3, leave ECM disconnected.
Step 8 Check for short between Open H and Open L circuits in UVC harness. Decision
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 9.
B. Disconnect Injector 3 connector from UVC harness.
C. Disconnect UVC harness connector 3 from engine harness.
D. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4793 to UVC harness connector 3, leave
engine harness disconnected.
E. Use DMM, measure resistance between Breakout Harness ZTSE4793
pin-3 and pin-4.
Is resistance greater than 1000 ohms? No: Replace UVC Harness. After
repairs are complete, retest for
SPN 653 FMI 4.
Step 9 Check for short between Open H and Open L circuits in Engine Decision
Harness.
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 10.
E. Check Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) list for SPN 653 FMI 4.
Has original concern been resolved? No: Reinstall original ECM. Verify
each step was completed correctly
and proper decision were made.
Fault Overview
Fault code sets when Engine Control Module (ECM) detects an Open circuit on Injector 3 Open coil circuit.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during one drive cycle.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
Final number of SPN identifies affected injector, and name in Navistar® Engine Diagnostics identifies cylinder in
which injector is installed.
It may be necessary to perform the pin point circuit diagnostics tests with the engine at or near normal operating
temperature.
See latest version of MaxxForce® DT, 9 and 10 Engine and Aftertreatment Wiring Schematic Form 0000003221
for additional circuit information.
E. Check Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) list for SPN 653 FMI 5.
Has original concern been resolved? No: Reinstall original ECM. Verify
each step was completed correctly
and proper decisions were made.
SPN 653 FMI 7 - Injector 3 Spool Motion Compensation Max Authority Reached
Fault Overview
Fault code sets when Engine Control Module (ECM) determines injector spool motion compensation has reached
its maximum allowable time limit.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
Final number of SPN identifies affected injector, and name in Navistar® Engine Diagnostics identifies cylinder in
which injector is installed.
Fault Overview
Fault sets when Engine Control Module (ECM) determines injector timing is off when comparing cylinder balance
difference between two consecutive cylinders.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
• SPN 27 FMI 14 (EGR) • SPN 51 FMI 3, 4, and 7 • SPN 94 (FDP) • SPN 108 FMI 3 and 4
(ETV) (BARO)
• SPN 110 FMI 2, 3, and 4 • SPN 132 (MAF) • SPN 164 (ICP) • SPN 175 FMI 2, 3, and 4
(ECT1) (EOT)
• SPN 191 FMI 3 and 4 • SPN 636 FMI 2 and 7 • SPN 653 FMI 4, 5, and 7 • SPN 1322 - 1328 FMI 31
(TOSS) (CMP) (INJ) (INJ)
• SPN 1189 FMI 3 and 4 • SPN 2659 FMI 20 (AMS) • SPN 2791 FMI 2, 3, 4, 7, • SPN 3055 FMI 2 (INJ)
(TC2WC) 8, and 14 (EGR)
• SPN 3464 FMI 31 (ETV) • SPN 4257 FMI 7 (INJ) • SPN 5543 FMI 3, 4, and
5 (EBPV)
Fault Facts
None
Step 3 Inspect connections at injector circuits outside valve cover connector. Decision
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 4.
B. Disconnect injector circuits outside valve cover connector.
C. Check injector circuits outside valve cover and connector terminals for:
damaged or pinched wires; moist or corroded terminals; loose, bent, or
broken pins; or broken connector housing.
Are injector circuits outside valve cover connector, harness, and terminals clean No: Repair connector, harness,
and undamaged? or terminal damage. After repairs
are complete, retest for SPN 653
FMI 14.
Step 7 Inspect fuel system, fuel level, and fuel quality. Decision
• Perform Fuel Level Inspection(page 1634), Yes: Go to Step 8.
• Fuel Quality Inspection(page 1632), and
• Fuel System Inspection(page 1631).
Is there sufficient supply of good quality fuel? No: Drain dirty or aerated fuel, fill
with good quality fuel. Repair any
other fuel system discrepancies.
After repairs are complete, retest
for SPN 653 FMI 14.
Step 8 Inspect air intake and exhaust systems for restrictions, leaks, or Decision
physical damage.
• Perform Intake Air Inspection(page 1648) and Yes: Go to Step 9.
• Exhaust and Aftertreatment System Inspection(page 1651).
Are air intake system and exhaust system clear of restrictions, leaks, and physical No: Repair restrictions, leaks, or
damage? physical damage. After repairs are
complete, retest for SPN 653 FMI
14.
Fault Overview
Fault code sets when Engine Control Module (ECM) detects a short circuit on Injector 4 Open coil.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate immediately when this fault is detected.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
Final number of SPN identifies affected injector, and name in Navistar® Engine Diagnostics identifies cylinder in
which injector is installed.
It may be necessary to perform the pin point circuit diagnostics tests with the engine at or near normal operating
temperature.
See latest version of MaxxForce® DT, 9 and 10 Engine and Aftertreatment Wiring Schematic Form 0000003221
for additional circuit information.
WARNING:
To prevent personal injury or death, shut engine down before doing voltage checks
for injector solenoids. When engine is running, injector circuits have high voltage and
amperage.
CAUTION:
To prevent engine damage, turn ignition switch OFF before disconnecting connectors.
Failure to turn ignition switch OFF will cause a voltage spike and damage to electrical
components.
D. Use DMM, measure resistance between Injector 4 pin-2 and known good
GND.
Is resistance greater than 1000 ohms? No: Replace Injector 4 and
perform Injector Coil End of
Motion (CEOM) Reset Procedure
(page 1334) and Injector Coking
Accumulation Reset Procedure
(page 1338). After repairs are
complete, retest for SPN 654 FMI
4.
Step 6 Check Injector 4 Open Coil H Circuit for short to GND. Decision
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 7.
B. Disconnect Injector 4 connector from UVC harness.
C. Disconnect ECM - Driver 36-pin connector.
D. Use Engine Terminal Test Kit ZTSE4435C, insert proper terminal into ECM
- Driver 36-pin connector pin D-30, leave ECM disconnected.
E. Use DMM, measure resistance between ECM - Driver 36-pin connector
pin D-30 and known good GND.
Is resistance greater than 1000 ohms? No: Repair short to GND between
ECM - Driver 36-pin connector pin
D-30 and Injector 4. After repairs
are complete, retest for SPN 654
FMI 4.
578 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Step 7 Check Injector 4 Open Coil L Circuit for short to GND. Decision
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 8.
B. Disconnect Injector 4 connector from UVC harness.
C. Disconnect ECM - Driver 36-pin connector.
D. Use Engine Terminal Test Kit ZTSE4435C, insert proper terminal into ECM
- Driver 36-pin connector pin D-29, leave ECM disconnected.
Step 8 Check for short between Open H and Open L circuits in UVC harness. Decision
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 9.
B. Disconnect Injector 4 connector from UVC harness.
C. Disconnect UVC harness connector 3 from engine harness.
D. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4793 to UVC harness connector 3, leave
engine harness disconnected.
E. Use DMM, measure resistance between Breakout Harness ZTSE4793
pin-7 and pin-8.
Is resistance greater than 1000 ohms? No: Replace UVC Harness. After
repairs are complete, retest for
SPN 654 FMI 4.
Step 9 Check for short between Open H and Open L circuits in Engine Decision
Harness.
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 10.
E. Check Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) list for SPN 654 FMI 4.
Has original concern been resolved? No: Reinstall original ECM. Verify
each step was completed correctly
and proper decision were made.
Fault Overview
Fault code sets when Engine Control Module (ECM) detects an Open circuit on Injector 4 Open coil circuit.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during one drive cycle.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
Final number of SPN identifies affected injector, and name in Navistar® Engine Diagnostics identifies cylinder in
which injector is installed.
It may be necessary to perform the pin point circuit diagnostics tests with the engine at or near normal operating
temperature.
See latest version of MaxxForce® DT, 9 and 10 Engine and Aftertreatment Wiring Schematic Form 0000003221
for additional circuit information.
E. Check Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) list for SPN 654 FMI 5.
Has original concern been resolved? No: Reinstall original ECM. Verify
each step was completed correctly
and proper decisions were made.
SPN 654 FMI 7 - Injector 4 Spool Motion Compensation Max Authority Reached
Fault Overview
Fault code sets when Engine Control Module (ECM) determines injector spool motion compensation has reached
its maximum allowable time limit.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
Final number of SPN identifies affected injector, and name in Navistar® Engine Diagnostics identifies cylinder in
which injector is installed.
Fault Overview
Fault sets when Engine Control Module (ECM) determines injector timing is off when comparing cylinder balance
difference between two consecutive cylinders.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
• SPN 27 FMI 14 (EGR) • SPN 51 FMI 3, 4, and 7 • SPN 94 (FDP) • SPN 108 FMI 3 and 4
(ETV) (BARO)
• SPN 110 FMI 2, 3, and 4 • SPN 132 (MAF) • SPN 164 (ICP) • SPN 175 FMI 2, 3, and 4
(ECT1) (EOT)
• SPN 191 FMI 3 and 4 • SPN 636 FMI 2 and 7 • SPN 6546 FMI 4, 5, and 7 • SPN 1322 - 1328 FMI 31
(TOSS) (CMP) (INJ) (INJ)
• SPN 1189 FMI 3 and 4 • SPN 2659 FMI 20 (AMS) • SPN 2791 FMI 2, 3, 4, 7, • SPN 3055 FMI 2 (INJ)
(TC2WC) 8, and 14 (EGR)
• SPN 3464 FMI 31 (ETV) • SPN 4257 FMI 7 (INJ) • SPN 5543 FMI 3, 4, and 5
(EBPV)
Fault Facts
None
Step 3 Inspect connections at injector circuits outside valve cover connector. Decision
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 4.
B. Disconnect injector circuits outside valve cover connector.
C. Check injector circuits outside valve cover and connector terminals for:
damaged or pinched wires; moist or corroded terminals; loose, bent, or
broken pins; or broken connector housing.
Are injector circuits outside valve cover connector, harness, and terminals clean No: Repair connector, harness,
and undamaged? or terminal damage. After repairs
are complete, retest for SPN 654
FMI 14.
Step 7 Inspect fuel system, fuel level, and fuel quality. Decision
• Perform Fuel Level Inspection(page 1634), Yes: Go to Step 8.
• Fuel Quality Inspection(page 1632), and
• Fuel System Inspection(page 1631).
Is there sufficient supply of good quality fuel? No: Drain dirty or aerated fuel, fill
with good quality fuel. Repair any
other fuel system discrepancies.
After repairs are complete, retest
for SPN 654 FMI 14.
Step 8 Inspect air intake and exhaust systems for restrictions, leaks, or Decision
physical damage.
• Perform Intake Air Inspection(page 1648) and Yes: Go to Step 9.
• Exhaust and Aftertreatment System Inspection(page 1651).
Are air intake system and exhaust system clear of restrictions, leaks, and physical No: Repair restrictions, leaks, or
damage? physical damage. After repairs are
complete, retest for SPN 654 FMI
14.
Fault Overview
Fault code sets when Engine Control Module (ECM) detects a short circuit on Injector 5 Open coil.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate immediately when this fault is detected.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
Final number of SPN identifies affected injector, and name in Navistar® Engine Diagnostics identifies cylinder in
which injector is installed.
It may be necessary to perform the pin point circuit diagnostics tests with the engine at or near normal operating
temperature.
See latest version of MaxxForce® DT, 9 and 10 Engine and Aftertreatment Wiring Schematic Form 0000003221
for additional circuit information.
WARNING:
To prevent personal injury or death, shut engine down before doing voltage checks
for injector solenoids. When engine is running, injector circuits have high voltage and
amperage.
CAUTION:
To prevent engine damage, turn ignition switch OFF before disconnecting connectors.
Failure to turn ignition switch OFF will cause a voltage spike and damage to electrical
components.
D. Use DMM, measure resistance between Injector 5 pin-2 and known good
GND.
Is resistance greater than 1000 ohms? No: Replace Injector 5 and
perform Injector Coil End of
Motion (CEOM) Reset Procedure
(page 1334) and Injector Coking
Accumulation Reset Procedure
(page 1338). After repairs are
complete, retest for SPN 655 FMI
4.
Step 6 Check Injector 5 Open Coil H Circuit for short to GND. Decision
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 7.
B. Disconnect Injector 5 connector from UVC harness.
C. Disconnect ECM - Driver 36-pin connector.
D. Use Engine Terminal Test Kit ZTSE4435C, insert proper terminal into ECM
- Driver 36-pin connector pin D-26, leave ECM disconnected.
E. Use DMM, measure resistance between ECM - Driver 36-pin connector
pin D-26 and known good GND.
Is resistance greater than 1000 ohms? No: Repair short to GND between
ECM - Driver 36-pin connector pin
D-26 and Injector 5. After repairs
are complete, retest for SPN 655
FMI 4.
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 595
Step 7 Check Injector 5 Open Coil L Circuit for short to GND. Decision
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 8.
B. Disconnect Injector 5 connector from UVC harness.
C. Disconnect ECM - Driver 36-pin connector.
D. Use Engine Terminal Test Kit ZTSE4435C, insert proper terminal into ECM
- Driver 36-pin connector pin D-25, leave ECM disconnected.
Step 8 Check for short between Open H and Open L circuits in UVC harness. Decision
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 9.
B. Disconnect Injector 5 connector from UVC harness.
C. Disconnect UVC harness connector 4 from engine harness.
D. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4793 to UVC harness connector 4, leave
engine harness disconnected.
E. Use DMM, measure resistance between Breakout Harness ZTSE4793
pin-3 and pin-4.
Is resistance greater than 1000 ohms? No: Replace UVC Harness. After
repairs are complete, retest for
SPN 655 FMI 4.
Step 9 Check for short between Open H and Open L circuits in Engine Decision
Harness.
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 10.
E. Check Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) list for SPN 655 FMI 4.
Has original concern been resolved? No: Reinstall original ECM. Verify
each step was completed correctly
and proper decision were made.
Fault Overview
Fault code sets when Engine Control Module (ECM) detects an Open circuit on Injector 5 Open coil circuit.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during one drive cycle.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
Final number of SPN identifies affected injector, and name in Navistar® Engine Diagnostics identifies cylinder in
which injector is installed.
It may be necessary to perform the pin point circuit diagnostics tests with the engine at or near normal operating
temperature.
See latest version of MaxxForce® DT, 9 and 10 Engine and Aftertreatment Wiring Schematic Form 0000003221
for additional circuit information.
E. Check Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) list for SPN 655 FMI 5.
Has original concern been resolved? No: Reinstall original ECM. Verify
each step was completed correctly
and proper decisions were made.
SPN 655 FMI 7 - Injector 5 Spool Motion Compensation Max Authority Reached
Fault Overview
Fault code sets when Engine Control Module (ECM) determines injector spool motion compensation has reached
its maximum allowable time limit.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
Final number of SPN identifies affected injector, and name in Navistar® Engine Diagnostics identifies cylinder in
which injector is installed.
Fault Overview
Fault sets when Engine Control Module (ECM) determines injector timing is off when comparing cylinder balance
difference between two consecutive cylinders.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
• SPN 27 FMI 14 (EGR) • SPN 51 FMI 3, 4, and 7 • SPN 94 (FDP) • SPN 108 FMI 3 and 4
(ETV) (BARO)
• SPN 110 FMI 2, 3, and 4 • SPN 132 (MAF) • SPN 164 (ICP) • SPN 175 FMI 2, 3, and 4
(ECT1) (EOT)
• SPN 191 FMI 3 and 4 • SPN 636 FMI 2 and 7 • SPN 655 FMI 4, 5, and 7 • SPN 1322 - 1328 FMI 31
(TOSS) (CMP) (INJ) (INJ)
• SPN 1189 FMI 3 and 4 • SPN 2659 FMI 20 (AMS) • SPN 2791 FMI 2, 3, 4, 7, • SPN 3055 FMI 2 (INJ)
(TC2WC) 8, and 14 (EGR)
• SPN 3464 FMI 31 (ETV) • SPN 4257 FMI 7 (INJ) • SPN 5543 FMI 3, 4, and 5
(EBPV)
Fault Facts
None
Step 3 Inspect connections at injector circuits outside valve cover connector. Decision
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 4.
B. Disconnect injector circuits outside valve cover connector.
C. Check injector circuits outside valve cover and connector terminals for:
damaged or pinched wires; moist or corroded terminals; loose, bent, or
broken pins; or broken connector housing.
Are injector circuits outside valve cover connector, harness, and terminals clean No: Repair connector, harness,
and undamaged? or terminal damage. After repairs
are complete, retest for SPN 655
FMI 14.
Step 7 Inspect fuel system, fuel level, and fuel quality. Decision
• Perform Fuel Level Inspection(page 1634), Yes: Go to Step 8.
• Fuel Quality Inspection(page 1632), and
• Fuel System Inspection(page 1631).
Is there sufficient supply of good quality fuel? No: Drain dirty or aerated fuel, fill
with good quality fuel. Repair any
other fuel system discrepancies.
After repairs are complete, retest
for SPN 655 FMI 14.
Step 8 Inspect air intake and exhaust systems for restrictions, leaks, or Decision
physical damage.
• Perform Intake Air Inspection (page 1648) and Yes: Go to Step 9.
• Exhaust and Aftertreatment System Inspection (page 1651).
Are air intake system and exhaust system clear of restrictions, leaks, and physical No: Repair restrictions, leaks, or
damage? physical damage. After repairs are
complete, retest for SPN 655 FMI
14.
Fault Overview
Fault code sets when Engine Control Module (ECM) detects a short circuit on Injector 6 Open coil.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate immediately when this fault is detected.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
Final number of SPN identifies affected injector, and name in Navistar® Engine Diagnostics identifies cylinder in
which injector is installed.
It may be necessary to perform the pin point circuit diagnostics tests with the engine at or near normal operating
temperature.
See latest version of MaxxForce® DT, 9 and 10 Engine and Aftertreatment Wiring Schematic Form 0000003221
for additional circuit information.
WARNING:
To prevent personal injury or death, shut engine down before doing voltage checks
for injector solenoids. When engine is running, injector circuits have high voltage and
amperage.
CAUTION:
To prevent engine damage, turn ignition switch OFF before disconnecting connectors.
Failure to turn ignition switch OFF will cause a voltage spike and damage to electrical
components.
D. Use DMM, measure resistance between Injector 6 pin-2 and known good
GND.
Is resistance greater than 1000 ohms? No: Replace Injector 6 and
perform Injector Coil End of
Motion (CEOM) Reset Procedure
(page 1334) and Injector Coking
Accumulation Reset Procedure
(page 1338). After repairs are
complete, retest for SPN 656 FMI
4.
Step 6 Check Injector 6 Open Coil H Circuit for short to GND. Decision
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 7.
B. Disconnect Injector 6 connector from UVC harness.
C. Disconnect ECM - Driver 36-pin connector.
D. Use Engine Terminal Test Kit ZTSE4435C, insert proper terminal into ECM
- Driver 36-pin connector pin D-28, leave ECM disconnected.
E. Use DMM, measure resistance between ECM - Driver 36-pin connector
pin D-28 and known good GND.
Is resistance greater than 1000 ohms? No: Repair short to GND between
ECM - Driver 36-pin connector pin
D-28 and Injector 6. After repairs
are complete, retest for SPN 656
FMI 4.
612 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Step 7 Check Injector 6 Open Coil L Circuit for short to GND. Decision
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 8.
B. Disconnect Injector 6 connector from UVC harness.
C. Disconnect ECM - Driver 36-pin connector.
D. Use Engine Terminal Test Kit ZTSE4435C, insert proper terminal into ECM
- Driver 36-pin connector pin D-27, leave ECM disconnected.
Step 8 Check for short between Open H and Open L circuits in UVC harness. Decision
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 9.
B. Disconnect Injector 6 connector from UVC harness.
C. Disconnect UVC harness connector 4 from engine harness.
D. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4793 to UVC harness connector 4, leave
engine harness disconnected.
E. Use DMM, measure resistance between Breakout Harness ZTSE4793
pin-7 and pin-8.
Is resistance greater than 1000 ohms? No: Replace UVC Harness. After
repairs are complete, retest for
SPN 656 FMI 4.
Step 9 Check for short between Open H and Open L circuits in Engine Decision
Harness.
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 10.
E. Check Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) list for SPN 656 FMI 4.
Has original concern been resolved? No: Reinstall original ECM. Verify
each step was completed correctly
and proper decision were made.
Fault Overview
Fault code sets when Engine Control Module (ECM) detects an Open circuit on Injector 6 Open coil circuit.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during one drive cycle.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
Final number of SPN identifies affected injector, and name in Navistar® Engine Diagnostics identifies cylinder in
which injector is installed.
It may be necessary to perform the pin point circuit diagnostics tests with the engine at or near normal operating
temperature.
See latest version of MaxxForce® DT, 9 and 10 Engine and Aftertreatment Wiring Schematic Form 0000003221
for additional circuit information.
E. Check Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) list for SPN 656 FMI 5.
Has original concern been resolved? No: Reinstall original ECM. Verify
each step was completed correctly
and proper decisions were made.
SPN 656 FMI 7 - Injector 6 Spool Motion Compensation Max Authority Reached
Fault Overview
Fault code sets when Engine Control Module (ECM) determines injector spool motion compensation has reached
its maximum allowable time limit.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
Final number of SPN identifies affected injector, and name in Navistar® Engine Diagnostics identifies cylinder in
which injector is installed.
Fault Overview
Fault sets when Engine Control Module (ECM) determines injector timing is off when comparing cylinder balance
difference between two consecutive cylinders.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
• SPN 27 FMI 14 (EGR) • SPN 51 FMI 3, 4, and 7 • SPN 94 (FDP) • SPN 108 FMI 3 and 4
(ETV) (BARO)
• SPN 110 FMI 2, 3, and 4 • SPN 132 (MAF) • SPN 164 (ICP) • SPN 175 FMI 2, 3, and 4
(ECT1) (EOT)
• SPN 191 FMI 3 and 4 • SPN 636 FMI 2 and 7 • SPN 656 FMI 4, 5, and 7 • SPN 1322 - 1328 FMI 31
(TOSS) (CMP) (INJ) (INJ)
• SPN 1189 FMI 3 and 4 • SPN 2659 FMI 20 (AMS) • SPN 2791 FMI 2, 3, 4, 7, • SPN 3055 FMI 2 (INJ)
(TC2WC) 8, and 14 (EGR)
• SPN 3464 FMI 31 (ETV) • SPN 4257 FMI 7 (INJ) • SPN 5543 FMI 3, 4, and
5 (EBPV)
Fault Facts
None
Step 3 Inspect connections at injector circuits outside valve cover connector. Decision
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 4.
B. Disconnect injector circuits outside valve cover connector.
C. Check injector circuits outside valve cover and connector terminals for:
damaged or pinched wires; moist or corroded terminals; loose, bent, or
broken pins; or broken connector housing.
Are injector circuits outside valve cover connector, harness, and terminals clean No: Repair connector, harness,
and undamaged? or terminal damage. After repairs
are complete, retest for SPN 656
FMI 14.
Step 7 Inspect fuel system, fuel level, and fuel quality. Decision
• Perform Fuel Level Inspection(page 1634), Yes: Go to Step 8.
• Fuel Quality Inspection(page 1632), and
• Fuel System Inspection(page 1631).
Is there sufficient supply of good quality fuel? No: Drain dirty or aerated fuel, fill
with good quality fuel. Repair any
other fuel system discrepancies.
After repairs are complete, retest
for SPN 656 FMI 14.
Step 8 Inspect air intake and exhaust systems for restrictions, leaks, or Decision
physical damage.
• Perform Intake Air Inspection(page 1648) and Yes: Go to Step 9.
• Exhaust and Aftertreatment System Inspection(page 1651).
Are air intake system and exhaust system clear of restrictions, leaks, and physical No: Repair restrictions, leaks, or
damage? physical damage. After repairs are
complete, retest for SPN 656 FMI
14.
Fault Overview
Fault code sets when Electronic Control Module (ECM) detects Injection Pressure Regulator (IPR) valve
frequency is greater than expected.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during one trip.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
None
Step 3 Test IPR circuit while IPR is being actuated by ECM. Decision
A. Perform Test 1(page 627). Yes: Replace IPR valve. After
repairs are complete, retest for
B. Select KOEO Tests > Output State Test High(page 1359).
SPN 679 FMI 3.
C. While test is active, use DMM, measure voltage between Breakout
Harness 12-800-02 pin-2 and known good GND.
Is voltage less than 0.5 volts? No: Repair short to PWR between
IPR valve pin-2 and ECM pin
E-43. After repairs are complete,
retest for SPN 679 FMI 3.
See latest version of MaxxForce® DT, 9, and 10 Engine and Aftertreatment Wiring Schematic Form 0000003221
for additional circuit information.
Tools Required
• Digital Multimeter (DMM)
• Injection Pressure Regulator (IPR) Breakout Harness 12-800-02
628 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Test 1
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect Injection Pressure Regulator (IPR) valve connector.
C. Connect Breakout Harness 12-800-02 to vehicle harness and leave IPR valve connector disconnected.
D. Connect Electronic Service Tool (EST) to vehicle Diagnostic Connector (page 1345).
E. Key-On Engine-Off (KOEO). Log into Navistar® Engine Diagnostics.
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 629
Fault Overview
Fault code sets when Engine Control Module (ECM) detects Injection Pressure Regulation (IPR) valve frequency
is less than 100 Hz.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during one trip.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
None
Step 3 Check Injection Pressure Regulator (IPR) valve circuit for Open. Decision
A. Perform Test 1(page 631). Yes: Go to Step 4.
B. Use DMM, measure voltage between Breakout Harness 12-800-02 pin-1
and known good GND.
Is voltage B+ ± 0.5 volts? No: Repair Open between IPR
valve pin-1 and ignition switch.
After repairs are complete, retest
for SPN 679 FMI 4.
Step 4 Test IPR circuit while IPR is being actuated by ECM. Decision
A. Perform Test 2(page 632). Yes: Replace IPR valve. After
repairs are complete, retest for
B. Select KOEO Tests > Output State Test High(page 1359).
SPN 679 FMI 4.
C. While test is active, use DMM, measure voltage between Breakout
Harness 12-800-02 pin-1 and pin-2.
Is voltage B+ ± 0.5 volts? No: Repair Open or short to GND
between IPR valve pin-2 and
ECM pin E-43. After repairs are
complete, retest for SPN 679 FMI
4.
See latest version of MaxxForce® DT, 9, and 10 Engine and Aftertreatment Wiring Schematic Form 0000003221
for additional circuit information.
Tools Required
• Digital Multimeter (DMM)
• Breakout Harness 12-800-02
632 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Test 1
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect Injection Pressure Regulator (IPR) valve connector.
C. Connect Breakout Harness 12-800-02 to vehicle harness and leave IPR valve connector disconnected.
D. Key-On Engine-Off (KOEO).
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 633
12-800-02
2
0000429466
Test 2
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect Injection Pressure Regulator (IPR) valve connector.
C. Connect Breakout Harness 12-800-02 to vehicle harness and leave IPR valve connector disconnected.
D. Connect Electronic Service Tool (EST) to vehicle Diagnostic Connector (page 1345).
E. Key-On Engine-Off (KOEO). Log into Navistar® Engine Diagnostics.
634 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Fault Overview
Fault sets when Engine Control Module (ECM) determines Injection Pressure Regulator (IPR) has an open
circuit.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
None
Step 2 Inspect Injection Pressure Regulator (IPR) sensor and connector. Decision
A. Key OFF. Yes: Go to Step 3.
B. Disconnect IPR valve.
C. Check IPR valve and connector terminals for: damaged or pinched
wires; wet or corroded terminals; loose, bent, or broken pins; or broken
connector housing.
Are IPR valve connector, harness, and terminals clean and undamaged? No: Repair connector, harness, or
terminal damage. After repairs are
complete, retest for SPN 679 FMI
5.
Step 3 Test IPR valve circuit for Open or Short to GND Decision
Perform Test 1 (page 638). Use DMM, measure voltage between IPR valve Yes: Go to Step 4.
breakout harness pin-1 and known good GND.
Is voltage B+ ± 0.5 volts? No: Repair Open or Short to
GND in IPR voltage supply circuit
between IPR valve pin-1 and
switched ignition PWR. After
repairs are complete, retest for
SPN 679 FMI 5.
Step 5 Test IPR valve circuit for Open or Short to PWR. Decision
A. Perform Test 3 (page 640). Yes: Clear any faults codes that
set during test, and go to Step 6.
B. Perform IPR Output State High Test (page 1359).
C. While test is running, use DMM, measure voltage between IPR valve
breakout harness pin-1 and pin-2.
Is voltage B+ ± 0.5 volts while test is running? No: Repair Open or Short to PWR
in IPR low side driver control circuit
between IPR valve pin-2 and black
ECM 76-pin connector pin E-43.
After repairs are complete, retest
for SPN 679 FMI 5.
See latest version of MaxxForce® DT, 9, and 10 Engine and Aftertreatment Wiring Schematic Form 0000003221
for additional circuit information.
Tools Required
• Digital Multimeter (DMM)
• Breakout Harness 12-800-02
• Breakout Harness ZTSE4484
638 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Test 1
A. Key Off.
B. Disconnect IPR valve connector.
C. Compare IPR valve connector configuration to ZTSE4484 (Figure 186) and 12-800-02 (Figure 187) connector
ends and select appropriate breakout harness.
D. Connect appropriate IPR valve breakout harness to engine harness and leave IPR valve disconnected.
E. Key-On Engine-Off (KOEO).
640 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
2
12-800-02
0000432664
Test 2
A. Key Off.
B. Disconnect IPR valve connector.
C. Connect IPR valve breakout harness to engine harness and leave IPR valve disconnected.
D. Key-On Engine-Off (KOEO).
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 641
12-800-02
2
0000429466
Test 3
A. Key Off.
B. Disconnect IPR valve connector.
C. Connect IPR valve breakout harness to engine harness and leave IPR valve disconnected.
D. Connect Electronic Service Tool (EST) to vehicle Diagnostic Connector (page 1345).
E. Key-On Engine-Off (KOEO). Log into Navistar® Engine Diagnostics.
642 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
12-800-02
2
0000429466
Test 4
A. Key Off.
B. Disconnect IPR valve connector.
C. Install IPR valve breakout harness between IPR valve and engine harness.
D. Connect Electronic Service Tool (EST) to vehicle Diagnostic Connector (page 1345).
E. Key-On Engine-Off (KOEO). Log into Navistar® Engine Diagnostics.
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 643
12-800-02 2
0000432665
Test 5
A. Key Off.
B. Disconnect IPR valve connector.
C. Connect IPR valve breakout harness to IPR valve and leave engine harness disconnected.
644 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Fault Overview
Fault sets when Engine Control Module (ECM) determines IAH is shorted to B+.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
SPN 158 FMI 15 and 17
(ECM)
Fault Facts
None
Step 3 Intake Air Heater Control (IAHC) relay and connector inspection. Decision
A. Key OFF. Yes: Go to Step 4.
B. Disconnect IAHC relay.
C. Check IAHC relay and connector terminals for: damaged or pinched
wires; wet or corroded terminals; loose, bent, or broken pins; or broken
connector housing.
Are IAHC relay connector, harness, and terminals clean and undamaged? No: Repair connector, harness, or
terminal damage. After repairs are
complete, retest for SPN 729 FMI
3.
See latest version of MaxxForce® DT, 9, and 10 Engine and Aftertreatment Wiring Schematic Form 0000003221
for additional circuit information.
Tools Required
• Breakout Harness ZTSE6025
• Digital Multimeter (DMM)
Test 1
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect IAHC relay.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE6025 to vehicle harness and leave IAHC relay disconnected.
D. Key ON Engine OFF (KOEO).
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 647
Fault Overview
Fault sets when Engine Control Module (ECM) determines IAH is shorted to ground.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
SPN 158 FMI 15 and 17
(ECM)
Fault Facts
None
Step 3 Inspect Intake Air Heater Control (IAHC) sensor and connector. Decision
A. Key OFF. Yes: Go to Step 4.
B. Disconnect IAHC sensor.
C. Check IAHC sensor and connector terminals for: damaged or pinched
wires; wet or corroded terminals; loose, bent, or broken pins; or broken
connector housing.
Are IAHC sensor connector, harness, and terminals clean and undamaged? No: Repair connector, harness,
or terminal damage. After repairs
are complete, retest for SPN 729
FMI 4.
Step 4 Check Intake Air Heater Control (IAHC) circuit for short to GND. Decision
A. Perform Test 1 (page 649). Yes: Replace Intake Air Heater
Relay (IAH Relay).
B. Use DMM, measure voltage between Breakout Harness ZTSE6025 pin-2
and PWR.
Is voltage less than 0.5 volts? No: Repair short to GND between
ECM pin E-59 and IAH Relay
pin-2. After repairs are complete,
retest for SPN 729 FMI 4.
See latest version of MaxxForce® DT, 9, and 10 Engine and Aftertreatment Wiring Schematic Form 0000003221
for additional circuit information.
Tools Required
• Breakout Harness ZTSE6025
• Digital Multimeter (DMM)
• Electronic Service Tool (EST) with Navistar® Engine Diagnostics
• Interface cable (RP1210B-compliant supporting J1939 and J1708)
650 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Test 1
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect Intake Air Heater Control (IAHC) sensor connector.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE6025 to vehicle harness and leave IAHC sensor disconnected.
D. Key-On Engine-Off (KOEO).
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 651
Fault Overview
Fault code sets when Engine Control Module (ECM) detects an Open circuit in Intake Air Heater (IAH) Relay
control circuit.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
SPN 158 FMI 15 and 17
(ECM PWR)
Fault Facts
None
See latest version of MaxxForce® DT, 9, and 10 Engine and Aftertreatment Wiring Schematic Form 0000003221
for additional circuit information.
Tools Required
• Breakout Harness ZTSE6025
• Breakout Harness ZTSE4993
• Breakout Harness ZTSE4497
• Digital Multimeter (DMM)
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 655
Test 1
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect Intake Air Heater (IAH) relay
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE6025 to vehicle engine and leave IAH relay disconnected
Test 2
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect Intake Air Heater (IAH) relay
C. Connect breakout harness ZTSE6025 to IAHC and leave engine harness disconnected.
656 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Test 3
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect Intake Manifold Temperature (IMT) sensor
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4993 to vehicle harness connector and leave IMT sensor disconnected
D. Connect Resistor Harness ZTSE4497 between Breakout Harness ZTSE4993 pin-1 and pin-2
E. Connect Electronic Service Tool (EST) to vehicle Diagnostic Connector
F. Key ON Engine OFF (KOEO). Log in to Navistar® Engine Diagnostics.
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 657
Test 4
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect Intake Manifold Temperature (IMT) sensor
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4993 to vehicle harness connector and leave IMT sensor disconnected
D. Connect Resistor Harness ZTSE4497 between Breakout Harness ZTSE4993 pin-2 and known good GND
E. Connect Electronic Service Tool (EST) to vehicle Diagnostic Connector
F. Key ON Engine OFF (KOEO). Log in to Navistar® Engine Diagnostics.
658 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
SPN 729 FMI 18 - IAH Monitor fault: Lack of Heat in the Intake Manifold
Fault Overview
Fault sets when Engine Control Module (ECM) detects an Intake Air Heater (IAH) monitor fault, lack of heat in
intake manifold.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
• SPN 105 FMI 3 and 4 (IMT) • SPN 729 FMI 3, 4, and 5
(IAHC)
Fault Facts
None
Step 3 Determine if IAH components and circuits are operating properly. Decision
Perform Intake Air Heater (IAH) System Test (page 1590). Yes: Repair or replace failed
components or circuits. After
repairs are complete, retest for
SPN 729 FMI 18.
Were failed IAH components or circuits identified? No: End Diagnostics. Retest for
SPN 729 FMI 18.
Step 4 Determine if Intake Manifold Temperature (IMT) sensor or bore has Decision
excessive soot or damage.
A. Key OFF. Yes: Replace IMT sensor. If
needed, clean sensor bore
B. Disconnect IMT sensor connector.
and repair source of soot
C. Remove IMT sensor from intake manifold and inspect for damage and contamination. After repairs are
excessive soot buildup. A thin layer of soot is normal. complete, retest for SPN 729 FMI
18.
Is the IMT sensor damaged or have excessive soot buildup? No: End Diagnostics. Retest for
SPN 729 FMI 18.
Fault Overview
Fault code sets when B+ is on EFP PWR circuit when Electric Fuel Pump (EFP) is commanded Off or when no
voltage is present when the EFP is commanded On.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
ECM will power fuel pump for 30 seconds after key is turned on. If ECM doesn’t see engine rotation at end of
30 seconds, pump will shut off until engine rotation is detected.
C. Check EFP relay and Fuse terminals for: damaged or pinched wires;
moist or corroded terminals; loose, bent, or broken pins; or broken
connector housing.
D. If fuse is blown replace with new. If fuse blows again, repair short to GND.
Are EFP relay and Fuse, harness, and terminals clean and undamaged? No: Repair connector, harness,
terminal damage, or short to GND.
After repairs are complete, retest
for SPN 931 FMI 3.
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 661
E. Use DMM, measure voltage from ZTSE4908 (or ZTSE4674 for Bus
Application) pin-85 to known B+ when fuel pump is commanded OFF.
Is voltage B+ ± 0.5 Volts? No: Repair short to PWR between
fuel pump relay pin-87 and ECM
pin E-69, EFP Pin-4 and EFP
662 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
A. Key-Off.
B. Disconnect the Fuel Pump Relay.
C. Connect breakout harness ZTSE4908 (or ZTSE4674 for Bus Application)
between relay socket and relay.
D. Key On Engine Off (KOEO).
E. Use DMM, measure voltage from ZTSE4908 (or ZTSE4674 for Bus
Application) pin-85 to B+ when fuel pump is commanded ON.
Is voltage B+ ± 0.5 Volts? No: Repair Open between fuel
pump relay pin-85 and ECM pin
C-76. After repairs are complete,
retest for SPN 931 FMI 3.
Fault Overview
Fault code sets when Engine Control Module (ECM) detects Electronic Fuel Pump (EFP) circuit voltage is 0
volts when the the pump is commanded ON.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
ECM will power fuel pump for 30 seconds after key is turned on. If ECM doesn’t see engine rotation at end of
30 seconds, pump will shut off until engine rotation is detected.
Step 5 Check for Open in SWBAT circuit to Fuel Pump Relay. Decision
A. Perform Test 3 (page 668). Yes: Go to Step 6.
B. Use DMM, measure voltage between Breakout Harness ZTSE4908 (or
ZTSE4674 for Bus Application) pin-86 and known good GND.
Is voltage B+ ± 0.5 volts? No: Repair Open between ignition
switch and Fuel Pump Relay
pin-86. See appropriate vehicle
"Electrical Circuit Diagrams".
After repairs are complete, retest
for SPN 931 FMI 4.
Test 1
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect Electric Fuel Pump (EFP).
Test 2
A. Key OFF.
B. Reconnect Fuel Pump connector.
C. Disconnect Fuel Pump Relay.
D. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4908 (or ZTSE4674 for Bus Application) to vehicle harness and leave Fuel
Pump Relay disconnected.
E. Key ON Engine OFF (KOEO).
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 669
Test 3
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect Fuel Pump Relay.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4908 (or ZTSE4674 for Bus Application) to vehicle harness and leave Fuel
Pump Relay disconnected.
D. Key ON Engine OFF (KOEO).
670 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Test 4
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect Fuel Pump Relay.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4908 (or ZTSE4674 for Bus Application) between vehicle harness and
Fuel Pump Relay.
D. Perform Output State High Test (page 1359).
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 671
Test 5
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect Fuel Pump Relay.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4908 (or ZTSE4674 for Bus Application) between vehicle harness and
Fuel Pump Relay.
D. Use Breakout Harness ZTSE4498, short Breakout Harness ZTSE4908 pin-85 to GND (manually commanding
EFP ON).
E. Key ON Engine OFF (KOEO).
672 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Fault Overview
Update calibration to prevent this fault code from falsely setting.
Lamp Reaction
None
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
Update calibration to prevent this fault code from falsely setting.
Possible Causes
None
Fault Overview
Update calibration to prevent this fault code from falsely setting.
Lamp Reaction
None
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
Update calibration to prevent this fault code from falsely setting.
Possible Causes
None
Fault Overview
Fault code sets when Engine Control Module (ECM) detects Remote Accelerator Pedal Position (RAPP) signal
is greater than expected.
Lamp Reaction
No Lamp
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
Remote Accelerator Pedal Position (RAPP) signal is provided at Body Builder cut wires. Diagnosing this fault
will involve aftermarket equipment attached to these wires.
Test 1
A. Key OFF.
Fault Overview
Lamp Reaction
No Lamp.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
Remote Accelerator Pedal Position (RAPP) signal is provided at Body Builder cut wires. Diagnosing this fault
will involve aftermarket equipment attached to these wires.
Fault Overview
Fault sets when over temperature is detected in Engine Control Module (ECM).
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
None
Fault Overview
Engine Control Module (ECM) compares Turbocharger 2 Compressor Intake Temperature (TC2CIT) sensor
to Intake Manifold Temperature (IMT), Intake Air Temperature (IAT), Charge Air Cooler Outlet Temperature
(CACOT), Engine Coolant Temperature 1 (ECT1), and Engine Oil Temperature (EOT) sensors after calibrated
adjustable cold-soak period (time).
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
None
Fault Overview
Fault Code sets when Engine Control Module (ECM) detects that Turbocharger 2 Compressor Intake
Temperature (TC2CIT) signal is greater than 4.8 volts.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
None
Step 3 Decision
A. Perform Test 1(page 687). Yes: Repair short to PWR
between TC2CIT pin-2 and
B. Use DMM, measure voltage between Breakout Harness ZTSE4993 pin-2
ECM pin E-72. After repairs are
and known good GND.
complete, retest for SPN 1173
FMI 3.
Is voltage greater than 6 volts? No: Go to Step 4.
Step 4 Decision
A. Perform Test 2(page 687). Yes: Replace TC2CIT sensor.
After repairs are complete, retest
B. Use EST, clear DTC list.
for SPN 1173 FMI 3.
Does SPN 1173 FMI 4 set after DTC list is cleared? No: Go to Step 5.
Step 5 Decision
A. Perform Test 3(page 688). Yes: Repair Open between
TC2CIT pin-1 and ECM pin E-28.
B. Use EST, clear DTC list.
After repairs are complete, retest
for SPN 1173 FMI 3.
Does SPN 1173 FMI 4 set after DTC list is cleared? No: Repair Open between
TC2CIT pin-2 and ECM pin E-72.
After repairs are complete, retest
for SPN 1173 FMI 3.
686 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
See latest version of MaxxForce® DT, 9, and 10 Engine and Aftertreatment Wiring Schematic Form 0000003221
for additional circuit information.
Tools Required
• Breakout Harness ZTSE4993
• Breakout Harness Banana Plug ZTSE4498
• Digital Multimeter (DMM)
• Electronic Service Tool (EST) with Navistar® Engine Diagnostics
• Interface cable (RP1210B-compliant supporting J1939 and J1708)
Test 1
A. Key OFF.
Test 2
A. Key-Off.
B. Disconnect Turbocharger 2 Compressor Intake Temperature (TC2CIT) sensor connector.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4993 to vehicle harness and leave TC2CIT sensor connector disconnected.
D. Use Breakout Harness ZTSE4498, short Breakout Harness ZTSE4993 pin-1 and pin-2 together.
E. Connect EST to vehicle Diagnostic Connector (page 1345).
F. Key ON Engine OFF (KOEO), log in to Navistar® Engine Diagnostics.
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 689
Test 3
A. Key-Off.
B. Disconnect Turbocharger 2 Compressor Intake Temperature (TC2CIT) sensor connector.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4993 to vehicle harness and leave TC2CIT sensor connector disconnected.
D. Use Breakout Harness ZTSE4498, short Breakout Harness ZTSE4993 pin-2 to ground.
E. Connect EST to vehicle Diagnostic Connector (page 1345).
F. Key ON Engine OFF (KOEO), log in to Navistar® Engine Diagnostics.
690 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Fault Overview
Fault code sets when Engine Control Module (ECM) detects Turbocharger 2 Compressor Intake Temperature
(TC2CIT) signal is less than 0.195 volts.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
None
Step 3 Decision
A. Key OFF. Yes: Replace TC2CIT sensor.
After repairs are complete, retest
B. Disconnect Turbocharger 2 Compressor Intake Temperature (TC2CIT)
for SPN 1173 FMI 3.
sensor.
C. Connect EST to vehicle Diagnostic Connector (page 1345).
D. Key ON Engine OFF (KOEO), use EST clear DTC list.
Does SPN 1173 FMI 3 set in DTC list? No: Repair short to GND between
TC2CIT pin-2 and ECM pin E-72.
After repairs are complete, retest
for SPN 1173 FMI 3.
SPN 1173 FMI 16 - TC2CIT signal above desired (Interstage CAC under cooling)
Fault Overview
Fault sets when TC2CIT signal is above desired, due to Low Pressure CAC Interstage under cooling.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
• SPN 102 FMI 3, 4, 7, and • SPN 105 FMI 2, 3, and 4 • SPN 108 FMI 3 and 4 • SPN 110 FMI 2, 3, and 4
16 (IMP) (IMT) (BARO) (ECT1)
• SPN 132 FMI 3 and 4 • SPN 172 FMI 2, 3, and 4 • SPN 191 FMI 3 and 4 • SPN 651 - 656 FMI 4 and
(MAF) (MAF) (TOSS) 5 (INJ)
• SPN 1173 FMI 2 (TC2CIT)
Fault Facts
None
Step 4 Inspect vehicle grille and Charge Air Cooler (CAC) for damage or Decision
blockage.
Inspect vehicle grille and CAC for damage, blockage, or anything that could prevent Yes: Go to Step 5.
proper air flow through CAC.
Is grille and CAC undamaged, not blocked, and is air able to flow through properly? No: Repair damage or blockage.
After repairs are complete, retest
for SPN 1173 FMI 16.
Fault Overview
Fault code sets when Electronic Control Module (ECM) determines that Turbocharger 2 Wastegate Control
(TC2WC) circuit is shorted to power for 25.5 seconds. TC2WC circuit current is greater than 1 amp for 20
microseconds or greater than 2 amps for 2 microseconds.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during one drive cycle.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
None
Step 3 Check TC2WC gound side switch circuit for short to PWR. Decision
A. Perform Test 1(page 697). Yes: Repair short to PWR between
TC2WC solenoid pin-2 and
B. Use DMM, measure voltage between Breakout Harness ZTSE4831 pin-2
ECM pin E-73. After repairs are
and known good GND.
complete, retest for SPN 1189 FMI
3.
Is voltage B+ ± 0.5 volts? No: Replace TC2WC solenoid.
After repairs are complete, retest
for SPN 1189 FMI 3.
Test 1
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect Turbocharger 2 Wastegate (TC2WC) solenoid connector.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4831 to vehicle harness and leave TC2WC solenoid connector disconnected.
D. Key ON Engine OFF (KOEO).
698 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Fault Overview
Fault code sets when Engine Control Module (ECM) determines Turbocharger 2 Wastegate (TC2WC) solenoid
circuit is shorted to ground or open.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
None
Step 3 Check ACT PWR Circuit for open or high resistance. Decision
A. Perform Test 1 (page 700). Yes: Go to Step 4.
B. Use DMM, measure voltage between Breakout Harness ZTSE4831 pin-1
and known good GND.
Is voltage B+ ± 0.5 volt? No: Repair Open circuit between
TC2WC pin-1 and ACT PWR Relay
pin-87. After repairs are complete,
retest for SPN 1189 FMI 4.
Test 1
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect Turbocharger 2 Wastegate (TC2WC) actuator valve connector.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4831 to vehicle harness and leave TC2WC connector disconnected.
D. Key ON Engine OFF (KOEO).
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 701
Test 2
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect Turbocharger 2 Wastegate (TC2WC) actuator valve connector.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4831 to vehicle harness and leave TC2WC connector disconnected.
D. Key ON Engine OFF (KOEO). Wait 10 seconds after key is turned On before taking voltage measurement.
702 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Fault Overview
Fault sets when Exhaust Back Pressure (EBP) is above desired pressure.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
• SPN 27 (EGR) • SPN 94 FMI 1 (EFP) • SPN 102 FMI 2, 3, and 4 • SPN 105 FMI 2, 3, and 4
• SPN 173 FMI 2, 3, and 4 • SPN 1189 • SPN 1209 FMI 2, 3, and 4 • SPN 2791
Fault Facts
Perform a MAF Sensor Calibration after doing repairs that change engine air intake, exhaust, or Exhaust Gas
Recirculation (EGR) flow characteristics.
Step 3 Check if Exhaust Back Pressure (EBP) sensor is reading correctly. Decision
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 4.
B. Connect Electronic Service Tool (EST) to vehicle Diagnostic Connector
(page 1345).
Step 4 Check if Intake Manifold Temperature (IMT) sensor is reading correctly. Decision
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 5.
B. Connect Electronic Service Tool (EST) to vehicle Diagnostic Connector
(page 1345).
C. Key-On, Engine-Off (KOEO), log in to Navistar® Engine Diagnostics.
D. Use Infrared Thermometer ZTSE4799, check intake manifold temperature
near IMT sensor.
E. Use EST, monitor IMT signal.
Is Infrared Thermometer reading and EST value within 30°F (17°C) of each other? No: Replace IMT sensor. After
repairs are complete, retest for
SPN 1209 FMI 0.
Step 9 Determine if KOEO IMP is within specification, and IMP sensor bore Decision
is not restricted.
A. Key OFF. Yes: Perform Boost Control
System Test (page 1533). Repair
B. Connect Electronic Service Tool (EST) to vehicle Diagnostic Connector
or replace failed component(s).
(page 1345).
After repairs are complete, go to
C. Key-On, Engine-Off (KOEO), log in to Navistar® Engine Diagnostics. Step 12.
D. Use EST, select: Pressure tab.
E. Compare Intake Manifold Pressure value to KOEO specification.
F. Remove IMP sensor and inspect sensor and bore for carbon buildup and
restrictions.
Is IMP within KOEO specification, and is sensor bore free of restrictions? No, KOEO IMP out of
specification: replace IMP sensor.
After repairs are complete, go to
Step 12.
No, sensor or bore restricted:
clean sensor and / or bore. After
repairs are complete, go to Step
12.
Step 10 Determine if air and EGR mixer duct are restricted. Decision
A. Remove Engine Throttle Value (ETV) assembly. See Engine Service Yes: Remove and clean air and
Manual. EGR mixer duct. Do not replace
EGR Valve. Replace O-rings
B. Inspect air and EGR mixer duct assembly for restrictions and carbon
if needed. After repairs are
build up.
complete, go to Step 12.
Is a severe amount of carbon restricting air and EGR mixer duct? No: Go to Step 11
Fault Overview
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
None
See latest version of MaxxForce® DT, 9, and 10 Engine and Aftertreatment Wiring Schematic Form 0000003221
for additional circuit information.
Tools Required
• Breakout Harness ZTSE4850
• Digital Multimeter (DMM)
• Electronic Service Tool (EST) with Navistar® Engine Diagnostics
• Interface cable (RP1210B-compliant supporting J1939 and J1708)
1. Use EST with Navistar® Engine Diagnostics, open Continuous Monitor session.
2. Monitor sensor voltage. Verify an active code for sensor.
• If code is inactive, monitor signal while wiggling connector and all wires at suspected location. If circuit
is interrupted, signal will spike and code will go active.
• If code is active, proceed to next Step.
3. Disconnect engine harness from sensor.
Inspect connectors for damaged pins, corrosion, or loose pins. Repair if necessary.
4. Connect breakout harness to engine harness. Leave sensor disconnected.
Fault Overview
Fault sets when absolute pressure difference between Barometric Absolute Pressure (BARO) and Intake
Manifold Pressure (IMP) and absolute pressure difference between Exhaust Gas Pressure (EGP) and BARO
and absolute pressure difference between EGP and IMP are greater than 4.4 psi (30 kPa) for two seconds with
Wastegate Actuator Position Command is less than 100%.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
Exhaust Back Pressure (EBP) cannot be checked in SMX, because SMX does not display negative values for
EBP. Type 2 errors are possible due to 4.4 psi (30 kPa) value.
Fault Overview
Fault sets when Exhaust Back-Pressure (EBP) sensor signal voltage is greater than 4.8 volts for 2.5 seconds.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
SPN 3509 FMI 3 and 4
(VREF 1)
Fault Facts
A restricted exhaust system may set this fault.
Step 4 Check for Open or high resistance in SIG GND circuit. Decision
A. Perform Test 1 (page 714). Yes: Replace EBP sensor. After
repairs are complete, retest for
B. Use DMM, measure voltage between Breakout Harness ZTSE4850 pin-1
SPN 1209 FMI 3.
and B+.
Is voltage B+ ± 0.5 volts? No: Repair Open or high
resistance between EBP pin-1
and ECM pin E-28. After repairs
are complete, retest for SPN
1209 FMI 3.
See latest version of MaxxForce® DT, 9, and 10 Engine and Aftertreatment Wiring Schematic Form 0000003221
for additional circuit information.
Tools Required
• Breakout Harness ZTSE4850
• Digital Multimeter (DMM)
• Electronic Service Tool (EST) with Navistar® Engine Diagnostics
• Interface cable (RP1210B-compliant supporting J1939 and J1708)
Test 1
A. Key OFF.
Fault Overview
Fault sets when Exhaust Back Pressure (EBP) sensor voltage less than 0.2 volts.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
SPN 3509 FMI 3 and 4
(VREF 1)
Fault Facts
None
Step 3 Check EBP signal circuit for Open or high resistance Decision
A. Perform Test 1 (page 718). Yes: Go to Step 4.
B. Use DMM, measure voltage between Breakout Harness ZTSE4850 pin-2
and known good GND.
Is voltage 5 ± 1.0 volts? No: Repair Open between EBP
pin-2 and Engine Control Module
pin E-35. After repairs are
complete, retest for SPN 1209
FMI 4.
See latest version of MaxxForce® DT, 9, and 10 Engine and Aftertreatment Wiring Schematic Form 0000003221
for additional circuit information.
Tools Required
• Breakout Harness ZTSE4850
• Breakout Harness ZTSE4498
• Digital Multimeter (DMM)
• Electronic Service Tool (EST) with Navistar® Engine Diagnostics
• Interface cable (RP1210B-compliant supporting J1939 and J1708)
Test 1
A. Key OFF.
Test 2
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect Exhaust Back Pressure (EBP) sensor.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4850 to vehicle harness and leave EBP sensor disconnected.
D. Use Breakout Harness ZTSE4498, short Breakout Harness ZTSE4850 pin-2 and pin-3 together.
E. Connect EST to vehicle Diagnostic Connector (page 1345).
F. Key ON Engine OFF (KOEO). Log in to Navistar® Engine Diagnostics.
720 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Test 3
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect Exhaust Back Pressure (EBP) sensor.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4850 to vehicle harness and leave EBP sensor disconnected.
D. Use Breakout Harness ZTSE4498, short Breakout Harness ZTSE4850 pin-2 and pin-3 together.
E. Connect EST to vehicle Diagnostic Connector (page 1345).
F. Key-On Engine-Off (KOEO). Log in to Navistar® Engine Diagnostics.
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 721
Fault Overview
Fault sets when Exhaust Back Pressure (EBP) signal does not respond as expected.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
SPN 1209 FMI 2, 3, and 4
Fault Facts
None
Step 2 Inspect Exhaust Back Pressure (EBP) sensor tube assembly. Decision
Inspect EBP sensor tube assembly. Yes: Replace tube assembly.
After repairs are complete, retest
or SPN 1209 FMI 7.
Is EBP sensor tube assembly plugged? No: Replace EBP sensor. After
repairs are complete, retest for
SPN 1209 FMI 7.
Fault Overview
Controller Area Network (CAN) circuit problem.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
SPN 609 FMI 3 and 4 (DCU)
Fault Facts
None
Step 3 Inspect Doser Control Unit (DCU) Module 53-pin and 86-pin Decision
connectors.
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 4.
B. Disconnect DCU Module connectors.
• Between DCU Module 53-pin connector pin-7 and known good GND.
Is voltage B+ ± 0.5 volts? No: Repair Open or short to GND
in DCU B+ circuits. After repairs
are complete, retest for SPN 1231
FMI 19.
724 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Step 6 Check DCU SWBAT circuit for Open or short to GND. Decision
A. Key OFF. Yes: Go to Step 7.
B. Disconnect DCU Module 53-pin connector.
C. Insert applicable terminal test pins from Terminal Test Kit ZTSE4435C, into
DCU 53-pin connector pin-52 and leave DCU disconnected.
E. Use DMM, measure voltage between DCU Module 53-pin connector pin-52
and known good GND.
Is voltage B+ ± 0.5 volts? No: Repair Open or short to GND
in DCU SWBAT circuit. After
repairs are complete, retest for
SPN 1231 FMI 19.
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 725
E. Use DMM, measure voltage between DCU Module 53-pin connector pin-14
and known good GND.
Is voltage greater than 1 volt? No: Repair CAN-H short to GND.
After repairs are complete, retest
for SPN 1231 FMI 19.
E. Use DMM, measure voltage between DCU Module 53-pin connector pin-15
and known good GND.
Is voltage greater than 1 volt? No: Repair CAN-L short to GND.
After repairs are complete, retest
for SPN 1231 FMI 19.
726 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
E. Use DMM, measure voltage between DCU Module 53-pin connector pin-15
and known good GND.
Is voltage less than 4 volts? No: Repair CAN-L short to PWR.
After repairs are complete, retest
for SPN 1231 FMI 19.
Step 11 Check for short between CAN-H and CAN-L circuits. Decision
A. Key OFF. Yes: Go to Step 12.
B. Disconnect DCU Module 53-pin connector.
C. Insert applicable terminal test pins from Terminal Test Kit ZTSE4435C, into
DCU 53-pin connector pin-14 and pin-15 and leave DCU disconnected.
D. Use DMM, measure resistance between DCU Module 53-pin connector
pin-14 and pin-15.
Is resistance greater than 50 ohms? No: Repair short between CAN-H
and CAN-L. After repairs are
complete, retest for SPN 1231
FMI 19.
Step 12 Check for Open or high resistance between DCU and ECM. Decision
A. Key OFF. Yes: Repair Open or high
resistance between DCU pin-14
B. Disconnect DCU Module 53-pin connector.
and ECM pin C-61. After repairs
C. Disconnect ECM Chassis 76-pin connector are complete, retest for SPN 1231
FMI 19.
D. Insert applicable terminal test pins from Terminal Test Kit ZTSE4435C, into
DCU 53-pin connector pin-14 and leave DCU disconnected.
E. Connect Breakout Harness 00-00959-01 between vehicle harness and
180-pin Breakout Box 00-00956-08 and leave ECM disconnected.
Step 13 Check for Open or high resistance between DCU and ECM. Decision
A. Key OFF. Yes: Repair Open or high
resistance between DCU pin-15
B. Disconnect DCU Module 53-pin connector.
and ECM pin C-62. After repairs
C. Disconnect ECM Chassis 76-pin connector are complete, retest for SPN 1231
FMI 19.
D. Insert applicable terminal test pins from Terminal Test Kit ZTSE4435C, into
DCU 53-pin connector pin-15 and leave DCU disconnected.
Fault Overview
Fault sets when Engine Control Module (ECM) determines there is a balance difference between cylinders.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
SPN 27 FMI 14 (EGR) SPN 51 FMI 3, 4, 7 and 11 SPN 94 FMI 3 and 4 (FDP) SPN 102 FMI 3, 4, and 7
(ETV) (IMP)
SPN 108 FMI 3 and 4 SPN 110 FMI 2, 3, 4, 17, SPN 132 FMI 0, 1, 3, and 4 SPN 164 FMI 0, 3, 4, 15, 16,
(BARO) and 18 (ECT1) (MAF) 17, and 18 (ICP)
SPN 175 FMI 2, 3, and 4 SPN 191 FMI 3 and 4 SPN 636 FMI 2 and 7 (CMP) SPN 651 - 656 FMI 4, 5, and
(EOT) (TOSS) 7 (INJ)
SPN 1189 FMI 3 and 4 SPN 2659 FMI 20 (AMS) SPN 2791 FMI 2, 3, 4, 7, 8, SPN 2797-2798 FMI 3, 4,
(TC2WG) and 14 (EGR) and 6 (INJ)
SPN 3055 FMI 2 (INJ) SPN 3659-3664 FMI 4 and SPN 3464 FMI 31 (ETV) SPN 4257 FMI 7 (INJ)
5 (INJ)
SPN 5543 FMI 3, 4, and 5
(EBPV)
Fault Facts
None
Step 3 Inspect air intake system and fuel system for leaks or physical damage. Decision
Perform following: Yes: Go to Step 4.
• Intake Air Inspection(page 1648)
• Fuel System Inspection(page 1631)
Are Intake system and fuel system free of restrictions, leaks or physical damage? No: Repair restrictions, leaks and
physical damage. After repairs
are complete, retest for SPN 1322
FMI 31.
Fault Overview
Fault sets when Engine Control Module (ECM) determines there is a balance difference between cylinders.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
SPN 27 FMI 14 (EGR) SPN 51 FMI 3, 4, 7 and 11 SPN 94 FMI 3 and 4 (FDP) SPN 102 FMI 3, 4, and 7
(ETV) (IMP)
SPN 108 FMI 3 and 4 SPN 110 FMI 2, 3, 4, 17, SPN 132 FMI 0, 1, 3, and 4 SPN 164 FMI 0, 3, 4, 15,
(BARO) and 18 (ECT1) (MAF) 16, 17, and 18 (ICP)
SPN 175 FMI 2, 3, and 4 SPN 191 FMI 3 and 4 SPN 636 FMI 2 and 7 (CMP) SPN 651 - 656 FMI 4, 5,
(EOT) (TOSS) and 7 (INJ)
SPN 1189 FMI 3 and 4 SPN 2659 FMI 20 (AMS) SPN 2791 FMI 2, 3, 4, 7, 8, SPN 2797-2798 FMI 3, 4,
(TC2WG) and 14 (EGR) and 6 (INJ)
SPN 3055 FMI 2 (INJ) SPN 3659-3664 FMI 4 and SPN 3464 FMI 31 (ETV) SPN 4257 FMI 7 (INJ)
5 (INJ)
SPN 5395 FMI 0 and 1 SPN 5543 FMI 3, 4, and 5
(Engine) (EBPV)
Fault Facts
None
Fault Overview
Fault sets when Engine Control Module (ECM) determines there is a balance difference between cylinders.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
SPN 27 FMI 14 (EGR) SPN 51 FMI 3, 4, 7 and 11 SPN 94 FMI 3 and 4 (FDP) SPN 102 FMI 3, 4, and 7
(ETV) (IMP)
SPN 108 FMI 3 and 4 SPN 110 FMI 2, 3, 4, 17, SPN 132 FMI 0, 1, 3, and 4 SPN 164 FMI 0, 3, 4, 15,
(BARO) and 18 (ECT1) (MAF) 16, 17, and 18 (ICP)
SPN 175 FMI 2, 3, and 4 SPN 191 FMI 3 and 4 SPN 636 FMI 2 and 7 SPN 651 - 656 FMI 4, 5,
(EOT) (TOSS) (CMP) and 7 (INJ)
SPN 1189 FMI 3 and 4 SPN 2659 FMI 20 (AMS) SPN 2791 FMI 2, 3, 4, 7, 8, SPN 2797-2798 FMI 3, 4,
(TC2WG) and 14 (EGR) and 6 (INJ)
SPN 3055 FMI 2 (INJ) SPN 3659-3664 FMI 4 and SPN 3464 FMI 31 (ETV) SPN 4257 FMI 7 (INJ)
5 (INJ)
SPN 5395 FMI 0 and 1 SPN 5543 FMI 3, 4, and 5
(Engine) (EBPV)
• SPN 3659 - 3664 FMI 4
and 5 (INJ)
Fault Facts
None
Fault Overview
Fault sets when Engine Control Module (ECM) determines there is a balance difference between cylinders.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
SPN 27 FMI 14 (EGR) SPN 51 FMI 3, 4, 7 and 11 SPN 94 FMI 3 and 4 (FDP) SPN 102 FMI 3, 4, and 7
(ETV) (IMP)
SPN 108 FMI 3 and 4 SPN 110 FMI 2, 3, 4, 17, SPN 132 FMI 0, 1, 3, and 4 SPN 164 FMI 0, 3, 4, 15,
(BARO) and 18 (ECT1) (MAF) 16, 17, and 18 (ICP)
SPN 175 FMI 2, 3, and 4 SPN 191 FMI 3 and 4 SPN 636 FMI 2 and 7 SPN 651 - 656 FMI 4, 5,
(EOT) (TOSS) (CMP) and 7 (INJ)
SPN 1189 FMI 3 and 4 SPN 2659 FMI 20 (AMS) SPN 2791 FMI 2, 3, 4, 7, 8, SPN 2797-2798 FMI 3, 4,
(TC2WG) and 14 (EGR) and 6 (INJ)
SPN 3055 FMI 2 (INJ) SPN 3659-3664 FMI 4 and SPN 3464 FMI 31 (ETV) SPN 4257 FMI 7 (INJ)
5 (INJ)
SPN 5395 FMI 0 and 1 SPN 5543 FMI 3, 4, and 5
(Engine) (EBPV)
• SPN 3659 - 3664 FMI 4
and 5 (INJ)
Fault Facts
None
Fault Overview
Fault sets when Engine Control Module (ECM) determines there is a balance difference between cylinders.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
SPN 27 FMI 14 (EGR) SPN 51 FMI 3, 4, 7 and 11 SPN 94 FMI 3 and 4 (FDP) SPN 102 FMI 3, 4, and 7
(ETV) (IMP)
SPN 108 FMI 3 and 4 SPN 110 FMI 2, 3, 4, 17, SPN 132 FMI 0, 1, 3, and 4 SPN 164 FMI 0, 3, 4, 15,
(BARO) and 18 (ECT1) (MAF) 16, 17, and 18 (ICP)
SPN 175 FMI 2, 3, and 4 SPN 191 FMI 3 and 4 SPN 636 FMI 2 and 7 SPN 651 - 656 FMI 4, 5,
(EOT) (TOSS) (CMP) and 7 (INJ)
SPN 1189 FMI 3 and 4 SPN 2659 FMI 20 (AMS) SPN 2791 FMI 2, 3, 4, 7, 8, SPN 2797-2798 FMI 3, 4,
(TC2WG) and 14 (EGR) and 6 (INJ)
SPN 3055 FMI 2 (INJ) SPN 3659-3664 FMI 4 and SPN 3464 FMI 31 (ETV) SPN 4257 FMI 7 (INJ)
5 (INJ)
SPN 5395 FMI 0 and 1 SPN 5543 FMI 3, 4, and 5
(Engine) (EBPV)
• SPN 3659 - 3664 FMI 4
and 5 (INJ)
Fault Facts
None
Fault Overview
Fault sets when Engine Control Module (ECM) determines there is a balance difference between cylinders.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
SPN 27 FMI 14 (EGR) SPN 51 FMI 3, 4, 7 and 11 SPN 94 FMI 3 and 4 (FDP) SPN 102 FMI 3, 4, and 7
(ETV) (IMP)
SPN 108 FMI 3 and 4 SPN 110 FMI 2, 3, 4, 17, SPN 132 FMI 0, 1, 3, and 4 SPN 164 FMI 0, 3, 4, 15,
(BARO) and 18 (ECT1) (MAF) 16, 17, and 18 (ICP)
SPN 175 FMI 2, 3, and 4 SPN 191 FMI 3 and 4 SPN 636 FMI 2 and 7 SPN 651 - 656 FMI 4, 5,
(EOT) (TOSS) (CMP) and 7 (INJ)
SPN 1189 FMI 3 and 4 SPN 2659 FMI 20 (AMS) SPN 2791 FMI 2, 3, 4, 7, 8, SPN 2797-2798 FMI 3, 4,
(TC2WG) and 14 (EGR) and 6 (INJ)
SPN 3055 FMI 2 (INJ) SPN 3659-3664 FMI 4 and SPN 3464 FMI 31 (ETV) SPN 4257 FMI 7 (INJ)
5 (INJ)
SPN 5395 FMI 0 and 1 SPN 5543 FMI 3, 4, and 5
(Engine) (EBPV)
• SPN 3659 - 3664 FMI 4
and 5 (INJ)
Fault Facts
None
Fault Overview
Fault sets when Engine Control Module (ECM) determines there is a balance difference between cylinders.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
SPN 27 FMI 14 (EGR) SPN 51 FMI 3, 4, 7 and 11 SPN 94 FMI 3 and 4 (FDP) SPN 102 FMI 3, 4, and 7
(ETV) (IMP)
SPN 108 FMI 3 and 4 SPN 110 FMI 2, 3, 4, 17, SPN 132 FMI 0, 1, 3, and 4 SPN 164 FMI 0, 3, 4, 15,
(BARO) and 18 (ECT1) (MAF) 16, 17, and 18 (ICP)
SPN 175 FMI 2, 3, and 4 SPN 191 FMI 3 and 4 SPN 636 FMI 2 and 7 SPN 651 - 656 FMI 4, 5,
(EOT) (TOSS) (CMP) and 7 (INJ)
SPN 1189 FMI 3 and 4 SPN 2659 FMI 20 (AMS) SPN 2791 FMI 2, 3, 4, 7, 8, SPN 2797-2798 FMI 3, 4,
(TC2WG) and 14 (EGR) and 6 (INJ)
SPN 3055 FMI 2 (INJ) SPN 3659-3664 FMI 4 and SPN 3464 FMI 31 (ETV) SPN 4257 FMI 7 (INJ)
5 (INJ)
SPN 5395 FMI 0 and 1 SPN 5543 FMI 3, 4, and 5
(Engine) (EBPV)
• SPN 3659 - 3664 FMI 4
and 5 (INJ)
Fault Facts
None
Fault Overview
Change oil reminder can be programmed for kilometers, miles, hours, or calculated fuel consumption. These
service interval limits may be adjusted at owner's discretion. Change engine oil message below odometer
illuminates after a preselected parameter is reached.
Possible Causes
• Change oil and re-set interval counter
756 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Fault Overview
Fault sets when Engine Control Module (ECM) determines that it has exceeded 98% CPU load.
Associated Faults
• SPN 102 FMI 2, 7, 16, and • SPN 108 FMI 2 • SPN 628 FMI 12 • SPN 629 FMI 0 and 12
18
• SPN 1209 FMI 0, 1, 7, and
31.
Fault Facts
None
Step 3 Inspect Exhaust Back Pressure (EBP) and Intake Manifold Pressure Decision
(IMP) sensor and connector.
A. Key OFF. Yes: Go to Step 4.
B. Disconnect EBP and IMP sensors.
C. Check EBP and IMP sensors and connector terminals for: damaged or
pinched wires; wet or corroded terminals; loose, bent, or broken pins; or
broken connector housing.
Are EBP and IMP sensor connector, harness, and terminals clean and undamaged? No: Repair connector, harness,
or terminal damage. After repairs
are complete, retest for SPN 1387
FMI 31.
Step 4 Test EBP and IMP circuits for open, short, or high resistance Decision
conditions.
• Do EBP connector voltage checks and resistance checks Yes: Go to Step 5.
• and IMP connector voltage checks and resistance checks.
Are Barometric Absolute Pressure (BARO), EBP, and IMP circuits within No: Repair circuits as required.
specifications? After repairs are complete, retest
for SPN 1387 FMI 31.
If voltage checks pass, doing resistance checks is not required.
Step 5 Test BARO, EBP, and IMP for intermittent circuit operation. Decision
A. Perform Continuous Monitor Test (page 1361). Yes: End diagnostics, retest for
SPN 1387 FMI 31.
B. Verify EBP and IMP sensor voltages are within specifications (page 1677).
Are sensor voltages within specifications (page 1677)? No: Locate specific circuit
component causing erratic or
intermittent operation. Perform
voltage and resistance checks
in this section. Repair circuits
as required. After repairs are
complete, retest for SPN 1387
FMI 31.
758 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Fault Overview
Fault sets when Engine Control Module (ECM) detects Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) is not matching the
modeled value.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
SPN 110 FMI 2, 3, and 4
(ECT1)
Fault Facts
None
Step 4 Decision
Perform Thermostat Operational Test (page 1608). Yes: Go to Step 5.
Does upper radiator hose temperature increase to ECT1 ± 25°F after engine warms No: Replace thermostat. After
up past thermostat opening temperature specification? repairs are complete, retest for
SPN 1659 FMI 20.
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 761
Test 1
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect Engine Fan Relay connector.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4908 to relay vehicle harness connector and leave Engine Fan Relay
connector disconnected.
D. Key ON Engine OFF (KOEO).
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 763
Fault Overview
Fault code sets when Electronic Control Module (ECM) detects that APP2 voltage is greater than 2.476 volts.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
None
Step 3 Decision
A. Key OFF. Yes: Go to Step 4.
B. Disconnect Accelerator Pedal Position (APP) sensor
C. Connect Electronic Service Tool (EST) to vehicle Diagnostic Connector
(page 1345).
D. Key ON Engine OFF (KOEO), log in to Navistar® Engine Diagnostics.
E. Use EST, clear DTC list.
Does fault code SPN 2623 FMI 4 set? No: Repair short to PWR between
APP connector pin-F and ECM
connector pin C-48. After repairs
are complete, retest for SPN 2623
FMI 3.
Step 4 Decision
A. Perform Test 1(page 766). Yes: Replace APP sensor. After
repairs are complete, retest for
B. Use Digital Multimeter (DMM), measure voltage between Breakout
SPN 2623 FMI 3.
Harness ZTSE4485A pin-E and B+.
Is voltage 12.0 ± 1.0 volts? No: Repair Open between APP
sensor connector pin-E and ECM
connector pin C-36. After repairs
are complete, retest for SPN 2623
FMI 3.
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 765
See latest version of MaxxForce® DT, 9, and 10 Engine and Aftertreatment Wiring Schematic Form 0000003221
for additional circuit information.
Tools Required
• Breakout Harness ZTSE4485A
• Digital Multimeter (DMM)
• Electronic Service Tool (EST) with Navistar® Engine Diagnostics
• Interface cable (RP1210B-compliant supporting J1939 and J1708)
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 767
Test 1
A. Key-Off.
B. Disconnect Accelerator Pedal Position (APP) sensor.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4485A to vehicle harness connector and leave APP sensor disconnected.
D. Key-On Engine-Off (KOEO).
768 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Fault Overview
Fault code sets when the Electronic Control Module (ECM) detects the Accelerator Pedal Position (APP) sensor
is reading lower than 0.273 volt on APP2 signal circuit.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
SPN 3511 FMI 3 and 4
(VREF 3)
Fault Facts
None
See latest version of MaxxForce® DT, 9, and 10 Engine and Aftertreatment Wiring Schematic Form 0000003221
for additional circuit information.
Tools Required
• 180-pin Breakout Box 00-00956-08
• Breakout Harness ZTSE4485A
• 3-Banana Plug Harness ZTSE4498
• Digital Multimeter (DMM)
• Electronic Service Tool (EST) with Navistar® Engine Diagnostics
• Interface cable (RP1210B-compliant supporting J1939 and J1708)
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 771
Test 1
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect Accelerator Pedal Position (APP) sensor.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4485A to vehicle harness connector and leave APP sensor disconnected.
D. Key ON Engine OFF (KOEO).
772 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Test 2
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect Accelerator Pedal Position (APP) sensor.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4485A to vehicle harness connector and leave APP sensor disconnected.
D. Use 3-Banana Plug Harness ZTSE4498 short Breakout Harness ZTSE4485A pin-D to pin-F.
E. Connect Electronic Service Tool (EST) to vehicle Diagnostic (page 1345).
F. Key ON Engine OFF (KOEO). Log in to Navistar® Engine Diagnostics.
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 773
Test 3
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect Accelerator Pedal Position (APP) sensor.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4485A to vehicle harness connector and leave APP sensor disconnected.
D. Use 3-Banana Plug Harness ZTSE4498 short Breakout Harness ZTSE4485A pin-D to pin-F.
E. Connect EST to vehicle Diagnostic (page 1345).
F. Key ON Engine OFF (KOEO). Log in to Navistar® Engine Diagnostics.
774 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Fault Overview
ECM compares Charge Air Cooler Outlet Temperature (CACOT) sensor to Intake Manifold Temperature (IMT),
Intake Air Temperature (IAT), Turbocharger 2 Compressor Intake Temperature (TC2CIT), Engine Coolant
Temperature 1 (ECT1), and Engine Oil Temperature (EOT) sensors after calibrated adjustable cold-soak period
(time).
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
None
Step 2 Inspect connections at Charge Air Cooler Outlet Temperature (CACOT) Decision
connector.
A. Key OFF. Disconnect CACOT connector. Yes: Go to Step 3.
B. Check CACOT and connector terminals for: damaged or pinched wires;
moist or corroded terminals; loose, bent, or broken pins; or broken
connector housing.
Are CACOT connector, harness, and terminals clean and undamaged? No: Repair connector, harness,
or terminal damage. After repairs
are complete, retest for SPN
2630 FMI 2.
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 775
Fault Overview
Fault Code sets when Engine Control Module (ECM) detects Charge Air Cooler Temperature (CACOT) sensor
voltage is greater than 4.70 volts.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected after two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
None
See latest version of MaxxForce® DT, 9, and 10 Engine and Aftertreatment Wiring Schematic Form 0000003221
for additional circuit information.
Tools Required
• Breakout Harness ZTSE4498
• Breakout Harness ZTSE4993
• Digital Multimeter (DMM)
• Electronic Service Tool (EST) with Navistar® Engine Diagnostics
• Interface cable (RP1210B-compliant supporting J1939 and J1708)
Test 1
A. Key OFF.
Test 2
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect Charge Air Cooler Temperature (CACOT) sensor
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4993 to vehicle harness connector and leave CACOT disconnected.
D. Use Breakout Harness ZTSE4498 short Breakout Harness ZTSE4993 pin-1 and pin-2 together.
E. Connect Electronic Service Tool (EST) to vehicle Diagnostic Connector (page 1345).
F. Key ON Engine OFF (KOEO). Log in to Navistar® Engine Diagnostics.
780 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Test 3
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect Charge Air Cooler Temperature (CACOT) sensor
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4993 to vehicle harness connector and leave CACOT disconnected.
D. Use Breakout Harness ZTSE4498 short Breakout Harness ZTSE4993 pin-2 of known good GND.
E. Connect EST to vehicle Diagnostic Connector (page 1345).
F. Key ON Engine OFF (KOEO). Log in to Navistar® Engine Diagnostics.
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 781
Fault Overview
Fault Code sets when Engine Control Module (ECM) detects Charge Air Cooler Outlet Temperature (CACOT)
signal is less than 0.11 volts.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive trips.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
None
Step 3 Decision
A. Key OFF. Yes: Replace CACOT sensor.
After repairs are complete, retest
B. Disconnect Charge Air Cooler Outlet Temperature (CACOT) sensor.
for SPN 2630 FMI 4.
C. Connect EST to vehicle Diagnostic Connector (page 1345).
D. Key ON Engine OFF (KOEO). Log in to Navistar® Engine Diagnostics.
E. Use EST, clear DTC list.
Does SPN 2630 FMI 3 set after DTC list is cleared? No: Repair short to ground
between CACOT pin-1 and
ECM pin E-65. After repairs are
complete, retest for SPN 2630
FMI 4.
Fault Overview
Fault sets when Engine Control Module (ECM) determines Charge Air Cooler (CAC) efficiency is below
programmed threshold.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
SPN 102 SPN 105 SPN 172 SPN 1173
SPN 2630 FMI 2, 3, and 4
Fault Facts
None
Step 3 Determine if winter front (grille cover) is installed during warm Decision
temperatures.
Determine if a winter front (grille cover) is installed during warm temperatures. Yes: Go to Step 4
Is winter front (grille cover) removed during warm temperatures? No: Remove winter front (grille
cover). After repairs are complete,
retest for SPN 2630 FMI 16.
Step 4 Inspect vehicle radiator and CAC for damage or blockage. Decision
Perform following: Yes: Repair damage or blockage.
After repairs are complete, retest
A. Intake Air Inspection (page 1648) to inspect vehicle radiator and radiator
for SPN 2630 FMI 16.
grille for damage, blockage, or anything that could prevent proper air flow
through CAC and radiator.
B. Charge Air Cooler Inspection (page 1646)for damage, blockage, or
anything that could prevent proper air flow through CAC.
Is radiator, radiator grille, or CAC damaged or restricted? No: Go to Step 5.
Step 5 Inspect Interstage Cooler (ISC) coolant supply and return hoses. Decision
A. Inspect Interstage Cooler (ISC) coolant supply and return hoses for Yes: Go to Step 6.
incorrect routing, damage, and pinched hoses or pipes.
B. Inspect interstage cooler for external damage.
Are ISC and coolant supply and return hoses and pipes routed correct and No: Repair ISC or coolant hoses.
undamaged? After repairs are complete, retest
for SPN 2630 FMI 16.
Step 7 Check fan, shroud, and air dams for damage and proper operation. Decision
Check engine fan, fan shroud, and air dams for damage and proper operation. Yes: Go to Step 8.
Are engine fan, fan shroud, and air dams intact and operating properly? No: Repair or replace engine fan,
fan shroud, and/or air dams. After
repairs are complete, retest for
SPN 2630 FMI 16.
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 785
See latest version of MaxxForce® DT, 9, and 10 Engine and Aftertreatment Wiring Schematic Form 0000003221
for additional circuit information.
Tools Required
• Breakout Harness ZTSE4498
• Breakout Harness ZTSE4497
• Digital Multimeter (DMM)
• Electronic Service Tool (EST) with Navistar® Engine Diagnostics
• Interface cable (RP1210B-compliant supporting J1939 and J1708)
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 787
Test 1
A. Key-Off.
B. Disconnect Charge Air Cooler Outlet Temperature (CACOT) sensor.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4993 to engine harness connector and leave CACOT sensor disconnected.
D. Connect Resistor Harness ZTSE4497 between Breakout Harness ZTSE4993 pin-1 and pin-2.
E. Connect Electronic Service Tool (EST) to vehicle Diagnostic Connector (page 1345).
F. Key-On Engine-Off (KOEO), log in to Navistar® Engine Diagnostics.
788 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Test 2
A. Key-Off.
B. Disconnect Charge Air Cooler Outlet Temperature (CACOT) sensor.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4993 to engine harness connector and leave CACOT sensor disconnected.
D. Connect Resistor Harness ZTSE4497 between Breakout Harness ZTSE4993 pin-2 and known good GND.
E. Connect Electronic Service Tool (EST) to vehicle Diagnostic Connector (page 1345).
F. Key On Engine Off (KOEO), log in to Navistar® Engine Diagnostics.
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 789
Fault Overview
Fault sets when Engine Control Module (ECM) determines Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) mass flow rate is
low.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
• SPN 27 (EGR) • SPN 2791 (EGR)
Fault Facts
Perform a MAF Sensor Calibration after doing repairs that change engine air intake, exhaust, or Exhaust Gas
Recirculation (EGR) flow characteristics.
Step 6 Determine if KOEO IMP is within specification, and IMP sensor bore Decision
is not restricted.
A. Key-Off. Yes: Perform Boost Control
System Test (page 1533). Repair
B. Use EST with Navistar® Engine Diagnostics, select: Pressure tab.
or replace failed component(s).
C. Compare Intake Manifold Pressure value to KOEO specification. After repairs are complete, go to
Step 8.
D. Remove IMP sensor and inspect sensor and bore for carbon buildup and
restrictions.
Is IMP within KOEO specification, and is sensor bore free of restrictions? No, KOEO IMP out of
specification: replace IMP sensor.
After repairs are complete, go to
Step 8.
No, sensor or bore restricted:
clean sensor and/or bore. After
repairs are complete, go to Step
8.
SPN 2659 FMI 14 - EGR System flow rate error during Air Management Test
Fault Overview
Fault code sets when the difference between high and low Mass Air Flow (MAF) readings exceed a set threshold
during Air Management Test.
Lamp Reaction
None.
Associated Faults
• SPN 27 (EGR) • SPN 2791 (EGR)
Fault Facts
You are able to analyze the Air Management Test results even if fault became active during the test.
Perform MAF Sensor Calibration after doing repairs that change engine air intake, exhaust, or Exhaust Gas
Recirculation (EGR) flow characteristics.
Step 2 Test for proper Exhaust gas Recirculation Valve Operation. Decision
Perform Exhaust Gas Recirculation Valve (EGRV) Operational Test (page 1543). Yes: Replace EGR valve. Perform
MAF Sensor Calibration (page
1539). After repairs are complete,
retest for SPN 2659 FMI 14.
Is SPN 2791 FMI 7 or SPN 27 FMI 7 Pending or Active in DTC list after running test? No: Go to Step 3.
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 793
Fault Overview
Fault code sets when Engine Control Module (ECM) detects high Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) flow rate.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
• SPN 27 FMI 14 • SPN 51 FMI 3, 4, and 7 • SPN 102 FMI 2, 3, 4, 7, • SPN 105 FMI 2, 3, and 4
and 18
• SPN 172 FMI 2, 3, and 4 • SPN 2791 FMI 3, 4, 7, 8, • SPN 3464 FMI 31 • SPN 4752 FMI 4
and 14
Fault Facts
Ensure correct Programmable Parameter (PP) is programmed for air induction system.
Fault Overview
Fault sets when Engine Control Module (ECM) determines EGR mass flow rate is low.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
Fault Facts
Perform MAF Sensor Calibration after doing repairs that change engine air intake, exhaust, or Exhaust Gas
Recirculation (EGR) flow characteristics.
Step 6 Determine if KOEO IMP is within specification, and IMP sensor bore Decision
is not restricted.
A. Key-Off. Yes: Perform Boost Control
®
System Test (page 1533). Repair
B. Use EST Navistar Engine Diagnostics, select: Pressure tab.
or replace failed component(s).
C. Compare Intake Manifold Pressure value to KOEO specification. After repairs are complete,
perform MAF Sensor Calibration
D. Remove IMP sensor and inspect sensor and bore for carbon buildup and
(page 1539)and retest for SPN
restrictions.
2659 FMI 21.
Is IMP within KOEO specification, and is sensor bore free of restrictions? No, KOEO IMP out of
specification: replace IMP sensor.
After repairs are complete,
perform MAF Sensor Calibration
(page 1539)and retest for SPN
2659 FMI 21.
No, sensor or bore restricted:
clean sensor and/or bore. After
repairs are complete, perform
MAF Sensor Calibration (page
1539)and retest for SPN 2659
FMI 21.
Fault Overview
Fault sets when Engine Control Module (ECM) fails to detect rising edge of a response pulse on Exhaust Gas
Recirculation (EGR) position signal line within 0.0057 seconds following commanded position change.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
None
Step 7 Check ACT PWR circuit for Open or blown fuse. Decision
A. Perform Test 4 (page 805). Yes: Go to Step 10.
B. Use DMM, measure voltage between Breakout Harness ZTSE4948 pin-4
and known good GND.
Is voltage greater than 9 volts? No: Go to Step 8.
Step 10 Check for failed Exhaust Gas Recirculation Valve (EGRV). Decision
A. Key OFF. Yes: Replace EGRV. After repairs
are complete, retest for SPN 2791
B. Connect TC2WC engine harness connector to wastegate.
FMI 2.
C. Perform Exhaust Gas Recirculation Valve (EGRV) Operational Test (page
1543).
Is SPN 2791 FMI 2 or 7 active or pending? No: End diagnostics, retest for
SPN 2791 FMI 2.
See latest version of MaxxForce® DT, 9, and 10 Engine and Aftertreatment Wiring Schematic Form 0000003221
for additional circuit information.
Tools Required
• Breakout Harness ZTSE4948
• Digital Multimeter (DMM)
• Electronic Service Tool (EST) with Navistar® Engine Diagnostics
• Interface cable (RP1210B-compliant, supporting J1939 and J1708)
804 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Test 1
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect Exhaust Gas Recirculation Valve (EGRV).
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4948 to vehicle harness connector and leave EGRV disconnected.
D. Key-On Engine-Off (KOEO).
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 805
Test 2
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect Exhaust Gas Recirculation Valve (EGRV).
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4948 to vehicle harness connector and leave EGRV disconnected.
D. Key-On Engine-Off (KOEO).
Test 3
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect Exhaust Gas Recirculation Valve (EGRV).
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4948 to vehicle harness connector and leave EGRV disconnected.
806 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Test 4
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect Exhaust Gas Recirculation Valve (EGRV).
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4948 to vehicle harness connector and leave EGRV disconnected.
D. Key-On Engine-Off (KOEO).
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 807
Test 5
A. Key-Off.
B. Disconnect Turbocharger 2 Wastegate Control (TC2WC) solenoid connector and leave solenoid disconnected.
C. Disconnect Exhaust Gas Recirculation Valve (EGRV) connector.
D. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4948 to engine harness connector and leave EGRV disconnected.
E. Key-On, Engine-Off (KOEO).
808 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Test 6
A. Key-Off.
B. Disconnect Turbocharger 2 Wastegate Control (TC2WC) solenoid connector and leave solenoid disconnected.
C. Disconnect Exhaust Gas Recirculation Valve (EGRV) connector.
D. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4948 to engine harness connector and leave EGRV disconnected.
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 809
Fault Overview
This fault sets when Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) valve receives a voltage supply of greater than 18 volts
for 5 seconds.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
This is not an EGR valve problem; it is a voltage supply problem.
Fault code may set if vehicle was jump started or charged using a 24-volt power supply.
Step 3 Check for proper operation of battery pack and alternator. Decision
Perform Electrical System Test (page 1577). Yes: Repair or replace failed
components identified by test.
After repairs are complete, retest
for SPN 2791 FMI 3.
Did test identify an electrical system failure? No: End diagnostics. Retest for
SPN 2791 FMI 3.
Fault Overview
This fault sets when Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) valve receives a voltage supply of less than 8 volts for
13 seconds.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
None
See latest version of MaxxForce® DT, 9, and 10 Engine and Aftertreatment Wiring Schematic Form 0000003221
for additional circuit information.
Tools Required
• Breakout Harness ZTSE4948
• Digital Multimeter (DMM)
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 815
Test 1
A. Key-Off.
B. Disconnect Exhaust Gas Recirculation Valve (EGRV) connector.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4948 to vehicle harness, leave EGRV disconnected.
D. Key-On Engine-Running (KOER).
816 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Test 2
A. Key-Off.
B. Disconnect Exhaust Gas Recirculation Valve (EGRV) connector.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4948 to vehicle harness, leave EGRV disconnected.
D. Key-On Engine-Running (KOER).
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 817
Fault Overview
Fault code sets when Engine Control Module (ECM) determines Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) valve is Not
functioning properly when commanded.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
SPN 2791 FMI 2, 3, 4, 8,
and 14 (EGR)
Fault Facts
This fault is also used to detect EGR valve positive and negative deviation faults.
Step 3 Test for proper Exhaust Gas Recirculation Valve (EGRV) operation. Decision
Perform Exhaust Gas Recirculation Valve (EGRV) Operational Test (page 1543). Yes: Replace EGR valve. Notify
supervisor for further action.
Is SPN 2791 FMI 7 Pending or Active in DTC list? No: End Diagnostics. After
repairs are complete, retest for
SPN 2791 FMI 7.
SPN 2791 FMI 8 - EGR valve not receiving ECM PWM signal
Fault Overview
Fault code sets when the Engine Control Module (ECM) detects a failure of the Exhaust Gas Recirculation Valve
Control (EGRV CTL) circuit.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
None
See latest version of MaxxForce® DT, 9, and 10 Engine and Aftertreatment Wiring Schematic Form 0000003221
for additional circuit information.
Tools Required
• Breakout Harness ZTSE4948
• Breakout Harness ZTSE4674
• Digital Multimeter (DMM)
824 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Test 1
A. Key-Off.
B. Disconnect Exhaust Gas Recirculation Valve (EGRV) connector.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4948 to vehicle harness and leave EGRV disconnected.
D. Key-ON Engine-OFF (KOEO).
Test 2
A. Key-Off.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4948 to vehicle harness and leave EGRV disconnected.
D. Key-On Engine-Off (KOEO).
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 825
Test 3
A. Key-Off.
B. Disconnect EGRV connector.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4948 to vehicle harness and leave EGRV disconnected.
D. Key-On Engine-Off (KOEO).
826 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Test 4
A. Key-Off.
B. Disconnect EGRV connector.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4948 to vehicle harness and leave EGRV disconnected.
D. Use DMM set to % duty cycle to measure duty cycle.
E. Key-On Engine-Off (KOEO).
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 827
Test 5
A. Key-Off.
B. Disconnect ACT PWR relay connector.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4674 between vehicle harness and ACT PWR relay.
D. Key-On Engine-Off (KOEO).
Test 6
A. Key-Off.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4674 to vehicle harness and leave ACT PWR relay disconnected.
D. Key-On Engine-Off (KOEO).
828 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Fault Overview
Fault code sets when Engine Control Module (ECM) detects seated Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) valve
position has increased by 2 mm during a single drive cycle.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during one drive cycle.
Associated Fault
None
Fault Facts
Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) valve seat position is recorded during initial Key OFF.
Fault Overview
Fault sets when Engine Control Module (ECM) determines Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) valve is not
functioning properly when initialized.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Fault
SPN 2791 FMI 7 (EGRV)
Fault Facts
None
Step 3 Test for proper Exhaust Gas Recirculation Valve (EGRV) operation. Decision
Perform Exhaust Gas Recirculation Valve (EGRV) Operational Test (page 1543). Yes: Replace EGRV. After repairs
are complete, retest for SPN 2791
FMI 14.
Is SPN 2791 FMI 7 active or pending? No: End Diagnostics. After repairs
are complete, retest for SPN 2791
FMI 14.
Fault Overview
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
None
Step 4 Decision
Test XCS circuits for open, short, or high resistance conditions. Do connector Yes: Go to Step 5.
voltage checks and resistance checks (page 835).
Are XCS circuits within specifications? No: Replace XCS. After repairs
are complete retest for SPN 2796
If voltage checks pass, doing resistance checks is not required.
FMI 2.
834 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Step 5 Decision
A. Key On. Yes: After doing all diagnostic
steps, if SPN 2796 FMI 2 remains,
B. Use DMM, do KOEO voltage check of J1939 signal and ground at
verify each step was completed
Diagnostic Connector.
correctly and proper decisions
were made. Notify supervisor for
further action.
Is voltage within specification (page 1704)? No: Replace J1939 cable. After
repairs are complete retest for
SPN 2796 FMI 2.
Fault Overview
Fault code sets when short circuit is detected on Bank 0 (Injectors 1, 2, and 3) Open coil.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
Fault Facts
It may be necessary to perform the pin point circuit diagnostics tests with the engine at or near normal operating
temperature.
See latest version of MaxxForce® DT, 9 and 10 Engine and Aftertreatment Wiring Schematic Form 0000003221
for additional circuit information.
Step 8 Check Injector 1 Open Coil H Circuit for short to GND. Decision
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 9
B. Reconnect Injector 1 to UVC harness if previously left disconnected
C. Disconnect ECM - Driver 36-pin connector.
D. Use Terminal Test Kit ZTSE4435C, insert proper terminal into ECM -
Driver 36-pin connector pin D-2, leave ECM disconnected.
Step 9 Check Injector 1 Open Coil L Circuit for short to GND. Decision
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 10.
B. Reconnect Injector 1 to UVC harness if previously left disconnected.
C. Disconnect ECM - Driver 36-pin connector.
D. Use Terminal Test Kit ZTSE4435C, insert proper terminal into ECM -
Driver 36-pin connector pin D-1, leave ECM disconnected.
E. Use DMM, measure resistance between ECM - Driver 36-pin connector
pin D-1 and known good GND.
Is resistance greater than 1000 ohms? No: Repair short to GND between
ECM pin D-1 and Injector 1. After
repairs are complete, retest for
SPN 2797 FMI 3.
Step 10 Check for short between Injector 1 Open H and Open L circuits. Decision
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 11.
B. Disconnect ECM - Driver 36-pin connector.
C. Disconnect Injector 1 from UVC harness.
D. Use Terminal Test Kit ZTSE4435C, insert proper terminals into ECM -
Driver 36-pin connector pins D-1 and D-2, leave ECM disconnected.
E. Use DMM, measure resistance between ECM - Driver 36-pin connector
pins D-1 and D-2.
Is resistance greater than 1000 ohms? No: Repair short between INJ1
Open H and INJ1 Open L. After
repairs are complete, retest for
SPN 2797 FMI 3
840 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Step 11 Check Injector 2 Open Coil H Circuit for short to GND. Decision
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 12.
B. Reconnect Injector 2 to UVC harness if previously left disconnected
C. Disconnect ECM - Driver 36-pin connector.
D. Use Terminal Test Kit ZTSE4435C, insert proper terminal into ECM -
Driver 36-pin connector pin D-6, leave ECM disconnected.
Step 12 Check Injector 2 Open Coil L Circuit for short to GND. Decision
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 13.
B. Reconnect Injector 2 to UVC harness if previously left disconnected
C. Disconnect ECM - Driver 36-pin connector.
D. Use Terminal Test Kit ZTSE4435C, insert proper terminal into ECM -
Driver 36-pin connector pin D-5, leave ECM disconnected.
E. Use DMM, measure resistance between ECM - Driver 36-pin connector
pin D-5 and known good GND.
Is resistance greater than 1000 ohms? No: Repair short to GND between
ECM D-5 and Injector 2. After
repairs are complete, retest for
SPN 2797 FMI 3
Step 13 Check for short between Injector 2 Open H and Open L circuits. Decision
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 14.
B. Disconnect ECM - Driver 36-pin connector.
C. Disconnect injector 2 from UVC harness.
D. Use Terminal Test Kit ZTSE4435C, insert proper terminals into ECM -
Driver 36-pin connector pins D-5 and D-6, leave ECM disconnected.
E. Use DMM, measure resistance between ECM - Driver connector pins
D-5 and D-6.
Is resistance greater than 1000 ohms? No: Repair short between INJ2
Open H and INJ2 Open L. After
repairs are complete, retest for
SPN 2797 FMI 3
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 841
Step 14 Check Injector 3 Open Coil H Circuit for short to GND. Decision
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 15
B. Reconnect Injector 3 to UVC harness if previously left disconnected.
C. Disconnect ECM - Driver 36-pin connector.
D. Use Terminal Test Kit ZTSE4435C, insert proper terminal into ECM -
Driver 36-pin connector pin D-4, leave ECM disconnected.
Step 15 Check Injector 3 Open Coil L Circuit for short to GND. Decision
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 16
B. Reconnect Injector 3 to UVC harness if previously left disconnected.
C. Disconnect ECM - Driver 36-pin connector.
D. Use Terminal Test Kit ZTSE4435C, insert proper terminal into ECM -
Driver 36-pin connector pin D-3, leave ECM disconnected.
E. Use DMM, measure resistance between ECM - Driver 36-pin connector
pin D-3 and known good GND.
Is resistance greater than 1000 ohms? No: Repair short to GND between
ECM D-3 and Injector 3. After
repairs are complete, retest for
SPN 2797 FMI 3
Step 16 Check for short between Injector 3 Open H and Open L circuits. Decision
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 17
B. Disconnect ECM - Driver 36-pin connector.
C. Disconnect injector 3 from UVC harness.
D. Use Terminal Test Kit ZTSE4435C, insert proper terminals into ECM -
Driver 36-pin connector pins D-3 and D-4, leave ECM disconnected.
E. Use DMM, measure resistance between ECM - Driver 36-pin connector
pins D-3 and D-4.
Is resistance greater than 1000 ohms? No: Repair short between INJ3
Open H and INJ3 Open L. After
repairs are complete, retest for
SPN 2797 FMI 3
842 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Fault Overview
Fault code sets when short circuit is detected on Bank 1 (Injectors 1, 2, and 3) Close coil.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
Fault Facts
It may be necessary to perform the pin point circuit diagnostics tests with the engine at or near normal operating
temperature.
See latest version of MaxxForce® DT, 9 and 10 Engine and Aftertreatment Wiring Schematic Form 0000003221
for additional circuit information.
Step 6 Check Injector 1 Closed Coil H Circuit for short to GND. Decision
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 7.
Step 7 Check Injector 1 Closed Coil L Circuit for short to GND. Decision
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 8.
Step 8 Check for short between Injector 1 Closed H and Closed L circuits. Decision
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 9.
B. Disconnect ECM - Driver 36-pin connector.
C. Disconnect injector 1 from UVC harness.
D. Use Terminal Test Kit ZTSE4435C, insert proper terminals into ECM -
Driver 36-pin connector pins D-7 and D-8, leave ECM disconnected.
Step 9 Check Injector 2 Closed Coil H Circuit for short to GND. Decision
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 10.
B. Reconnect Injector 2 to UVC harness if previously left disconnected
C. Disconnect ECM - Driver 36-pin connector.
D. Use Terminal Test Kit ZTSE4435C, insert proper terminal into ECM -
Driver 36-pin connector pin D-12, leave ECM disconnected.
E. Use DMM, measure resistance between ECM - Driver 36-pin connector
pin D-12 and known good GND.
Is resistance greater than 1000 ohms? No: Repair short to GND between
ECM D-12 and Injector 2. After
repairs are complete, retest for
SPN 2797 FMI 4
Step 10 Check Injector 2 Closed Coil L Circuit for short to GND. Decision
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 11.
B. Reconnect Injector 2 to UVC harness if previously left disconnected
C. Disconnect ECM - Driver 36-pin connector.
D. Use Terminal Test Kit ZTSE4435C, insert proper terminal into ECM -
Driver 36-pin connector pin D-11, leave ECM disconnected.
E. Use DMM, measure resistance between ECM - Driver 36-pin connector
pin D-11 and known good GND.
Is resistance greater than 1000 ohms? No: Repair short to GND between
ECM D-11 and Injector 2. After
repairs are complete, retest for
SPN 2797 FMI 4
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 847
Step 12 Check Injector 3 Closed Coil H Circuit for short to GND. Decision
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 13.
B. Reconnect Injector 3 to UVC harness if previously left disconnected.
C. Disconnect ECM - Driver 36-pin connector.
D. Use Terminal Test Kit ZTSE4435C, insert proper terminal into ECM -
Driver 36-pin connector pin D-10, leave ECM disconnected.
E. Use DMM, measure resistance between ECM - Driver 36-pin connector
pin D-10 and known good GND.
Is resistance greater than 1000 ohms? No: Repair short to GND between
ECM D-10 and Injector 3. After
repairs are complete, retest for
SPN 2797 FMI 4.
Step 13 Check Injector 3 Closed Coil L Circuit for short to GND. Decision
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 14.
B. Reconnect Injector 3 to UVC harness if previously left disconnected.
C. Disconnect ECM - Driver 36-pin connector.
D. Use Terminal Test Kit ZTSE4435C, insert proper terminal into ECM - Driver
36-pin connector pin D-9, leave ECM disconnected.
E. Use DMM, measure resistance between ECM - Driver 36-pin connector
pin D-9 and known good GND.
Is resistance greater than 1000 ohms? No: Repair short to GND between
ECM D-9 and Injector 3. After
repairs are complete, retest for
SPN 2797 FMI 4.
848 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Step 14 Check for short between Injector 3 Closed H and Closed L circuits. Decision
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 15.
B. Disconnect ECM - Driver 36-pin connector.
C. Disconnect injector 3 from UVC harness.
D. Use Terminal Test Kit ZTSE4435C, insert proper terminals into ECM -
Driver 36-pin connector pins D-9 and D-10, leave ECM disconnected.
Fault Overview
Fault code sets when short circuit is detected on Bank 0 (Injectors 1, 2, and 3) Open or Close coil.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
Fault Facts
It may be necessary to perform the pin point circuit diagnostics tests with the engine at or near normal operating
temperature.
850 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
See latest version of MaxxForce® DT, 9 and 10 Engine and Aftertreatment Wiring Schematic Form 0000003221
for additional circuit information.
Step 11 Check Injector 1 Open Coil H Circuit for short to GND. Decision
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 12.
B. Reconnect Injector 1 to UVC harness if previously left disconnected
C. Disconnect ECM - Driver 36-pin connector.
D. Use Terminal Test Kit ZTSE4435C, insert proper terminal into ECM -
Driver 36-pin connector pin D-2, leave ECM disconnected.
Step 12 Check Injector 1 Open Coil L Circuit for short to GND Decision
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 13.
B. Reconnect Injector 1 to UVC harness if previously left disconnected.
C. Disconnect ECM - Driver 36-pin connector.
D. Use Terminal Test Kit ZTSE4435C, insert proper terminal into ECM -
Driver 36-pin connector pin D-1, leave ECM disconnected.
E. Use DMM, measure resistance between ECM - Driver 36-pin connector
pin D-1 and known good GND.
Is resistance greater than 1000 ohms? No: Repair short to GND between
ECM D-1 and Injector 1. After
repairs are complete, retest for
SPN 2797 FMI 6.
Step 13 Check Injector 1 Closed Coil H Circuit for short to GND. Decision
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 14.
B. Reconnect Injector 1 to UVC harness if previously left disconnected.
C. Disconnect ECM - Driver 36-pin connector.
D. Use Terminal Test Kit ZTSE4435C, insert proper terminal into ECM -
Driver 36-pin connector pin D-8, leave ECM disconnected.
E. Use DMM measure resistance between ECM - Driver 36-pin connector pin
D-8 and known good GND.
Is resistance greater than 1000 ohms? No: Repair short to GND between
ECM D-8 and Injector 1. After
repairs are complete, retest for
SPN 2797 FMI 6.
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 855
Step 14 Check Injector 1 Closed Coil L Circuit for short to GND. Decision
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 15.
B. Reconnect Injector 1 to UVC harness if previously left disconnected.
C. Disconnect ECM - Driver 36-pin connector.
D. Use Terminal Test Kit ZTSE4435C, insert proper terminal into ECM -
Driver 36-pin connector pin D-7, leave ECM disconnected.
Step 15 Check for short between Injector 1 Open H and Open L circuits. Decision
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 16.
B. Disconnect ECM - Driver 36-pin connector.
C. Disconnect injector 1 from UVC harness.
D. Use Terminal Test Kit ZTSE4435C, insert proper terminals into ECM -
Driver 36-pin connector pins D-1 and D-2, leave ECM disconnected.
E. Use DMM, measure resistance between ECM - Driver 36-pin connector
pins D-1 and D-2.
Is resistance greater than 1000 ohms? No: Repair short between INJ1
Open H and INJ1 Open L. After
repairs are complete, retest for
SPN 2797 FMI 6.
Step 16 Check for short between Injector 1 Closed H and Closed L circuits. Decision
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 17.
B. Disconnect ECM - Driver 36-pin connector.
C. Disconnect injector 1 from UVC harness.
D. Use Terminal Test Kit ZTSE4435C, insert proper terminals into ECM -
Driver 36-pin connector pins D-7 and D-8, leave ECM disconnected.
E. Use DMM measure resistance between ECM - Driver 36-pin connector
pins D-7 and D-8.
Is resistance greater than 1000 ohms? No: Repair short between INJ1
Close H and INJ1 Close L. After
repairs are complete, retest for
SPN 2797 FMI 6.
856 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Step 17 Check Injector 2 Open Coil H Circuit for short to GND. Decision
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 18.
B. Reconnect Injector 2 to UVC harness if previously left disconnected
C. Disconnect ECM - Driver 36-pin connector.
D. Use Terminal Test Kit ZTSE4435C, insert proper terminal into ECM -
Driver 36-pin connector pin D-6, leave ECM disconnected.
Step 18 Check Injector 2 Open Coil L Circuit for short to GND. Decision
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 19.
B. Reconnect Injector 2 to UVC harness if previously left disconnected
C. Disconnect ECM - Driver 36-pin connector.
D. Use Terminal Test Kit ZTSE4435C, insert proper terminal into ECM -
Driver 36-pin connector pin D-5, leave ECM disconnected.
E. Use DMM, measure resistance between ECM - Driver 36-pin connector
pin D-5 and known good GND.
Is resistance greater than 1000 ohms? Repair short to GND between
ECM D-5 and Injector 2. After
repairs are complete, retest for
SPN 2797 FMI 6.
Step 19 Check Injector 2 Closed Coil H Circuit for short to GND. Decision
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 20.
B. Reconnect Injector 2 to UVC harness if previously left disconnected
C. Disconnect ECM - Driver 36-pin connector.
D. Use Terminal Test Kit ZTSE4435C, insert proper terminal into ECM -
Driver 36-pin connector pin D-12, leave ECM disconnected.
E. Use DMM, measure resistance between ECM - Driver 36-pin connector
pin D-12 and known good GND.
Is resistance greater than 1000 ohms? No: Repair short to GND between
ECM D-12 and Injector 2. After
repairs are complete, retest for
SPN 2797 FMI 6.
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 857
Step 20 Check Injector 2 Closed Coil L Circuit for short to GND. Decision
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 21.
B. Reconnect Injector 2 to UVC harness if previously left disconnected
C. Disconnect ECM - Driver 36-pin connector.
D. Use Terminal Test Kit ZTSE4435C, insert proper terminal into ECM -
Driver 36-pin connector pin D-11, leave ECM disconnected.
Step 21 Check for short between Injector 2 Open H and Open L circuits. Decision
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 22.
B. Disconnect ECM - Driver 36-pin connector.
C. Disconnect injector 2 from UVC harness.
D. Use Terminal Test Kit ZTSE4435C, insert proper terminals into ECM -
Driver 36-pin connector pins D-5 and D-6, leave ECM disconnected.
E. Use DMM, measure resistance between ECM - Driver connector pins
D-5 and D-6.
Is resistance greater than 1000 ohms? No: Repair short between INJ2
Open H and INJ2 Open L. After
repairs are complete, retest for
SPN 2797 FMI 6.
Step 22 Check for a short between Fuel Injector 2 Closed H and Closed L Decision
circuits.
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 23.
Step 23 Check Injector 3 Open Coil H Circuit for short to GND. Decision
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 24.
B. Reconnect Injector 3 to UVC harness if previously left disconnected.
C. Disconnect ECM - Driver 36-pin connector.
D. Use Terminal Test Kit ZTSE4435C, insert proper terminal into ECM -
Driver 36-pin connector pin D-4, leave ECM disconnected.
Step 24 Check Injector 3 Open Coil L Circuit for short to GND. Decision
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 25.
B. Reconnect Injector 3 to UVC harness if previously left disconnected.
C. Disconnect ECM - Driver 36-pin connector.
D. Use Terminal Test Kit ZTSE4435C, insert proper terminal into ECM -
Driver 36-pin connector pin D-3, leave ECM disconnected.
E. Use DMM, measure resistance between ECM - Driver 36-pin connector
pin D-3 and known good GND.
Is resistance greater than 1000 ohms? No: Repair short to GND between
ECM D-3 and Injector 3. After
repairs are complete, retest for
SPN 2797 FMI 6.
Step 25 Check Injector 3 Closed Coil H Circuit for short to GND. Decision
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 26.
B. Reconnect Injector 3 to UVC harness if previously left disconnected.
C. Disconnect ECM - Driver 36-pin connector.
D. Use Terminal Test Kit ZTSE4435C, insert proper terminal into ECM -
Driver 36-pin connector pin D-10, leave ECM disconnected.
E. Use DMM, measure resistance between ECM - Driver 36-pin connector
pin D-10 and known good GND.
Is resistance greater than 1000 ohms? No: Repair short to GND between
ECM D-10 and Injector 3. After
repairs are complete, retest for
SPN 2797 FMI 6.
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 859
Step 26 Check Injector 3 Closed Coil L Circuit for short to GND. Decision
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 27.
B. Reconnect Injector 3 to UVC harness if previously left disconnected.
C. Disconnect ECM - Driver 36-pin connector.
D. Use Terminal Test Kit ZTSE4435C, insert proper terminal into ECM - Driver
36-pin connector pin D-9, leave ECM disconnected.
Step 27 Check for short between Injector 3 Open H and Open L circuits. Decision
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 28.
B. Disconnect ECM - Driver 36-pin connector.
C. Disconnect injector 3 from UVC harness.
D. Use Terminal Test Kit ZTSE4435C, insert proper terminals into ECM -
Driver 36-pin connector pins D-3 and D-4, leave ECM disconnected.
E. Use DMM, measure resistance between ECM - Driver 36-pin connector
pins D-3 and D-4.
Is resistance greater than 1000 ohms? No: Repair short between INJ3
Open H and INJ3 Open L. After
repairs are complete, retest for
SPN 2797 FMI 6.
Step 28 Check for short between Injector 3 Closed H and Closed L circuits. Decision
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 29.
B. Disconnect ECM - Driver 36-pin connector.
C. Disconnect injector 3 from UVC harness.
D. Use Terminal Test Kit ZTSE4435C, insert proper terminals into ECM -
Driver 36-pin connector pins D-9 and D-10, leave ECM disconnected.
E. Use DMM, measure resistance between ECM - Driver 36-pin connector
pins D-9 and D-10.
Is resistance greater than 1000 ohms? No: Repair short between INJ3
Close H and INJ3 Close L. After
repairs are complete, retest for
SPN 2797 FMI 6.
860 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Fault Overview
Fault code sets when short circuit is detected on Bank 1 (Injectors 4, 5, and 6) Open coil.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
Fault Facts
It may be necessary to perform the pin point circuit diagnostics tests with the engine at or near normal operating
temperature.
Step 8 Check Injector 4 Open Coil H circuit for short to GND. Decision
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 9.
Step 9 Check Injector 4 Open Coil L circuit for short to GND. Decision
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 10.
Step 10 Check for short between Injector 4 Open H and Open L circuits. Decision
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 11.
B. Disconnect ECM - Driver 36-pin connector.
C. Disconnect injector 4 from UVC harness.
D. Use Terminal Test Kit ZTSE4435C, insert proper terminal into ECM - Driver
36-pin connector pins D-29 and D-30, leave ECM disconnected.
Step 11 Check Injector 5 Open Coil H circuit for short to GND. Decision
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 12.
B. Reconnect Injector 5 to UVC harness if previously left disconnected.
C. Disconnect ECM - Driver 36-pin connector.
D. Use Terminal Test Kit ZTSE4435C, insert proper terminal into ECM - Driver
36-pin connector pin D-26, leave ECM disconnected.
E. Use DMM, measure resistance between ECM - Driver 36-pin connector
pin D-26 and known good GND.
Is resistance greater than 1000 ohms? No: Repair short to GND between
ECM D-26 and Injector 5. After
repairs are complete, retest for
SPN 2798 FMI 3.
Step 12 Check Injector 5 Open Coil L circuit for short to GND. Decision
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 13.
B. Reconnect Injector 5 to UVC harness if previously left disconnected.
C. Disconnect ECM - Driver 36-pin connector.
D. Use Terminal Test Kit ZTSE4435C, insert proper terminal into ECM -
Driver 36-pin connector pin D-25, leave ECM disconnected.
E. Use DMM, measure resistance between ECM - Driver 36-pin connector
pin D-25 and known good GND.
Is resistance greater than 1000 ohms? No: Repair short to GND between
ECM D-25 and Injector 5. After
repairs are complete, retest for
SPN 2798 FMI 3.
866 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Step 13 Check for short between Injector 5 Open H and Open L circuits. Decision
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 14.
B. Disconnect ECM - Driver 36-pin connector.
C. Disconnect injector 5 from UVC harness.
D. Use Terminal Test Kit ZTSE4435C, insert proper terminal into ECM - Driver
36-pin connector pins D-25 and D-26, leave ECM disconnected.
Step 14 Check Injector 6 Open Coil H circuit for short to GND. Decision
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 15.
B. Reconnect Injector 6 to UVC harness if previously left disconnected.
C. Disconnect ECM - Driver 36-pin connector.
D. Use Terminal Test Kit ZTSE4435C, insert proper terminal into ECM - Driver
36-pin connector pin D-28, leave ECM disconnected.
E. Use DMM, measure resistance between ECM - Driver 36-pin connector pin
D-28 and known good GND.
Is resistance greater than 1000 ohms? No: Repair short to GND between
ECM D-28 and Injector 6. After
repairs are complete, retest for
SPN 2798 FMI 3.
Step 15 Check Injector 6 Open Coil L circuit for short to GND. Decision
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 16.
B. Reconnect Injector 6 to UVC harness if previously left disconnected.
C. Disconnect ECM - Driver 36-pin connector.
D. Use Terminal Test Kit ZTSE4435C, insert proper terminal into ECM - Driver
36-pin connector pin D-27, leave ECM disconnected.
E. Use DMM, measure resistance between ECM - Driver 36-pin connector
pin D-27 and known good GND.
Is resistance greater than 1000 ohms? No: Repair short to GND between
ECM D-27 and Injector 6. After
repairs are complete, retest for
SPN 2798 FMI 3.
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 867
Step 16 Check for short between Injector 6 Open H and Open L circuits. Decision
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 17.
B. Disconnect ECM - Driver 36-pin connector.
C. Disconnect injector 6 from UVC harness.
D. Use Terminal Test Kit ZTSE4435C, insert proper terminal into ECM - Driver
36-pin connector pins D-27 and D-28, leave ECM disconnected.
Fault Overview
Fault code sets when short circuit is detected on Bank 2 (Injectors 4, 5, and 6) Close coil.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
Fault Facts
It may be necessary to perform the pin point circuit diagnostics tests with the engine at or near normal operating
temperature.
See latest version of MaxxForce® DT, 9 and 10 Engine and Aftertreatment Wiring Schematic Form 0000003221
for additional circuit information.
Step 6 Check Injector 4 Closed Coil H circuit for short to GND. Decision
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 7.
Step 7 Check Injector 4 Closed Coil L circuit for short to GND. Decision
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 8.
Step 8 Check for short between Injector 4 Closed H and Closed L circuits. Decision
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 9.
B. Disconnect ECM - Driver 36-pin connector.
C. Disconnect injector 4 from UVC harness.
D. Use Terminal Test Kit ZTSE4435C, insert proper terminal into ECM -
Driver 36-pin connector pins D-35 and D-36, leave ECM disconnected.
Step 9 Check Injector 5 Closed Coil H circuit for short to GND. Decision
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 10.
B. Reconnect Injector 5 to UVC harness if previously left disconnected.
C. Disconnect ECM - Driver 36-pin connector.
D. Use Terminal Test Kit ZTSE4435C, insert proper terminal into ECM -
Driver 36-pin connector pin D-32, leave ECM disconnected.
E. Use DMM, measure resistance between ECM - Driver 36-pin connector
pin D-32 and known good GND.
Is resistance greater than 1000 ohms? No: Repair short to GND between
ECM D-32 and Injector 5. After
repairs are complete, retest for
SPN 2798 FMI 4.
Step 10 Check Injector 5 Closed Coil L circuit for short to GND. Decision
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 11.
B. Reconnect Injector 5 to UVC harness if previously left disconnected.
C. Disconnect ECM - Driver 36-pin connector.
D. Use Terminal Test Kit ZTSE4435C, insert proper terminal into ECM -
Driver 36-pin connector pin D-31, leave ECM disconnected.
E. Use DMM, measure resistance between ECM - Driver 36-pin connector
pin D-31 and known good GND.
Is resistance greater than 1000 ohms? No: Repair short to GND between
ECM D-31 and Injector 5. After
repairs are complete, retest for
SPN 2798 FMI 4.
872 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Step 11 Check for short between Injector 5 Closed H and Closed L circuits. Decision
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 12.
B. Disconnect ECM - Driver 36-pin connector.
C. Disconnect injector 5 from UVC harness.
D. Use Terminal Test Kit ZTSE4435C, insert proper terminal into ECM - Driver
36-pin connector pins D-31 and D-32, leave ECM disconnected.
Step 12 Check Injector 6 Closed Coil H circuit for short to GND. Decision
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 13.
B. Reconnect Injector 6 to UVC harness if previously left disconnected.
C. Disconnect ECM - Driver 36-pin connector.
D. Use Terminal Test Kit ZTSE4435C, insert proper terminal into ECM - Driver
36-pin connector pin D-34, leave ECM disconnected.
E. Use DMM, measure resistance between ECM - Driver 36-pin connector
pin D-34 and known good GND.
Is resistance greater than 1000 ohms? No: Repair short to GND between
ECM D-34 and Injector 6. After
repairs are complete, retest for
SPN 2798 FMI 4.
Step 13 Check Injector 6 Closed Coil L circuit for short to GND. Decision
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 14.
B. Reconnect Injector 6 to UVC harness if previously left disconnected.
C. Disconnect ECM - Driver 36-pin connector.
D. Use Terminal Test Kit ZTSE4435C, insert proper terminal into ECM - Driver
36-pin connector pin D-33, leave ECM disconnected.
E. Use DMM, measure resistance between ECM - Driver 36-pin connector
pin D-33 and known good GND.
Is resistance greater than 1000 ohms? No: Repair short to GND between
ECM D-33 and Injector 6. After
repairs are complete, retest for
SPN 2798 FMI 4.
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 873
Step 14 Check for short between Injector 6 Closed H and Closed L circuits. Decision
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 15.
B. Disconnect ECM - Driver 36-pin connector.
C. Disconnect injector 6 from UVC harness.
D. Use Terminal Test Kit ZTSE4435C, insert proper terminal into ECM - Driver
36-pin connector pins D-33 and D-34, leave ECM disconnected.
Fault Overview
Fault code sets when short circuit is detected on Bank 1 (Injectors 4, 5, and 6) Open or Close coil.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
Fault Facts
It may be necessary to perform the pin point circuit diagnostics tests with the engine at or near normal operating
temperature.
See latest version of MaxxForce® DT, 9 and 10 Engine and Aftertreatment Wiring Schematic Form 0000003221
for additional circuit information.
Step 11 Check Injector 4 Open Coil H circuit for short to GND. Decision
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 12.
B. Reconnect Injector 4 to UVC harness if previously left disconnected.
C. Disconnect ECM - Driver 36-pin connector.
D. Use Terminal Test Kit ZTSE4435C, insert proper terminal into ECM - Driver
36-pin connector pin D-30, leave ECM disconnected.
Step 12 Check Injector 4 Open Coil L circuit for short to GND. Decision
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 13.
B. Reconnect Injector 4 to UVC harness if previously left disconnected.
C. Disconnect ECM - Driver 36-pin connector.
D. Use Terminal Test Kit ZTSE4435C, insert proper terminal into ECM -
Driver 36-pin connector pin D-29, leave ECM disconnected.
E. Use DMM, measure resistance between ECM - Driver 36-pin connector
pin D-29 and known good GND.
Is resistance greater than 1000 ohms? No: Repair short to GND between
ECM D-29 and Injector 4. After
repairs are complete, retest for
SPN 2798 FMI 6.
Step 13 Check Injector 4 Closed Coil H circuit for short to GND. Decision
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 14.
B. Reconnect Injector 4 to UVC harness if previously left disconnected.
C. Disconnect ECM - Driver 36-pin connector.
D. Use Terminal Test Kit ZTSE4435C, insert proper terminal into ECM - Driver
36-pin connector pin D-36, leave ECM disconnected.
E. Use DMM, measure resistance between ECM - Driver 36-pin connector
pin D-36 and known good GND.
Is resistance greater than 1000 ohms? No: Repair short to GND between
ECM D-36 and Injector 4. After
repairs are complete, retest for
SPN 2798 FMI 6.
880 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Step 14 Check Injector 4 Closed Coil L circuit for short to GND. Decision
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 15.
B. Reconnect Injector 4 to UVC harness if previously left disconnected.
C. Disconnect ECM - Driver 36-pin connector.
D. Use Terminal Test Kit ZTSE4435C, insert proper terminal into ECM - Driver
36-pin connector pin D-35, leave ECM disconnected.
Step 15 Check for short between Injector 4 Open H and Open L circuits. Decision
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 16.
B. Disconnect ECM - Driver 36-pin connector.
C. Disconnect Injector 4 from UVC harness.
D. Use Terminal Test Kit ZTSE4435C, insert proper terminal into ECM - Driver
36-pin connector pins D-29 and D-30, leave ECM disconnected.
E. Use DMM, measure resistance between ECM - Driver 36-pin connector
pins D-29 and D-30.
Is resistance greater than 1000 ohms? No: Repair short between INJ4
Open H and INJ4 Open L. After
repairs are complete, retest for
SPN 2798 FMI 6.
Step 16 Check for short between Injector 4 Closed H and Closed L circuits. Decision
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 17.
B. Disconnect ECM - Driver 36-pin connector.
C. Disconnect Injector 4 from UVC harness.
D. Use Terminal Test Kit ZTSE4435C, insert proper terminal into ECM -
Driver 36-pin connector pins D-35 and D-36, leave ECM disconnected.
E. Use DMM, measure resistance between ECM - Driver 36-pin connector
pins D-35 and D-36.
Is resistance greater than 1000 ohms? No: Repair short between INJ4
Close H and INJ4 Close L. After
repairs are complete, retest for
SPN 2798 FMI 6.
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 881
Step 17 Check Injector 5 Open Coil H circuit for short to GND. Decision
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 18.
B. Reconnect Injector 5 to UVC harness if previously left disconnected.
C. Disconnect ECM - Driver 36-pin connector.
D. Use Terminal Test Kit ZTSE4435C, insert proper terminal into ECM - Driver
36-pin connector pin D-26, leave ECM disconnected.
Step 18 Check Injector 5 Open Coil L circuit for short to GND. Decision
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 19.
B. Reconnect Injector 5 to UVC harness if previously left disconnected.
C. Disconnect ECM - Driver 36-pin connector.
D. Use Terminal Test Kit ZTSE4435C, insert proper terminal into ECM -
Driver 36-pin connector pin D-25, leave ECM disconnected.
E. Use DMM, measure resistance between ECM - Driver 36-pin connector
pin D-25 and known good GND.
Is resistance greater than 1000 ohms? No: Repair short to GND between
ECM D-25 and Injector 5. After
repairs are complete, retest for
SPN 2798 FMI 6.
Step 19 Check Injector 5 Closed Coil H circuit for short to GND. Decision
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 20.
B. Reconnect Injector 5 to UVC harness if previously left disconnected.
C. Disconnect ECM - Driver 36-pin connector.
D. Use Terminal Test Kit ZTSE4435C, insert proper terminal into ECM -
Driver 36-pin connector pin D-32, leave ECM disconnected.
E. Use DMM, measure resistance between ECM - Driver 36-pin connector
pin D-32 and known good GND.
Is resistance greater than 1000 ohms? No: Repair short to GND between
ECM D-32 and Injector 5. After
repairs are complete, retest for
SPN 2798 FMI 6.
882 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Step 20 Check Injector 5 Closed Coil L circuit for short to GND. Decision
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 21.
B. Reconnect Injector 5 to UVC harness if previously left disconnected.
C. Disconnect ECM - Driver 36-pin connector.
D. Use Terminal Test Kit ZTSE4435C, insert proper terminal into ECM -
Driver 36-pin connector pin D-31, leave ECM disconnected.
Step 21 Check for short between Injector 5 Open H and Open L circuits. Decision
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 22.
B. Disconnect ECM - Driver 36-pin connector.
C. Disconnect Injector 5 from UVC harness.
D. Use Terminal Test Kit ZTSE4435C, insert proper terminal into ECM - Driver
36-pin connector pins D-25 and D-26, leave ECM disconnected.
E. Use DMM, measure resistance between ECM - Driver 36-pin connector
pins D-25 and D-26.
Is resistance greater than 1000 ohms? No: Repair short between INJ5
Open H and INJ5 Open L. After
repairs are complete, retest for
SPN 2798 FMI 6.
Step 22 Check for short between Injector 5 Closed H and Closed L circuits. Decision
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 23.
B. Disconnect ECM - Driver 36-pin connector.
C. Disconnect Injector 5 from UVC harness.
D. Use Terminal Test Kit ZTSE4435C, insert proper terminal into ECM - Driver
36-pin connector pins D-31 and D-32, leave ECM disconnected.
E. Use DMM, measure resistance between ECM - Driver 36-pin connector
pins D-31 and D-32.
Is resistance greater than 1000 ohms? No: Repair short between INJ5
Close H and INJ5 Close L. After
repairs are complete, retest for
SPN 2798 FMI 6.
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 883
Step 23 Check Injector 6 Open Coil H circuit for short to GND. Decision
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 24.
B. Reconnect Injector 6 to UVC harness if previously left disconnected.
C. Disconnect ECM - Driver 36-pin connector.
D. Use Terminal Test Kit ZTSE4435C, insert proper terminal into ECM - Driver
36-pin connector pin D-28, leave ECM disconnected.
E. Use DMM, measure resistance between ECM - Driver 36-pin connector pin
D-28 and known good GND.
Is resistance greater than 1000 ohms? No: Repair short to GND between
ECM D-28 and Injector 6. After
repairs are complete, retest for
SPN 2798 FMI 6.
Step 24 Check Injector 6 Open Coil L circuit for short to GND. Decision
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 25.
B. Reconnect Injector 6 to UVC harness if previously left disconnected.
C. Disconnect ECM - Driver 36-pin connector.
D. Use Terminal Test Kit ZTSE4435C, insert proper terminal into ECM - Driver
36-pin connector pin D-27, leave ECM disconnected.
E. Use DMM, measure resistance between ECM - Driver 36-pin connector
pin D-27 and known good GND.
Is resistance greater than 1000 ohms? No: Repair short to GND between
ECM D-27 and Injector 6. After
repairs are complete, retest for
SPN 2798 FMI 6.
Step 25 Check Injector 6 Closed Coil H circuit for short to GND. Decision
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 26.
B. Reconnect Injector 6 to UVC harness if previously left disconnected.
C. Disconnect ECM - Driver 36-pin connector.
D. Use Terminal Test Kit ZTSE4435C, insert proper terminal into ECM - Driver
36-pin connector pin D-34, leave ECM disconnected.
E. Use DMM, measure resistance between ECM - Driver 36-pin connector
pin D-34 and known good GND.
Is resistance greater than 1000 ohms? No: Repair short to GND between
ECM D-34 and Injector 6. After
repairs are complete, retest for
SPN 2798 FMI 6.
884 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Step 26 Check Injector 6 Closed Coil L circuit for short to GND. Decision
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 27.
B. Reconnect Injector 6 to UVC harness if previously left disconnected.
C. Disconnect ECM - Driver 36-pin connector.
D. Use Terminal Test Kit ZTSE4435C, insert proper terminal into ECM - Driver
36-pin connector pin D-33, leave ECM disconnected.
Step 27 Check for short between Injector 6 Open H and Open L circuits. Decision
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 28.
B. Disconnect ECM - Driver 36-pin connector.
C. Disconnect Injector 6 from UVC harness.
D. Use Terminal Test Kit ZTSE4435C, insert proper terminal into ECM - Driver
36-pin connector pins D-27 and D-28, leave ECM disconnected.
E. Use DMM, measure resistance between ECM - Driver 36-pin connector
pins D-27 and D-28.
Is resistance greater than 1000 ohms? No: Repair short between INJ6
Open H and INJ6 Open L. After
repairs are complete, retest for
SPN 2798 FMI 6.
Step 28 Check for short between Injector 6 Closed H and Closed L circuits. Decision
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 29.
B. Disconnect ECM - Driver 36-pin connector.
C. Disconnect Injector 6 from UVC harness.
D. Use Terminal Test Kit ZTSE4435C, insert proper terminal into ECM - Driver
36-pin connector pins D-33 and D-34, leave ECM disconnected.
E. Use DMM, measure resistance between ECM - Driver 36-pin connector
pins D-33 and D-34.
Is resistance greater than 1000 ohms? No: Repair short between INJ6
Close H and INJ6 Close L. After
repairs are complete, retest for
SPN 2798 FMI 6.
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 885
Fault Overview
Fault code sets when fuel system Injection Pressure Control Valve adaptation value exceeds threshold values
immediately.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive trips.
Associated Faults
SPN 164 FMI 3 and 4, and SPN 679 FMI 3 and 4
Fault Facts
Do not replace Injection Control Pressure (ICP) sensor unless directed by diagnostic procedure. This fault can
set if a high-pressure oil system repair was completed and "Fuel Pressure Adaptation Reset" procedure was not
performed.
Possible Causes
• Fuel Pressure Adaptation Reset procedure not performed after high-pressure oil system repairs
• High-pressure oil system repair is necessary
• Oil level and quality
• ICP system leak
• IPR sensor or circuit fault
• IPR valve sticking or stuck
• Oil additive package worn out, foaming (overfilled)
• High pressure oil pump worn out or leaking
• High pressure oil leakage
• Injector static leakage
• Injector Oil Inlet Adapter (Puck) Assembly leakage
• Engine brake control valve leakage
Step 4 Inspect High-Pressure Oil Pump (HPOP) reservoir to ensure there is enough Decision
fluid.
Check that reservoir has oil in it. Remove Engine Oil Temperature (EOT) Yes: Reinstall EOT sensor
sensor for observation. and then go to Step 5.
Step 5 Check High-Pressure Oil Pump (HPOP) Injection Pressure Regulator (IPR) Decision
electrical circuit.
Inspect IPR valve electrical circuit by connecting Cylinder Performance Analyzer Yes: Diagnose / repair
(CPA) tool(page 1402) to engine and perform CPA HPOP test(page 1440). electrical circuit for IPR
valve. After repairs are
complete, retest for SPN
Is there a detected issue with IPR valve electrical circuit?
3055 FMI 2.
No: Go to Step 6.
888 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Step 6 Mechanically test Injection Pressure Regulator (IPR) valve hydraulic circuit. Decision
Hydraulically block off IPR return path by connecting Cylinder Performance Yes: Replace IPR valve,
Analyzer (CPA) tool(page 1402) to engine and use IPR Plug Tester(Figure 754) then perform Fuel Pressure
to bring IPR valve hydraulic circuit under maximum pressure. Adaptation Reset(page
1341). After repairs are
complete, retest for SPN
Is there a detected issue with IPR valve hydraulic circuit?
3055 FMI 2.
No: Go to Step 7.
Step 7 Perform dead head test of High-Pressure Oil Pump (HPOP). Decision
Connect Cylinder Performance Analyzer (CPA) tool(page 1402) to engine and Yes: Go to Step 8.
use Pressure Adapter Fitting and ICP Test Kit(Figure 752) isolating hydraulic
system from HPOP to determine if it develops pressure when pump is dead
headed.
Fault Overview
Fault code sets when Aftertreatment Control Module (ACM) detects a difference between Diesel Particulate
Filter Intake Temperature (DPFIT) sensor and Diesel Particulate Filter Outlet Temperature (DPFOT) or Diesel
Oxidation Catalyst Inlet Temperature (DOCIT) sensor readings do not match expected values for engine
operating conditions.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
Fault Facts
None
Fault Overview
Diesel Particulate Filter Inlet Temperature (DPFIT) signal is higher then the expected range.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
None
Step 2 Inspect Diesel Particulate Filter Intake Temperature (DPFIT) sensor Decision
and connector.
A. Key OFF. Yes: Go to Step 3
B. Disconnect DPFIT sensor.
Fault Overview
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
None
Step 2 Inspect Diesel Particulate Filter Intake Temperature (DPFIT) sensor Decision
and connector.
A. Key OFF. Yes: Go to Step 3
B. Disconnect DPFIT sensor.
C. Check DPFIT sensor and connector terminals for: damaged or pinched
wires; wet or corroded terminals; loose, bent, or broken pins; or broken
connector housing.
Are DPFIT sensor connector, harness, and terminals clean and undamaged? No: Repair connector, harness,
or terminal damage. After repairs
are complete, retest for SPN 3242
FMI 4.
Test 1
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect Diesel Particulate Filter Intake Temperature (DPFIT) sensor.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4760A to DPFIT harness connector and leave DPFIT sensor disconnected.
D. Key ON Engine OFF (KOEO).
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 897
Fault Overview
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
None
WARNING:
To prevent personal injury or death, stay clear of rotating parts (belts and fan) and hot
engine surfaces.
1. Use EST with NNavistar® Engine Diagnostics, open Continuous Monitor Session.
2. Monitor sensor voltage. Verify an active code for sensor.
• If code is inactive, monitor signal while wiggling connector and all wires at suspected locations. If circuit
is interrupted, signal will spike and code will go active.
• If code is active, proceed to next Step.
3. Disconnect chassis harness from sensor.
NOTE: Inspect connectors for damaged pins, corrosion, or loose pins. Repair if necessary.
4. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4760A to chassis harness. Leave sensor disconnected.
900 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
None
WARNING:
To prevent personal injury or death, stay clear of rotating parts (belts and fan) and hot
engine surfaces.
1. Use EST with Navistar® Engine Diagnostics, open Continuous Monitor Session.
2. Monitor sensor voltage. Verify an active code for sensor.
• If code is inactive, monitor signal while wiggling connector and all wires at suspected locations. If circuit
is interrupted, signal will spike and code will go active.
• If code is active, proceed to next Step.
3. Disconnect chassis harness from sensor.
NOTE: Inspect connectors for damaged pins, corrosion, or loose pins. Repair if necessary.
4. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4760A to chassis harness. Leave sensor disconnected.
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 903
Fault Overview
Fault sets when ECM determines difference between actual Aftertreatment Fuel Temperature (AFTFT) and
measured AFTFT is incorrect and/or erratic.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
• SPN 1322 - 1328 FMI 31 • SPN 2659 FMI 20 • SPN 3471 FMI 1, 7, and • SPN 3480 FMI 3 and 4
10
• SPN 3482 FMI 7
Fault Facts
None
Step 6 Inspect Diesel Oxidation Catalyst (DOC) and Diesel Particulate Filter Decision
(DPF).
A. Remove DOC and DPF. Yes: Re-install DOC. Go to Step 8.
WARNING:
To prevent personal injury or death, do not perform an On Board Filter Cleanliness Test
(OBFCT) or Parked Regeneration if liquid oil or fuel is present or suspected to be present
in DPF. Liquid oil or fuel will ignite during an OBFCT causing fires or damage to vehicle
or other equipment.
906 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Step 10 Check Diesel Particulate Filter Differential Pressure (DPFDP) signal Decision
after OBFCT complete.
A. Perform Low to High Idle Test(page 1383). Yes: After doing all diagnostic
steps, if SPN 3242 FMI 20
B. At high idle, measure DPFDP signal pressure.
remains, verify each step was
completed correctly and proper
decision was made. Notify
supervisor for further action.
Does DPFDP signal measure less than 0.5 psi (3 kPa)? No: Remove DPF for external
cleaning. After repairs are
complete, retest for SPN 3242
FMI 20.
Fault Overview
Fault sets when Engine Control Module (ECM) determines Diesel Particulate Filter Intake Temperature (DPFIT)
is reading under 410°F (210°C).
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
None
Step 4 Check DPFIT, against Diesel Oxidation Catalyst Inlet Temperature Decision
(DOCIT) and Diesel Particulate Filter Outlet Temperature (DPFOT).
A. Do Hot Run Sensor Compare Test (page 1322). Yes: End diagnostics. After
repairs are complete, retest for
B. Compare DPFIT against DOCIT and DPFOT.
SPN 3242 FMI 21.
Are all temperature sensors within 77°F (43°C) of other sensors? No: Replace failed temperature
sensor. After repairs are
complete, retest for SPN 3242
FMI 21.
Fault Overview
This fault sets when Diesel Particulate Filter Outlet Temperature (DPFOT) sensor signal doesn't match Diesel
Oxidation Catalyst Intake Temperature (DOCIT) and Diesel Particulate Filter Intake Temperature (DPFIT) at
initial engine start up after an 8 hour cold soak.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
None
Step 2 Inspect Diesel Particulate Filter Outlet Temperature (DPFOT) sensor Decision
and connector.
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 3.
B. Disconnect DPFOT sensor.
C. Check DPFOT sensor and connector terminals for: damaged or pinched
wires; wet or corroded terminals; loose, bent, or broken pins; or broken
connector housing.
Are DPFOT sensor connector, harness, and terminals clean and undamaged? No: Repair connector, harness,
or terminal damage. After repairs
are complete, retest for SPN 3246
FMI 2.
Step 4 Check for high resistance in the DPFOT GND circuit. Decision
A. Perform Test (page 911). Yes: Replace DPFOT sensor.
After repairs are complete, retest
B. Use EST, clear DTC codes.
for SPN 3246 FMI 2.
Did SPN 3246 FMI 4 set after the codes were cleared? No: Repair high resistance
between DPFOT connector pin-1
and ECM pin C-37. After repairs
are complete, retest for SPN 3246
FMI 2.
See latest version of MaxxForce® DT, 9, and 10 Engine and Aftertreatment Wiring Schematic Form 0000003221
for additional circuit information.
Tools
• Breakout Harness ZTSE4760A
• 3-Banana Plug Harness ZTSE4498
• Digital Multimeter (DMM)
Test 1
A. Key-Off.
B. Disconnect Diesel Particulate Filter Outlet Temperature (DPFOT) sensor.
C. Connect Electronic Service Tool (EST) to vehicle Diagnostic Connector (page 1345).
D. Key-On Engine-Off (KOEO), log in to Navistar® Engine Diagnostics.
Test 2
A. Key-Off.
B. Disconnect DPFOT sensor.
C. Connect breakout harness ZTSE4760A to the vehicle harness and leave the DPFOT disconnected.
D. Use 3-Banana Plug Harness ZTSE4498 to short Breakout Harness ZTSE4760A pin-1 to pin-2.
E. Connect Electronic Service Tool (EST) to vehicle Diagnostic Connector (page 1345).
F. Key-On Engine-Off (KOEO), log in to Navistar® Engine Diagnostics.
912 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Fault Overview
Fault code sets when Aftertreatment Control Module (ACM) detects that Diesel Particulate Filter Outlet
Temperature (DPFOT) sensor signal voltage is greater than expected for 16 seconds.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
None
Step 2 Inspect Diesel Particulate Filter Outlet Temperature (DPFOT) sensor Decision
and connector.
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 3.
B. Disconnect DPFOT sensor.
C. Check DPFOT sensor and connector terminals for: damaged or pinched
wires; wet or corroded terminals; loose, bent, or broken pins; or broken
connector housing.
Are DPFOT sensor connector, harness, and terminals clean and undamaged? No: Repair connector, harness, or
terminal damage. After repairs are
complete, retest for SPN 3246 FMI
3.
See latest version of MaxxForce® DT, 9, and 10 Engine and Aftertreatment Wiring Schematic Form 0000003221
for additional circuit information.
Tools
• Breakout Harness ZTSE4760A
• 3-Banana Plug Harness ZTSE4498
• Digital Multimeter (DMM)
Test 1
A. Key-Off.
B. Disconnect Diesel Particulate Filter Outlet Temperature (DPFOT) sensor.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4760A to vehicle harness and leave DPFOT sensor disconnected.
D. Use 3-Banana Plug Harness ZTSE4498 to short Breakout Harness ZTSE4760A pin-1 to pin-2.
E. Connect Electronic Service Tool (EST) to vehicle Diagnostic Connector (page 1345).
F. Key-On Engine-Off (KOEO), log in to Navistar® Engine Diagnostics.
Test 2
A. Key-Off.
B. Disconnect DPFOT sensor.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4760A to vehicle harness and leave DPFOT sensor disconnected.
D. Use 3-Banana Plug Harness ZTSE4498 to short Breakout Harness ZTSE4760A pin-2 to ground.
E. Connect Electronic Service Tool (EST) to vehicle Diagnostic Connector (page 1345).
F. Key-On Engine-Off (KOEO), log in to Navistar® Engine Diagnostics.
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 915
Fault Overview
Fault code sets when Aftertreatment Control Module (ACM) detects that DPFOT sensor signal voltage is less
than expected for 16 seconds.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
None
Step 2 Inspect Diesel Particulate Filter Outlet Temperature (DPFOT) sensor Decision
and connector.
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 3.
B. Disconnect DPFOT sensor.
C. Check DPFOT sensor and connector terminals for: damaged or pinched
wires; wet or corroded terminals; loose, bent, or broken pins; or broken
connector housing.
Are DPFOT sensor connector, harness, and terminals clean and undamaged? No: Repair connector, harness,
or terminal damage. After repairs
are complete, retest for SPN 3246
FMI 4.
See latest version of MaxxForce® DT, 9, and 10 Engine and Aftertreatment Wiring Schematic Form 0000003221
for additional circuit information.
Tools
• Breakout Harness ZTSE4760A
• 3-Banana Plug Harness ZTSE4498
• Digital Multimeter (DMM)
Test 1
A. Key-Off.
B. Disconnect Diesel Particulate Filter Outlet Temperature (DPFOT) sensor.
C. Connect Electronic Service Tool (EST) to vehicle Diagnostic Connector (page 1345).
D. Key-On Engine-Off (KOEO), log in to Navistar® Engine Diagnostics.
918 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Fault Overview
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
SPN 3246 FMI 3 and 4
(DPFOT)
Fault Facts
None
See latest version of MaxxForce® DT, 9, and 10 Engine and Aftertreatment Wiring Schematic Form 0000003221
for additional circuit information.
Tools
• Breakout Harness ZTSE4760A
• Digital Multimeter (DMM)
Test 1
A. Key-Off.
Test 2
A. Key-Off.
B. Disconnect Diesel Particulate Filter Outlet Temperature (DPFOT) sensor.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4760A DPFOT chassis harness and leave DPFOT sensor disconnected.
D. Key-On Engine-Off (KOEO).
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 923
Fault Overview
Fault is set when Engine Control Module (ECM) detects Diesel Particulate Filter Outlet Temperature (DPFOT)
sensor reading is greater than expected for current operating conditions.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
SPN 2791 SPN 3480 SPN 4077 SPN 5456
SPN 5541
Fault Facts
None
Step 2 Inspect air intake system, exhaust system, and air filter. Decision
• Perform Intake Air Inspection (page 1648) and Yes: Go to Step 3.
• Exhaust and Aftertreatment System Inspection (page 1651).
Is air intake system, exhaust system, fuel system, and air filter free of restrictions, No: Repair restrictions, air leaks,
leaks, and physical damage? fuel leaks, or physical damage.
After repairs are complete, retest
for SPN 3246 FMI 20.
924 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Step 6 Check for High DPFOT during 0-60 Road Test. Decision
Perform 0 to 60 MPH Test (page 1514). Open snapshot recording to view data. Yes: Go to Step 7.
Did DPFOT ever rise above 1022°F (550°C)? No: End Diagnostics and retest for
SPN 3246 FMI 20.
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 925
Fault Overview
Fault sets when Engine Control Module (ECM) determines Diesel particulate Filter Outlet Temperature (DPFOT)
is less than 500°F (260°C).
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
None
Fault Overview
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
SPN 3251 FMI 2 and 21 SPN 3556 FMI 0, 1, and 7
Fault Facts
None
Step 6 Test DPFDP, IAH, and DSI for intermittent circuit operation using ESTe. Decision
A. Perform Continuous Monitor Test (page 1361). Yes: Go to Step 7.
B. Verify sensor voltages are within specifications.
Are voltages within specification? No: Locate specific circuit
component causing erratic or
intermittent operation. Perform
voltage and resistance checks
in this section. Repair circuits
as required. After repairs are
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 933
Step 7 Decision
Remove DOC and DPF and inspect DPF internal areas for restrictions, damage, Yes: Clean DPF using appropriate
or evidence of defects. DPF cleaning equipment and
cleaning equipment instructions.
Look for:
Re-install DPF. Reset DPF
• Black on both ends of filter Soot Load. In Navistar® Engine
Diagnostics go to: Parameters
• Black holes on clean side (not more than 20 allowed)
> CDPF Reset Request > Yes >
• Discoloration rings Program Engine. Go to Step 8.
• Chipped, cracked, dented, or bent rims
• Packing failure
• Oil soaked
Does DPF meet all cleaning requirements? No: Replace DPF. Reinstall on
vehicle, and reset DPF Soot Load.
In Navistar® Engine Diagnostics
go to: Parameters > CDPF Reset
Request > Yes > Program Engine.
After replacement is complete,
retest for SPN 3251 FMI 0.
WARNING:
To prevent personal injury or death, do not perform an On Board Filter Cleanliness Test
(OBFCT) or Parked Regeneration if liquid oil or fuel is present or suspected in DPF.
Liquid oil or fuel will ignite during an OBFCT causing fires or damage to vehicle or other
equipment.
Step 8 Decision
Use EST, start an On Board Filter Cleanliness Test (OBFCT) (page 1331). Yes: Go to Step 9.
Is OBFCT running without an Abort Message in EST? No: Correct Parked regen
Inhibitors and redo Step 8.
Step 9 Decision
While running OBFCT, inspect exhaust system for leaks or physical damage. Yes: Go to Step 10.
Is exhaust system clear of leaks and physical damage? No: Repair leaks or physical
damage. After repairs are
complete, retest for SPN 3251
FMI 0.
934 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Step 10 Decision
Yes: After doing all diagnostic
steps, if SPN 3251 FMI 0 remains,
verify each step was completed
correctly and proper decisions
were made. Notify supervisor for
further action.
After OBFCT is complete, does Diesel Particulate Filter Differential Pressure No: Remove DPF and inspect for
(DPFDP) signal measure below 0.5 psi (3 kPa) at high idle? restrictions. If restricted, have DPF
cleaned using appropriate DPF
cleaning equipment. After repairs
are complete, retest for SPN 3251
FMI 0.
Fault Overview
Fault code sets when Engine Control Module (ECM) detects aftertreatment Diesel Particulate Filter Differential
Pressure (DPFDP) is greater than 0.25 psi (1.5 kPa), is not changing with engine conditions, or range since last
monitor < 0.15 psi (1 kPa).
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
• SPN 3251 FMI 3 and 4 • SPN 3510 (VREF)
(DPFDP)
Step 3 Inspect Diesel Particulate Filter Differential Pressure (DPFDP) sensor Decision
hoses and tubes.
Inspect DPFDP sensor hoses, and tubes for kinks, improper hose routing, reversed Yes: Go to Step 4.
hoses, or damage.
Are DPFDP hoses routed correctly and clear of damage? No: Reroute or replace DPFDP
sensor hoses and/or tubes
as needed. After repairs are
complete, retest for SPN 3251
FMI 2.
Fault Overview
Fault sets when Engine Control Module (ECM) determines DPF Differential Pressure (DPFDP) sensor voltage
is greater than 4.75 Volts.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
None
Step 2 Inspect Diesel Particulate Filter Differential Pressure (DPFDP) sensor Decision
and connector.
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 3.
B. Disconnect DPFDP sensor.
C. Check DPFDP sensor and connector terminals for: damaged or pinched
wires; wet or corroded terminals; loose, bent, or broken pins; or broken
connector housing.
Are DPFDP sensor connector, harness, and terminals clean and undamaged? No: Repair connector, harness,
or terminal damage. After repairs
are complete, retest for SPN 3251
FMI 3.
Test 1
A. Key-Off.
B. Disconnect Diesel Particulate Filter Differential Pressure (DPFDP) sensor.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4761A to chassis harness and leave DPFDP sensor disconnected.
D. Key-On Engine-Off (KOEO).
Test 2
A. Key-Off.
B. Disconnect Diesel Particulate Filter Differential Pressure (DPFDP) sensor.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4761A to chassis harness and leave DPFDP sensor disconnected.
D. Key-On Engine-Off (KOEO).
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 941
Fault Overview
Fault sets when Engine Control Module (ECM) determines DPF Differential Pressure (DPFDP) sensor voltage
is less than 0.425 Volts.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
None
See latest version of MaxxForce® DT, 9, and 10 Engine and Aftertreatment Wiring Schematic Form 0000003221
for additional circuit information.
Tools
• Breakout Harness ZTSE4761A
• 3-Banana Plug Harness ZTSE4498
• Digital Multimeter (DMM)
• Electronic Service Tool (EST) with Navistar® Engine Diagnostics
• Interface cable (RP1210B compliant supporting J1939 and J1708)
Test 1
A. Key-Off.
Test 2
A. Key-Off.
B. Disconnect Diesel Particulate Filter Differential Pressure (DPFDP) sensor harness.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4761A to DPFDP chassis harness and leave sensor disconnected.
D. Use 3-Banana Plug Harness ZTSE4498 short Breakout Harness ZTSE4761A pin-2 to pin-3.
E. Connect Electronic Service Tool (EST) to vehicle Diagnostic Connector (page 1345).
F. Key On Engine Off (KOEO), log in to Navistar® Engine Diagnostics.
946 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Fault Overview
Fault code sets when the Engine Control Module (ECM) detects Aftertreatment Diesel Particulate Filter
Differential Pressure (DPFDP) is not changing with engine conditions.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
Fault Facts
None
Step 2 Inspect Diesel Particulate Filter Differential Pressure (DPFDP) sensor Decision
hoses and tubes.
Inspect DPFDP sensor hoses, and tubes for kinks, improper hose routing, reversed Yes: Replace DPFDP sensor.
hoses, or damage. After repairs are complete, retest
for SPN 3251 FMI 10.
Are DPFDP hoses routed correctly and clear of damage? No: Reroute or replace DPFDP
sensor hoses and/or tubes
as needed. After repairs are
complete, retest for SPN 3251
FMI 10.
Fault Overview
Fault sets when Engine Control Module (ECM) determines DPFDP is less than 0 psi (0 kPa).
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
• SPN 3246 FMI 20 • SPN 3251 FMI 2 and 21 • SPN 3556 FMI 0, 1, and 7 • SPN 3719 FMI 0, 15, and
16
• SPN 3936 FMI 0, 2, and 14
Fault Facts
None
Step 3 Decision
Inspect exhaust system for reversed sensor hoses, restrictions, leaks, or physical Yes: Go to Step 4.
damage.
Is exhaust system clear of restrictions, leaks, and physical damage? No: Repair restrictions, leaks, or
physical damage. After repairs
are complete, retest for SPN 3251
FMI 14.
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 951
Step 4 Inspect Diesel Particulate Filter Differential Pressure (DPFDP) sensor Decision
hoses and tubes.
Inspect DPFDP sensor hoses, and tubes for kinks, improper hose routing, reversed Yes: Go to Step 5.
hoses, or damage.
Are DPFDP hoses routed correctly and clear of damage? No: Reroute or replace DPFDP
sensor hoses and/or tubes
as needed. After repairs are
complete, retest for SPN 3251
FMI 2.
Step 5 Inspect Diesel Particulate Filter Differential Pressure (DPFDP) sensor Decision
and connector.
A. Key OFF. Yes: Go to Step 6.
B. Disconnect DPFDP sensor.
C. Check DPFDP sensor and connector terminals for: damaged or pinched
wires; wet or corroded terminals; loose, bent, or broken pins; or broken
connector housing.
Are DPFDP sensor connector, harness, and terminals clean and undamaged? No: Repair connector, harness,
or terminal damage. After repairs
are complete, retest for SPN 3251
FMI 14.
Step 6 Test DPFDP circuits for open, short, or high resistance conditions. Decision
Do connector voltage checks and resistance checks (page 1677). Yes: Go to Step 7.
Are DPFDP circuits within specifications? No: Repair circuits as required.
After repairs are complete, retest
If voltage checks pass, doing resistance checks is not required.
for SPN 3251 FMI 14.
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 953
A. Perform Continuous Monitor Test (page 1361). Yes: After doing all diagnostic
steps, if SPN 3251 FMI 14
B. Verify sensor voltages are within specifications.
remains, verify each step was
completed correctly and proper
decision was made. Notify
supervisor for further action.
Are sensor voltages within specification? No: Locate specific circuit
component causing erratic or
intermittent operation. Perform
voltage and resistance checks
in this section. Repair circuits
as required. After repairs are
complete, retest for SPN 3251
FMI 14.
SPN 3251 FMI 21 - DPFDP excessively LOW (Sensor/circuit fault or missing DPF)
Fault Overview
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
• SPN 3251 FMI 3 and 4 • SPN 3510 (VREF)
(DPFDP)
Fault Facts
None
Step 2 Check exhaust system for an installed Diesel Particulate Filter (DPF). Decision
• Check exhaust system for an installed DPF. Yes: Go to Step 3.
• Check to make sure DPF is not damaged.
• Perform Exhaust and Aftertreatment System Inspection (page 1651).
Is DPF installed in exhaust system and is system free of external damage? No: Install correct DPF or repair
system damage as needed. After
repairs are complete, retest for
SPN 3251 FMI 21.
956 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Step 3 Inspect Diesel Particulate Filter Differential Pressure (DPFDP) sensor Decision
hoses and tubes.
Inspect DPFDP sensor hoses, and tubes for kinks, improper hose routing, reversed Yes: Go to Step 4.
hoses, restrictions (soot, water, icing) or damage.
Are DPFDP hoses routed correctly clear of damage and unrestricted? No: Reroute or replace DPFDP
sensor hoses and/or tubes
as needed. After repairs are
complete, retest for SPN 3251
FMI 21.
Fault Overview
Update calibration to prevent these codes from falsely setting.
Step 1 Obtain vehicle health report and check for current Engine Control Decision
Module (ECM) calibration.
Perform Obtain Vehicle Health Report (page 1324). Yes: Retest for active faults.
Is ECM calibration current? No: ECM calibration not current.
Ensure vehicle has latest ECM
calibration. After repairs are
complete, retest for SPN 3387
FMI 20.
Fault Overview
Update calibration to prevent these codes from falsely setting.
Step 1 Obtain vehicle health report and check for current Engine Control Decision
Module (ECM) calibration.
Perform Obtain Vehicle Health Report (page 1324). Yes: Retest for active faults.
Is ECM calibration current? No: ECM calibration not current.
Ensure vehicle has latest ECM
calibration. After repairs are
complete, retest for SPN 3387
FMI 21.
Fault Overview
Update calibration to prevent these codes from falsely setting.
Step 1 Obtain vehicle health report and check for current Engine Control Decision
Module (ECM) calibration.
Perform Obtain Vehicle Health Report (page 1324). Yes: Retest for active faults.
Is ECM calibration current? No: ECM calibration not current.
Ensure vehicle has latest ECM
calibration. After repairs are
complete, retest for SPN 3388
FMI 20.
Fault Overview
Update calibration to prevent these codes from falsely setting.
Step 1 Obtain vehicle health report and check for current Engine Control Decision
Module (ECM) calibration.
Perform Obtain Vehicle Health Report (page 1324). Yes: Retest for active faults.
Is ECM calibration current? No: ECM calibration not current:
Ensure vehicle has latest ECM
calibration. After repairs are
complete, retest for SPN 3388
FMI 21.
Fault Overview
Update calibration to prevent these codes from falsely setting.
Step 1 Obtain vehicle health report and check for current Engine Control Decision
Module (ECM) calibration.
Perform Obtain Vehicle Health Report (page 1324). Yes: Retest for active faults.
Is ECM calibration current? No: ECM calibration not current.
Ensure vehicle has latest ECM
calibration. After repairs are
complete, retest for SPN 3388
FMI 21.
Fault Overview
Update calibration to prevent these codes from falsely setting.
Step 1 Obtain vehicle health report and check for current Engine Control Decision
Module (ECM) calibration.
Perform Obtain Vehicle Health Report (page 1324). Yes: Retest for active faults.
Is ECM calibration current? No: ECM calibration not current.
Ensure vehicle has latest ECM
calibration. After repairs are
complete, retest for SPN 3389
FMI 21.
Fault Overview
Update calibration to prevent these codes from falsely setting.
Step 1 Obtain vehicle health report and check for current Engine Control Decision
Module (ECM) calibration.
Perform Obtain Vehicle Health Report (page 1324). Yes: Retest for active faults.
Is ECM calibration current? No: ECM calibration not current.
Ensure vehicle has latest ECM
calibration. After repairs are
complete, retest for SPN 3390
FMI 20.
Fault Overview
Update calibration to prevent these codes from falsely setting.
Step 1 Obtain vehicle health report and check for current Engine Control Decision
Module (ECM) calibration.
Perform Obtain Vehicle Health Report (page 1324). Yes: Retest for active faults.
Is ECM calibration current? No: ECM calibration not current.
Ensure vehicle has latest ECM
calibration. After repairs are
complete, retest for SPN 3390
FMI 21.
Fault Overview
Update calibration to prevent these codes from falsely setting.
Step 1 Obtain vehicle health report and check for current Engine Control Decision
Module (ECM) calibration.
Perform Obtain Vehicle Health Report (page 1324). Yes: Retest for active faults.
Is ECM calibration current? No: ECM calibration not current.
Ensure vehicle has latest ECM
calibration. After repairs are
complete, retest for SPN 3391
FMI 20.
Fault Overview
Update calibration to prevent these codes from falsely setting.
Step 1 Obtain vehicle health report and check for current Engine Control Decision
Module (ECM) calibration.
Perform Obtain Vehicle Health Report (page 1324). Yes: Retest for active faults.
Is ECM calibration current? No: ECM calibration not current.
Ensure vehicle has latest ECM
calibration. After repairs are
complete, retest for SPN 3391
FMI 21.
Fault Overview
Update calibration to prevent these codes from falsely setting.
Step 1 Obtain vehicle health report and check for current Engine Control Decision
Module (ECM) calibration.
Perform Obtain Vehicle Health Report (page 1324). Yes: Retest for active faults.
Is ECM calibration current? No: ECM calibration not current.
Ensure vehicle has latest ECM
calibration. After repairs are
complete, retest for SPN 3392
FMI 20.
Fault Overview
Update calibration to prevent these codes from falsely setting.
Step 1 Obtain vehicle health report and check for current Engine Control Decision
Module (ECM) calibration.
Perform Obtain Vehicle Health Report (page 1324). Yes: Retest for active faults.
Is ECM calibration current? No: ECM calibration not current.
Ensure vehicle has latest ECM
calibration. After repairs are
complete, retest for SPN 3392
FMI 21.
Fault Overview
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
None
See latest version of MaxxForce® DT, 9, and 10 Engine and Aftertreatment Wiring Schematic Form 0000003221
for additional circuit information.
• Breakout Harness ZTSE4735A
• Digital Multimeter (DMM)
Test 1
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect ETV connector.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4735A to engine harness and leave ETV disconnected.
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 975
Test 2
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect ETV connector.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4735A to engine harness and leave ETV disconnected.
Test 3
A. Key OFF.
D. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4735A to engine harness and leave ETV disconnected.
976 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Fault Overview
Engine Throttle Valve (ETV) control circuit is shorted to ground.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
None
See latest version of MaxxForce® DT, 9 and 10 Engine and Aftertreatment Wiring Schematic Form 0000003221
for additional circuit information.
Tools Required
• Breakout Harness ZTSE4735A
• Digital Multimeter (DMM)
Test 1
A. Key OFF.
Test 2
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect Engine Throttle Valve (ETV) connector.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4735A to engine harness and leave ETV disconnected.
Test 3
A. Key OFF.
Fault Overview
Fault sets when Engine Control Module (ECM) determines ETC is receiving more than 8 amps for longer than
10 microseconds.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
None
Step 2 Inspect Engine Throttle Valve (ETV) sensor and connector. Decision
A. Key OFF. Yes: Go to Step 3.
B. Disconnect ETV sensor.
C. Check ETV sensor and connector terminals for: damaged or pinched
wires; wet or corroded terminals; loose, bent, or broken pins; or broken
connector housing.
Are ETV sensor connector, harness, and terminals clean and undamaged? No: Repair connector, harness,
or terminal damage. After repairs
are complete, retest for SPN 3464
FMI 11.
Step 4 Check for butterfly valve missing or unattached, butterfly and shaft Decision
damage, and evidence of icing.
Do visual inspection of Engine Throttle Valve (ETV) in Engine Service Manual. Yes: Go to Step 5.
Is butterfly valve condition satisfactory? No: Replace ETV. After repairs are
complete, retest for SPN 3464 FMI
11.
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 983
Step 5 Determine if Engine Throttle Valve (ETV) sensor is operating within Decision
specification.
A. Key OFF. Yes: After doing all diagnostic
steps, if SPN 3464 FMI 11 remains,
B. Disconnect ETV.
verify each step was completed
C. Connect breakout harness ZTSE4735A between ETV and ETV connector. correctly and proper decision was
made. Notify supervisor for further
D. Connect Electronic Service Tool (EST) to vehicle Diagnostic Connector
action.
(page 1345).
E. Key ON Engine OFF (KOEO). Log in to Navistar® Engine Diagnostics.
F. Do Output State High or Low(page 1359) Test.
Is voltage for Output State Test Low approximately 1.15 volts and Output State No: Replace ETV. After repairs are
Test High approximately 3.0 volts? complete, retest for SPN 3464 FMI
11.
Fault Overview
Fault sets when Engine Control Module (ECM) detects short circuit on Engine Throttle Valve (ETV)
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
None
See latest version of MaxxForce® DT, 9 and 10 Engine and Aftertreatment Wiring Schematic Form 0000003221
for additional circuit information.
Tools Required
• Breakout Harness ZTSE4735A
• Digital Multimeter (DMM)
Test 1
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect Engine Throttle Valve (ETV) connector.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4735A to vehicle harness and leave ETV connector disconnected.
988 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Test 2
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect Engine Throttle Valve (ETV) connector.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4735A to vehicle harness and leave ETV connector disconnected.
Test 3
A. Key OFF.
Test 4
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect Engine Throttle Valve (ETV) connector.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4735A to vehicle harness and leave ETV connector disconnected.
Test 5
A. Key OFF.
SPN 3471 FMI 1 - AFT Fuel Pressure 1 below desired (Low System Pressure)
Fault Overview
Fault sets when Doser Control Unit (DCU) detects Aftertreatment Fuel Pressure 1 (AFTFP1) is below desired
pressure.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
SPN 94 (FDP) SPN 3480 (AFTFP1)
Fault Facts
None
Step 2 Aftertreatment Fuel Inlet Sensor (AFTFIS) and connector inspection. Decision
A. Key OFF. Yes: Go to Step 3.
B. Disconnect AFTFIS.
Step 5 Inspect for system leak between Electric Fuel Pump (EFP) and Down Decision
Stream Injection (DSI) unit.
Perform a visual inspection of DSI module and fuel supply line for damage, Yes: Go to Step 6.
restrictions, or leaks.
Is DSI module fuel supply line in good condition, not restricted, leaking, or No: Repair or replace damaged or
damaged? leaking component. After repairs
are complete, retest for SPN 3471
FMI 1.
Step 7 Check for Down Stream Injection (DSI) system leaks. Decision
Perform KOER DSI System Test (page 1385) to check DSI system for leaks. Yes: Repair leak. After repairs
are complete, retest for SPN 3471
FMI 1.
Does DSI system test indicate a leak? No: End diagnostics. After repairs
are complete, retest for SPN 3471
FMI 1.
992 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Test 1
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect Aftertreatment Fuel Inlet Sensor (AFTFIS).
C. Install Breakout Harness ZTSE4830 to vehicle harness and leave AFTFIS disconnected.
Test 2
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect Aftertreatment Fuel Inlet Sensor (AFTFIS).
C. Install Breakout Harness ZTSE4830 to vehicle harness and leave AFTFIS disconnected.
D. Key ON Engine OFF (KOEO).
Test 3
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect Aftertreatment Fuel Inlet Sensor (AFTFIS).
C. Install Breakout Harness ZTSE4830 to vehicle harness and leave AFTFIS disconnected.
SPN 3471 FMI 7 - AFT Fuel Doser Valve not responding as expected
Fault Overview
Fault sets when Doser Control Unit (DCU) detects Aftertreatment Fuel Doser (AFTFD) is not responding as
expected.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
• SPN 3482 (AFTFSV) • SPN 3556 (AFTFP2)
Fault Facts
None
Step 5 Inspect for system leak between Down Stream Injection (DSI) unit and Decision
Aftertreatment Fuel Injector (AFTFI).
Check DSI module and AFTFI fuel supply line for damage, restrictions, or leaks. Yes: Go to Step 6.
Is fuel supply line and DSI module in good condition and not restricted, leaking, No: Repair or replace damaged or
or damaged? leaking component. After repairs
are complete, retest for SPN 3471
FMI 7.
Step 6 Check for Down Stream Injection (DSI) system leaks. Decision
Perform KOER DSI System Test (page 1385) to check DSI system for leaks. Yes: Repair leak. After repairs
are complete, retest for SPN 3471
FMI 7.
Does DSI system test indicate a leak? No: End diagnostics. After repairs
are complete, retest for SPN 3471
FMI 7.
6027
2
0000413828
Test 1
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect Aftertreatment Fuel Pressure 2 (AFTFP2).
C. Install Breakout Harness ZTSE6027 to vehicle harness and leave AFTFP2 disconnected.
D. Key ON Engine OFF (KOEO).
998 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
2
6027
0000413832
Test 2
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect Aftertreatment Fuel Pressure 2 (AFTFP2).
C. Install Breakout Harness ZTSE6027 to vehicle harness and leave AFTFP2 disconnected.
D. Key ON Engine OFF (KOEO).
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 999
Test 3
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect Aftertreatment Fuel Pressure 2 (AFTFP2).
C. Install Breakout Harness ZTSE6027 to vehicle harness and leave AFTFP2 disconnected.
D. Key ON Engine OFF (KOEO).
1000 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
SPN 3471 FMI 10 - AFT Fuel Pressure incorrect dosing pressure multiple events
Fault Overview
Fault sets when Doser Control Unit (DCU) detects Aftertreatment Fuel Doser (AFTFD) valve has incorrect dosing
pressure multiple events.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
• SPN 3482 (AFTFSV) • SPN 3556 (AFTFP2)
Fault Facts
None
Step 6 Inspect for system leak between Down Stream Injection (DSI) unit and Decision
Aftertreatment Fuel Injector (AFTFI).
Check DSI module and AFTFI fuel supply line for damage, restrictions, or leaks. Yes: Go to Step 7.
Is fuel supply line and DSI module in good condition and not restricted, leaking, No: Repair or replace damaged or
or damaged? leaking component. After repairs
are complete, retest for SPN 3471
FMI 10.
Step 7 Check for Down Stream Injection (DSI) system leaks. Decision
Perform KOER DSI System Test (page 1385) to check DSI system for leaks. Yes: Repair leak. After repairs are
complete, retest for SPN 3471 FMI
10.
Does DSI system test indicate a leak? No: End diagnostics, clear fault
and retest for SPN 3471 FMI 10.
6027
2
0000413828
Test 1
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect Aftertreatment Fuel Pressure 2 (AFTFP2) connector.
C. Install Breakout Harness ZTSE6027 to vehicle harness and leave AFTFP2 connector disconnected.
D. Key ON Engine OFF (KOEO).
1004 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
2
6027
0000413832
Test 2
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect Aftertreatment Fuel Pressure 2 (AFTFP2).
C. Install Breakout Harness ZTSE6027 to vehicle harness and leave AFTFP2 disconnected.
D. Key ON Engine OFF (KOEO).
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 1005
Test 3
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect Aftertreatment Fuel Pressure 2 (AFTFP2).
C. Install Breakout Harness ZTSE6027 to vehicle harness and leave AFTFP2 disconnected.
D. Key ON Engine OFF (KOEO).
1006 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Fault Overview
Fault code sets when Doser Control Unit (DCU) detects a short to PWR on low-side driver circuit.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
Doser Control Unit (DCU) deactivates circuits when a circuit fault is present, so NOID Lamp is needed to simulate
correct circuit. Fault is latched for a key cycle, so Engine Control Module (ECM) must be reset by a Key OFF
cycle.
E. Use Terminal Test Kit ZTSE4435C insert appropriate terminal into DCU
connector pin-10.
F. Use DMM, measure resistance between Breakout Harness ZTSE6020
pin-10 and Terminal Test Kit ZTSE4435C pin-10.
Is resistance less than 5 ohms? No: Repair Open between 24-pin
connector pin-10 and DCU
Module pin-10. After repairs are
complete, retest for SPN 3479
FMI 3.
E. Use Terminal Test Kit ZTSE4435C insert appropriate terminal into 86-pin
connector pin-30.
F. Use DMM, measure resistance between Breakout Harness ZTSE6020
pin-9 and Terminal Test Kit ZTSE4435C pin-30.
Is resistance less than 5 ohms? No: Repair Open between 24-pin
connector pin-9 and DCU Module
pin-30. After repairs are complete,
retest for SPN 3479 FMI 3.
1010 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Test 1
A. Key OFF. Disconnect Aftertreatment Fuel Doser (AFTFD) connector.
B. Disconnect 24-pin Engine to Chassis connector.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE6021 to engine harness and leave AFTFD disconnected.
D. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE6020 to 24-pin connector and leave DCU Module side disconnected.
Test 2
A. Key OFF. Disconnect AFTFD.
B. Disconnect 24-pin connector.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE6021 to engine harness and leave AFTFD disconnected.
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 1011
Test 3
A. Key OFF. Disconnect AFTFD connector.
B. Disconnect 24-pin connector.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE6021 to engine harness and leave AFTFD disconnected.
D. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE6020 to 24-pin connector and leave DCU Module side disconnected.
Test 4
A. Key OFF. Disconnect AFTFD connector.
B. Disconnect 24-pin connector.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE6021 to engine harness and leave AFTFD disconnected.
Test 5
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect 24-pin connector.
SPN 3479 FMI 4 - AFT Fuel Doser Valve Open or Short to GND
Fault Overview
Fault code sets when Doser Control Unit (DCU) detects a short to ground on the high-side circuit.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
Doser Control Unit (DCU) deactivates circuits when a circuit fault is present, so NOID lamp is needed to simulate
correct circuit. Fault is latched for a key cycle, so Engine Control Module (ECM) must be reset by a Key OFF
cycle.
Test 1
A. Key OFF. Disconnect AFTFD.
B. Disconnect 24-pin Engine to Chassis connector.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE6021 to engine harness and leave AFTFD disconnected.
Test 2
A. Key OFF. Disconnect AFTFD connector.
B. Disconnect 24-pin Engine to Chassis connector.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE6021 to engine harness and leave AFTFD disconnected.
1018 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
SPN 3479 FMI 5 - AFT Fuel Pressure Control Valve Open or short to GND on low side
Fault Overview
Fault code sets when Doser Control Unit (DCU) detects a short to ground on low-side circuit.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
Doser Control Unit (DCU) deactivates circuits when a circuit fault is present, so NOID lamp is needed to simulate
correct circuit. Fault is latched for a key cycle, so Engine Control Module (ECM) must be reset by a Key OFF
cycle.
D. Use Terminal Test Kit insert appropriate terminal into 86-pin connector
pin-10.
E. Measure resistance between Breakout Harness ZTSE6020 pin-10 and
ZTSE4435C pin-10.
Is resistance less than 5 ohms? No: Repair Open between 24-pin
Engine to Chassis connector
pin-10 and DCU Module pin-10.
After repairs are complete, retest
for SPN 3479 FMI 5.
Test 1
A. Key OFF. Disconnect Aftertreatment Fuel Doser (AFTFD) connector.
B. Disconnect 24-pin Engine to Chassis connector.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE6021 to engine harness and leave AFTFD disconnected.
D. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE6020 to 24-pin Engine to Chassis connector and leave DCU Module side
disconnected.
Test 2
A. Key OFF. Disconnect AFTFD.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE6021 to engine harness and leave AFTFD disconnected.
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 1023
Test 3
A. Key OFF. Disconnect Aftertreatment Fuel Doser (AFTFD) connector.
B. Disconnect 24-pin Engine to Chassis connector.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE6021 to engine harness and leave AFTFD disconnected.
D. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE6020 to 24-pin Engine to Chassis connector and leave DCU Module side
disconnected.
Test 4
A. Key OFF. Disconnect AFTFD connector.
B. Disconnect 24-pin Engine to Chassis connector.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE6021 to engine harness and leave AFTFD disconnected.
Test 5
A. Key OFF. Disconnect 24-pin Engine and Chassis connector.
B. Disconnect DCU 86-pin connector.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE6020 to chassis harness and leave engine harness side disconnected.
1024 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
SPN 3479 FMI 6 - AFT Fuel Pressure Control (Doser) Valve Open or short to PWR on high side
Fault Overview
Fault code sets when Doser Control Unit (DCU) detects a short to power or Open load on high-side circuit.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
Doser Control Unit (DCU) deactivates circuits when a circuit fault is present, so NOID Lamp is needed to simulate
correct circuit. Fault is latched for a key cycle, so Engine Control Module (ECM) must be reset by a Key OFF
cycle.
C. Use Terminal Test Kit insert appropriate terminal into 86-pin connector
pin-10.
D. Measure resistance between Breakout Harness ZTSE6020 pin-10 and
ZTSE4435C pin-10.
Is resistance less than 5 ohms? No: Repair Open between 24-pin
Engine to Chassis connector
pin-10 and DCU Module pin-10.
After repairs are complete, retest
for SPN 3479 FMI 6.
Test 1
A. Key OFF. Disconnect Aftertreatment Fuel Doser (AFTFD) connector.
B. Disconnect 24-pin Engine to Chassis connector.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE6021 to engine harness and leave AFTFD disconnected.
D. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE6020 to 24-pin Engine to Chassis connector and leave DCU Module side
disconnected.
Test 2
A. Key OFF. Disconnect AFTFD.
Test 3
A. Key OFF. Disconnect AFTFD connector.
B. Disconnect 24-pin Engine to Chassis connector.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE6021 to engine harness and leave AFTFD disconnected.
D. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE6020 to 24-pin Engine to Chassis connector and leave DCU Module side
disconnected.
Test 4
A. Key OFF. Disconnect AFTFD connector.
B. Disconnect 24-pin Engine to Chassis connector.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE6021 to engine harness and leave AFTFD disconnected.
Test 5
A. Key OFF. Disconnect 24-pin Engine and Chassis connector.
B. Disconnect DCU 86-pin connector.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE6020 to chassis harness and leave engine harness side disconnected.
1030 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Fault Overview
Fault code sets when the Engine Control Module (ECM) detects Aftertreatment Fuel Pressure 1 (AFTFP1) signal
voltage is greater than 4.85 volts. Engine torque may be reduced if engine is operated for an extended period
of time with this fault active. Active regeneration of the aftertreatment system may be disabled until the next key
cycle.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
None
Test 1
A. Key OFF.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4830 to vehicle harness and leave AFTFIS connector disconnected.
Test 2
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect Aftertreatment Fuel Inlet Sensor (AFTFIS) connector.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4830 to vehicle harness and leave AFTFIS sensor disconnected.
D. Use Breakout Harness ZTSE4498, short Breakout Harness ZTSE4830 pin-1 and pin-4 together.
E. Connect Electronic Service Tool (EST) to vehicle Diagnostic Connector (page 1345).
F. Key-On Engine-Off (KOEO). Log in to Navistar® Engine Diagnostics.
1034 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Test 3
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect Aftertreatment Fuel Inlet Sensor (AFTFIS) connector.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4830 to vehicle harness and leave AFTFIS connector disconnected.
D. Use Breakout Harness ZTSE4498, short pin-4 of Breakout Harness ZTSE4830 to know good GND.
E. Connect EST to vehicle Diagnostic Connector (page 1345).
F. Key ON Engine OFF (KOEO). Log in to Navistar® Engine Diagnostics.
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 1035
Fault Overview
Fault code sets when the Engine Control Module (ECM) detects the Aftertreatment Fuel Pressure 1 (AFTFP1)
signal voltage is less than 0.25 volts for 2 seconds. Active aftertreatment regeneration may be disabled until
next key cycle. Engine torque will be reduced if fault is active for an extended period of time.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
None
Step 4 Check voltage for AFTFP1 circuit for short to GND. Decision
A. Perform Test 2 (page 1037). Yes: Replace AFTFIS. After
repairs are complete, retest for
B. Use DMM, measure voltage between Breakout Harness ZTSE4830 pin-4
SPN 3480 FMI 4.
and known good GND.
Is voltage 5 +/- 1 volt? No: Repair short to GND between
AFTFIS pin-4 and DCU pin-22.
After repairs are complete, retest
for SPN 3480 FMI 4.
Test 1
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect Aftertreatment Fuel Inlet Sensor (AFTFIS) connector.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4830 to vehicle harness and leave AFTFIS connector disconnected.
D. Key-On Engine-Off (KOEO).
Test 2
A. Key OFF.
Fault Overview
Fault Code sets when Doser Control Unit (DCU) Module detects a circuit fault for Aftertreatment Fuel Shutoff
(AFTFSO) circuit.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
None.
Fault Facts
DCU deactivates circuits when a circuit fault is present, NOID Lamp is needed to simulate correct circuit
operation. Fault is latched for a key cycle, ECM must be reset by a Key OFF cycle
Step 5 Check for Open in Aftertreatment Fuel Shutoff (AFTFSO) CTL-H Decision
circuit.
A. Perform Test 1 (page 1041). Yes: Go to Step 6.
B. Use DMM, measure resistance between Breakout Harness ZTSE4602
pin-1 and Breakout Harness ZTSE6020 pin-18.
Is resistance less than 5 ohms? No: Repair Open between 24-pin
connector pin-18 and AFTFSO
pin-1. After repairs are complete,
retest for SPN 3482 FMI 3.
Test 1
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect Aftertreatment Fuel Shutoff (AFTFSO).
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4602 to engine harness and leave AFTFSO disconnected.
D. Disconnect 24-pin Engine to Chassis connector.
E. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE6020 to 24-pin connector and leave DCU Module side disconnected.
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 1043
Test 2
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect AFTFSO.
C. Disconnect 24-pin connector.
D. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4602 to engine harness and leave AFTFSO disconnected.
1044 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Test 3
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect AFTSO.
C. Disconnect 24-pin connector.
D. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4602 to engine harness and leave AFTFSO disconnected.
E. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE6020 to 24-pin connector and leave DCU Module side disconnected.
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 1045
Test 4
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect AFTSO.
C. Disconnect 24-pin connector.
D. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4602 to engine harness and leave AFTFSO disconnected.
1046 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Test 5
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect 24-pin connector.
C. Disconnect DCU 86-pin connector.
D. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE6020 to vehicle harness and leave AFTFSO side disconnected.
E. Use Terminal Test Kit ZTSE4435C insert appropriate terminal into 86-pin connector pin-11.
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 1047
Test 6
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect 24-pin connector.
C. Disconnect DCU 86-pin connector.
D. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE6020 to vehicle harness and leave AFTFSO side disconnected.
1048 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Test 7
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect 24-pin connector.
C. Disconnect DCU 86-pin connector.
D. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE6020 to vehicle harness and leave AFTFSO side disconnected.
E. Use Terminal Test Kit ZTSE4435C insert appropriate terminal into 86-pin connector pin-31.
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 1049
SPN 3482 FMI 4 - AFT Fuel Shutoff Valve open or short to GND
Fault Overview
Fault Code sets when Doser Control Unit (DCU) Module detects signal from Aftertreatment Fuel Shutoff
(AFTFSO) actuator is shorted to ground.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
Doser Control Unit (DCU) deactivates circuits when a circuit fault is present, so NOID light is needed to simulate
correct circuit. Fault is latched for a key cycle, so Engine Control Module (ECM) must be reset by a Key OFF
cycle.
Test 1
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect Aftertreatment Fuel Shutoff (AFTFSO).
C. Disconnect 24-pin Engine to Chassis connector.
D. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4602 to engine harness and leave AFTFSO disconnected.
E. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE6020 to 24-pin connector and leave DCU Module side disconnected.
1054 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Test 2
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect AFTFSO.
C. Disconnect 24-pin connector.
D. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4602 to engine harness and leave AFTFSO disconnected.
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 1055
Test 3
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect AFTSO.
C. Disconnect 24-pin connector.
D. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4602 to engine harness and leave AFTFSO disconnected.
E. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE6020 to 24-pin connector and leave DCU Module side disconnected.
1056 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Test 4
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect AFTSO.
C. Disconnect 24-pin connector.
D. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4602 to engine harness and leave AFTFSO disconnected.
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 1057
Test 5
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect 24-pin connector.
C. Disconnect DCU 86-pin connector.
D. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE6020 to vehicle harness and leave AFTFSO side disconnected.
E. Use Terminal Test Kit ZTSE4435C insert appropriate terminal into DCU connector pin-11.
1058 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Test 6
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect 24-pin connector.
C. Disconnect DCU 86-pin connector.
D. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE6020 to vehicle harness and leave AFTFSO side disconnected.
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 1059
Test 7
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect 24-pin connector.
C. Disconnect DCU 86-pin connector.
D. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE6020 to vehicle harness and leave AFTFSO side disconnected.
E. Use Terminal Test Kit ZTSE4435C insert appropriate terminal into 86-pin connector pin-31.
1060 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Fault Overview
Fault sets when Engine Control Module (ECM) senses VREF 1 sensor supply voltage is greater than 5.498 volts.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
None
Step 3 Measure VREF 1 voltage at ACV with Engine Control Module (ECM) Decision
disconnected.
A. Perform Test 2(page 1063). Yes: Go to Step 5.
B. Use DMM, measure voltage between Breakout Harness ZTSE4850 pin-2
and known good GND.
Is voltage greater than 5.5 volts? No: Go to Step 4.
Step 4 Measure VREF 1 voltage with Under Valve Cover 1 (UVC1) harness Decision
disconnected.
A. Perform Test 3(page 1064). Yes: Repair engine harness for
Short between ECM pin D-13 and
B. Use DMM, measure voltage between Breakout Harness ZTSE4952 pin-8
PWR. After repairs are complete,
and known good GND.
retest for SPN 3509 FMI 3.
Is voltage greater than 5.5 volts? No: Repair UVC harness for
Short between pin-5 and pin-8 OR
pin-5 and pin-3. After repairs are
complete, retest for SPN 3509 FMI
3.
Step 5 Measure VREF 1 voltage with Turbocharger 1 Turbine Outlet Pressure Decision
(TC1TOP) sensor disconnected.
A. Perform Test 4(page 1065). Yes: Replace ACV which contains
TC1TOP sensor. After repairs are
B. Use DMM, measure voltage between Breakout Harness ZTSE4850 pin-2
complete, retest for SPN 3509 FMI
and known good GND.
3.
Is voltage greater than 5.5 volts? No: Go to Step 6.
1062 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Step 6 Measure VREF 1 voltage with Engine Throttle Valve (ETV) sensor Decision
disconnected.
A. Perform Test 5(page 1066). Yes: Replace ETP sensor. After
repairs are complete, retest for
B. Use DMM, measure voltage between Breakout Harness ZTSE4850 pin-2
SPN 3509 FMI 3.
and known good GND.
Is voltage greater than 5.5 volts? No: Repair Short to PWR in engine
harness to pin E-35. After repairs
are complete, retest for SPN 3509
FMI 3.
See latest version of MaxxForce® DT, 9, and 10 Engine and Aftertreatment Wiring Schematic Form 0000003221
for additional circuit information.
Tools Required
• Breakout Harness ZTSE4850
• Breakout Harness ZTSE4952
• Digital Multimeter (DMM)
Test 1
A. Key-Off.
B. Disconnect Exhaust Back Pressure (EBP) sensor connector.
C. Connect breakout harness ZTSE4850 to vehicle harness and reconnect EBP sensor connector.
D. Key-On Engine-Off (KOEO).
1064 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Test 2
A. Key-Off.
B. Disconnect Engine Control Module (ECM) 36-pin driver connector.
C. Disconnect Exhaust Back Pressure (EBP) sensor connector.
D. Connect breakout harness ZTSE4850 to vehicle harness, reconnect EBP sensor connector, and leave ECM
36-pin connector disconnected.
E. Key-On Engine-Off (KOEO).
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 1065
Test 3
A. Key-Off.
B. Reconnect Engine Control Module (ECM) 36-pin driver connector.
C. Disconnect Under Valve Connector (UVC) connector.
D. Connect breakout harness ZTSE4952 to vehicle harness and leave UVC connector disconnected.
E. Key-On Engine-Off (KOEO).
1066 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Test 4
A. Key-Off.
B. Disconnect Turbocharger 1 Turbine Outlet Pressure (TC1TOP) connector.
C. Disconnect Exhaust Back Pressure (EBP) sensor connector.
D. Connect breakout harness ZTSE4850 to vehicle harness, reconnect EBP sensor connector, and leave
TC1TOP connector disconnected.
E. Key-On Engine-Off (KOEO).
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 1067
Test 5
A. Key-Off.
B. Disconnect Engine Throttle Valve Position (ETP) connector. Reconnect Turbocharger 1 Turbine Outlet
Pressure (TC1TOP) connector.
C. Disconnect Exhaust Back Pressure (EBP) sensor connector.
D. Connect breakout harness ZTSE4850 to vehicle harness, reconnect EBP sensor connector, and leave ETP
connector disconnected.
E. Key-On Engine-Off (KOEO).
1068 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Fault Overview
Fault sets when Engine Control Module (ECM) senses VREF 1 sensor supply voltage is less than 4.5 volts.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
Wiring harness routing to all sensors is very important. Make sure that wiring harnesses are routed properly to
avoid contact with serpentine belt or pulleys.
Step 2 Measure VREF 1 voltage at Exhaust Back Pressure (EBP) sensor. Decision
A. Perform Test 1 (page 1072). Yes: Go to Step 3.
B. Use Digital Multimeter (DMM), measure voltage between Breakout
Harness ZTSE4850 pin-2 and known good GND.
Is voltage less than 4.5 volts? No: Go to Intermittent or Not
Active Fault Diagnostic Procedure
(page 1344).
Step 3 Measure VREF 1 voltage at EBP sensor with Engine Control Module Decision
(ECM) driver harness disconnected.
A. Perform Test 2 (page 1073). Yes: Go to Step 7.
B. Use DMM, measure voltage between Breakout Harness ZTSE4850 pin-2
and known good GND.
Is voltage less than 4.5 volts? No: Go to Step 4.
Step 4 Measure VREF 1 voltage at Under Valve Cover (UVC) connector 1. Decision
A. Perform Test 3 (page 1074). Yes: Repair short to GND
between ECM pin D-13 and GND.
B. Use DMM, measure voltage between Breakout Harness ZTSE4952 pin-8
After repairs are complete, retest
and known good GND.
for SPN 3509 FMI 4.
Is voltage less than 4.5 volts? No: Go to Step 5.
Step 5 Measure VREF 1 voltage at UVC 1 with Injector Control Pressure Decision
(ICP) disconnected.
A. Perform Test 4 (page 1075). Yes: Go to Step 6.
B. Use DMM, measure voltage between Breakout Harness ZTSE4952 pin-8
and known good GND.
Is voltage less than 4.5 volts? No: Replace ICP sensor. After
repairs are complete, retest for
SPN 3509 FMI 4.
1070 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Step 6 Measure VREF 1 voltage at UVC 1 with Engine Compression Brake Decision
Pressure (ECBP) disconnected.
A. Perform Test 5 (page 1076). Yes: Repair UVC harness. After
repairs are complete, retest for
B. Use DMM, measure voltage between Breakout Harness ZTSE4952 pin-8
SPN 3509 FMI 4.
and known good GND.
Is voltage less than 4.5 volts? No: Replace ECBP sensor. After
repairs are complete, retest for
SPN 3509 FMI 4.
Step 7 Measure VREF 1 voltage with Turbocharger 1 Turbine Outlet Pressure Decision
(TC1TOP) sensor disconnected.
A. Perform Test 6 (page 1077). Yes: Go to Step 8.
B. Use DMM, measure voltage between Breakout Harness ZTSE4850 pin-2
and known good GND.
Is voltage less than 4.5 volts? No: Replace TC1TOP sensor.
After repairs are complete, retest
for SPN 3509 FMI 4.
Step 8 Measure VREF 1 voltage with Engine Throttle Valve (ETV) sensor Decision
disconnected.
A. Perform Test 7 (page 1078). Yes: Go to Step 9.
B. Use DMM, measure voltage between Breakout Harness ZTSE4850 pin-2
and known good GND.
Is voltage less than 4.5 volts? No: Replace ETV sensor. After
repairs are complete, retest for
SPN 3509 FMI 4.
Step 9 Measure VREF 1 voltage with Fuel Delivery Pressure (FDP) sensor Decision
disconnected.
A. Perform Test 8 (page 1079). Yes: Go to Step 10.
B. Use DMM, measure voltage between Breakout Harness ZTSE4850 pin-2
and known good GND.
Is voltage less than 4.5 volts? No: Replace FDP sensor. After
repairs are complete, retest for
SPN 3509 FMI 4.
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 1071
Step 10 Measure VREF 1 voltage with Engine Oil Pressure (EOP) sensor Decision
disconnected.
A. Perform Test 9 (page 1080). Yes: Go to Step 11.
B. Use DMM, measure voltage between Breakout Harness ZTSE4850 pin-2
and known good GND.
Is voltage less than 4.5 volts? No: Replace EOP sensor. After
repairs are complete, retest for
SPN 3509 FMI 4.
Step 11 Measure VREF 1 voltage with Intake Manifold Pressure (IMP) sensor Decision
disconnected.
A. Perform Test 10 (page 1081). Yes: Go to Step 12.
B. Use DMM, measure voltage between Breakout Harness ZTSE4850 pin-2
and known good GND.
Is voltage less than 4.5 volts? No: Replace IMP sensor. After
repairs are complete, retest for
SPN 3509 FMI 4.
See latest version of MaxxForce® DT, 9, and 10 Engine and Aftertreatment Wiring Schematic Form 0000003221
for additional circuit information.
Tools Required
• Breakout Harness ZTSE4850
• Breakout Harness ZTSE4952
• Digital Multimeter (DMM)
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 1073
Test 1
A. Key-Off.
B. Disconnect Exhaust Back Pressure (EBP) sensor connector.
C. Connect breakout harness ZTSE4850 to vehicle harness and reconnect EBP sensor connector.
D. Key-On Engine-Off (KOEO).
1074 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Test 2
A. Key-Off.
B. Disconnect Engine Control Module (ECM) 36-pin driver connector.
C. Disconnect EBP sensor connector.
D. Connect breakout harness ZTSE4850 to vehicle harness and reconnect EBP sensor connector.
E. Key-On Engine-Off (KOEO).
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 1075
Test 3
A. Key-Off.
B. Reconnect ECM 36-pin driver connector.
C. Disconnect Under Valve Connector 1 (UVC 1) connector.
D. Connect breakout harness ZTSE4952 to vehicle harness and leave UVC 1 connector disconnected.
E. Key-On Engine-Off (KOEO).
1076 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Test 4
A. Key-Off.
B. Remove valve cover.
C. Disconnect Under Valve Cover (UVC) connector 1.
D. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4952 to vehicle harness and leave UVC connector 1 disconnected.
E. Disconnect Injection Control Pressure (ICP) connector.
F. Key-On Engine-Off (KOEO).
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 1077
Test 5
A. Key-Off.
B. Remove valve cover
C. Disconnect UVC 1 connector.
D. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4952 to vehicle harness and leave UVC 1 connector disconnected.
E. Reconnect ICP connector. Disconnect Engine Compression Brake Pressure (ECBP) connector.
F. Key-On Engine-Off (KOEO).
1078 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Test 6
A. Key-Off.
B. Disconnect Turbocharger 1 Turbine Outlet Pressure (TC1TOP) connector.
C. Disconnect EBP sensor connector.
D. Connect breakout harness ZTSE4850 to vehicle harness, reconnect EBP sensor connector, and leave
TC1TOP disconnected.
E. Key-On Engine-Off (KOEO).
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 1079
Test 7
A. Key-Off.
B. Disconnect Engine Throttle Valve (ETV) connector. Reconnect TC1TOP connector.
C. Disconnect EBP sensor connector.
D. Connect breakout harness ZTSE4850 to vehicle harness, reconnect EBP sensor connector, and leave ETP
disconnected.
E. Key-On Engine-Off (KOEO).
1080 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Test 8
A. Key-Off.
B. Disconnect Fuel Delivery Pressure (FDP) connector. Reconnect ETV connector.
C. Disconnect EBP sensor connector.
D. Connect breakout harness ZTSE4850 to vehicle harness, reconnect EBP sensor connector, and leave FDP
disconnected.
E. Key-On Engine-Off (KOEO).
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 1081
Test 9
A. Key-Off.
B. Disconnect Engine Oil Pressure (EOP) connector. Reconnect FDP connector.
C. Disconnect EBP sensor connector.
D. Connect breakout harness ZTSE4850 to vehicle harness, reconnect EBP sensor connector, and leave EOP
disconnected.
E. Key-On Engine-Off (KOEO).
1082 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Test 10
A. Key-Off.
B. Disconnect Intake Manifold Pressure (IMP) connector. Reconnect EOP connector.
C. Disconnect EBP sensor connector.
D. Connect breakout harness ZTSE4850 to vehicle harness, reconnect EBP sensor connector, and leave IMP
disconnected.
E. Key-On Engine-Off (KOEO).
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 1083
Test 11
A. Key-Off.
B. Disconnect EBP sensor connector. Reconnect IMP connector.
C. Connect breakout harness ZTSE4850 to vehicle harness and leave EBP sensor disconnected.
D. Key-On Engine-Off (KOEO).
1084 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Fault Overview
Fault sets when Engine Control Module (ECM) senses VREF 2 sensor supply voltage is greater than 5.498 volts.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
None
Fault Overview
Fault sets when Engine Control Module (ECM) senses VREF 2 sensor supply voltage is less than 4.502 volts.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
None
Test 1
A. Key-Off.
B. Disconnect Accelerator Pedal Position (APP) sensor connector.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4485A to vehicle harness and reconnect APP connector.
D. Key-On Engine-Off (KOEO).
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 1089
Fault Overview
Fault sets when Engine Control Module (ECM) senses VREF 3 sensor supply voltage is greater than 5.498 volts.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
None
Test 1
A. Key-Off.
B. Disconnect APP sensor.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4485A to vehicle harness and leave APP connector disconnected.
D. Key-On Engine-Off (KOEO).
1092 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Test 2
A. Key-Off.
B. Disconnect 42-pin IP/Engine connector.
C. Connect Breakout Box 00-00956-08 to Breakout Harness 00-00979-01.
D. Connect Breakout Harness 00-00979-01 to vehicle harness (ECM side of connector) and leave vehicle side
disconnected.
E. Disconnect ECM 76-pin Chassis connector.
F. Key-On Engine-Off (KOEO).
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 1093
Fault Overview
Fault sets when Engine Control Module (ECM) senses VREF 3 sensor supply voltage is less than 4.502 volts.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
None
Step 3 Measure VREF voltage for Accelerator Pedal Position (APP) sensor. Decision
A. Perform Test 1 (page 1096). Yes: Go to Step 4.
B. Use DMM, measure voltage between Breakout Harness ZTSE4485A
pin-D and known good GND.
Is voltage less than 4.5 volts? No: Replace APP sensor. After
repairs are complete, retest for
SPN 3511 FMI 4.
Step 5 Check for short to GND between 42-pin connector and APP. Decision
A. Perform Test 2 (page 1096). Yes: Repair short to GND between
APP pin-D and 42-pin connector
B. Use DMM, measure voltage between Breakout Harness ZTSE4485A
pin-30. After repairs are complete,
pin-D and PWR.
retest for SPN 3511 FMI 4.
Is voltage within B+ ± 0.5 volts? No: Go to Step 6
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 1095
Step 6 Check for short to GND between ECM and 42-pin connector. Decision
A. Perform Test 3 (page 1097). Yes: Repair short to GND between
42-pin connector pin-30 and
B. Use DMM, measure voltage between Breakout Harness 00-00979-01
ECM pin C-9. After repairs are
pin-30 and PWR.
complete, retest for SPN 3511 FMI
4.
Is voltage within B+ ± 0.5 volts? No: Go to Step 7.
Step 7 Check for short to GND between ECM and DPF sensor. Decision
A. Perform Test 4 (page 1098). Yes: Go to Step 8.
B. Use DMM, measure voltage between Breakout Harness ZTSE4761A
Pin-3 and a known good GND.
Is voltage 5V +/- 0.25V? No: Repair Short to GND between
DPF sensor Pin-3 and ECM pin
C-51. After repairs are complete,
retest SPN 3511 FMI 4.
Test 1
A. Key-Off.
B. Disconnect Accelerator Pedal Position (APP) sensor.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4485A to vehicle harness and leave APP connector disconnected.
D. Key-On Engine-Off (KOEO).
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 1097
Test 2
A. Key-Off.
B. Disconnect APP sensor.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4485A to vehicle harness and leave APP connector disconnected.
D. Disconnect 42-pin IP/Engine connector.
E. Key-On Engine-Off (KOEO).
1098 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Test 3
A. Key-Off.
B. Disconnect 42-pin IP/Engine connector between engine and chassis.
C. Connect Breakout Harness 00-00979-01 to vehicle harness ECM side of connector and leave 42-pin IP/Engine
chassis side of connector disconnected.
D. Key-On Engine-Off (KOEO).
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 1099
Test 4
A. Key-Off.
B. Disconnect Diesel Particulate Filter Differential Pressure (DPFDP) sensor.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4761A to chassis harness and leave DPFDP sensor disconnected.
D. Key-On Engine-Off (KOEO).
1100 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
C-27
0000415056
Test 5
A. Key-Off.
B. Disconnect ECM Chassis 76-pin connector.
C. Connect Breakout Harness 00-00959-01 between vehicle harness and ECM Chassis connector.
D. Connect Breakout Harness 00-00959-01 to 180-pin Breakout Box 00-00956-08.
E. Key-On Engine-Off (KOEO).
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 1101
Fault Overview
Fault code sets when Engine Control Module (ECM) detects that Doser Control Unit (DCU) VREF 1 or VREF 2
circuit voltage is greater than 5.1 volts or less than 4.9 volts.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
The Aftertreatment Fuel Inlet sensor is a combination sensor that monitors Aftertreatment Fuel Pressure 1 and
Aftertreatment Fuel Temperature.
See latest version of MaxxForce® DT, 9, and 10 Engine and Aftertreatment Wiring Schematic Form 0000003221
for additional circuit information.
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 1105
Test 1
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect AFTFP2 connector.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE6027 between AFTFP2 sensor and engine harness.
D. Key-On Engine-Off (KOEO).
1106 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Test 2
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect AFTFP2 connector.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE6027 to engine harness and leave AFTFP2 sensor disconnected.
D. Key-On Engine-Off (KOEO).
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 1107
Test 3
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect Aftertreatment Fuel Inlet Sensor (AFTFIS) connector.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4830 to engine harness and leave AFTIS disconnected.
D. Key-On Engine-Off (KOEO).
1108 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
SPN 3556 FMI 0 - AFT Fuel Pressure 2 excessively high (Restricted injection)
Fault Overview
Fault sets when Aftertreatment Control Module (ACM) detects Aftertreatment Fuel Doser (AFTFD) is not
responding.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
• SPN 3479 FMI 3, 4, and 6 • SPN 4077 FMI 3 and 4
(AFTFD) (AFTFP2)
Fault Facts
None
SPN 3556 FMI 1 - AFT Fuel Pressure 2 below desired (Possible system leak)
Fault Overview
Fault code sets when Doser Control Unit (DCU) detects Aftertreatment Fuel Pressure 2 (AFTFP2) is below
desired pressure indicating a possible system leak.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
SPN 94 SPN 3479 SPN 3480 SPN 4077
SPN 5456
Fault Facts
None
Step 2 Inspect for system leak between Down Stream Injection (DSI) unit and Decision
Aftertreatment Fuel Injector (AFTFI).
Check DSI module and AFTFI fuel supply line for damage, restrictions, or leaks. Yes: Go to Step 3.
Is fuel supply line and DSI module in good condition and not restricted, leaking, No: Repair or replace damaged or
or damaged? leaking component. After repairs
are complete, retest for SPN 3556
FMI 1.
1112 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Step 3 Check for Down Stream Injection (DSI) system leaks. Decision
Perform KOER DSI System Test (page 1385) to check DSI system for leaks. Yes: Repair leak. After repairs
are complete, retest for SPN 3556
FMI 1.
Does DSI system test indicate a leak? No: Go to Step 4.
Fault Overview
Fault sets when the Aftertreatment Control Module (ACM) detects the Aftertreatment Fuel Injector (AFI) is not
responding as expected.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
• SPN 94 FMI 17 (FDP) • SPN 3479 (AFTFD) • SPN 3480 (AFTFIS) • SPN 3482 (AFTFSV)
Fault Facts
None
Step 2 Inspect for system leak between Down Stream Injection (DSI) unit and Decision
Aftertreatment Fuel Injector (AFI).
Check DSI module and AFI fuel supply line for damage, restrictions, or leaks. Yes: Go to Step 3.
Is fuel supply line and DSI module in good condition and not restricted, leaking, No: Repair or replace damaged or
or damaged? leaking component. After repairs
are complete, retest for SPN 3556
FMI 7.
Step 3 Check for Down Stream Injection (DSI) system leaks. Decision
Perform KOER DSI System Test (page 1385) to check DSI system for leaks. Yes: Repair leaking or restricted
component. After repairs are
complete, retest for SPN 3556
FMI 7.
Does DSI system test indicate a leak? No: Clear fault and retest for SPN
3556 FMI 7.
1114 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Fault Overview
Fault is set when short circuit is detected on injector 1 Close coil.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
It may be necessary to perform the pin point circuit diagnostics tests with the engine at or near normal operating
temperature.
See latest version of MaxxForce® DT, 9 and 10 Engine and Aftertreatment Wiring Schematic Form 0000003221
for additional circuit information.
Step 6 Check Injector 1 Closed Coil H circuit for short to GND. Decision
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 7.
B. Disconnect Injector 1 from UVC harness.
C. Disconnect ECM - Driver 36-pin connector.
D. Use Terminal Test Kit ZTSE4435C, insert proper terminal into ECM -
Driver 36-pin connector pin D-8, leave ECM disconnected.
Step 7 Check Injector 1 Closed Coil L circuit for short to GND. Decision
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 8.
B. Disconnect Injector 1 from UVC harness.
C. Disconnect ECM - Driver 36-pin connector.
D. Use Terminal Test Kit ZTSE4435C, insert proper terminal into ECM -
Driver 36-pin connector pin D-7, leave ECM disconnected.
E. Use DMM, measure resistance between ECM - Driver 36-pin connector
pin D-7 and known good GND.
Is resistance greater than 1000 ohms? No: Repair short to ground
between ECM D-7 and Injector 1.
After repairs are complete, retest
for SPN 3659 FMI 4.
Step 8 Check for short between Closed H and Closed L circuits in Under Decision
Valve Cover (UVC) harness.
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 9.
B. Disconnect Injector 1 from UVC harness.
Step 9 Check for short between Closed H and Closed L circuits in engine Decision
harness.
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 10.
B. Disconnect UVC harness connector 2 from engine harness
D. Use Terminal Test Kit ZTSE4435C, insert proper terminal into ECM -
Driver 36-pin connector pins D-7 and D-8, leave ECM disconnected.
E. Use DMM, measure resistance between ECM - Driver 36-pin connector
pins D-7 and D-8.
Is resistance greater than 1000 ohms? Replace engine harness. After
repairs are complete, retest for
SPN 3659 FMI 4.
Fault Overview
Fault is set when Engine Control Module (ECM) detects an Open circuit in Injector 1 Close coil circuit.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during one drive cycle.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
It may be necessary to perform the pin point circuit diagnostics tests with the engine at or near normal operating
temperature.
See latest version of MaxxForce® DT, 9 and 10 Engine and Aftertreatment Wiring Schematic Form 0000003221
for additional circuit information.
Step 3 Inspect Under Valve Cover (UVC) harness under valve cover. Decision
A. Key-Off. Yes: Replace UVC harness and
install in proper routing. After
B. Remove valve cover.
repairs are complete, retest for
C. Inspect UVC harness under valve cover for improper harness routing, SPN 3659 FMI 5.
evidence of harness contacting rocker arms, or other signs of harness
damage.
Is there evidence of harness damage? No: Go to Step 4.
Fault Overview
Fault is set when short circuit is detected on injector 2 Close coil.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
It may be necessary to perform the pin point circuit diagnostics tests with the engine at or near normal operating
temperature.
See latest version of MaxxForce® DT, 9 and 10 Engine and Aftertreatment Wiring Schematic Form 0000003221
for additional circuit information.
Step 6 Check Injector 2 Closed Coil H circuit for short to GND. Decision
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 7.
B. Disconnect Injector 2 from UVC harness.
C. Disconnect ECM - Driver 36-pin connector.
D. Use Terminal Test Kit ZTSE4435C, insert proper terminal into ECM -
Driver 36-pin connector pin D-12, leave ECM disconnected.
Step 7 Check Injector 2 Closed Coil L circuit for short to GND. Decision
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 8.
B. Disconnect Injector 2 from UVC harness.
C. Disconnect ECM - Driver 36-pin connector.
D. Use Terminal Test Kit ZTSE4435C, insert proper terminal into ECM -
Driver 36-pin connector pin D-11, leave ECM disconnected.
E. Use DMM, measure resistance between ECM - Driver 36-pin connector
pin D-11 and known good GND.
Is resistance greater than 1000 ohms? No: Repair short to ground
between ECM D-11 and Injector 2.
After repairs are complete, retest
for SPN 3660 FMI 4.
Step 8 Check for short between Closed H and Closed L circuits in Under Decision
Valve Cover (UVC) harness.
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 9.
B. Disconnect Injector 2 from UVC harness.
Step 9 Check for short between Closed H and Closed L circuits in engine Decision
harness.
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 10.
B. Disconnect UVC harness connector 2 from engine harness
D. Use Terminal Test Kit ZTSE4435C, insert proper terminal into ECM -
Driver 36-pin connector pins D-11 and D-12, leave ECM disconnected.
E. Use DMM, measure resistance between ECM - Driver 36-pin connector
pins D-11 and D-12.
Is resistance greater than 1000 ohms? Replace engine harness. After
repairs are complete, retest for
SPN 3660 FMI 4.
Fault Overview
Fault is set when Engine Control Module (ECM) detects an Open circuit in Injector 2 Close coil circuit.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during one drive cycle.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
It may be necessary to perform the pin point circuit diagnostics tests with the engine at or near normal operating
temperature.
See latest version of MaxxForce® DT, 9 and 10 Engine and Aftertreatment Wiring Schematic Form 0000003221
for additional circuit information.
Step 3 Inspect Under Valve Cover (UVC) harness under valve cover. Decision
A. Key-Off. Yes: Replace UVC harness and
install in proper routing. After
B. Remove valve cover.
repairs are complete, retest for
C. Inspect UVC harness under valve cover for improper harness routing, SPN 3660 FMI 5.
evidence of harness contacting rocker arms, or other signs of harness
damage.
Is there evidence of harness damage? No: Go to Step 4.
Fault Overview
Fault is set when short circuit is detected on injector 3 Close coil.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
It may be necessary to perform the pin point circuit diagnostics tests with the engine at or near normal operating
temperature.
See latest version of MaxxForce® DT, 9 and 10 Engine and Aftertreatment Wiring Schematic Form 0000003221
for additional circuit information.
Step 6 Check Injector 3 Closed Coil H circuit for short to GND. Decision
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 7.
B. Disconnect Injector 3 from UVC harness.
C. Disconnect ECM - Driver 36-pin connector.
D. Use Terminal Test Kit ZTSE4435C, insert proper terminal into ECM -
Driver 36-pin connector pin D-10, leave ECM disconnected.
Step 7 Check Injector 3 Closed Coil L circuit for short to GND. Decision
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 8.
B. Disconnect Injector 3 from UVC harness.
C. Disconnect ECM - Driver 36-pin connector.
D. Use Terminal Test Kit ZTSE4435C, insert proper terminal into ECM -
Driver 36-pin connector pin D-9, leave ECM disconnected.
E. Use DMM, measure resistance between ECM - Driver 36-pin connector
pin D-9 and known good GND.
Is resistance greater than 1000 ohms? No: Repair short to ground
between ECM D-9 and Injector 3.
After repairs are complete, retest
for SPN 3661 FMI 4.
Step 8 Check for short between Closed H and Closed L circuits in Under Decision
Valve Cover (UVC) harness.
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 9.
B. Disconnect Injector 3 from UVC harness.
Step 9 Check for short between Closed H and Closed L circuits in engine Decision
harness.
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 10.
B. Disconnect UVC harness connector 3 from engine harness
D. Use Terminal Test Kit ZTSE4435C, insert proper terminal into ECM -
Driver 36-pin connector pins D-9 and D-10, leave ECM disconnected.
E. Use DMM, measure resistance between ECM - Driver 36-pin connector
pins D-9 and D-10.
Is resistance greater than 1000 ohms? Replace engine harness. After
repairs are complete, retest for
SPN 3661 FMI 4.
Fault Overview
Fault is set when Engine Control Module (ECM) detects an Open circuit in Injector 3 Close coil circuit.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during one drive cycle.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
It may be necessary to perform the pin point circuit diagnostics tests with the engine at or near normal operating
temperature.
See latest version of MaxxForce® DT, 9 and 10 Engine and Aftertreatment Wiring Schematic Form 0000003221
for additional circuit information.
Step 3 Inspect Under Valve Cover (UVC) harness under valve cover. Decision
A. Key-Off. Yes: Replace UVC harness and
install in proper routing. After
B. Remove valve cover.
repairs are complete, retest for
C. Inspect UVC harness under valve cover for improper harness routing, SPN 3661 FMI 5.
evidence of harness contacting rocker arms, or other signs of harness
damage.
Is there evidence of harness damage? No: Go to Step 4.
Fault Overview
Fault is set when short circuit is detected on injector 4 Close coil.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
It may be necessary to perform the pin point circuit diagnostics tests with the engine at or near normal operating
temperature.
See latest version of MaxxForce® DT, 9 and 10 Engine and Aftertreatment Wiring Schematic Form 0000003221
for additional circuit information.
Step 6 Check Injector 4 Closed Coil H circuit for short to GND. Decision
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 7.
B. Disconnect Injector 4 from UVC harness.
C. Disconnect ECM - Driver 36-pin connector.
D. Use Terminal Test Kit ZTSE4435C, insert proper terminal into ECM -
Driver 36-pin connector pin D-36, leave ECM disconnected.
Step 7 Check Injector 4 Closed Coil L circuit for short to GND. Decision
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 8.
B. Disconnect Injector 4 from UVC harness.
C. Disconnect ECM - Driver 36-pin connector.
D. Use Terminal Test Kit ZTSE4435C, insert proper terminal into ECM -
Driver 36-pin connector pin D-35, leave ECM disconnected.
E. Use DMM, measure resistance between ECM - Driver 36-pin connector
pin D-35 and known good GND.
Is resistance greater than 1000 ohms? No: Repair short to ground
between ECM D-35 and Injector 4.
After repairs are complete, retest
for SPN 3662 FMI 4.
Step 8 Check for short between Closed H and Closed L circuits in Under Decision
Valve Cover (UVC) harness.
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 9.
B. Disconnect Injector 4 from UVC harness.
Step 9 Check for short between Closed H and Closed L circuits in engine Decision
harness.
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 10.
B. Disconnect UVC harness connector 3 from engine harness
D. Use Terminal Test Kit ZTSE4435C, insert proper terminal into ECM -
Driver 36-pin connector pins D-35 and D-36, leave ECM disconnected.
E. Use DMM, measure resistance between ECM - Driver 36-pin connector
pins D-35 and D-36.
Is resistance greater than 1000 ohms? Replace engine harness. After
repairs are complete, retest for
SPN 3662 FMI 4.
Fault Overview
Fault is set when Engine Control Module (ECM) detects an Open circuit in Injector 4 Close coil circuit.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during one drive cycle.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
It may be necessary to perform the pin point circuit diagnostics tests with the engine at or near normal operating
temperature.
See latest version of MaxxForce® DT, 9 and 10 Engine and Aftertreatment Wiring Schematic Form 0000003221
for additional circuit information.
Step 3 Inspect Under Valve Cover (UVC) harness under valve cover. Decision
A. Key-Off. Yes: Replace UVC harness and
install in proper routing. After
B. Remove valve cover.
repairs are complete, retest for
C. Inspect UVC harness under valve cover for improper harness routing, SPN 3662 FMI 5.
evidence of harness contacting rocker arms, or other signs of harness
damage.
Is there evidence of harness damage? No: Go to Step 4.
Fault Overview
Fault is set when short circuit is detected on injector 5 Close coil.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
It may be necessary to perform the pin point circuit diagnostics tests with the engine at or near normal operating
temperature.
See latest version of MaxxForce® DT, 9 and 10 Engine and Aftertreatment Wiring Schematic Form 0000003221
for additional circuit information.
Step 6 Check Injector 5 Closed Coil H circuit for short to GND. Decision
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 7.
B. Disconnect Injector 5 from UVC harness.
C. Disconnect ECM - Driver 36-pin connector.
D. Use Terminal Test Kit ZTSE4435C, insert proper terminal into ECM -
Driver 36-pin connector pin D-32, leave ECM disconnected.
Step 7 Check Injector 5 Closed Coil L circuit for short to GND. Decision
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 8.
B. Disconnect Injector 5 from UVC harness.
C. Disconnect ECM - Driver 36-pin connector.
D. Use Terminal Test Kit ZTSE4435C, insert proper terminal into ECM -
Driver 36-pin connector pin D-31, leave ECM disconnected.
E. Use DMM, measure resistance between ECM - Driver 36-pin connector
pin D-31 and known good GND.
Is resistance greater than 1000 ohms? No: Repair short to ground
between ECM D-31 and Injector 5.
After repairs are complete, retest
for SPN 3663 FMI 4.
Step 8 Check for short between Closed H and Closed L circuits in Under Decision
Valve Cover (UVC) harness.
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 9.
B. Disconnect Injector 5 from UVC harness.
Step 9 Check for short between Closed H and Closed L circuits in engine Decision
harness.
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 10.
B. Disconnect UVC harness connector 4 from engine harness
D. Use Terminal Test Kit ZTSE4435C, insert proper terminal into ECM -
Driver 36-pin connector pins D-31 and D-32, leave ECM disconnected.
E. Use DMM, measure resistance between ECM - Driver 36-pin connector
pins D-31 and D-32.
Is resistance greater than 1000 ohms? Replace engine harness. After
repairs are complete, retest for
SPN 3663 FMI 4.
Fault Overview
Fault is set when Engine Control Module (ECM) detects an Open circuit in Injector 5 Close coil circuit.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during one drive cycle.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
It may be necessary to perform the pin point circuit diagnostics tests with the engine at or near normal operating
temperature.
See latest version of MaxxForce® DT, 9 and 10 Engine and Aftertreatment Wiring Schematic Form 0000003221
for additional circuit information.
Step 3 Inspect Under Valve Cover (UVC) harness under valve cover. Decision
A. Key-Off. Yes: Replace UVC harness and
install in proper routing. After
B. Remove valve cover.
repairs are complete, retest for
C. Inspect UVC harness under valve cover for improper harness routing, SPN 3663 FMI 5.
evidence of harness contacting rocker arms, or other signs of harness
damage.
Is there evidence of harness damage? No: Go to Step 4.
Fault Overview
Fault is set when short circuit is detected on injector 6 Close coil.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
It may be necessary to perform the pin point circuit diagnostics tests with the engine at or near normal operating
temperature.
See latest version of MaxxForce® DT, 9 and 10 Engine and Aftertreatment Wiring Schematic Form 0000003221
for additional circuit information.
Step 6 Check Injector 6 Closed Coil H circuit for short to GND. Decision
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 7.
B. Disconnect Injector 6 from UVC harness.
C. Disconnect ECM - Driver 36-pin connector.
D. Use Terminal Test Kit ZTSE4435C, insert proper terminal into ECM -
Driver 36-pin connector pin D-34, leave ECM disconnected.
Step 7 Check Injector 6 Closed Coil L circuit for short to GND. Decision
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 8.
B. Disconnect Injector 6 from UVC harness.
C. Disconnect ECM - Driver 36-pin connector.
D. Use Terminal Test Kit ZTSE4435C, insert proper terminal into ECM -
Driver 36-pin connector pin D-33, leave ECM disconnected.
E. Use DMM, measure resistance between ECM - Driver 36-pin connector
pin D-33 and known good GND.
Is resistance greater than 1000 ohms? No: Repair short to ground
between ECM D-33 and Injector 6.
After repairs are complete, retest
for SPN 3664 FMI 4.
Step 8 Check for short between Closed H and Closed L circuits in Under Decision
Valve Cover (UVC) harness.
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 9.
B. Disconnect Injector 6 from UVC harness.
Step 9 Check for short between Closed H and Closed L circuits in engine Decision
harness.
A. Key-Off. Yes: Go to Step 10.
B. Disconnect UVC harness connector 4 from engine harness
D. Use Terminal Test Kit ZTSE4435C, insert proper terminal into ECM -
Driver 36-pin connector pins D-33 and D-34, leave ECM disconnected.
E. Use DMM, measure resistance between ECM - Driver 36-pin connector
pins D-33 and D-34.
Is resistance greater than 1000 ohms? Replace engine harness. After
repairs are complete, retest for
SPN 3664 FMI 4.
Fault Overview
Fault is set when Engine Control Module (ECM) detects an Open circuit in Injector 6 Close coil circuit.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during one drive cycle.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
It may be necessary to perform the pin point circuit diagnostics tests with the engine at or near normal operating
temperature.
See latest version of MaxxForce® DT, 9 and 10 Engine and Aftertreatment Wiring Schematic Form 0000003221
for additional circuit information.
Step 3 Inspect Under Valve Cover (UVC) harness under valve cover. Decision
A. Key-Off. Yes: Replace UVC harness and
install in proper routing. After
B. Remove valve cover.
repairs are complete, retest for
C. Inspect UVC harness under valve cover for improper harness routing, SPN 3664 FMI 5.
evidence of harness contacting rocker arms, or other signs of harness
damage.
Is there evidence of harness damage? No: Go to Step 4.
Fault Overview
This fault sets when Level 3 Diesel Particulate Filter (DPF) soot loading is over 100% full and engine de-rate
has been enabled. DPF regeneration is required.
Fault Overview
This fault sets when Level 1 Diesel Particulate Filter (DPF) soot loading is above 80% full and a DPF regeneration
is required.
Fault Overview
This fault sets when Level 2 Diesel Particulate Filter (DPF) soot loading is 100% full and a DPF regeneration is
required.
Fault Overview
This fault sets when Level 4 DPF soot loading is overfull and engine shutdown is enabled. DPF regeneration
functionality has been disabled.
Fault Overview
This fault sets when Level 4 DPF soot loading is overfull and engine shutdown is enabled. DPF regeneration
functionality has been disabled.
Fault Overview
This fault sets when Engine Control Module (ECM) determines DPF regenerations are occurring too frequently.
Fault Overview
This fault code sets when the Engine Control Module (ECM) detects regeneration of the Diesel Particulate Filter
(DPF) has run for longer than expected and soot load cannot be effectively reduced.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
None
Fault Overview
Fault sets when Engine Control Module (ECM) determines pressure in DPF adaptive limits have been reached.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
None
Step 1 Decision
Check calibration scorecard or use NavKal to check is ECM has latest calibration. Yes: Go to Step 2.
Is calibration up to date? No: Re-calibrate ECM. After
re-calibration is complete, retest
for SPN 3936 FMI 20.
Step 5 Test DPFIT and MAF/IAT for intermittent circuit operation. Decision
A. Key OFF. Yes: Go to Step 6.
WARNING:
To prevent personal injury or death, do not perform an On Board Filter Cleanliness Test
(OBFCT) or Parked Regeneration if liquid oil or fuel is present or suspected in DPF.
Liquid oil or fuel will ignite during an OBFCT causing fires or damage to vehicle or other
equipment.
Step 7 Decision
Perform On Board Filter Cleanliness Test (OBFCT) (page 1331). Yes: Go to Step 8.
Is OBFCT running without an Abort Message in EST? No: Correct parked regen
inhibitors and redo Step 8.
Step 8 Decision
While running OBFCT, inspect for exhaust system for leaks or physical damage. Yes: Go to Step 9.
Is exhaust system clear of leaks and physical damage? No: Repair leaks and/or physical
damage. After repairs are
complete, retest for SPN 3936 FMI
20.
Fault Overview
Fault code sets when Engine Control Module (ECM) detects that Aftertreatment Fuel Pressure 2 Sensor
(AFTFP2) signal voltage is greater than 4.75 volts.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
SPN 3512 FMI 14 (VREF)
Fault Facts
None
See latest version of MaxxForce® DT, 9, and 10 Engine and Aftertreatment Wiring Schematic Form 0000003221
for additional circuit information.
Tools Required
• Breakout Harness ZTSE4498
• Breakout Harness ZTSE6027
• Digital Multimeter (DMM)
• Electronic Service Tool (EST) with Navistar® Engine Diagnostics
• Interface cable (RP-1210B-compliant supporting J1939 and J1708)
1190 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Test 1
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect Aftertreatment Fuel Pressure 2 (AFTFP2) sensor.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE6027 to vehicle harness connector and leave AFTFP2 sensor disconnected.
D. Key ON Engine OFF (KOEO).
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 1191
Test 2
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect Aftertreatment Fuel Pressure 2 (AFTFP2) sensor.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE6027 to vehicle harness connector and leave AFTFP2 sensor disconnected.
D. Key ON Engine OFF (KOEO).
1192 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Test 3
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect Aftertreatment Fuel Pressure 2 (AFTFP2) sensor.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE6027 to vehicle harness connector and leave AFTFP2 sensor disconnected.
D. Use Breakout Harness ZTSE4498, short Breakout Harness ZTSE6027 pin-2 and pin-3 together.
E. Connect Electronic Service Tool (EST) to Vehicle Diagnostic Connector (page 1345).
F. Key ON Engine OFF (KOEO). Log in to Navistar® Engine Diagnostics.
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 1193
Test 4
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect Aftertreatment Fuel Pressure 2 (AFTFP2) sensor.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE6027 to vehicle harness connector and leave AFTFP2 sensor disconnected.
D. Use Breakout Harness ZTSE4498, short Breakout Harness ZTSE6027 pin-3 to known good GND.
E. Connect EST to Vehicle Diagnostic Connector .
F. Key ON Engine OFF (KOEO). Log in to Navistar® Engine Diagnostics.
1194 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Fault Overview
Fault code sets when Engine Control Module (ECM) detects AFTFP2 signal is less than 0.25 volt.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
None
E. Use DMM, measure voltage between Pin 1 (VREF5) and known good
ground.
Does voltage measure less than 5 V +-.25 V? No: Go to Step 4.
Fault Overview
This fault sets when the ECM detects an short to power in the Water In Fuel (WIF) sensor circuit.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
None
C. Key ON. Use Digital Multimeter (DMM), measure voltage from Breakout
harness ZTSE6002 pin-1 to known good GND.
Does voltage measure 5 ± 0.25 volts? No: Repair short to PWR between
WIF pin-1 and ECM pin E-7. After
repairs are complete, retest for
SPN 4192 FMI 3.
Fault Overview
Fault code sets when Engine Control Module (ECM) detects Water In Fuel (WIF) sensor signal voltage is lower
than expected.
Lamp Reaction
No Lamp
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
None
Test 1
A. Key OFF
B. Disconnect WIF sensor.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE6002 to chassis harness and leave WIF sensor disconnected.
D. Key ON, Engine OFF (KOEO).
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 1201
Fault Overview
This fault sets when the ECM detects an open circuit in the Water In Fuel (WIF) sensor circuit.
Lamp Reaction
No Lamp
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
None
C. Key ON. Use Digital Multimeter (DMM), measure voltage from Breakout
harness ZTSE6002 pin-1 to known good GND.
Does voltage measure 5 ± 0.25 volts? No: Repair Open between WIF
pin-1 and ECM pin E-7. After
repairs are complete, retest for
SPN 4192 FMI 5.
Fault Overview
Fault code sets when Engine Control Module (ECM) receives indication water in fuel is detected.
Lamp Reaction
No Lamp
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
Water In Fuel (WIF) text message in instrument cluster is displayed and remains on when water in fuel is
detected. During initial Key ON, WIF text message may be briefly flash. WIF text message may remain on
for approximately 10 seconds at Key OFF.
Possible Causes
• Water detected in primary fuel filter housing.
1204 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Fault Overview
Fault code sets when the Engine Control Module (ECM) detects Crankcase Oil Separator Speed (CCOSS)
sensor speed is less than 230 rpm.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
None
Step 2 Crankcase Oil Separator Speed (CCOSS) sensor connector inspection. Decision
A. Key OFF. Yes: Go to Step 3.
Test 1
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect Crankcase Oil Separator Speed (CCOSS).
C. Install Breakout Harness ZTSE4951 to CCOSS sensor and leave engine harness disconnected.
1208 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Test 2
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect Crankcase Oil Separator Speed (CCOSS).
C. Install Breakout Harness ZTSE4951 to vehicle harness and leave CCOSS sensor disconnected.
D. Key ON Engine OFF (KOEO).
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 1209
Test 3
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect Crankcase Oil Separator Speed (CCOSS).
C. Install Breakout Harness ZTSE4951 to vehicle harness and leave CCOSS sensor disconnected.
D. Key ON Engine OFF (KOEO).
1210 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
SPN 4257 FMI 7 - Injector Coking Compensation Factor Reached Maximum Authority
Fault Overview
Fault code sets when Engine Control Module (ECM) determines injector coking compensation has reached
its maximum level. Cumulative coking compensation value estimated by injector coking compensation factor
accumulator model greater than 16%.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
Coking is buildup of deposits on tip of Injector.
Fault Overview
Fault code sets when Engine Control Module (ECM) detects that Exhaust Gas Temperature (EGT) temperature
is higher than expected for current operating conditions, indicating an issue with fuel flow.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
• SPN 27 FMI 0, 3, 4, 7, and • SPN 651 - 656 FMI 14 • SPN 1209 FMI 0, 2, 3, 4, • SPN 3251 FMI 0, 2, 10,
11 7, and 31 and 14
• SPN 3387 - 3392 FMI 20 • SPN 3387 - 3392 FMI 21
Fault Facts
None
Step 4 Inspect intake air system for leaks, restrictions, and damage. Decision
Perform Intake Air Inspection (page 1648). Yes: Go to Step 5.
Is intake air system free of leaks, restrictions, and damage? No: Repair leaks, restrictions,
and damage. After repairs are
complete, retest for SPN 4257
FMI 16.
Fault Overview
Fault code sets when Engine Control Module (ECM) detects that Exhaust Gas Temperature (EGT) temperature
is lower than expected for current operating conditions, indicating an issue with fuel flow.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
• SPN 27 (EGR) • SPN 51 FMI 3, 4, and 7 • SPN 94 FMI 3 and 4 (FDP) • SPN 102 FMI 3, 4, and 7
(ETP) (IMP)
• SPN 105 FMI 2, 3, and 4 • SPN 108 FMI 3 and 4 • SPN 110 FMI 2, 3, and 4 • SPN 164 FMI 0, 3, 4, 16,
(IMT) (BARO) (ECT) and 18 (ICP)
• SPN 172 (IAT) • SPN 173 (EGT) • SPN 175 FMI 2, 3, and 4 • SPN 188 FMI 0 and 1
(EOT) (Eng)
• SPN 651 - 656 FMI 4 and • SPN 679 FMI 3 and 4 • SPN 1173 FMI 16 • SPN 1189 FMI 3 and 4
5 (INJ) (IPR) (TC2CIT) (TC2WC)
• SPN 1322 - 1328 FMI 31 • SPN 2630 (CACOT) • SPN 2659 FMI 20 and 21 • SPN 2791 FMI 2, 3, 4, 7,
(Engine) (AMS) 8, and 14 (EGR)
• SPN 3055 FMI 2 (INJ) • SPN 3464 FMI 31 (ETP) • SPN 3471 FMI 1 and 7 • SPN 3479 (AFTPC)
(AFTPC)
• SPN 3480 FMI 3 and 4 • SPN 3482 FMI 3 and 4 • SPN 3556 FMI 1 and 7 • SPN 4257 FMI 7 (INJ)
(AFTFIS) (AFTFSV) (AFTFP2)
• SPN 5543 FMI 3, 4, and 5
(EBPV)
Fault Facts
None
Fault Overview
Fault code sets when the Engine Control Module (ECM) detects the Brake Control Pressure (BCP) signal is
greater than expected.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two trips.
Associated Faults
SPN 164 (ICP) SPN 679 FMI 3 and 4 (IPR) SPN 4287 FMI 3 and 4 SPN 5543 FMI 3, 4, and 5
(ECBP) (EBPV)
Fault Facts
None
Step 3 Check for leaking Engine Compression Brake (ECB1) valve assembly Decision
A. Key OFF. Yes: Replace ECB1 valve
assembly. After repairs are
B. Connect EST to vehicle Diagnostic Connector. (page 1345).
complete, retest for SPN 4287
C. Key ON Engine OFF (KOEO), log in to Navistar® Engine Diagnostics. FMI 0.
D. Start Engine, Key ON Engine Running (KOER).
Fault Overview
Fault sets when engine Exhaust Valve Actuation System Oil Pressure is lower than expected. Injection control
pressure minus measured retarder pressure is greater than 580.3 psi (4.001 MPa) for greater than 20 seconds.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
• SPN 164 (ICP) • SPN 679 FMI 3 and 4 (IPR) • SPN 4287 FMI 3 and 4
Fault Facts
None
Fault Overview
Fault sets when Engine Control Module (ECM) senses Brake Control Pressure (BCP) sensor signal is out of
range high.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
Fault Facts
None
Step 6 Check SIG GND circuit for Open or high resistance. Decision
Perform Test 3 (page 1227). Use EST, clear DTC list. Yes: Go to Step 8.
Does SPN 4287 FMI 4 set after DTC list is cleared? No: Go to Step 7.
Step 7 Check SIG GND circuit for Open or high resistance. Decision
Perform Test 4 (page 1228). Use EST, clear DTC list. Yes: Repair Open between UVC
pin-2 and ECM pin D-14. After
repairs are complete, retest for
SPN 4287 FMI 3.
Does SPN 4287 FMI 4 set after DTC list is cleared? No: Repair Open between UVC
pin-1 and ECM pin D-21. After
repairs are complete, retest for
SPN 4287 FMI 3.
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 1225
Step 8 Check for broken locking tab or damage to harness connector. Decision
A. Key OFF. Yes: Go to Step 9.
B. Remove Valve Cover. (See engine service manual)
C. Check BCP sensor connector terminals for damaged or pinched wires; wet
or corroded terminals; loose, bent, or broken pins; or broken connector
housing.
Are BCP sensor connector, harness, and terminals clean and undamaged? No: Repair connector, harness,
or terminal damage. After repairs
are complete, retest for SPN 4287
FMI 3.
Test 1
A. Key OFF.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4952 to engine harness and leave UVC harness disconnected.
D. Key ON, Engine OFF (KOEO).
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 1227
Test 2
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect Under Valve Cover (UVC) harness.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4952 to engine harness and leave UVC harness disconnected.
D. Key ON, Engine OFF (KOEO).
1228 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Test 3
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect Under Valve Cover (UVC) harness.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4952 to engine harness and leave UVC harness disconnected.
D. Use Breakout Harness ZTSE4498, short Breakout Harness ZTSE4952 pin-1 and pin-2 together.
E. Connect EST to vehicle Diagnostic Connector. (page 1345).
F. Key ON, Engine OFF (KOEO), log in to Navistar® Engine Diagnostics.
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 1229
Test 4
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect Under Valve Cover (UVC) harness.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4952 to engine harness and leave UVC harness disconnected.
D. Use Breakout Harness ZTSE4498, short Breakout Harness ZTSE4952 pin-1 to known good GND.
E. Connect EST to vehicle Diagnostic Connector. (page 1345).
F. Key ON, Engine OFF (KOEO), log in to Navistar® Engine Diagnostics.
1230 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Test 5
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect Under Valve Cover (UVC) harness.
C. Remove valve cover.
D. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4952 to engine harness and leave UVC harness disconnected.
E. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4686 to UVC harness leave BCP sensor disconnected.
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 1231
Test 6
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect Under Valve Cover (UVC) harness.
C. Remove valve cover.
D. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4952 to engine harness and leave UVC harness disconnected.
E. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4686 to UVC harness leave BCP sensor disconnected.
1232 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Test 7
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect Under Valve Cover (UVC) harness.
C. Remove valve cover.
D. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4952 to engine harness and leave UVC harness disconnected.
E. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4686 to UVC harness leave BCP sensor disconnected.
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 1233
Fault Overview
Fault code sets when Engine Control Module (ECM) detects Engine Compression Brake Pressure (ECBP)
sensor signal is out of range low.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive trips.
Associated Faults
SPN 3509 FMI 3 and 4
Fault Facts
None
Step 4 Isolate fault to engine harness or Under Valve Cover (UVC) harness. Decision
A. Key OFF. Disconnect UVC 1 harness connector. Yes: Correct short circuit to GND
between UVC connector pin-1 and
B. Connect EST to vehicle Diagnostic Connector. (page 1345).
ECM pin D-21. After repairs are
C. Key ON Engine OFF (KOEO), log in to Navistar® Engine Diagnostics. complete, retest for SPN 4287
FMI 4.
D. Clear codes, check Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) list for SPN 4287
FMI 4.
Is SPN 4287 FMI 4 still active after clearing codes? No: Go to Step 5.
SPN 4752 FMI 4 - EGR Cooler Efficiency: EGR Outlet Temperature above expected
Fault Overview
Fault sets when Engine Control Module (ECM) determines EGR outlet temperature is above normal operating
range.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
• SPN 110 FMI 0, 15, 16, • SPN 111 FMI 1 and 2 • SPN 1209 FMI 0 • SPN 2630 FMI 16
and 18
Fault Facts
None
Step 3 Check for Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) cooler leaks. Decision
• Perform Coolant Leak Visual Inspection(page 1643). Yes: Go to Step 4.
• Inspect EGR cooler for any external coolant.
• Inspect EGR cooler for any external exhaust gas leaks.
Are there no external leaks? No: Repair external coolant
and/or exhaust leak(s), retest for
SPN 4752 FMI 4.
Fault Overview
Fault code sets when the Engine Control Module (ECM) detects a difference between the Diesel Oxidation
Catalyst Intake Temperature (DOCIT) and Diesel Particulate Filter Intake Temperature (DPFIT) signals that do
not match expected values for 300 seconds. Active and parked regeneration of Diesel Particulate Filter (DPF)
will be disabled. Engine torque may be reduced if engine is operated for an extended period of time with this
fault active.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
SPN 4765 FMI 3 and 4
(DOCIT)
Fault Facts
None
See latest version of MaxxForce® DT, 9, and 10 Engine and Aftertreatment Wiring Schematic Form 0000003221
for additional circuit information.
Tools
• Breakout Harness ZTSE4760A
• Digital Multimeter (DMM)
Test 1
A. Key OFF
Test 2
A. Key OFF
B. Disconnect Diesel Oxidation Catalyst Inlet Temperature (DOCIT) sensor.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4760A to DOCIT chassis harness and leave DOCIT sensor disconnected.
D. Key ON Engine OFF (KOEO).
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 1243
Fault Overview
Fault code sets when the Doser Control Unit (DCU) detects DOCIT sensor signal voltage is greater than
expected. Active and parked regeneration of Diesel Particulate Filter (DPF) will be disabled. Engine torque will
be reduced if engine is operated for an extended period of time with this fault active.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
None
Fault Overview
Fault sets when the Engine Control Module (ECM) determines the Diesel Oxidation Catalyst Inlet Temperature
(DOCIT) value is lower than expected.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
None
Test 1
A. Key OFF
B. Disconnect DOCIT sensor.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4760A to DOCIT chassis harness and leave DOCIT sensor disconnected.
D. Key ON, Engine OFF (KOEO).
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 1249
Fault Overview
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
SPN 4765 FMI 3 and 4
(DOCIT)
Fault Facts
None
See latest version of MaxxForce® DT, 9, and 10 Engine and Aftertreatment Wiring Schematic Form 0000003221
for additional circuit information.
Tools
• Breakout Harness ZTSE4760A
• Digital Multimeter (DMM)
Test 1
A. Key OFF
Test 2
A. Key OFF
B. Disconnect Diesel Oxidation Catalyst Inlet Temperature (DOCIT) sensor.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4760A to DOCIT chassis harness and leave DOCIT sensor disconnected.
D. Key ON Engine OFF (KOEO).
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 1253
Fault Overview
Fault sets when Engine Control Module (ECM) determines DOCIT sensor is measuring temperature greater
than 842°F (450°C).
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
SPN 1322 - 1328 FMI 31
Fault Facts
None
Step 3 Decision
A. Do Hot Run Sensor Compare Check (page 1322). Yes: Go to Step 4.
B. Compare Diesel Particulate Filter (DPF) Inlet Temperature (DPFIT), Diesel
Oxidation Catalyst (DOC) Inlet Temperature (DOCIT), and DPF Outlet
Temperature (DPFOT). All sensors should be within 68°F (38°C) of each
other.
Are all temperature sensors within 68°F (38°C) other sensors? No: Replace failed temperature
sensor. After repairs are
complete, retest for SPN 4765
FMI 20.
Step 4 Use terminal test kit inspect connections at DOCIT sensor. Decision
A. Key OFF. Yes: Go to Step 5.
B. Disconnect DOCIT sensor connector.
C. Check DOCIT sensor and connector for: damaged or pinched wires; wet
or corroded terminals; loose, bent, or broken pins; or broken connector
housing.
Are DOCIT sensor connector, harness, and terminals clean and undamaged? No: Repair connector, harness,
or terminal damage. After repairs
are complete, retest for SPN 4765
FMI 20.
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 1255
Fault Overview
Fault sets when Engine Control Module (ECM) determines Diesel Oxidation Catalyst Inlet Temperature (DOCIT)
sensor is measuring temperature less than 446°F (230°C).
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
SPN 4765 FMI 2, 3, and 4
(DOCIT)
Fault Facts
None
WARNING:
To prevent property damage, personal injury, and/or death, before working on exhaust
system, allow sufficient time for cool down. During regeneration, exhaust gas
temperature could reach 1500°F (800°C), and exhaust system surface temperature could
exceed 1300°F (700°C), which is hot enough to ignite or melt common materials, and to
burn skin. Exhaust and exhaust components can remain hot after vehicle has stopped
moving.
Step 5 Inspect exhaust system (engine and vehicle) for missing equipment, Decision
damage, or leaks.
Perform Exhaust and Aftertreatment System Inspection (page 1651). Yes: End diagnostics. Retest for
SPN 4765 FMI 21.
Is exhaust system undamaged and sensor installed? No: Repair exhaust or install
sensor as needed. After repairs
are complete, retest for SPN 4765
FMI 21.
Fault Overview
Fault sets when Engine Control Module (ECM) determines Diesel Oxidation Catalyst (DOC) is not working
efficiently.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
SPN 4765 FMI 2, 7, and 20
Step 2 Check for Intake and Exhaust systems for leaks and/or damage. Decision
• Perform Intake Air Inspection (page 1648), Yes: Go to Step 3.
• Charge Air Cooler Inspection (page 1646),
• Exhaust and Aftertreatment System Inspection(page 1651).
Are all items checked in good condition and clear of leaks and damage? No: Repair leaks or damage to
intake and exhaust. After repair
are complete, retest for SPN 4766
FMI 10.
B. Check sensor and connector terminals for: damaged or pinched wires; wet
or corroded terminals; loose, bent, or broken pins; or broken connector
housing.
Are DOCIT, DPFIT, and DPFOT sensor connectors, harnesses, and terminals clean No: Repair damaged connector,
and undamaged? harness, or terminal. After repairs
are complete, retest for SPN 4766
FMI 10.
1260 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Step 6 Inspect for exhaust leaks during DPF Regeneration procedure. Decision
While running DPF Regeneration procedure, inspect exhaust system for leaks or Yes: Go to Step 7.
physical damage.
Is exhaust system clear of leaks and physical damage? No: Repair leaks and/or physical
damage. After repairs are
complete, retest for SPN 4776
FMI 10.
Fault Overview
Fault sets when Engine Control Module (ECM) determines soot load of the DPF is still too high after active
regeneration has completed.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
SPN 3251 FMI 2 and 14
(DPFDP)
Step 4 Check DPFDP sensor hoses for correct routing and restrictions. Decision
Inspect DPFDP sensor hoses for kinks, improper hose routing, restrictions, or Yes: Go to Step 5.
damage.
Are DPFDP sensor hoses routed correctly, clear of damage, and unrestricted? No: Repair or replace DPFDP
sensor hose(s). After repairs are
complete, retest for SPN 5319
FMI 31.
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 1263
SPN 5395 FMI 0 - Engine unable to achieve desired idle torque (too high)
Fault Overview
Fault sets when Engine Control Module (ECM) monitoring idle fueling is greater than 199 mg/stroke for 60
seconds or more.
Time Requirement
Immediate
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
• SPN 651 - 656 (INJ) • SPN 4257 (INJ) • SPN 1322 - 1328 FMI 31
(Engine)
Fault Facts
None
Step 6 Check for correctly programmed Power Take Off (PTO). Decision
A. Key OFF. Yes: Go to Step 7.
Step 7 Check for Power Take Off (PTO) engagement without command. Decision
A. Key-Off. Yes: Repair PTO unit. After repairs
are complete, retest for SPN 5395
B. Verify aftermarket PTO system programed correctly.
FMI 0.
C. Key-On Engine-Running (KOER).
D. Monitor PTO output shaft for rotation.
Is PTO output shaft rotating without throttle? No: Retest for SPN 5395 FMI 0.
SPN 5395 FMI 1 - Engine unable to achieve desired idle torque (too low)
Fault Overview
Fault sets when Engine Control Module (ECM) monitoring idle fueling is less than 1 mg/stroke for 60 seconds
or more.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two trips.
Associated Faults
• SPN 651 - 656 (INJ) • SPN 4257 (INJ) • SPN 1322 - 1328 FMI 31
(Engine)
Fault Facts
None
Fault Overview
Fault sets when Engine Control Module (ECM) detects difference between Aftertreatment Fuel Temperature
(AFTFT) and other temperature sensors is greater than 27°F (15°C) after a cold soak.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
SPN 5456 FMI 3 and 4
Fault Facts
None
Drive Cycle
Continuous
Possible Causes
• Incorrect DCU for ECM.
• AFTFT circuit high resistance
• SIG GND circuit high resistance
• Failed AFTFT
Step 3 Check for correct Doser Control Unit (DCU) part number. Decision
Use EST, check for correct DCU part number. Yes: Go to Step 4.
Does DCU match correct part number for model year of engine? No: Install correct DCU for model
year of engine. After repairs are
complete, retest for SPN 5456 FMI
2.
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 1271
Test 1
A. Key OFF
B. Disconnect Aftertreatment Fuel Inlet Sensor (AFTFIS).
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4830 to vehicle harness and leave AFTFIS disconnected.
D. Use Breakout Harness ZTSE4498 short Breakout Harness ZTSE4830 pin-1 and pin-2 together.
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 1273
Test 2
A. Key OFF
B. Disconnect Aftertreatment Fuel Inlet Sensor (AFTFIS).
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4830 to vehicle harness and leave AFTFIS disconnected.
D. Use Breakout Harness ZTSE4498 short Breakout Harness ZTSE4830 pin-2 to a known good GND.
1274 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Fault Overview
Fault code sets when Electronic Control Module (ECM) detects that Aftertreatment Fuel Temperature (AFTFT)
sensor is reading greater than 4.75 volts.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
None
Test 1
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect Aftertreatment Fuel Inlet Sensor (AFTFIS) connector.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4830 to engine harness connector and leave AFTFIS connector disconnected.
D. Key ON Engine OFF (KOEO).
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 1277
Test 2
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect Aftertreatment Fuel Inlet Sensor (AFTFIS) connector.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4830 to engine harness connector and leave AFTFIS sensor disconnected.
D. Use Breakout Harness ZTSE4498, short Breakout Harness ZTSE4830 pin-1 and pin-2 together.
E. Connect EST to vehicle Diagnostic Connector. (page 1345).
F. Key ON Engine OFF (KOEO). Log in to Navistar® Engine Diagnostics.
1278 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Test 3
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect Aftertreatment Fuel Inlet Sensor (AFTFIS) connector.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4830 to engine harness connector and leave AFTFIS sensor disconnected.
D. Use Breakout Harness ZTSE4498, short Breakout Harness ZTSE4830 pin-2 to known good GND.
E. Connect EST to vehicle Diagnostic Connector. (page 1345).
F. Key ON Engine OFF (KOEO). Log in to Navistar® Engine Diagnostics.
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 1279
Fault Overview
Fault code sets when Electronic Control Module (ECM) detects that Aftertreatment Fuel Temperature (AFTFT)
sensor is reading less than 0.25 volts.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
None
Fault Overview
Fault set when comparison of Turbocharger 1 Turbine Outlet Pressure (TC1TOP) to Intake Manifold Pressure
(IMP), Barometric Absolute Pressure (BARO), or Exhaust Back Pressure (EBP) has an absolute pressure value
difference of greater than 3.6 psi (25 kPa).
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during one drive cycle.
Associated Faults
SPN 5543 FMI 3, 4, and 5
Fault Facts
None
Function
Fault set when comparison of Turbocharger 1 Turbine Outlet Pressure (TC1TOP) to Intake Manifold Pressure
(IMP), Barometric Absolute Pressure (BARO), or Exhaust Back Pressure (EBP) has an absolute pressure value
difference of greater than 3.6 psi (25 kPa).
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during one trip.
Associated Faults
SPN 102 FMI 3 and 4 (IMP) SPN 108 FMI 3 and 4 SPN 1209 FMI 3 and 4 (EBP) SPN 3509 FMI 3 and 4
(BARO) (VREF 1)
Fault Facts
None
Fault Overview
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Overview
Fault is set when Engine Control Module (ECM) detects Turbocharger 1 Turbine Outlet Pressure (TC1TOP)
signal is out of range LOW.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
SPN 3509 FMI 3 and 4
(VREF 1)
Fault Facts
None
Test 1
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect ACV connector.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4834 to vehicle harness and leave ACV disconnected.
D. Key ON Engine OFF (KOEO).
1290 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
Test 2
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect ACV connector.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4834 to vehicle harness and leave ACV disconnected.
D. Use Breakout Harness ZTSE4498 jumper between Breakout Harness ZTSE4834 pin-2 and pin-5.
E. Connect EST to vehicle Diagnostic Connector. (page 1345).
F. Key ON Engine OFF (KOEO). Log in to Navistar® Engine Diagnostics.
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 1291
Fault Overview
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
None
Fault Overview
Fault sets when Engine Control Module (ECM) detects Exhaust Back Pressure Valve (EBPV) Control circuit is
shorted to ground.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two consecutive drive cycles.
Associated Faults
None
Fault Facts
None
Step 3 Decision
Test EBP sensor. Connect breakout harness between EBP sensor and EBP sensor Yes: After doing all diagnostic
connector. Do KOEO voltage check of EBP sensor between EBP signal and ground. steps, if SPN 5543 FMI 4 remains
active, verify each step was
completed correctly and proper
decision was made.
Notify supervisor for further action.
Is voltage within specification? No: Replace EBP sensor.
After repairs are complete, retest
for SPN 5543 FMI 4.
Fault Overview
Fault sets when Exhaust Back Pressure Control (EBPC) is less than 25 mA for 100 microseconds when enabled.
Lamp Reaction
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) will illuminate when this fault is detected during two trips.
Associated Faults
SPN 158 FMI 15 and 17
(ECM)
Fault Facts
None
Test 1
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect ACV connector.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4834 to vehicle harness and leave ACV connector disconnected.
D. Key ON Engine OFF (KOEO).
1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES 1299
Test 2
A. Key OFF.
B. Disconnect ACV connector.
C. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4834 to vehicle harness and leave ACV connector disconnected.
D. Key ON Engine OFF (KOEO).
1300 1 DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLESHOOTING PROCEDURES
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1301
Table of Contents
Tests. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1357
KOEO Tests. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1357
KOEO Standard Test. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1357
Output State High or Low. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1359
Continuous Monitor Test. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1361
Injector Test. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1365
KOEO DCU Actuator Test – Actuator Output High and Low Diagnostics. . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1368
Relative Compression Test. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1371
Engine Cranking Test. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1374
Engine Running Tests. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1376
Air Management Test. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1376
KOER Standard Test. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1380
Low to High Idle Test. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1383
KOER DSI System Test. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1385
KOER DSI Deaeration Procedure. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1388
Connecting CPA Tool for HPOP Testing. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1391
Connecting CPA Tool for Misfire Diagnostics. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1402
Injector Misfire Detection Cold Idle Test. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1407
Injector Misfire Detection Signal Check. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1413
Injector Misfire Detection Hot Idle Test. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1421
Injector Misfire Detection Full Load to Highway Speed Test. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1427
CPA Advanced Testing. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1433
CPA High-Pressure Oil Pump (HPOP) Test. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1440
CPA HPOP Signal Test. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1447
Record Snapshot of Engine Running Data. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1464
1302 2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS
Aftertreatment. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1671
Snap Acceleration Test. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1671
Downstream Injection System Operation Test. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1672
1304 2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1305
Overview
This procedure will guide technicians on how to upload and analyze a recorded snapshot using Cylinder
Performance Analyzer (CPA) Snapshot Viewer (SSV).
Special Tools
• Electronic Service Tool (EST) with Navistar® Engine Diagnostics
• Cylinder Performance Analyzer software
• Interface cable (RP1210B-compliant supporting J1939 and J1708)
Equipment Condition
None
Procedure
1. Key ON Engine OFF (KOEO).
2. Connect EST to vehicle Diagnostic Connector. (page 1345).
3. Log in to Navistar® Engine Diagnostics.
4. Start CPA software in Navistar® Engine Diagnostics by selecting Tests > Cylinder Performance Analyzer.
1306 2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS
5. Fill in Dealer location, operator/technician Information and Customer Complaint text fields.
6. Verify Vehicle Data matches information in text fields, then select proceed.
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1307
9. Select Snapshot File folder icon (1), locate desired recorded test file (2) and click OK.
10. Under the Test Type List, select Medium Duty, select corresponding test type, then select “Analyze
Snapshot”.
NOTE: Selecting the incorrect Engine Type and Torque rating will produce false results.
1310 2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS
11. Analyze the data by clicking the fault under Error Name (1) and read the Error Description (2) for further
instruction if fault was found.
NOTE: YELLOW curser (3) can be adjusted and numeric value (4) will displayed.
Expected Outcome
Test will complete successfully and will automatically stop when necessary data has been recorded. Review
test results and return to step-based diagnostics.
Follow-on Procedure
None
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1311
Overview
Navistar® Engine Diagnostics is an Electronic Service Tool (EST) used to run Tests, Procedures, and to Program
features. It can also monitor and record signals from the Engine Control Module (ECM), Doser Control Unit
(DCU), and Aftertreatment Control Module (ACM).
Engine Auto-Detection
Pre 2007 engines can only Auto-Detect at Key-On, Engine-Off (KOEO). The only difference when connecting
with a running engine is most of the parameters will not load. You will notice lot of missing values in the Vehicle
Information window.
Connection (Sniffer)
This area will display all the modules communicating on the Public Controller Area Network (CAN) Network.
Special Tools
• Electronic Service Tool (EST) with Navistar® Engine Diagnostics
• Interface cable (RP1210B-compliant supporting J1939 and J1708)
Equipment Condition
None
1312 2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS
Test Setup
1. Key On, Engine Off (KOEO) will load signals and parameters.
2. Key On, Engine-Running (KOER) will load signals, but will not load parameters.
3. Connect Electronic Service Tool (EST) to vehicle Diagnostic Connector .
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1313
NOTE: If Navistar® Engine Diagnostics displays the Engine selection window (Figure 401), it was unable
to Auto- Detect. The Engine Control Module (ECM) or the Public Controller Area Network (CAN) to the
Data Link connector maybe at fault.
1314 2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS
2. Click on the Stop Logging Watched Signals button (Figure 403) to stop the recording.
3. Snapshot recording will be saved in the Snapshot folder (Figure 404) located on your computers desktop.
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1315
1. Open previously recorded snapshot, Click on the Open Snapshot Recording File (Figure 405) from the
File Menu.
2. Select the desired recording you wish to open.
1316 2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS
3. Once the recording is open (Figure 406), you can select any signal you wish to show up in the graph.
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1317
DTC Type:
The fault type, or fault status, will consist of one of the following: Pending, Active, or Previously Active. HD-OBD
software monitors the system many times during a drive cycle or trip. Continuously monitoring the system allows
for trouble codes to be viewed at different status levels. When a 2 trip failure is detected once, a freeze frame
is stored, and the code status is displayed as Pending. Malfunction Indicator Light (MIL) will be illuminate when
the failure is detected a second time, and the code status will change to Active. The code status will remain
Active until the 3 consecutive trips happen without a fault detected. After the three trips are completed, the MIL
will turn off and the code status will change to Previously Active. It will take 40 trips to remove the Previously
Active code and freeze frame from the vehicles history. If at any time during Previously Active status, the system
monitor detects a failure again, the code status will immediately change to Active and clearing process begins
again.
Pending DTC
Pending Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC)s are possible faults that were detected on the first trip. Pending
HD-OBD faults do not turn on the MIL.
Active DTC
There are 3 types of Active DTCs: Non HD-OBD faults, 1 trip and 2 trip HD-OBD.
• Active Non HD-OBD faults go active on the first trip and do not turn on the MIL. Non HD-OBD faults may
not illuminate any lamps or may illuminate the Red Stop Lamp (RSL) or Amber Warning Lamp (AWL). Non
HD-OBD faults require only require 1 trip without detecting the fault code to clear.
• Active HD-OBD 1 trip faults turn on the Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) immediately when the fault is
detected. HD-OBD 1 Trip faults require a specific drive cycle to monitor for the fault code.
• Active HD-OBD 2 drive cycle faults turn on the MIL after detecting a fault on 2 consecutive drive cycles.
HD-OBD 2 Trip faults require a specific drive cycle to monitor for the fault code.
1318 2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS
DTC Count
DTC Count logs the amount of times the fault was detected.
Freeze Frame
Freeze Frame data is a snapshot of the engines operating condition at the time the fault was detected.
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1319
Procedure:
Navistar® Engine Diagnostics will update DTC status every 10 seconds and will check for DTCs as soon as the
Refresh DTC / Vehicle Events button (Figure 408) is pressed.
1320 2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS
Session Files
Overview
Navistar® Engine Diagnostics has a variety of Sessions; Signal Monitoring, Engine Programming and Testing.
Tests and Procedures will automatically load pre-made default sessions. Technicians are not limited to using
pre-made default sessions. Sessions (Figure 409) can be built or modified, saved and loaded (Figure 410) at
any time. A saved session can be use to run a Test as long as the check mark is removed from the Load Test
Specific Session (Figure 411) before running the test.
Purpose
Check for failed aftertreatment system temperature sensor.
Special Tools
• Electronic Service Tool (EST) with Navistar® Engine Diagnostics
• Interface cable (RP1210B compliant supporting J1939 and J1708)
This test is not dependent on engine temperature.
1. Turn ignition switch to ON position.
2. Connect Electronic Service Tool (EST) with Navistar® Engine Diagnostics to vehicle’s diagnostic connector.
WARNING:
To prevent personal injury or death, shift transmission to park or neutral, set parking
brake, and block wheels before doing diagnostic or service procedures.
4. Start and run engine at 1400 to 1500 rpm for 10 minutes.
5. Monitor the following signals in the All Signals tab:
Compare the following three signals:
• Diesel Oxidation Catalyst (DOC) Inlet Temperature
• Diesel Particulate Filter (DPF) Inlet Temperature
• DPF Outlet Temperature
After 10 minutes, if any of these three aftertreatment temperature sensors are not within 77°F (43°C) of each
other, diagnose appropriate sensor and / or circuit.
1324 2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS
Overview
Connect Electronic Service Tool (EST) to vehicle and generate a Health Report of current vehicle information:
• Vehicle Identification Number (VIN) validation
• Vehicle mileage
• Engine hours
• Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC)
• Engine Control Module (ECM) calibration
• Fuel economy data
Special Tools
PocketMaxx™, EST with International Graphical User Interface, or International® EZ-Tech Launcher
Equipment Condition
None
Test Setup
None
Procedure
1. Key-On, Engine-Off (KOEO).
2. Connect interface cable between PocketMaxx™, EST, or EZ-tech Launcher and to vehicle Diagnostic
Connector (page 1345).
3. Use PocketMaxx™, EST, or EZ-tech Launcher to retrieve a vehicle Health Report.
4. Connect to internet and upload Health Report to International® Service Portal.
5. Verify Health Report is visible on International® Service Portal. Select: Write Up > Vehicle Information.
Expected Outcome
Current vehicle Health Report is viewable on International® Service Portal.
Follow-On Procedure
None
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1325
Programmable Features
Overview
Many features can be programmed into the Engine Control Module (ECM) to fit many different applications. To
make programming changes using Navistar® Engine Diagnostics, load the Programming session.
Special Tools
• Electronic Service Tool (EST) with Navistar® Engine Diagnostics
• Interface cable (RP1210B-compliant supporting J1939 and J1708)
Equipment Condition
None
1326 2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS
Test Setup
1. Key-On, Engine-Off (KOEO)
2. Connect Electronic Service Tool (EST) to vehicle Diagnostic Connector (page 1345).
3. Log in to Navistar® Engine Diagnostics.
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1327
Procedure
4. Turn ignition Key-Off for 15 seconds, so new value change be saved into the module (Figure 417).
5. Turn Key-On.
6. Clear Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC)s, if any.
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1329
Expected Outcome
None
Follow-On Procedure
None
1330 2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS
Overview
Record Key-On, Engine-Off (KOEO) data to be referenced now, and in the future.
Special Tools
• Electronic Service Tool (EST) with Navistar® Engine Diagnostics
• Interface cable (RP1210B-compliant supporting J1939 and J1708)
Equipment Condition
Do not crank or run engine for 3 minutes or more. This will allow Injection Control Pressure (ICP) to bleed off.
Test Setup
1. Key-On.
2. Connect Electronic Service Tool (EST) to vehicle Diagnostic Connector (page 1345).
3. Log in to Navistar® Engine Diagnostics.
Procedure
1. Select: Sessions > Default.
2. Cycle ignition Key Off, then On.
NOTE: Fuel pump will run for 10 seconds after the ignition key is cycled.
3. Select: Tools > Start Recording Snapshot.
4. Wiggle harness connections on the Under Valve Cover (UVC) harness for ICP connector, ICP harness, and
36-pin Engine Control Module (ECM) connector.
5. Select: Tools > Stop Recording Snapshot.
Expected Outcome
KOEO values will be within specification.
Follow-On Procedure
None
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1331
Overview
An Onboard Filter Cleanliness Test (OBFCT) cleans the DPF while allowing monitoring of the the Aftertreatment
system.
WARNING:
To prevent personal injury or death, set parking brake, shift transmission to park or
neutral, and block wheels.
Special Tools
• Electronic Service Tool (EST) with Navistar® Engine Diagnostics
• Interface cable (RP1210B-compliant supporting J1939 and J1708)
Equipment Condition
1. Regen Inhibit switch Off.
2. Engine Coolant Temperature above 122°F (50°C).
3. Accelerator Pedal Position (APP) 0% (pedal released).
4. Break switch released.
5. Parking break set.
6. Clutch switch released.
Test Setup
1. Key-On Engine-Off (KOEO).
2. Connect Electronic Service Tool (EST) to vehicle Diagnostic Connector (page 1345).
3. Log in to Navistar® Engine Diagnostics.
Procedure
1. Start engine and allow engine coolant temperature to reach above 158°F (70°C).
2. Perform KOER Standard Test.
3. Select KOER Aftertreatment Tests > Onboard Filter Cleanliness Test from Test drop down menu.
1332 2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS
4. Verify DPF Regeneration Procedure entry conditions are met and DPF regeneration inhibitors (Figure 418)
are not inhibited.
If regen inhibitors are displayed as inhibited, refer to Check Regen Inhibitors (page 1333) table.
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1333
5. Engine Speed will ramp up to increase exhaust flow through DPF. Procedure will run for 20 minutes and will
not display pass or fail results.
Expected Outcome
Exhaust temperature will rise and soot load will decrease.
Follow-On Procedure
None
1334 2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS
Overview
Injector Coil End Of Motion (CEOM) corrects aging effect of fuel injector on fuel quantity. Over time injectors
inject less fuel due to injectors wearing. CEOM measures this wear and adds fuel back in to make it work like
new. When a new injector is installed in the engine, CEOM should be reset so it does not add too much fuel to
the engine.
NOTE: Only reset CEOM of injector being replaced.
Special Tools
• Electronic Service Tool (EST) with Navistar® Engine Diagnostics
• Interface cable (RP1210B-compliant supporting J1939 and J1708)
Equipment Condition
Key-On Engine-Off (KOEO)
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1335
Test Setup
Procedure
1. Select Injector CEOM Reset (Figure 420) from the KOEO Procedures drop-down menu.
2. Only reset the injector (Figure 421) that was replaced to prevent any injection imbalance.
Expected Outcome
Results
• Not Properly Measured: Displayed after selected injector has been reset and vehicle needs to be run to set
new values.
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1337
• Properly Measured: Displayed after engine has run long enough to calculate proper fuel quantity for the
new injector.
1338 2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS
Overview
This procedure is used to reset the Engine Control Module’s (ECM) injector coking compensation strategy after
replacing injectors.
Special Tools
• Electronic Service Tool (EST) with Navistar® Engine Diagnostics
• Interface cable (RP1210B-compliant supporting J1939 and J1708)
Equipment Condition
None.
Test Setup
1. Key-On Engine-Off (KOEO).
2. Connect Electronic Service Tool (EST) to vehicle Diagnostic Connector (page 1345).
3. Start and log in to Navistar® Engine Diagnostics.
Procedure
3. Change value of 63001 Mode 1: Time factor for coking accumulation, 63011 Mode 2: Time factor for coking
accumulation, 63021 Mode 3: Time factor for coking accumulation to zero.
Expected Outcome
Engine will program successfully and the injector coking accumulation will reset.
Follow-On Procedure
None
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1341
Overview
Engine Control Module (ECM) maintains reliability of Fuel Rail Pressure (FRP) system as parts age by storing
Fuel Pressure Adaptation (FPA) values.When any fuel system part is replaced: [Engine Injection Pressure
Regulator (IPR) valve, Injection Control Pressure (ICP) sensor, high-pressure pump, high-pressure rail, or ECM],
this parameter must be reset.
NOTE: For vehicles equipped with a 405HP MaxxForce 10, the Fuel Pressure Adaptation Reset must be
performed by a Navistar dealer with the assistance of Navistar Technician Services. PP99502 is not available
and cannot be programmed by any access level of NED users on vehicles with a 405HP calibration.
Special Tools
• Electronic Service Tool (EST) with Navistar® Engine Diagnostics
• Interface cable (J1939 - compliant)
Equipment Condition
One of the following components was replaced:
1. Engine Injection Control Pressure Regulator (IPR)
2. Injection Control Pressure (ICP) sensor
3. High-pressure pump
4. High-pressure rail
5. Engine Control Module (ECM)
1342 2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS
Test Setup
1. Key-On, Engine-Off (KOEO).
2. Connect Electronic Service Tool (EST) to vehicle Diagnostic Connector (page 1345).
3. Start Navistar® Engine Diagnostics.
Procedure
1. Replace failed part.
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1343
2. Select Fuel Pressure Adaptation Reset from KOEO Procedure (Figure 426) drop down menu.
Follow-On Procedure
None
1344 2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS
Overview
Use this test to diagnose inactive and/or intermittent faults. Inactive and/or intermittent faults are currently
healing, previously active, or inactive.
NOTE: For component faults that are pending or active, follow specific step based diagnostics for fault.
NOTE: Permanent faults are historic faults and are used for reporting purposes only. They should never be
treated as a current issue or used for diagnostics.
Special Tools
• Electronic Service Tool (EST) with Navistar® Engine Diagnostics
• J1939–compliant interface cable
Equipment Condition
None
Test Setup
1. Key-On, Engine-Off (KOEO).
2. Connect Electronic Service Tool (EST) to vehicle Diagnostic Connector (page 1345).
3. Log in to Navistar® Engine Diagnostics.
Procedure
1. Verify health report was saved. Clear fault codes.
2. Perform Continuous Monitor Test (page 1361)and view voltage signal for suspect sensor.
• The Continuous Monitor Test will have you watch for voltage signal spikes while wiggling affected
harness and connections.
• A voltage spike while performing continuous monitor wiggle test indicates a damaged harness and/or
connector pin.
NOTE: During continuous monitor wiggle test, if a fault code sets (high or low), voltage will latch high or low. To
continue performing continuous monitor wiggle test, faults will need to be cleared.
3. If a voltage spike or fault occurs during continuous monitor wiggle test start from the point the voltage spike
occurred and inspect harness for rubbing, and inspect nearby connectors for pin damage, corrosion, fretting,
etc.
Expected Outcome
The source of the intermittent / inactive fault will be isolated.
Follow-On Procedure
None
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1345
If cable is not at fault, see J1939 Data Link Error (ECM unable to transmit) (page 518) .
1348 2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS
NOTE: If software has connected to the ECM, active signals will populate startup screen, and ECM
connected icon in bottom right corner will show connected.
NOTE: When software is unable to connect to ECM, signals and vehicle information will not be displayed,
and ECM disconnected icon in bottom right corner will show disconnected.
If software is unable to connect to ECM, go to Interface Device Selection (page 1345) section, above.
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1349
Figure 438 ECM (Engine Control Module) 180 Pin Breakout Harness Overlay
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1355
Figure 439 ACM (Aftertreatment Control Module) 180 Pin Breakout Harness Overlay
1356 2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS
Tests
KOEO Tests
KOEO Standard Test
Overview
The Key-On, Engine-Off (KOEO) Standard Test will command Engine Control Module (ECM) actuators to their
high state and low state. This test must be run before running other KOEO Tests: Output State Test High, Low,
and Intake Air Heater Test.
Special Tools
• Electronic Service Tool (EST) with Navistar® Engine Diagnostics
• Interface cable (RP1210B-compliant supporting J1939 and J1708)
Equipment Condition
None
Test Setup
1. Key-On, Engine-Off (KOEO).
2. Connect Electronic Service Tool (EST) to vehicle Diagnostic Connector (page 1345).
3. Start and log in to Navistar® Engine Diagnostics.
Procedure
1. Select: Tests > KOEO Tests > Standard Test. (Figure 441).
NOTE: This test does not display pass or fail results and will display test complete when finished.
1358 2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS
Expected Outcome
Test will complete without fault codes setting or problems occurring.
Follow-On Procedure
None
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1359
Overview
The Key-On, Engine-Off (KOEO) Output State Test High or Low will command actuators to their high or low
position. This test allows users to diagnose actuator movement by commanding actuators high or low and
monitoring signals in Navistar® Engine Diagnostics or using a multimeter to measure circuits and also to visually
monitor movement on some actuators. This test does not display pass or fail results and user will need to cancel
test before running any other test. The KOEO Standard Test must be performed before this test is allowed to
run.
Special Tools
• Digital Multimeter (DMM)
• Electronic Service Tool (EST) with Navistar® Engine Diagnostics
• Interface cable (RP1210B-compliant supporting J1939 and J1708)
Equipment Condition
None
Test Setup
1. Key-On, Engine-Off (KOEO).
2. Connect Electronic Service Tool (EST) to vehicle Diagnostic Connector (page 1345).
3. Log in to Navistar® Engine Diagnostics
Procedure
1. Perform KOEO Standard Test (page 1357).
1360 2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS
2. Once test is complete, select Tests > KOEO Tests > Output State High Test (Figure 444) or select Tests >
KOEO Tests > Output State Low Test (Figure 443).
3. Monitor signals, verify visual movement or make measurements as needed.
4. Allow test to run for a minimum of 30 seconds before stopping testing.
Expected Outcome
Actuators will cycle to their high or low state as commanded; signals will show the command to high or low state
and remain steady while test is active.
Follow-On Procedure
None
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1361
Overview
The Continuous Monitoring – Intermittent Sensor Diagnostics test is used to detect sensor intermittent faults.
During this test, sensor voltages are continuously monitored. This test provides a graphical view of all signals
and allows the technician to detect intermittent spiking or monetary loss of signal. Perform this test while wiggling
connectors, wiring, and harnesses of the suspected faulty component.
NOTE: A sensor fault that goes out of range high or low will cause the voltage signal to display Error. The
Continuous Monitor Test will force all sensor voltage to display actual voltages.
NOTE: This test does not work on early calibrations. Out of Range HIGH and Out of Range LOW faults will
display during this test until early 2015.
Special Tools
• Electronic Service Tool (EST) with Navistar® Engine Diagnostics
• Interface cable (RP1210B-compliant supporting J1939 and J1708)
Equipment Condition
None
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1363
Test Setup
1. Key-On, Engine-Off (KOEO).
2. Connect Electronic Service Tool (EST) to Vehicle Diagnostic Connector (page 1345).
3. Log in to Navistar® Engine Diagnostics.
Procedure
1. Select: Tests > KOEO Tests > Continuous Monitor Test (Figure 446) from drop down menu.
2. Monitor suspect voltage signal while wiggling the wiring harness and connectors. If the circuit is interrupted,
the signal will spike.
3. Test will run until cancelled by pressing the Stop test button (Figure 448).
Follow-on Procedure
None
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1365
Injector Test
Overview
Verify all 6 injectors are being electronically activated by the Engine Control Module (ECM). This test will activate
all injectors at the same time, then active each individual injector in order (1, 2, 3, 4, 5 and 6) for 2 seconds with
a 1 second pause in between. This is an audible test only (audible buzz sound) and will not activate any other
codes.
Special Tools
• Electronic Service Tool (EST) with Navistar® Engine Diagnostics
• Interface cable (RP1210B-compliant supporting J1939 and J1708)
Equipment Condition
None
Test Setup
1. Key-On, Engine-Off (KOEO).
2. Connect Electronic Service Tool (EST) to vehicle Diagnostic Connector (page 1345).
3. Log in to Navistar® Engine Diagnostics.
Procedure
NOTE: The Key-On, Engine-Off (KOEO) Standard Test must be run before running this test.
1. Select: Tests > KOEO Tests > Standard Test (Figure 449) .
1366 2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS
NOTE: This is an audible test only and does not load a special session.
2. Select: Injector Test (Figure 450) from drop-down menu.
3. Check fuel injectors for the following while test is active:
• Do not rapidly cycle (buzz)
• Make a single or few “clicks” and stop
• Are faint in sound as compared to other 5 injectors
• Exhibit an irregular or inconsistent rhythm
• Are activated out of order (correct order is 1 through 6 sequentially)
If any of the above conditions are present, go to next step.
If none of the above conditions are present, end diagnostic steps.
NOTE: This test does not display pass or fail results and will display test complete (Figure 451) when finished.
4. Remove valve cover (see Engine Service Manual).
5. Unplug first injector of suspect bank.
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1367
6. Cycle ignition key, and then select Injector Test from drop-down menu to repeat test.
• If two remaining injectors in suspect bank buzz, the unplugged injector has failed.
• If no injectors buzz, go to next step.
7. Reconnect first injector and disconnect next injector in same bank.
8. Cycle key, and then select Injector Test from drop-down menu to repeat test.
• Repeat steps 7 through 8 until failed injector is found.
Expected Outcome
Test will complete successfully, and audible buzz will be heard from each injector.
Follow-on Procedure
None
1368 2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS
KOEO DCU Actuator Test – Actuator Output High and Low Diagnostics
Overview
The Key-On, Engine Off (KOEO) Doser Control Unit (DCU) Actuator test will enable the technician to cycle any
actuator high or low. Some actuators have variable positions. A technician can use a Digital Multimeter (DMM) to
measure changes in voltage or duty cycle, or visually monitor actuator movement while actuator is commanded.
Special Tools
• Electronic Service Tool (EST) with Navistar® Engine Diagnostics.
• Interface cable (RP1210B-compliant supporting J1939 and J1708)
Test Setup
1. Key-On, Engine-Off (KOEO).
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1369
2. Connect Electronic Service Tool (EST) to vehicle Diagnostic Connector (page 1345).
3. Start Navistar® Engine Diagnostics.
Procedure
1. Select: Tests > KOEO Aftertreatment Tests > Actuator > DCU Actuators (Figure 453).
7. Actuator will cycle to commanded position for 5 seconds, before the Test Completed Successful (Figure
455) notification is displayed.
NOTE: This test does not display pass or fail results.
Expected Outcome
The test will complete successfully.
Follow-On Procedure
None
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1371
Overview
Measures cylinder balance to determine cylinder integrity. Test results are presented in graphical or numerical
displays. Graphs or numbers should be approximately the same, indicating well balanced and equal cylinders.
Special Tools
• Electronic Service Tool (EST) with Navistar® Engine Diagnostics
• Interface cable (RP1210B-compliant supporting J1939 and J1708)
Test Setup
1. Key-On, Engine-Off (KOEO).
1372 2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS
2. Connect Electronic Service Tool (EST) to vehicle Diagnostic Connector (page 1345).
3. Log in to Navistar® Engine Diagnostics.
4. Batteries must be charged (Use Battery charger if necessary).
Procedure
1. Select: Tests > KOEO Tests > Relative Compression Test (Figure 457).
3. Results are measured on the down travel of each cylinder's power stroke (Figure 459). A cylinder with low
compression will be significantly lower then the others.
Expected Outcome
Test will complete successfully
Follow-On Procedure
None
1374 2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS
Overview
Monitors engine systems as engine is cranked to determine if systems are able to meet minimum starting
requirements.
Special Tools
• Electronic Service Tool (EST) with Navistar® Engine Diagnostics
• Interface Cable (RP1210B compliant supporting J1939 and J1708)
Equipment Condition
None
Test Setup
1. Key On, Engine Off (KOEO).
2. Connect Electronic Service Tool (EST) to vehicle Diagnostic Connector (page 1345).
3. Log in to Navistar® Engine Diagnostics.
Procedure
1. Select Sessions > Default.
2. Select Start Recording Snapshot.
3. Crank engine for 10 seconds.
4. Select Stop Recording Snapshot.
5. Verify the following signals meet specification:
Signals:
• Diesel Particulate Filter Differential Pressure (DPFDP)
• Engine Speed (RPM)
• Exhaust Back Pressure (EBP)
• Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) Position
• Fuel Delivery Pressure (FDP)
• Injection Control Pressure (ICP)
• Injection Pressure Regulator (IPR) Control (Ctrl)
• Turbocharger 1 Turbine Outlet Pressure (TC1TOP)
• Switch Battery (SWBAT)
Expected Outcome
All signal values meet specification.
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1375
Follow-on Procedure
None
1376 2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS
Overview
Evaluates air management system by monitoring effects Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) valve position
changes have on Intake Manifold Pressure (IMP). IMP is normally 2 psi (14 kPa) or more during Air
Management Test engine ramp up (EGR valve closed). If the air management system is not operating
properly, IMP and Mass Air Flow (MAF) Mean Value will not change properly when changes in EGR valve
position are commanded. When this occurs, excess soot will be generated causing frequent regeneration of
the aftertreatment system. The recorded snapshot of the Air Management Test can also be analyzed using
Cylinder Performance Analyzer (CPA) Snapshot Viewer (SSV).
Special Tools
• Electronic Service Tool (EST) with Navistar® Engine Diagnostics
• Interface cable (RP1210B-compliant supporting J1939 and J1708)
Equipment Conditions
None
Test Setup
1. Key-On, Engine-Running (KOER).
2. Connect Electronic Service Tool (EST) to vehicle Diagnostic Connector (page 1345).
3. Log in to Navistar® Engine Diagnostics.
4. Run engine until Engine Coolant Temperature 1 (ECT1) is above 158°F (70°C).
Procedure
1. Select: Tests > KOER Tests > Standard Test (page 1380).
2. After Standard Test is complete, select: Tests > KOER Tests > Air Management Test.
3. Select: Start Recording Snapshot.
4. After Air Management Test is complete select: Stop Recording Snapshot.
5. If CPA software is available, go to CPA Snapshot Viewer (page 1305) to use SSV to analyze the snapshot.
6. Select: Open Snapshot Recording File.
7. Select and Open Air Management Test previously recorded.
8. Select the Graph box for: EGR position, Intake Manifold Pressure, and MAF Mean Value.
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1377
NOTE: EGR valve position will never read less than 35% and is considered closed.
9. Compare Air Management System Graph (Bad) (Figure 461) and Air Management System Graph (Good)
(Figure 462) with recorded snapshot.
10. Determine if Intake Manifold Pressure (1) and MAF Mean Value (2) drop when the EGR valve is commanded
open. In Air Management System Graph (Bad) Intake Manifold Pressure and MAF Mean Value do not drop
when the EGR valve is commanded open.
1378 2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS
11. Determine if intake manifold pressure is appropriate. Is Intake Manifold Pressure (EGRV closed) (5) 2 psi or
more, and is IMP spike (EGRV closed to open) (6) 1.5 psi or more above Intake Manifold Pressure (EGRV
closed)?
12. Determine vehicles Rated Power listed in Navistar® Engine Diagnostics Vehicle Information tab on the default
page.
13. Determine if MAF Mean Value difference is within specification: subtract MAF Mean Value low point (EGRV
open) (7) from MAF Mean Value high point (EGRV closed) (4) and compare to MAF Mean Value Difference
table.
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1379
Expected Outcome
Determine if IMP and MAF Mean Value change appropriately when EGR valve is commanded open.
A. Determine if Intake Manifold Pressure is appropriate.
B. Determine if MAF Mean Value Difference is within specification.
Follow-On Procedure
None
1380 2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS
Overview
The Key-On, Engine-Running (KOER) Standard Test verifies performance of the Injection Control Pressure
(ICP) System. During this test, engine speed increases to 1500 RPM and the Engine Control Module (ECM)
commands the Injection Pressure Regulator (IPR) valve to control ICP. The ECM will command 4000 psi, then
1000 psi thru the ICP Desired signal. The ECM monitors the ICP sensor (Actual pressure) to validate the
system’s ability to meet ICP desired.
Special Tools
• Electronic Service Tool (EST) with Navistar® Engine Diagnostics
• J1939-Compliant Interface Cable
Equipment Conditions
1. Engine speed at low idle (700 rpm)
2. Engine Coolant Temperature 1 (above 158°F 70°C)
3. Vehicle Not Moving
4. Accelerator Pedal Position (0%)
5. Brake Pedal (Released)
6. Clutch Pedal (Released)
7. Engine brake switch (OFF)
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1381
Test Setup
Procedure
1. Select: Tests > KOER Tests > Standard Test (Figure 464).
2. This test does not display pass or fail results and will display test complete (Figure 465) when finished.
Expected Outcome
Test will complete successfully.
Follow-On Procedure
None
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1383
Overview
This test is used to validate engine performance throughout its full rpm range. By monitoring specific signals,
this test helps identify which systems are not performing as expected. Using information gathered, it assists
with further diagnostics.
Special Tools
• Electronic Service Tool (EST) with Navistar® Engine Diagnostics
• Interface cable (RP1210B-compliant supporting J1939 and J1708)
Equipment Condition
None
Test Setup
1. Key On, Engine Off (KOEO).
2. Connect Electronic Service Tool (EST) to vehicle Diagnostic Connector (page 1345).
3. Log in to Navistar® Engine Diagnostics.
Procedure
1. Select Sessions > Default.
2. Press accelerator pedal to floor while monitoring the Accelerator Pedal Position (APP) signal value.
3. If APP signal consistently reads from 0 to approximately 99.6% continue test. If APP system is not consistent,
repair APP system as needed before continuing test.
4. In Navistar® Engine Diagnostics software, select Start Recording.
5. Start engine and idle for 20 seconds.
6. Press and hold accelerator pedal to floor for 20 seconds while listening and feeling for engine problems
such as:
• Engine does not accelerate smoothly
• Imbalance or vibrations
• Cylinders not firing or cylinders misfiring
7. Return to low idle.
8. Select Stop Recording and check the following signals against specifications:
• Fuel Delivery Pressure (FDP)
• Injection Control Pressure (ICP)
• Exhaust Back Pressure (EBP)
• Intake Manifold Pressure (IMP)
• Diesel Particulate Filter Differential Pressure (DPFDP)
9. If any signal does not meet specifications, diagnose that system in appropriate section or manual.
1384 2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS
Expected Outcome
Engine will accelerate smoothly, all signals will be within specifications, and no imbalance or misfire will be
detected.
Follow-On Procedure
None
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1385
Overview
The Key-On, Engine-Running (KOER) Down Stream Injection (DSI) System Test can be used to validate
performance of the DSI system.
Special Tools
• Electronic Service Tool (EST) with Navistar® Engine Diagnostics
• Interface cable (RP1210B-compliant, supporting J1939 and J1708)
1386 2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS
Equipment Conditions
NOTE: The conditions below are shown how they should be displayed on Navistar® Engine Diagnostics screen.
1. Engine speed (below 700 RPM).
2. Engine speed (below 700 RPM).
3. Accelerator pedal position (0%).
4. Brake pedal (Release).
5. Clutch pedal (Release).
Test Setup
1. Key On, Engine Off (KOEO).
2. Connect Electronic Service Tool (EST) to Vehicle Diagnostic Connector (page 1345).
3. Start and log in to Navistar® Engine Diagnostics.
Procedure
1. Select: KOER Aftertreatment Tests > DSI System Test (Figure 467).
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1387
2. This test will help validate DSI system performance (Figure 468), by cycling the AFT Fuel Shutoff (AFTFSO)
and Aftertreatment Fuel Doser (AFTFD), while monitoring effects on Aftertreatment Fuel Pressure 1
(AFTFP1) and Aftertreatment Fuel Pressure 2 (AFTFP2) sensors.
Expected Outcome
Determine if DSI systems are operating properly.
Follow-On Procedure
None
1388 2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS
Overview
The Key-On, Engine-Running (KOER) Down Stream Injection (DSI) Deaeration Procedure can be used to purge
air from the system after the fuel system was opened from a previous repair.
Special Tools
• Electronic Service Tool (EST) with Navistar® Engine Diagnostics
• Interface cable (RP1210B-compliant supporting J1939 and J1708)
Equipment Condition
NOTE: The conditions below are shown as they should be displayed on the Navistar® Engine Diagnostics screen.
1. Engine speed (below 700 RPM)
2. Vehicle not moving
3. Accelerator Pedal Position (APP) (0%)
4. Brake pedal released
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1389
Test Setup
1. Key-On, Engine-Off (KOEO).
2. Connect Electronic Service Tool (EST) to vehicle Diagnostic Connector (page 1345).
3. Key-On. Log in to Navistar® Engine Diagnostics.
1390 2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS
Procedure
1. Select: KOER Aftertreatment Procedures > DSI System De-Aeration (Figure 470) .
2. The procedure will cycle the AFT Fuel Shutoff (AFTFSO) and Aftertreatment Fuel Doser (AFTFD) to purge
air from the system.
3. This procedure does not display pass or fail results and will display Test Completed, Successful (Figure 471)
when finished.
Expected Outcome
Key-On, Engine-Running (KOER) test will complete without any problems occurring.
Follow-On Procedure
None
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1391
Overview
The Cylinder Performance Analyzer (CPA) Tool is a four-channel oscilloscope used to detect faults in various
electronically controlled components. This section describes connecting the CPA Tool for High-Pressure Oil
Pump (HPOP) system testing.
WARNING:
To prevent damage to property, personal injury and / or death, never allow metal sensor
tee harness connectors (BNC Connector) or CPA tool ports to contact metal, other sensor
tee harness connectors, or ground.
CAUTION:
To prevent damage to property, do not store CPA tool in the engine compartment.
Exterior damage may adversely affect tool functionality and cause flawed test results.
CAUTION:
To prevent damage to property, secure Cylinder Performance Analyzer (CPA) tool and
test cables away from hot or moving parts and sources of radio frequency interference
with cable ties while performing tests.
Special Tools
• Electronic Service Tool (EST) with Navistar® Engine Diagnostics and CPA software (V7.1.8.12 or higher).
• Interface cable (RP1210B-compliant supporting J1939 and J1708)
• Cylinder Performance Analyzer (CPA) Tool Kit 12-999-01
• Engine Oil Temperature (EOT) Breakout Harness ZTSE4602
• IPR Blockoff Adapter with Integrated ICP Sensor Kit 12-999-01-07
• IPR Valve Breakout Harness 12-800-02 or ZTSE4484
• IPR Valve Socket 12-800-01
Equipment Condition
Depending on truck model, it may be necessary to remove the following to properly connect and safely route
test cables into cab.
1. Driverside inner fender
2. Quarter fenders
3. Passenger-side inner fender
1392 2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS
1. Connect CPA Module 12-999-01-01 to Electronic Service Tool (EST) using supplied USB cable.
2. Disconnect engine harness from CMP sensor (2) and install Yellow Cam Sensor Harness (1) between
CMP sensor and engine harness.
WARNING:
To prevent damage to property, personal injury and / or death, do not drive vehicle with
CPA Tool attached unless CPA cables are attached to CPA Tool. Doing so may cause the
engine to stall without warning.
WARNING:
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1393
To prevent damage to property, personal injury and / or death, do not disturb, unplug,
or ground BNC connectors while vehicle is moving. Doing so may cause engine to stall
without warning.
WARNING:
To prevent damage to property, personal injury and / or death, never allow BNC
connectors or metal CPA ports to contact metal or ground. Doing so may cause engine
to stall without warning.
3. If equipped, turn both CPA Module signal adjustment knobs as far clockwise as possible.
4. Connect Yellow Cam Sensor Harness 2-pin connector to CPA module CAM SENSOR port (2) of CPA
Module (3) using CPA extension harness 12-999-01-05 (1). Route cable safely and securely behind
main drive belt on driver-side of vehicle to prevent damage.
5. Disconnect engine harness from Engine Oil Temperature (EOT) sensor and install EOT Breakout
Harness ZTSE4602 between engine harness and EOT sensor.
6. Connect 2-pin CPA banana jack Breakout Harness 12-999-01-06 to EOT Breakout Harness (EOT pin-1
to black end of banana jack and EOT pin-2 to red end of banana jack.)
7. Connect CPA Extension Harness to 2-pin CPA banana jack.
1394 2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS
Figure 474 High-Pressure Oil Pump (HPOP) Test Breakout Harness 12-999-01-04
1. Engine Oil Pressure (EOP)
Signal to CPA Extension
Harness (BLUE)
2. Connection to EOP Sensor
Engine Harness Connector
3. ICP UCV signal to CPA
extension harness (RED)
4. Connection to UVC Connector
(EPA 2010 MaxxForce® DT, 9
and 10, N9, and N10)
5. Connection to UVC Connector
(EPA 2007 MaxxForce® DT, 9
and 10)
6. Connection to Test ICP Sensor
(only used during high-pressure
pump dead-head test)
7. Connection to EOP Sensor
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1395
10. Connect HPOP Test Breakout harness between EOP Sensor (7) and EOP engine harness connector
(2).
11. Use Extension Harness 12-999-01-05 to connect EOP signal cable (BLUE) (1) to SENSOR 4 port of
CPA Tool.
12. Disconnect BEIGE ICP UVC engine harness connector (1) from ICP UVC connector (2).
13. Connect HPOP Test Breakout Harness to IPC UVC connector (2) and leave engine harness (1)
disconnected.
1396 2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS
14. Use Extension Harness 12-999-01-05 to connect ICP UVC signal cable (RED) (3) to SENSOR 3 port
of CPA Tool.
15. Disconnect either remaining three IPC UVC injector connectors (1) or ECM 36-pin connector, whichever
is more accessible by truck configuration. Injectors will remain disconnected for HPOP tests.
16. Return to CPA High-Pressure Oil Pump (HPOP) Test (page 1440) and continue testing.
3. Compare IPR valve connector configuration to ZTSE4484 and 12-800-02 connector ends and select
appropriate breakout harness.
1398 2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS
4. Connect correct IPR Breakout Harness to IPR valve and leave engine harness disconnected.
CAUTION:
To prevent damage to property, do not leave IPR fully fielded for more than 5 minutes.
CAUTION:
To prevent damage to property, do not connect engine harness to IPR Breakout Tee.
5. Connect 12 volts and ground to IPR Breakout Harness.
6. Return to CPA High-Pressure Oil Pump (HPOP) Test (page 1440) and follow CPA tool on-screen
instructions to perform Test 2: IPR Full Fielded.
4. Install Dead Head Plug (2) onto high-pressure oil hose (1).
• Oil leaks at high-pressure oil hose will cause test errors.
5. Return to CPA High-Pressure Oil Pump (HPOP) Test (page 1440) and follow CPA tool on-screen
instructions to perform Test 4: Pump Deadhead.
Expected Outcome
Cylinder Performance Analyzer (CPA) tool will be properly connected to perform HPOP testing.
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1401
Follow-on Procedure
Perform CPA High-Pressure Oil Pump (HPOP) Test (page 1440).
1402 2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS
Overview
Cylinder Performance Analyzer (CPA) Tool is a four-channel oscilloscope used to detect faults in various
electronically controlled components. This section describes connecting CPA Tool for misfire diagnostics
system testing.
WARNING:
To prevent damage to property, personal injury and / or death, never allow the metal
sensor tee harness connectors (BNC Connector) or the Cylinder Performance Analyzer
(CPA) tool ports to contact metal, other sensor tee harness connectors, or ground.
CAUTION:
To prevent property damage, do not store the CPA tool in the engine compartment. Any
exterior damage may adversely affect the functionality of the tool and cause flawed test
results.
CAUTION:
To prevent property damage, secure the Cylinder Performance Analyzer (CPA) tool
and test cables away from hot or moving parts and any sources of radio frequency
interference with cable ties while performing tests.
Special Tools
• Electronic Service Tool (EST) with Navistar® Engine Diagnostics
• Interface cable (RP1210B-compliant supporting J1939 and J1708)
• Cylinder Performance Analyzer (CPA) Tool Kit 12-999-01
Equipment Condition
Depending on truck model, it may be necessary to remove the following to properly connect and safely route
test cables into cab.
1. Driverside inner fender
2. Quarter fenders
3. Passenger-side inner fender
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1403
Test Setup
1. Key-Off.
2. Connect Electronic Service Tool (EST) to vehicle Diagnostic Connector (page 1345).
1404 2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS
4. Connect Yellow Tee Harness 12-999-01-02 (1) between Camshaft Position (CMP) sensor (2) and engine
harness, making sure to tie it back from hot or moving parts.
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1405
5. Securely connect metal end to connector on Cylinder Performance Analyzer (CPA) tool labeled Cam
Sensor.
6. Connect Black Tee Harness 12-999-01-03 (1) between Crankshaft Position (CKP) sensor (2) and engine
harness, making sure to tie it back from hot or moving parts.
7. Securely connect metal end to connector on CPA Tool labeled Crank Sensor.
8. Connect USB cable from CPA Tool to Electronic Service Tool (EST) with Navistar® Engine Diagnostics.
• Ensure light on CPA Tool (Figure 481) is flashing.
9. Recheck test cable connections and routing to ensure they do not come in contact with hot or moving
parts or radio frequency interference.
Expected Outcome
Cylinder Performance Analyzer (CPA) tool will be properly connected to perform misfire diagnostics.
1406 2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS
Follow-on Procedure
Perform CPA misfire diagnostics.
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1407
Overview
Cylinder performance analyzer (CPA) injector misfire detection (IMD) cold idle test detects faults with cylinder
combustion during idle speed, and is usually performed if customer complaint includes a misfire during cold idle.
When required, IMD cold idle test should be performed before signal check.
Special Tools
• Navistar® Engine Diagnostics
• Interface cable (RP1210B-compliant supporting J1939 and J1708)
• Cylinder Performance Analyzer (CPA) Tool Kit 12-999-01
Equipment Condition
Depending on truck model, it may be necessary to remove the following to properly connect and safely route
test cables into cab.
1. Driverside inner fender
2. Quarter fenders
3. Passenger-side inner fender
Test Setup
1. Key Off.
2. Connect Electronic Service Tool (EST) to vehicle Diagnostic Connector (page 1345).
3. Key On Engine Off (KOEO). Log in to Navistar® Engine Diagnostics.
4. Connect Cylinder Performance Analyzer (CPA) (page 1402) tool for misfire diagnostics.
5. Start CPA software in Navistar® Engine Diagnostics by selecting Tests > Cylinder Performance Analyzer.
6. Fill in Dealer location, operator/technician Information and Customer Complaint text fields.
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1409
7. Verify Vehicle Data matches information in text fields, then select Proceed.
9. Select Injector Misfire Detection (IMD) (1), then select “Launch Test”.
10. Enter information into Brief Test Description (2) and Detailed Test Description/Test Comments (1) text
fields.
Procedure
Expected Outcome
Test will run successfully, return to step based diagnostics with test information, or continue Cylinder
Performance Analyzer (CPA) diagnostics as needed. Green cylinders indicate no defects were found; a red
cylinder indicates problem with that cylinder (may or may not be an injector); and light blue cylinders indicates
high engine speed fluctuations, but no problem with particular cylinder
Follow-on Procedure
None
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1413
Overview
Signal check ensures information from Crankshaft Position (CKP) sensor and Camshaft Position (CMP) sensor
are being read properly by the Cylinder Performance Analyzer (CPA) program and are not distorted. Signal
check must be performed before the full load to highway speed test, or any other test involving the vehicle being
driven. CPA software will only recognize, for a limited time, that Signal Check has been completed before it
resets and inhibits any test involving the vehicle being driven.
Special Tools
• Cylinder Performance Analyzer (CPA) Tool Kit 12-999-01
• Electronic Service Tool (EST) with Navistar® Engine Diagnostics
• Interface cable (RP1210B-compliant supporting J1939 and J1708)
Equipment Condition
Depending on truck model, it may be necessary to remove the following to properly connect and safely route
test cables into cab.
1. Driverside inner fender
2. Quarter fenders
3. Passenger-side inner fender
Test Setup
1. Key Off.
2. Connect Electronic Service Tool (EST) to vehicle Diagnostic Connector(page 1345).
3. Key On Engine Off (KOEO). Log in to Navistar® Engine Diagnostics.
1414 2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS
4. Connect Cylinder Performance Analyzer (CPA) (page 1402) tool for misfire diagnostics.
5. Start CPA software in Navistar® Engine Diagnostics by selecting Tests > Cylinder Performance Analyzer.
6. Fill in Dealer location, operator/technician Information and Customer Complaint text fields.
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1415
7. Verify Vehicle Data matches information in text fields, then select Proceed.
9. Select Injector Misfire Detection (IMD) (1), then select “Launch Test”.
10. Enter information into Brief Test Description (2) and Detailed Test Description/Test Comments (1) text
fields.
11. Later generations of CPA tool do not have adjusting knobs. If using a tool with adjusting knobs, proper
calibration is rotated fully to right (clockwise).
1418 2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS
Procedure
Expected Outcome
Test will run successfully, signal adjustment will be made, and any road test can be performed after test is run.
Return to step based diagnostics or continue with Cylinder Performance Analyzer (CPA) diagnostics as needed.
Follow-on Procedure
None
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1421
Overview
Detects faults with cylinder combustion during idle speed with engine at or above operating temperature, and is
usually performed if customer complaint includes a misfire during hot idle.
Special Tools
• Cylinder Performance Analyzer (CPA) Tool Kit 12-999-01
• Electronic Service Tool (EST) with Navistar® Engine Diagnostics
• Interface cable (RP1210B-compliant supporting J1939 and J1708)
Equipment Condition
Depending on truck model, it may be necessary to remove the following to properly connect and safely route
test cables into cab.
1. Driverside inner fender
2. Quarter fenders
3. Passenger-side inner fender
Test Setup
1. Key Off.
2. Connect Electronic Service Tool (EST) to vehicle Diagnostic Connector (page 1345).
3. Key On Engine Off (KOEO). Log in to Navistar® Engine Diagnostics.
4. Connect Cylinder Performance Analyzer (CPA) (page 1402) tool for misfire diagnostics.
5. Start CPA software in Navistar® Engine Diagnostics by selecting Tests > Cylinder Performance Analyzer.
6. Fill in Dealer location, operator/technician Information and Customer Complaint text fields.
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1423
7. Verify Vehicle Data matches information in text fields, then select proceed.
9. Select Injector Misfire Detection (IMD) (1), then select “Launch Test”.
10. Enter information into Brief Test Description (2) and Detailed Test Description/Test Comments (1) text
fields.
Procedure
Expected Outcome
Test will run successfully. Return to step based diagnostics with test information or continue Cylinder
Performance Analyzer (CPA) diagnostics as needed.
1. Green cylinders indicate no defects were found
2. Red cylinder indicates a problem with that cylinder (may or may not be an injector)
3. Light blue cylinders indicates high engine speed fluctuations, but no problem with a particular cylinder
Follow-on Procedure
None
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1427
Overview
The Full Load to Highway Speed Test is used to detect faults with cylinder combustion during acceleration, under
a load. Signal check must be performed before this test. Testing will stop automatically once vehicle reaches
highway speed and/or all necessary data has been collected. Cylinder Performance Analyzer (CPA) software
will only recognize for a limited time that signal check has been completed before it will reset and inhibit any test
that involves vehicle being driven.
WARNING:
To prevent personal injury or death, do not exceed local speed limits, disobey traffic laws
or drive too fast for conditions while performing this test.
Special Tools
• Cylinder Performance Analyzer (CPA) Tool Kit 12-999-01
• Electronic Service Tool (EST) with Navistar® Engine Diagnostics
• Interface cable (RP1210B-compliant supporting J1939 and J1708)
Equipment Condition
Depending on truck model, it may be necessary to remove the following to properly connect and safely route
test cables into cab.
1. Driverside inner fender
2. Quarter fenders
3. Passenger-side inner fender
Test Setup
1. Key Off.
2. Connect Electronic Service Tool (EST) to vehicle Diagnostic Connector (page 1345).
3. Key On Engine Off (KOEO). Log in to Navistar® Engine Diagnostics.
1428 2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS
4. Connect Cylinder Performance Analyzer (CPA) (page 1402) tool for misfire diagnostics.
5. Start CPA software in Navistar® Engine Diagnostics by selecting Tests > Cylinder Performance Analyzer.
6. Fill in Dealer location, operator/technician Information and Customer Complaint text fields.
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1429
7. Verify Vehicle Data matches information in text fields, then select proceed.
9. Select Injector Misfire Detection (IMD) (1), then select “Launch Test”.
10. Enter information into Brief Test Description (2) and Detailed Test Description/Test Comments (1) text
fields.
Procedure
Expected Outcome
Test will complete successfully and will automatically stop when necessary data has been recorded. Review
test results and return to step-based diagnostics or continue with Cylinder Performance Analyzer (CPA) testing
as needed.
Follow-on Procedure
None
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1433
Overview
Cylinder Performance Analyzer (CPA) advanced testing can be used with or without the guidance of
International® Technical Services. This allows the user to test other sensor signals to perform a wider variety of
diagnostics. Technician can not view data taken on sensor ports 3 and 4 without contacting tech central support.
Special Tools
• Electronic Service Tool (EST) with Navistar® Engine Diagnostics
• Interface cable (RP1210B-compliant supporting J1939 and J1708)
• Cylinder Performance Analyzer (CPA) Tool Kit 12-999-01
Equipment Condition
Depending on truck model, it may be necessary to remove the following to properly connect and safely route
test cables into cab.
1. Driverside inner fender
2. Quarter fenders
3. Passenger-side inner fender
Test Setup
1. Key Off.
2. Connect Electronic Service Tool (EST) to vehicle Diagnostic Connector (page 1345).
3. Key On Engine Off (KOEO). Log in to Navistar® Engine Diagnostics.
4. Connect Cylinder Performance Analyzer (CPA) (page 1402) tool.
1434 2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS
5. Connect Extension Harness 12-999-01-05 and 2-pin Banana Plug 12-999-01-06 to sensor(s) to monitor
and to CPA tool, ensuring to route away from hot or moving parts.
6. Start CPA software in Navistar® Engine Diagnostics by selecting Tests > Cylinder Performance Analyzer.
7. Fill in dealer location, operator/technician information and customer complaint text fields.
8. Verify vehicle data matches information in text fields, then select Proceed.
10. Select Injector Misfire Detection (IMD) (1), then select “Launch Test”.
11. Enter information into Brief Test Description (2) and Detailed Test Description/Test Comments (1) text
fields.
Procedure
1. Add data for sensor(s) connected in field for Sensor 3 and Sensor 4, if needed.
1438 2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS
Expected Outcome
Test will run successfully, return to step based diagnostics with test information, or continue Cylinder
Performance Analyzer (CPA) diagnostics as needed.
1. Green cylinders indicate no defects were found
2. Red cylinder indicates a problem with that cylinder (may or may not be an injector)
3. Light blue cylinders indicates high engine speed fluctuations, but no problem with particular cylinder
Follow-on Procedure
None
1440 2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS
Overview
Cylinder Performance Analyzer (CPA) - High-Pressure Oil Pump (HPOP) Test is a group of tests used to
diagnose defects in high-pressure oil system consisting of the Injection Pressure Regulator (IPR) Engine
Control Module (ECM) Powered test, IPR (Full Fielded) test, IPR Blockoff Adaptor Installed test, and Pump
Deadheaded test. It may not be necessary to perform all tests in CPA HPOP Test. If software detects a fault
in high-pressure oil system during any test, a Warranty Authorization Code (WAC) will be generated. Other
faults will be displayed in Summary Text Box. If no fault is found, software will recommend performing next
test in series.
Special Tools
• Electronic Service Tool (EST) with Navistar® Engine Diagnostics
• Interface cable (RP1210B-compliant supporting J1939 and J1708)
• Cylinder Performance Analyzer (CPA) Tool Kit 12-999-01
• Breakout Harness ZTSE4602
• IPR Blockoff Adaptor with Integrated ICP Sensor Kit 12-999-01-07
Avoid using laptop chargers, vehicle chargers, power supplies, or power inverters during test as these may
cause interference with CPA tool.
Equipment Condition
1. hEST and vehicle batteries are fully charged.
2. 20+ mile break-in drive has been performed if a new IPR valve was recently installed,
3. Depending on truck model, it may be necessary to remove the following to properly connect and safely
route test cables into cab.
a. Driverside inner fender
b. Quarter fenders
c. Passenger-side inner fender
Test Setup
1. Disconnect battery charger and EST power cord.
2. Key Off.
3. Connect EST to vehicle diagnostic connector (page 1345).
4. Key On Engine Off (KOEO). Log in to Navistar® Engine Diagnostics.
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1441
5. Perform connecting CPA tool for HPOP testing (page 1391) procedure.
6. Start CPA software in Navistar® Engine Diagnostics by selecting: Tests > Cylinder Performance
Analyzer.
7. Fill in Dealer location, operator / technician Information and Customer Complaint text fields.
8. Verify Vehicle Data matches information in text fields, then select “Proceed.”
10. Select High Pressure Oil Pump Module (1), then select “Launch Test”.
Procedure
NOTE: Hold down Shift and click summary text box for instructions and setup pictures.
1. Follow on-screen instructions to prepare to run this group of tests.
2. Click Start Test button on bottom left corner.
3. If CPA Software indicates an error with CPA signals, perform CPA HPOP signal test (page 1447).
4. Follow on-screen instructions to complete each test.
5. When prompted to continue to next HPOP test, return to connecting CPA tool for HPOP testing (page 1402)
and perform test setup for given HPOP test.
6. When End of Test text field appears, enter any final details about test.
Expected Outcome
Tests will run successfully, identifying a failed component or sending user to the next test in the sequence. When
this series is complete, return to step-based diagnostics.
1446 2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS
Follow-on Procedure
CPA software automatically records completed HPOP tests to a .zip file starting with the last 8 digits of VIN.
Files are located in: C:\Engine Cylinder Performance Analyzer\
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1447
Overview
CPA high-pressure oil pump (HPOP) signal test is used to diagnose signal errors that may occur during the
HPOP test. This test is considered part of tool maintenance and will not be considered part of a warranty claim.
Special Tools
• Cylinder Performance Analyzer (CPA) Tool Kit 12-999-01
• IPR Blockoff Adapter with Integrated ICP Sensor Kit 12-999-01-07
• Digital Multimeter (DMM)
• Terminal test Kit ZTSE4435C
• Breakout Harness ZTSE4602
• Breakout Harness ZTSE4850
• Breakout Harness ZTSE4951
Avoid using laptop chargers, vehicle chargers, power supplies, or power inverters during test as these may
cause interference with CPA tool.
Equipment Condition
None
Test Setup
1. Retain test set up from unsuccessful HPOP test. All CPA cables must be installed on vehicle during
testing.
2. Ensure all equipment and cable connections are not visibly damaged.
3. Ensure all equipment and connections are secured and making full contact when connected.
4. Ensure there are no engine circuit fault codes caused by test set-up, pending or active. Diagnose and
repair circuit fault codes before continuing to test CPA signals.
Procedure
1. If you know what signal has issues based on CPA software error message or analyzing graph data, proceed
to that particular signal test below. If not, proceed to Step 2.
• engine oil temperature (EOT) sensor signal test (page 1447)
• camshaft position sensor (CMP) signal test (page 1449)
• injection control pressure (ICP) under valve cover (UVC) signal test (page 1452)
• injection pressure regulator (IPR) breakout harness signal test (page 1456)
• engine oil pressure (EOP) sensor signal test (page 1461)
4
0000431941
3. Key On. Using DMM, measure voltage between CPA extension harness center terminal and outer grounding
shell. Compare to Engine Oil Temperature Chart Specs. If voltage is within specification, inspect CPA
Module for possible defect or loose connection, then go to Step 10. If voltage is not within specification, go
to Step 4.
4. Key Off. Disconnect CPA extension harness from CPA banana jack breakout harness and leave CPA banana
jack breakout harness connected to Engine Oil Temperature Sensor breakout harness ZTSE4602.
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1449
0000432083
5. Using Terminal Test Kit ZTSE4435C, insert proper terminals into CPA banana jack breakout harness.
6. Key On. Using DMM, measure voltage between CPA banana jack breakout harness (both pins of the 2–pin
connector). Compare to Engine Oil Temperature Specs Chart. If voltage is within specification, replace CPA
extension harness and go to Step 9. If voltage is not within specification, go to Step 7.
7. Key Off. Disconnect CPA banana jack breakout harness from EOT breakout harness ZTSE4602 and leave
breakout harness ZTSE4602 connected to Engine Oil Temperature sensor and engine harness.
8. Key On. Using DMM, measure voltage between EOT breakout harness ZTSE4602 pin-1 and pin-2.
Compare to Engine Oil Temperature Specs Chart. If voltage is within specification, replace CPA banana
jack breakout harness and go to Step 9. If voltage is not within specification, reconnect engine harness
to EOT and test for EOT sensor circuit fault codes.
9. Reconnect the EOT sensor to the CRANK sensor port of the CPA module using CPA banana jack breakout
harness and CPA extension harness, and return to appropriate CPA HPOP test.
4
0000431941
11. Using DMM, measure resistance between CPA extension harness center terminal and outer grounding shell.
Compare to specification 300 to 400 Ohms. If resistance is within specification, inspect CPA Module for
possible defect or loose connection then go to Step 18. If resistance is not within specification, proceed to
Step 12.
12. Key Off. Disconnect CPA extension harness from CPA CAM sensor breakout harness and leave CPA CAM
sensor breakout harness connected to Camshaft Position (CMP) sensor.
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1451
0000431940
13. Using Terminal Test Kit ZTSE4435C, insert proper terminals into CAM sensor breakout harness.
14. Using DMM, measure resistance between CPA CAM sensor breakout harness (both pins of the 2–pin
connector). Compare to specification 300 - 400 Ohms. If resistance is within specification, replace CPA
extension harness and go to Step 17. If resistance is not within specification, go to Step 15.
15. Disconnect CPA CAM sensor breakout harness from CMP sensor. Connect ZTSE4951 to CMP sensor and
leave engine harness and CPA CAM breakout harness disconnected.
16. Using DMM, measure resistance between breakout harness ZTSE4951 pin-1 and pin-2. Compare to
specification 300 - 400 Ohms. If resistance is within specification, replace CPA CAM breakout harness and
go to Step 17. If resistance is not within specification, reconnect engine harness to CMP sensor and test
for CMP sensor circuit fault codes.
17. Reconnect the CMP sensor to the CAM sensor port of the CPA module using CPA CAM sensor breakout
harness and CPA extension harness, and return to appropriate CPA HPOP test.
1452 2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS
Injection Control Pressure (ICP) Under Valve Cover (UVC) Signal Test
18. If error with CPA signals occurred during CPA high-pressure oil pump (HPOP) Test 1 - IPR ECM powered
or Test 2 - IPR full fielded, go to Step 19. If error occurred during Test 3 - IPR blockoff adapter installed or
Test 4 - Pump deadhead, go to Step 34.
19. Key Off. Disconnect CPA extension harness from CPA Module Sensor 3 port and leave CPA extension
harness connected to CPA HPOP breakout harness.
4
0000431941
20. Key On. Using DMM, measure voltage between CPA extension harness center terminal and outer grounding
shell. Compare to specification 0.25V ± 0.1V. If voltage is within specification, inspect CPA Module for
possible defect or loose connection, then go to Step 34. If voltage is not within specification, proceed to
Step 21.
21. Disconnect CPA extension harness from CPA HPOP breakout harness.
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1453
0000432083
22. Using Terminal Test Kit ZTSE4435C, insert proper terminals into RED CPA HPOP breakout harness 2-pin
connector.
23. Key On. Using DMM, measure voltage between both pins of CPA HPOP 2-pin connector. Compare to
specification 0.25V ± 0.1V. If voltage is within specification, replace CPA extension harness and go to Step
33. If voltage is not within specification, proceed to step 24.
24. Key Off. Disconnect CPA HPOP breakout harness from Under Valve Cover (UVC) connector.
1454 2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS
7 2
4 1
8 5
1 2
0000432149
Figure 534 CPA HPOP UVC Connector and RED CPA HPOP 2-Pin Connector Continuity Test
25. Using Terminal Test Kit ZTSE4435C, insert proper terminal into CPA HPOP 2010 MaxxForce UVC BEIGE
connector pin-7 and RED CPA HPOP breakout harness 2-pin connector pin-2.
26. Using DMM, measure resistance between both pins. Compare to specification of less than 0.5 Ohms. If
resistance is within specification, proceed to Step 27. If resistance is not within specification, repair or
replace CPA HPOP breakout harness as needed and go to Step 33.
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1455
6 1
4 1
8 5
1 2
0000432150
Figure 535 CPA HPOP UVC Connector and RED CPA HPOP 2-Pin Connector Continuity Test
27. Using Terminal Test Kit ZTSE4435C, insert proper terminal into CPA HPOP 2010 MaxxForce UVC BEIGE
connector pin-6 and RED CPA HPOP breakout harness 2-pin connector pin-1.
28. Using DMM, measure resistance between both pins. Compare to specification of less than 0.5 ohms. If
resistance is within specification, proceed to Step 29. If resistance is not within specification, repair or
replace CPA HPOP breakout harness as needed and got to Step 33.
1456 2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS
4 1
8 5
7
0000432146
29. Using Terminal Test Kit ZTSE4435C, insert proper terminals into pin-8 and pin-7 of CPA HPOP 2010
MaxxForce UVC BEIGE connector.
30. Key On. Using DMM measure voltage between pin-8 and pin-7. Compare specification of 5.0V ± 0.5V.
If voltage is within specification, reconnect engine harness to UVC and test for ICP circuit fault codes. If
voltage is not within specification, go to Step 31.
31. Key Off. Disconnect CPA HPOP breakout harness from EOP sensor and engine harness, install ZTSE4850
between engine harness and EOP sensor.
32. Key On. Using DMM measure voltage between VREF and GND. Compare to specification 5.0V ± 0.5V. If
voltage is within specification, repair or replace CPA HPOP breakout harness as needed then go to Step
33. If voltage is not within specification, reconnect engine harness to EOP sensor and test for EOP sensor
circuit fault codes.
33. Reconnect the CPA HPOP breakout harness to the CPA extension and reconnect CPA extension harness
to CPA Module Sensor 3 port, and return to appropriate CPA HPOP test.
4
0000431941
35. Key On. Using DMM measure voltage between CPA extension harness center terminal and outer grounding
shell. Compare to specification 0.25V ± 0.1V. If voltage is within specification, inspect CPA Module for
possible defect or loose connection then go to Step 47. If voltage is not within specification, proceed to Step
36.
36. Key Off. Disconnect CPA extension harness from GREEN IPR blockoff harness.
1458 2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS
0000432083
37. Using Terminal Test Kit ZTSE4435C, insert proper terminals into GREEN IPR blockoff harness 2-pin
connector.
38. Key On. Using DMM, measure voltage between GREEN IPR blockoff harness 2-pin connector. Compare
to specification to 0.25V ± 0.1V. If voltage is within specification, replace CPA extension harness then go to
Step 46. If voltage is not within specification, go to Step 39.
0000432145
39. Key Off. Disconnect GREEN IPR blockoff harness from IPR adaptor and CPA HPOP breakout harness.
Inspect connector for missing terminal lock, replace IPR blockoff breakout harness if defect found.
3 2
3 1
1 2
0000432151
Figure 540 GREEN IPR Blockoff Breakout Harness Connector and 2-Pin Connector Continuity Test
40. Using Terminal Test Kit ZTSE4435C, insert proper terminal into GREEN IPR block-off breakout harness
connector pin-3 and 2-pin connector pin-2.
41. Using DMM, measure resistance between both pins. Compare to specification of less than 0.5 ohms. If
resistance is within specification, go to Step 42. If resistance is not within specification, replace GREEN IPR
blockoff breakout harness and go to Step 46.
1460 2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS
1 1
3 1
1 2
0000432152
Figure 541 GREEN IPR Blockoff Breakout Harness Connector and 2-Pin Connector Continuity Test
42. Using Terminal Test Kit ZTSE4435C, insert proper terminal into GREEN IPR blockoff breakout harness
connector pin-1 and 2-pin connector pin-1.
43. Using DMM, measure resistance between both pins. Compare to specification of less than 0.5 ohms. If
resistance is within specification, go to Step 44. If resistance is not within specification, replace GREEN IPR
blockoff breakout harness and go to Step 46.
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1461
3
3 1
0000432148
Figure 542 CPA HPOP Injector Control Pressure Sensor Connector VREF Test
44. Using Terminal Test Kit ZTSE4435C, insert proper terminals into pin-1 and pin-2 of ICP sensor connector of
CPA HPOP breakout harness.
45. Key On. Using DMM measure voltage between pin-1 and pin-2 on ICP sensor connector. Compare
specification of 5.0V ± 0.5V. If voltage is within specification, replace GREEN IPR blockoff breakout harness
and go to Step 46. If voltage is not within specification, go to Step 47.
46. Reconnect IPR block-off breakout harness to IPR block-off adaptor and CPA extension harness to CPA
Module Sensor 4 port.
4
0000431941
48. Key On. Using DMM measure voltage between CPA extension harness center terminal and outer grounding
shell. Compare to specification 0.5V ± 0.1V. If voltage is within specification, inspect CPA Module for possible
defect or loose connection then go to Step 54. If voltage is not within specification, proceed to Step 49.
49. Disconnect CPA extension harness from CPA HPOP breakout harness.
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1463
0000432083
50. Key on. Using DMM, measure voltage at BLUE EOP output voltage 2-Pin connector. Compare to
specification 0.5V ± 0.1V. If voltage is within specification, replace CPA extension harness then go to Step
53. If voltage is not within specification, go to Step 51.
51. Disconnect CPA HPOP breakout harness from engine harness and install ZTSE4850 between EOP sensor
and engine harness.
52. Key On. Using DMM, measure voltage between Signal and GND. Compare to specification of 0.5V ± 0.1V.
If voltage is within specification, repair or replace CPA HPOP breakout harness as needed and go to Step
53. If voltage is not within specification, reconnect engine harness into EOP sensor and test for EOP sensor
circuit fault codes.
53. Reconnect CPA HPOP breakout harness to engine harness and connect CPA extension harness to CPA
Module Sensor 4 port.
54. If all voltage and resistance readings are within specification and issue is not resolved, please open a Tools
case file for further instructions.
Expected Outcome
All voltage and resistance readings should be within given specification.
Follow-on Procedure
None
1464 2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS
Overview
Record engine running data to be referenced now and in the future. Recreate engine running problem during
the test if possible.
Special Tools
• Electronic Service Tool (EST) with Navistar® Engine Diagnostics
• Interface cable (RP1210B-compliant supporting J1939 and J1708)
Equipment Condition
None
Test Setup
1. Key On, Engine Running (KOER).
2. Connect Electronic Service Tool (EST) to vehicle Diagnostic Connector (page 1345).
3. Log into Navistar® Engine Diagnostics.
Procedure
1. Select: Sessions > Default.
2. Select: Start Recording Snapshot.
3. Recreate engine running problem.
4. Select: Stop Recording Snapshot.
Expected Outcome
Engine running values will be within specification. Save Snapshot for reference later in diagnostic procedures.
Follow-On Procedure
None
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1465
Special Tools
• Electronic Service Tool (EST) with Navistar® Engine Diagnostics and CPA (V7.1.8.12 or higher) software
• Interface cable (RP1210B-compliant supporting J1939 and J1708)
• Cylinder Performance Analyzer (CPA) Tool Kit 12-999-01
• Pressure Plus Module (Medium) Kit 12-999-05M
• 1 inch Rubber Cap 09-889-02-30 (from Coolant Flushing Adapter kit)
Equipment Condition
1. Verify engine coolant temperature is > 150°F (65°C). If engine does not start, test may still be performed.
Cold engine RCT+ testing can give a false "weak cylinder" result. WAC’s resulting from cold RCT+ tests
are invalid.
2. Verify battery voltage is > 12.5 volts.
1466 2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS
Test Setup
1. If equipped an Open Breather, install Rubber Cap 09-889-02-30 (Graphic 1, Item 2) into breather outlet
tube (Graphic 1, Item 1). If equipped with a closed breather, plug hose attached to Turbocharger inlet
(Graphic 2, Item 3) and install Breather Cap 12-999-05-10 (Graphic 2, Item 2) onto breather outlet elbow
(Graphic 2, Item 1) and tighten securely.
1468 2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS
3. Connect CPA yellow sensor harness 12–999–01–02 between “CAM SENSOR” channel and Camshaft
Position (CMP) sensor.
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1469
4. Connect CPA black sensor harness 12–999–01–03 between “CRANK SENSOR” channel and
Crankshaft Position (CKP) sensor.
7. Connect power cord 12-999-05-07 alligator clips either directly to battery or B+ and GND connections
on vehicle cowl panel.
9. Using Pressure Relief Valve Assembly 12-999-05-02, connect Pressure Plus Module 12-999-05-01 to
Cap Adapter 12-999-05-04.
10. Using extension harness 12-999-01-05, connect “Pressure Signal” port on Pressure Plus Module to
“SENSOR 3” port of CPA tool 12-999-01-01.
11. Using another extension harness 12-999-01-05, connect “BATT Signal” port on Pressure Plus Module
to “SENSOR 4” port of CPA tool 12-999-01-01.
12. Key Off, disconnect Engine Control Module (ECM) 36–pin Injector Driver connector from ECM.
13. Key-On Engine-Off (KOEO).
14. Connect EST to vehicle Diagnostic Connector.
1472 2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS
16. Start CPA software in Navistar® Engine Diagnostics by selecting Tests > Cylinder Performance Analyzer.
17. Fill in Dealer Name & Location, Operator, and Customer Complaints text fields.
1474 2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS
18. Verify vehicle data matches information in text fields, then select “Proceed”.
20. Select Base Engine Analysis Module (BEAM) (1), then select “Launch Test”.
1476 2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS
Procedure
1. Enter information into Customer Complaint & Test Notes text field (Item 1).
2. Select RCT with Crankcase Pressure Analysis (RCT+) (Item 2) from Test list.
3. Ensure vehicle is not connected to a battery charger.
4. Key-ON Engine-OFF (KOEO), select Start Test button (Item 3).
5. Follow on screen instructions. They will have you perform three cranking session lasting 15 seconds each
with a period of inactivity in-between each session to allow built up pressure to bleed off. If CPA Software or
data from test results indicate an error with signals or PPM, perform Pressure Plus Module and CPA Signal
Functionality Test (page 1501).
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1477
6. Once test is complete, review data by selecting "Show Results" (Item 1) from Test Summary drop down at
top of screen, and compare results to RCT+ Graph Analysis (page 1478) section.
Expected Outcome
Test will complete and give results on mechanical health of the engine. If a WAC is generated, repair given
component.
Follow-on Procedure
1. Key OFF, reconnect ECM 36–pin injector driver connector to ECM.
2. Clear any active fault codes set from disconnecting ECM.
1478 2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS
Graph Analysis
This graph shows a good engine.
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1479
Graph Analysis
This graph shows a good engine. Each cylinder shows three bars, one for each cranking session, which are all
within specification. Green indicates a good cylinder, while orange at the top of each bar indicates the standard
deviation occurred during testing. Standard deviation is a measurement of variation in the data values collected.
1480 2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS
Graph Analysis
This graph shows a weak number six cylinder. Both engine speed and battery voltage relative compression
shows cylinder 6 to have lower compression. There is no engine speed rise (Item 2) or battery voltage rise (Item
3) while cranking. Also, cylinder six is contributing too much pressure into the crankcase during the compression
stroke (Item 4). This means cylinder 6 has compression loss and it is going into the crankcase indicating a power
cylinder failure or a scored cylinder wall.
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1481
Graph Analysis
This graph shows a dead number two cylinder. Both engine speed and battery voltage relative compression
shows cylinder 2 to have low compression. There is no engine speed rise (Item 2) or battery voltage rise (Item
3) while cranking. Also, cylinder 2 is contributing too much pressure into the crankcase during the compression
stroke (Item 2). This means cylinder 2 has compression loss and it is going into the crankcase indicating a power
cylinder failure or a scored cylinder wall.
1482 2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS
Graph Analysis
This graph shows a vehicle with a dead or dying battery. When battery voltage drops too low, it will skew the test
results. A low battery message will indicate voltage is too low and stop the test. Diagnose and repair starting or
charging system before retesting.
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1483
Graph Analysis
This graph shows a vehicle with a dead or dying battery. When battery voltage drops too low, it will skew the test
results. A low battery message will indicate voltage is too low and stop the test. Diagnose and repair starting or
charging system before retesting.
1484 2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS
Graph Analysis
This graph shows crankcase pressure never building above 30 in H2O (Item 1). If crankcase pressure never
builds above 30 in H2O, the crankcase is not sealed properly. The results will not be accurate and an error
message will be displayed. This will prevent a Warranty Authorization Code (WAC) from generating. Check the
following for proper installation: breather cap, dipstick tube, and oil fill cap.
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1485
Graph Analysis
This graph shows crankcase pressure never building above 30 in H2O (Item 1). If crankcase pressure never
builds above 30 in H2O, the crankcase is not sealed properly. The results will not be accurate and an error
message will be displayed. This will prevent a Warranty Authorization Code (WAC) from generating. Check the
following for proper installation: breather cap, dipstick tube, and oil fill cap.
1486 2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS
Blow By Test
Overview
This test will identify an engine with excessive blow by monitoring crankcase pressure (in of H2O) at the breather
outlet tube during a high idle event.
Special Tools
• Electronic Service Tool (EST) with Navistar® Engine Diagnostics and CPA (V7.1.8.12 or higher) software
• Interface cable (RP1210B-compliant supporting J1939 and J1708)
• Cylinder Performance Analyzer (CPA) Tool Kit 12-999-01
• Pressure Plus Module (Medium) Kit 12-999-05M
• Crankcase Pressure Test Orifice Tool ZTSE4039
Equipment Condition
1. Verify engine coolant temperature is > 150°F (65°C).
2. Verify battery voltage is > 12.5 volts.
3. Fan must be OFF when the reading is taking at high idle (WOT). Readings taken with fan ON are invalid.
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1487
Test Setup
1. For Open Breather, connect ZTSE4039 (Graphic 1, Item 2) to breather outlet tube (Graphic 1, Item 1)
using hose clamps to seal the connection. For closed breather, plug turbo inlet tube (Graphic 2, Item 1)
and install ZTSE4039 (Graphic 2, Item 2) onto crankcase breather outlet elbow (Graphic 2, Item 3) with
hose clamps..
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1489
3. Connect CPA black sensor harness 12–999–01–03 between “CRANK SENSOR” channel and
Crankshaft Position (CKP) sensor.
4. Connect CPA yellow sensor harness 12–999–01–02 between “CAM SENSOR” channel and Camshaft
Position (CMP) sensor.
1490 2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS
5. Connect power cord 12-999-05-07 alligator clips either directly to battery or B+ and GND connections
on vehicle cowl panel.
NOTE: black threaded fitting will need to be removed from Tube, Crankcase Breather Adapter
12-999-05-06 hose to be used with ZTSE4039.
1492 2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS
7. Using Tube, Crankcase Breather Adapter 12-999-05-06, Connect Pressure Plus Module 12-999-05-01
to Crankcase Pressure Test Orifice Tool ZTSE4039.
8. Using extension harness 12-999-01-05, connect “Pressure Signal” port on Pressure Plus Module to
“SENSOR 3” port of CPA tool 12-999-01-01.
9. Using another extension harness 12-999-01-05, connect “Batt Signal” port on Pressure Plus Module to
“SENSOR 4” port of CPA tool 12-999-01-01.
10. Key-On Engine-Off (KOEO).
11. Connect EST to vehicle Diagnostic Connector.
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1493
13. Start CPA software in Navistar® Engine Diagnostics by selecting Tests > Cylinder Performance Analyzer.
14. Fill in Dealer Name & Location, Operator, and Customer Complaints text fields.
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1495
15. Verify vehicle data matches information in text fields, then select “Proceed”.
17. Select Base Engine Analysis Module (BEAM) (1), then select “Launch Test”.
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1497
Procedure
1. Enter information into Customer Complaint & Test Notes text field (Item 1).
2. Select Blow By Test (BBT) (Item 2) from Test list.
3. Verify Save to file when test starts box is unchecked (Item 3).
4. Key-ON Engine-OFF (KOEO), select Start Test button (Item 4).
5. Follow on screen instructions. Perform KOER Standard test in Navistar® Engine Diagnostics followed by two
5-10 seconds sessions of high-idle with accelerator pedal fully depressed. Ensure fan is OFF during both
high idle events. If engine cannot perform Navistar® Engine Diagnostics Standard test (that CPA requests)
continue to next Step, otherwise go to Step 9. If CPA Software or data from test results indicate an error
with signals or PPM, perform Pressure Plus Module and CPA Signal Functionality Test (page 1501).
6. box at Item 3 should be checked.
7. When CPA requests Navistar® Engine Diagnostics Standard test, rev engine to high idle (WOT) for 5 seconds
and return to low idle. Repeat for 5 seconds at high idle, then return to low idle.
8. Select STOP TEST and review results.
1498 2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS
9. Once test is complete, review data by selecting "Show Results" (Item 1) from Test Summary drop down at
top of screen, and compare results to Blow By Test Graph Analysis (page 1499) section.
Expected Outcome
Test will complete and give results on mechanical health of the engine. If a WAC is generated, repair given
component.
Follow-on Procedure
None
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1499
Graph Analysis
This graph shows an engine with blow by within specification.
1500 2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS
Graph Analysis
This graph shows an engine with blow by out of specification. This indicates a worn or damaged power cylinder
or an air compressor leaking to crankcase.
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1501
Tools Required
• Pressure Plus Module (Medium) Kit 12-999-05M
• CPA Complete Tester Kit 12-999-01
• Terminal Test Kit ZTSE4435C
• Breakout Harness ZTSE4950
• Breakout Harness ZTSE4951
• Digital Multimeter (DMM)
Equipment Condition
Verify battery voltage is > 12.5 volts.
Test Setup
1. Perform Test Setup from either Relative Compression Test Plus (RCT+) (page 1465) or Blow By Test
(page 1486).
2. Ensure all equipment and cable connections are not visibly damaged.
3. Ensure all equipment and connections are secured and making full contact when connected.
4. Ensure there are no engine circuit fault codes pending or active. Diagnose and repair circuit fault codes
before continuing to test PPM and CPA signals.
1502 2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS
Procedure
1. Verify LED light is illuminated. If LED On light is not illuminated or LED Fault light is illuminated, open Tools
Case File.
2. If graph data or CPA software indicates an error with a specific signal, proceed to that specific signal test
below. If not, proceed to Step 3.
• Camshaft Position Sensor Signal Test (page 1502)
• Crankshaft Position Sensor Signal Test (page 1504)
• PPM BATT Signal Test (page 1507)
• PPM Pressure Signal Test (page 1508)
4
0000431941
4. Using DMM, measure resistance between CPA extension harness center terminal (1) and outer grounding
shell (2). Compare to specification 300 to 400 Ohms. If resistance is within specification, inspect CPA
Module for possible defect or loose connection then go to Step 11. If resistance is not within specification,
proceed to Step 5.
5. Disconnect CPA extension harness from CPA CAM sensor breakout harness and leave CPA CAM sensor
breakout harness connected to Camshaft Position (CMP) sensor.
1504 2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS
0000431940
6. Using Terminal Test Kit ZTSE4435C, insert proper terminals into CAM sensor breakout harness (both pins
of 2-pin connector).
7. Using DMM, measure resistance between CPA CAM sensor breakout harness (1) (both pins of 2-pin
connector). Compare to specification 300 - 400 Ohms. If resistance is within specification, replace CPA
extension harness, and go to Step 10. If resistance is not within specification, proceed to Step 8.
8. Disconnect CPA CAM sensor breakout harness from CMP sensor. Connect ZTSE4951 to CMP sensor and
leave engine harness and CPA CAM breakout harness disconnected.
9. Using DMM, measure resistance between breakout harness ZTSE4951 pin-1 and pin-2. Compare to
specification 300 - 400 Ohms. If resistance is within specification, replace CPA CAM breakout harness and
go to Step 10. If resistance is not within specification, reconnect engine harness to CMP sensor and test
for CMP sensor circuit fault codes.
10. Reconnect CMP sensor to CAM SENSOR port of CPA module using CPA CAM sensor breakout harness
and CPA extension harness, and return to appropriate BEAM Test.
4
0000431941
12. Using DMM, measure resistance between CPA extension harness center terminal (1) and outer grounding
shell (2). Compare to specification 616-1275 Ohms. If resistance is within specification, inspect CPA Module
for possible defect or loose connection then go to Step 19. If resistance is not within specification, proceed
to Step 13.
13. Disconnect CPA extension harness from CPA CRANK sensor breakout harness and leave CPA CRANK
sensor breakout harness connected to Crankshaft Position (CKP) sensor.
1506 2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS
0000431940
0000431940
14. Using Terminal Test Kit ZTSE4435C, insert proper terminals into CRANK sensor breakout harness (both
pins of 2-pin connector).
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1507
15. Using DMM, measure resistance between CPA CRANK sensor breakout harness (1) (both pins of 2-pin
connector). Compare to specification 616-1275 Ohms. If resistance is within specification, replace CPA
extension harness, and go to Step 18. If resistance is not within specification, proceed to Step 16.
16. Disconnect CPA CRANK sensor breakout harness from CKP sensor. Connect ZTSE4950 to CKP sensor
and leave engine harness and CPA CRANK breakout harness disconnected.
17. Using DMM, measure resistance between breakout harness ZTSE4950 pin-1 and pin-2. Compare to
specification 616-1275 Ohms. If resistance is within specification, replace CPA CRANK breakout harness
and go to Step 18. If resistance is not within specification, reconnect engine harness to CKP sensor and
test for CKP sensor circuit fault codes.
18. Reconnect CKP sensor to CRANK SENSOR port of CPA module using CPA CRANK sensor breakout
harness and CPA extension harness, and return to appropriate BEAM Test.
4
0000431941
20. Using DMM, measure voltage between CPA extension harness center terminal (1) and outer grounding shell
(2). Voltage reading should be 5.9 ± 0.25 volts. If voltage is within specification, inspect CPA Module for
possible defect or loose connection then go to Step 25. If voltage is not within specification, proceed to Step
21.
1508 2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS
21. Disconnect CPA extension harness from PPM BATT Signal port.
Pressure Port
12V Batt IN
On Pressure Signal
0000432085
22. Use Terminal Test Kit ZTSE4435C, insert proper terminals into PPM BATT Signal port (both pins of 2-pin
connector).
23. Using DMM with correct test lead orientation, measure voltage between BATT Signal pins. Voltage reading
should be 5.9 ± 0.25 volts. If voltage is within specification, replace CPA extension harness, and continue
to Step 24. If voltage is not within specification, open a Tools case file for further instructions.
24. Reconnect PPM BATT Signal port to CPA module Sensor 4 port using new CPA extension harness, and
return to appropriate BEAM Test.
4
0000431941
26. Using DMM, measure voltage between CPA extension harness center terminal (1) and outer grounding
shell (2). Voltage reading should be 0.5 ± 0.1 volts. If voltage is within specification, inspect CPA Module
for possible defect or loose connection then go to Step 31. If voltage is not within specification, proceed to
Step 27.
27. Disconnect CPA extension harness from PPM Pressure Signal port.
1510 2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS
Pressure Port
12V Batt IN
On Pressure Signal
0000432086
28. Use Terminal Test Kit ZTSE4435C. Insert proper terminals into PPM Pressure Signal port (both pins of 2-pin
connector).
29. Using DMM with correct test lead orientation, measure voltage between Pressure Signal pins. Voltage
reading should be 0.5 ± 0.1 volts. If voltage is within specification, replace CPA extension harness, and
continue to Step 30. If voltage is not within specification, open a Tools case file for further instructions.
30. Reconnect PPM Pressure Signal port to CPA module Sensor 3 port using new CPA extension harness, and
return to appropriate BEAM Test.
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1511
Pressure Port
12V Batt IN
On Pressure Signal
0000432084
31. Using DMM with correct test lead orientation, measure voltage between 5V Output pins. Voltage reading
should be 4.9 ± 0.1 volts. If voltage is within specification, proceed to Step 32. If voltage is not within
specification, open a Tools case file for further instructions.
1512 2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS
2
3
1 4
Pressure Port
12V Batt IN
On Pressure Signal
0000432087
NOTE: Gold threaded T-fitting may need to be removed from Pressure Relief Valve Assembly 12-999-05-02 (1)
hose to be used with an air pressure regulator.
32. Connect air pressure regulator to PPM “Pressure Port” using Pressure Relief Valve Assembly 12-999-05-02
(1).
CAUTION:
Adjust air regulator valve to minimum setting before connecting shop air supply.
Accidentally applying high-pressure can damage tool components
33. Connect filtered shop air supply (4) to air valve (3) on air pressure regulator assembly.
WARNING:
To prevent personal injury or death, increase air pressure slowly to prevent fittings and
couplings from blowing-out during testing.
CAUTION:
To prevent damage to internal sensor, do not exceed 20 PSI when applying regulated air
to PPM “Pressure Port”.
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1513
34. Open air valve (3) slightly, and slowly increase air pressure until gauge reads between 0.0 and 7.0 PSI. If
needed, adjust regulator knob (2) as follows until gauge reads between 0.0 and 7.0 PSI.
a. Pull air regulator knob (2) outward to unlock.
b. Turn air regulator knob (2) to adjust pressure to between 0.0 and 7.0 PSI.
c. Push air regulator knob (2) inward back into locked position.
35. Inspect regulated air supply adapters and fittings for leaks.
36. Use Terminal Test Kit ZTSE4435C. Insert proper terminals into PPM Pressure Signal port (both pins of 2-pin
connector).
37. Using DMM with correct test lead orientation, measure voltage between Pressure Signal pins.
38. Use regulator knob (2) to vary pressure applied to PPM “Pressure Port” from 0.0 to 7.0 PSI and monitor
voltage reading. Voltage reading should vary proportionally to amount of pressure applied. If Voltage reading
does not vary as expected, open a Tools case file for further instructions.
Expected Outcome
All voltage and resistance readings should be within given specification.
Follow-on Procedure
With air pressure at 0 PSI, disconnect Regulated Air Pressure Supply from Pressure Port.
1514 2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS
Road Test
0 to 60 MPH Test
Overview
This test checks for unacceptable performance under a load at rated speed, and requires operation of the vehicle.
Use record feature in Navistar® Engine Diagnostics while driving on an open stretch of road trying to reproduce
complaint. Signals are recorded so they can be analyzed to determine which system is causing faults.
WARNING:
To prevent personal injury or death, do not exceed local speed limit laws or drive too fast
for conditions when performing 0 to 60 MPH Test.
Special Tools
• Electronic Service Tool (EST) with Navistar® Engine Diagnostics
• Interface Cable (RP1210B compliant supporting J1939 and J1708)
Equipment Condition
None
Test Setup
1. Key-On, Engine-Running (KOER).
2. Connect Electronic Service Tool (EST) to Vehicle Diagnostic Connector (page 1345).
3. Log in to Navistar® Engine Diagnostics.
4. Run engine until Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) is above 158°F (70°C).
Procedure
1. Drive vehicle to a suitable and safe location to perform test.
2. Pull over to side of road.
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1515
7. After test is complete, Select Tools > Stop Recording Snapshot (Figure 593) and save snapshot in EST.
8. Return to shop and review snapshot data.
Expected Outcome
Safely perform road test and record data for analysis.
Follow-on Procedure
None
1518 2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS
Overview
This graph shows an Injection Control Pressure (ICP) system operating as designed, and is a representation only,
no two graphs will be exactly alike. This test does not give pass or fail results, it only allows the user to validate
ICP and Injection Control Pressure Desired (ICPD) signal values under load. As engine rpm increases, ICP
should steadily increase. Low ICP will cause low Intake Manifold Pressure (IMP). Diagnose low ICP concerns
before diagnosing low IMP concerns.
NOTE: Analyze 0 to 60 MPH test signal values only during acceleration, and not during deceleration or shifting.
Special Tools
• Electronic Service Tool (EST) with Navistar® Engine Diagnostics
• Interface Cable (RP1210B-compliant, supporting J1939 and J1708)
Equipment Condition
None
Test Setup
1. Key-On, Engine-Off (KOEO).
2. Connect Electronic Service Tool (EST) to vehicle Diagnostic Connector (page 1345).
3. Log in to Navistar® Engine Diagnostics
4. If not done previously, perform 0 to 60 MPH Test (page 1514) and save recording.
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1519
Procedure
Figure 594 Injection Control Pressure and Injection Control Pressure Desired Graph
1. Injection Pressure Regulator 2. Injection Control Pressure 4. Injection Control Pressure (ICP)
(IPR) Valve control (percent) Desired (ICPD) [Green] [Purple]
[Blue] 3. Engine Speed (RPM) [Orange]
1. Verify if ICP is within 150 psi (1,034 kPa) of ICPD signal value during acceleration.
2. Verify if Injection Pressure Regulator (IPR) valve control is less than 80 percent.
3. Compare graph information with recorded data from test.
Expected Outcome
A properly-operating ICP system will closely resemble this graph.
Follow-On Procedure
None
1520 2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS
Overview
This graph shows the Intake Manifold Pressure (IMP) signal value operating as designed, and is a representation
only, no two graphs will be exactly alike. This test does not give pass or fail results, it only allows the user to
validate the IMP signal value under load. Accelerator Pedal Position 1 (APP1) signal value must be 99.6% to
successfully reach peak boost during this test. Low IMP can be the result of low Injection Control Pressure (ICP).
Diagnose low ICP concerns before diagnosing low IMP concerns. IMP can vary based on ECM calibration and
vehicle weight. Using Electronic Service Tool (EST) with Navistar® Engine Diagnostics, monitor turbocharger
wastegate operation to verify low boost; IMP signal value may be as low as 29 psi (200 kPa) on lower horsepower
configurations; Analyze 0 to 60 MPH Test signal values only during acceleration, not deceleration or shifting.
Special Tools
• Navistar® Engine Diagnostics
• Interface Cable (RP1210B-compliant, supporting J1939 and J1708)
Equipment Condition
None
Test Setup
1. Key-On, Engine-Off (KOEO).
2. Connect Electronic Service Tool (EST) to vehicle Diagnostic Connector (page 1345).
3. Log in to Navistar® Engine Diagnostics
4. If not done previously, perform 0 to 60 MPH Test (page 1514) and save recording.
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1521
Procedure
1. Verify IMP signal value is between 29 psi (200 kPa) to 42 psi (289 kPa), with APP1 signal value at 99.6 %,
and engine speed between 1800 rpm to 2200 rpm.
2. Verify Exhaust Back Pressure (EBP) is less than 70 psi (482 kPa), with APP1 signal value at 99.6 %, and
engine speed between 1800 rpm to 2200 rpm.
3. Compare graph information with recorded data from test.
Expected Outcome
Properly operating system signals will closely resemble this graph.
1522 2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS
Follow-On Procedure
None
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1523
Overview
This graph shows an aftertreatment system operating as designed, and does not give pass or fail results. It only
allows the user to validate operation of the aftertreatment system by monitoring exhaust gas temperatures.
NOTE: It is normal to see Diesel Oxidation Catalyst Intake Temperature (DOCIT), Diesel Particulate Filter Intake
Temperature (DPFIT), and Diesel Particulate Filter Outlet Temperature (DPFOT) signal values fluctuate at the
beginning and end of the Onboard Filter Cleanliness Test (OBFCT). A snapshot is recorded below with Diesel
Particulate Filter (DPF) soot load level 1.
Special Tools
• Electronic Service Tool (EST) with Navistar® Engine Diagnostics
• Interface Cable (RP1210B-compliant, supporting J1939 and J1708)
Equipment Condition
None
Test Setup
1. Key-On, Engine-Off (KOEO).
2. Connect Electronic Service Tool (EST) to vehicle Diagnostic Connector (page 1345).
3. Log in to Navistar® Engine Diagnostics.
4. Perform Onboard Filter Cleanliness Test (OBFCT) (page 1331) if not already done and saved.
1524 2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS
Procedure
Expected Outcome
An aftertreatment system that is working properly will have signals that will be close to this graph.
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1525
Follow-On Procedure
None
1526 2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS
Overview
This graph shows erratic exhaust gas temperatures. Erratic temperatures in the exhaust stream occur when
the Diesel Oxidation Catalyst (DOC) becomes contaminated, or an issue with the Aftertreatment Fuel Injector
(AFI) is present. This test does not give pass or fail results. It only allows the user to validate operation of the
aftertreatment system by monitoring exhaust gas temperatures.
Special Tools
• Electronic Service Tool (EST) with Navistar® Engine Diagnostics
• Interface Cable (RP1210B-compliant, supporting J1939 and J1708)
Equipment Condition
None
Test Setup
1. Key-On, Engine-Off (KOEO).
2. Connect Electronic Service Tool (EST) to vehicle Diagnostic Connector (page 1345).
3. Log in to Navistar® Engine Diagnostics.
4. Perform Onboard Filter Cleanliness Test (OBFCT) (page 1331) if not already done and saved.
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1527
Procedure
Expected Outcome
Exhaust gas temperatures that fluctuate more than specified will have signal values that match this graph.
Follow-On Procedure
None
1528 2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS
Overview
This graph shows low exhaust gas temperatures indicating a restricted Aftertreatment Fuel Injector (AFI). Low
temperatures in the exhaust stream occur when fuel flow from the AFI is restricted, resulting in less fuel burning
in the exhaust stream. This test does not give pass or fail results. It only allows the user to validate operation of
the aftertreatment system by monitoring exhaust gas temperatures.
NOTE: It is normal to see Diesel Oxidation Catalyst Intake Temperature (DOCIT), Diesel Particulate Filter Intake
Temperature (DPFIT), and Diesel Particulate Filter Outlet Temperature (DPFOT) signal values fluctuate at the
beginning and end of the Onboard Filter Cleanliness Test (OBFCT). A snapshot is recorded below with Diesel
Particulate Filter (DPF) soot load level 1.
Special Tools
• Electronic Service Tool (EST) with Navistar® Engine Diagnostics
• Interface Cable (RP1210B-compliant, supporting J1939 and J1708)
Equipment Condition
None
Test Setup
1. Key-On, Engine-Off (KOEO).
2. Connect Electronic Service Tool (EST) to vehicle Diagnostic Connector (page 1345).
3. Log in to Navistar® Engine Diagnostics.
4. Perform Onboard Filter Cleanliness Test (OBFCT) (page 1331) if not already done and saved.
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1529
Procedure
Expected Outcome
An aftertreatment system with low exhaust gas temperatures indicative of a restricted AFI, will have signal values
that match this graph .
1530 2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS
Follow-On Procedure
None
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1531
Overview
This test measures performance of the Exhaust Back Pressure Valve (EBPV). This visual and functional test
uses pre-programmed actions of the Engine Control Module (ECM) to cycle the EBPV three times after the key
is turned Off. In recent calibration releases EBPV only cycles at or above an ECT of 140°F (60°C).
Special Tools
None
Equipment Condition
Remove truck-mounted components as necessary to have a clear view, and to allow access to EBPV.
Test Setup
1. Key-On, Engine-Off (KOEO).
2. Ensure air tanks are full.
Procedure
6. Disconnect vehicle air supply to Air Control Valve (ACV) and check for air supply to the valve.
• If airflow cannot be heard or felt, diagnose vehicle air system.
• If airflow is heard or felt, replace the Air Control Valve (ACV).
7. Check EBPV and linkage for binding and sticking.
Expected Outcome
The EBPV will cycle fully open and closed three times when the ignition key is turned Off. In recent calibration
releases EBPV only cycles at or above an ECT of 140°F (60° C).
Follow-on Procedure
None
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1533
Overview
Verify operation of Turbocharger 2 Wastegate Control (TC2WC) solenoid, turbocharger wastegate actuator,
turbocharger wastergate, and air lines. Determine root cause of boost control system failures. All steps may
not need to be performed. If a step identifies a failed component, replace that component and retest for original
problem.
WARNING:
To prevent personal injury or death, wear safety glasses with side shields.
CAUTION:
Limit supply air pressure to 21.5 psi (148 kPa) to prevent damage to system lines, hoses,
and Turbocharger 2 Wastegate Control (TC2WC) solenoid.
Special Tools
• Pressure Test Kit ZTSE4409
• Ruler or tape measure
Equipment Condition
None
Test Setup
Remove components as necessary to access TC2WC solenoid and turbocharger wastegate actuator.
1534 2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS
Procedure
Figure 600 Boost Control System Lines - Shown with Interstage Cooler (ISC) Removed for Clarity
1. Supply line 3. Turbocharger wastegate
2. Dump line actuator line
1. Perform visual inspection of Turbocharger 2 Wastegate Control (TC2WC) solenoid supply lines, wastegate
actuator and dump lines (Figure 600).
2. Using Pressure Test Kit ZTSE4409, apply 21.5 psi (148 kPa) air pressure to all three Boost control lines one
at a time. Check for leaking hoses. Repair broken or damaged lines as needed.
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1535
3. Check electrical connector (2) for bent, loose, damaged, or corroded pins. Repair as needed.
4. Turn ignition Key-Off.
5. Disconnect line from TC2WC solenoid to Vent / Dump (4) and Wastegate Actuator (3).
6. Using Pressure Test Kit ZTSE4409, apply 21.5 psi (148 kPa) air to TC2WC supply (1). With Key-Off, air
should pass from Boost Supply (1) to Wastegate Actuator (3), and no air should be exiting the Vent / Dump
(4). If air flows thru the vent / dump (4) at Key-Off, replace the TC2WC solenoid.
7. Start engine and run at low idle.
8. Apply 21.5 psi (148 kPa) air thru the supply line (1). No air should pass to either Wastegate Actuator (3) or
Vent / Dump (4). If air flows through TC2WC solenoid to either Wastegate Actuator (3) or vent / dump (4) at
idle, replace TC2WC solenoid.
1536 2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS
Figure 602 Pressure Test Kit ZTSE4409 Installed on Turbocharger Wastegate Actuator
1. Turbocharger Wastegate
Actuator
9. Install Pressure Test Kit on wastegate actuator (1), and connect to regulated air pressure.
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1537
Expected Outcome
Determine if Turbocharger 2 Wastegate Control (TC2WC) solenoid, turbocharger wastegate actuator,
turbocharger wastergate, and air lines are operating properly.
Follow-On Procedure
None
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1539
Overview
The Mass Air Flow (MAF) sensor monitors and calculates the amount and density of air entering the engine.
The Engine Control Module (ECM) uses this information to calculate the amount of Exhaust Gas Recirculation
(EGR) flow during engine operation. This test displays pass, fail or abort results.
Special Tools
• Electronic Service Tool (EST) with Navistar® Engine Diagnostics.
• Interface cable (RP1210B-compliant supporting J1939 and J1708)
Equipment Condition
1. Engine speed at low idle (700 RPM)
2. Key-On, Engine-Running (KOER) Standard Test run.
3. Engine Coolant Temperature 1 (ECT1) at or above 176°F (80°C)
4. Engine Oil Temperature (EOT) above 176°F (80°C)
5. Vehicle not moving
6. Accelerator Pedal Position (APP) at 0%
7. Brake pedal released
8. Clutch pedal released
Test Setup
1. Key On, Engine Off (KOEO).
2. Connect Electronic Service Tool (EST) to vehicle Diagnostic Connector (page 1345).
3. Perform KOER Standard Test (page 1380).
Procedure
4. Click OK (Figure 608) when the test is complete to return to Navistar® Engine Diagnostics homescreen.
5. Select: Tools > Stop Recording Snapshot.
Expected Outcome
Test will run successfully and give pass results.
Follow-On Procedure
None
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1543
Overview
This test commands the Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) valve to perform a self-diagnostic routine and
broadcast a fault code if there is a problem. The test commands the EGR valve completely open, waits for
a significant dwell time, commands the EGR valve completely closed, waits for a significant dwell time, and
repeats the test multiple times. Long dwell times and repeating tests are important. A stuck EGR valve will
broadcast an SPN 2791 FMI 7 fault code. Allowing at least 30 seconds between Output State tests is critical.
Output State tests will not finish without a minimum of 30 seconds between them. This is a manually-controlled
test.
Special Tools
• Electronic Service Tool (EST) with Navistar® Engine Diagnostics
• Interface cable (RP1210B-compliant, supporting J1939 and J1708)
Equipment Condition
None
Test Setup
1. Key-On, Engine-Off (KOEO)
2. Connect Electronic Service Tool (EST) to vehicle Diagnostic Connector (page 1345).
3. Log in to Navistar® Engine Diagnostics.
4. Perform KOEO Standard Test (page 1357).
Procedure
1. Select: Tests > KOEO Tests > Output State Low Test (Figure 609) and wait 30 seconds for test to run.
1544 2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS
2. Select Tests > KOEO Tests > Output State High Test (Figure 610) and wait 30 seconds for test to run.
3. Repeat step 2 and step 3 in sequence three more times, waiting 30 seconds for each test to run.
Expected Outcome
A good EGR valve will not set SPN 2791 FMI 7 during the EGRV Operational Test.
Follow-On Maintenance
None
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1545
Overview
Verifies High-Pressure Charge Air Cooler (HPCAC) integrity using compressed air to check for leaks.
WARNING:
To prevent personal injury or death, wear safety glasses with side shields.
WARNING:
To prevent personal injury or death, keep hoses and mating surfaces clear of oil and
grease.
Special Tools
Charge Air Cooler Pressure Test Kit – (ZTSE4341)
Equipment Condition
Remove piping, hump hoses and clamps from turbocharger and Engine Throttle Valve (ETV) or intake manifold.
1546 2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS
Test Setup
NOTE: Charge Air Cooler (CAC) can remain in chassis for this test.
1. Install Charge Air Cooler Pressure Test Kit onto HPCAC using existing hump hoses and clamps.
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1547
2. Double clamp hump hose connections and tighten hose clamps to 100 in-lbs.
WARNING:
To prevent possible injury or death, secure test adaptors with safety cables, and stay
clear while system is pressurized.
CAUTION:
Adjust air regulator valve to minimum setting before connecting shop air supply.
Accidentally applying high-pressure can damage tool components or HPCAC.
4. Attach shop air to valve on gauge / regulator assembly.
Procedure
WARNING:
Expected Outcome
Determine if High-Pressure Charge Air Cooler (HPCAC) system will hold air pressure. If HPCAC system drops
more than 5 psi in 15 seconds during test, determine component(s) that are leaking.
1550 2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS
Follow-On Procedure
None
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1551
Overview
Test Interstage Cooler (ISC) for air leaks using compressed air.
WARNING:
To prevent personal injury or death, tighten pressure test kit properly before testing.
WARNING:
To prevent personal injury or death, keep mating surfaces and hoses clear of oil and
grease.
WARNING:
To prevent personal injury or death, wear safety glasses with side shields.
WARNING:
Tools Required
• Air pressure regulator
• Interstage Cooler Test Kit ZTSE4937
• Spray bottle with soapy water
Equipment Condition
None
1552 2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS
Test Setup
1. Cover ISC air inlet with Air Inlet Disc Plug (Item 1).
2. Install Air Inlet Disc Plug Retaining Bracket (Item 4) on top of Air Inlet Disc Plug and tighten clamping
bolt to seal ISC air inlet.
3. Attach Air Outlet Cover (Item 2) to ISC air outlet, and tighten bolts.
4. Connect air pressure regulator assembly (Item 3) to Air Outlet Cover, and turn air regulator valve to
lowest setting.
Procedure
1. Connect shop air supply to air pressure regulator assembly.
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1553
2. Slowly turn air regulator valve till pressure reaches 30 psi (207 kPa).
3. Close air regulator valve and monitor gauge for 15 seconds.
• If air pressure drops 5 psi (34 kPa) or more after 15 seconds, spray connections and ISC with a soapy
water to determine location of leak.
4. Repeat steps 2 and 3 twice to verify reading.
• If air pressure still drops 5 psi (34 kPa) or more after 15 seconds, replace ISC.
Expected Outcome
Technician will determine if ISC is leaking.
Follow-On Procedure
None
1554 2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS
Overview
Verifies proper operation of the Fuel Delivery Pressure (FDP) system. FDP must be within specification to ensure
proper performance of engine.
WARNING:
To prevent personal injury or death, wear safety glasses with side shields.
WARNING:
To prevent personal injury or death, do not smoke and keep fuel away from flame and
sparks.
GOVERNMENT REGULATION: Engine fluid (oil, fuel, and coolant) may be a hazard to human
health and the environment. Handle all fluid and other contaminated materials (e.g. filters rags)
in accordance with applicable regulations. Recycle or dispose of engine fluids, filters, and other
contaminated materials according to applicable regulations.
Special Tools
• Electronic Service Tool (EST) with Navistar® Engine Diagnostics
• Fuel Pressure Gauge ZTSE4681
• Fuel / Oil Pressure Test Coupler (Compucheck) ZTSE4526
• Fuel Pressure Test Kit ZTSE4657
• Interface cable (RP1210B-compliant supporting J1939 and J1708)
Equipment Condition
None
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1555
Test Setup
1. Key-Off.
2. Fuel Pressure Gauge ZTSE4681 (Figure 615) (Item 1) connected to Fuel Filter Module test port.
3. Valve closed on fuel gauge.
4. Connect Electronic Service Tool (EST) to vehicle Diagnostic Connector (page 1345).
5. Log into Navistar® Engine Diagnostics.
1556 2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS
Procedure
1. Turn Key-On, Engine-Off (KOEO) to energize fuel pump (pump will run for 10 to 20 seconds).
2. Monitor and record fuel pressure displayed on gauge.
3. Turn key Off for a minimum of 30 seconds, allowing Engine Control Module (ECM) to reset.
4. Electric Fuel Pump can also be commanded on by using Output State High Test in Navistar® Engine
Diagnostics.
5. Perform Output State High Test (page 1359) and monitor gauge and sensor signal in Navistar® Engine
Diagnostics.
6. Repeat as necessary to get an accurate and steady pressure reading.
Expected Outcome
Fuel Delivery Pressure (FDP) will be within specifications (page 1677).
Follow-On Procedure
None
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1557
Overview
This test is used to determine if the Engine Control Module (ECM) is commanding the Electric Fuel Pump (EFP)
by measuring supply voltage to the EFP.
NOTE: Output state high test can be used to activate fuel pump.
Special Tools
• Electronic Service Tool (EST) with Navistar® Engine Diagnostics
• Digital Multimeter (DMM)
• Electric Fuel Pump (EFP) Breakout Harness ZTSE6023
• Interface cable (RP1210B-compliant supporting J1939 and J1708)
Equipment Condition
None
Test Setup
1. Key-Off.
2. Install Breakout Harness ZTSE6023 between Electric Fuel Pump (EFP) and EFP harness connector.
3. Connect Electronic Service Tool (EST) to vehicle Diagnostic Connector (page 1345).
4. Log into Navistar® Engine Diagnostics.
Procedure
1. Use Navistar® Engine Diagnostics and the Output State Test HIGH (page 1359) to command fuel pump On.
1558 2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS
2. While Electric Fuel Pump (EFP) is energized, use Digital Multimeter (DMM) to measure voltage between
Breakout Harness ZTSE6023 pin-6 and pin-1. Record measurement.
3. While EFP is energized, use Digital DMM to measure voltage between Breakout Harness ZTSE6023, pin-4,
and pin-1. Record measurement.
4. Repeat steps 1 through 3 as necessary.
Expected Outcome
Voltage reading between pin-6 and pin-1 and voltage reading between pin-4 and pin-1 are B+ ± 0.5 volts.
Follow-On Procedure
None
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1559
Overview
Test verifies fuel supply system is not restricted (fuel tank, lines, and chassis-mounted filter (if equipped)), by
providing a clean unrestricted fuel source.
WARNING:
To prevent personal injury or death, do not smoke and keep fuel away from flames and
sparks.
WARNING:
To prevent personal injury or death, wear safety glasses with side shields.
Special Tools
• Electronic Service Tool (EST) with Navistar® Engine Diagnostics
• Interface cable (RP1210B-compliant supporting J1939 and J1708)
• Clean Fuel Source Tool – 15–637–01
• Fuel Pressure Gauge – ZTSE4681
• Fuel Pressure Test Kit – ZTSE4657
• Fuel / Oil Pressure Test Coupler (Compucheck) – ZTSE4526
Equipment Condition
None
Test Setup
1. Key-On, Engine-Off (KOEO)
2. Connect Electronic Service Tool (EST) to vehicle Diagnostic Connector (page 1345).
3. Log into Navistar® Engine Diagnostics
1560 2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS
4. Disconnect fuel inlet dry-break fitting from the fuel filter module.
5. Connect Clean Fuel Source Tool 15-637-01 (item 1) to fuel inlet (item 2) of fuel filter module (item 3)
(Figure 619) and prime using primer bulb
6. Connect Fuel Pressure Gauge (Item 1) to Fuel Filter Module test port using Fuel Pressure Test Kit (item
2) and Fuel/Oil Pressure Test Coupler (item 3).
Procedure
1. Select Tests > KOEO Tests > Output State High Test (page 1359) to energize Electric Fuel Pump (EFP).
2. Observe fuel pressure reading while EFP is energized.
3. Activate EFP as many times as needed to record a consistent and accurate pressure reading.
Expected Outcome
Fuel pressure reading will be within specification.
1562 2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS
Follow-on Procedure
None
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1563
Overview
This test sends electrical current through both the positive and negative sides of the circuit being tested to
calculate voltage drop. A voltage drop reduces a circuits ability to pass current.
Special Tools
EXP-1000-HD-NAV, Handheld Battery and Electrical Diagnostic Tool with Wi-Fi
Equipment Condition
• Good batteries, fully charged.
• Battery terminals and electrical connections clean and tight.
Test Setup
WARNING:
To prevent property damage, personal injury, and / or death, shift transmission to Park or
Neutral, set parking brake, and install wheel chocks before doing diagnostic or service
procedures.
WARNING:
To prevent personal injury or death, always wear approved safe eye protection when
performing vehicle diagnostic or service procedures.
Connect Main Clamps connector to EXP-1000 HD NAV tool. Connect red clamp to battery positive (+) terminal
or adapter, and connect black clamp to battery negative (–) terminal or adapter.
Procedure
NOTE: This test requires a complete circuit. If you are testing a system with a remote solenoid, you can test
from battery to solenoid, but not from battery to starter.
0000453003
5. Connect Main Clamps to positive and negative wires of component under test, as close to component as
possible. Rock clamps back and forth to ensure good connection.
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1565
0000453063
6. Connect EXP-1000 HD DMM Clamps to positive and negative battery terminals. Rock clamps back and
forth to ensure good connection.
3
0000453163
Expected Outcome
Technician will determined if voltage drop is in specification: positive (+) side of circuit less than 0.5V AND
negative (-) side of circuit less than 0.5V.
Follow-On Procedure
None.
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1567
Overview
Determines if crankcase pressure is within specification to help determine worn or damaged internal engine
parts.
WARNING:
To prevent personal injury or death, when routing test line, do not crimp line, run line too
close to moving parts, or let line touch hot engine. Secure manometer and test line to
not obstruct vehicle operation.
Special Tools
• Crankcase Pressure Test Tool ZTSE4039
• Digital Manometer ZTSE2217
• Slack Tube® Manometer ZTSE2217A
• Standard shop bolt (to plug intake tube)
Equipment Condition
Remove necessary truck-mounted components to access breather tubes and install test equipment.
Test Setup
Procedure
1. Start engine.
2. Press accelerator pedal to the floor and hold. While pedal is pressed to the floor, allow manometer reading
to stabilize then record pressure reading and fan is OFF when reading is taken at high idle (WOT). Readings
taken with fan ON are invalid.
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1571
Expected Outcome
Determine if crankcase pressure is in specification. If pressure is above specification, determine if air compressor
or internal engine damage / wear are the cause.
Follow-on Procedure
None
1572 2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS
Purpose
Determine if engine mounted crankcase breather is operating at correct speeds. A poorly operating breather
system can lead to excessive oil carryover into the air intake system which can eventually lead to turbocharger
coking.
Special Tools
• Digital Multimeter (DMM) - Hz Setting
• Camshaft Position (CMP) sensor (Dealer sourced) or existing CCOSS sensor
• CMP Breakout Harness ZTSE4951
Procedure
WARNING:
To prevent personal injury or death, shift transmission to park or neutral, set parking
brake, and block wheels before running engine.
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1573
1. If engine mounted crankcase breather / oil separator does not have a speed sensor installed (Figure 629),
locate sensor provision on top of crankcase breather / oil separator. Obtain CMP sensor. If needed, wrap
electrical tape around base of sensor to ensure a snug fit, and insert CMP sensor into sensor provision.
2. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4950 to sensor and leave harness disconnected.
3. Connect DMM to breakout harness and set to measure Hz (Hertz).
4. Warm engine to operating temperature of 176˚F before collecting data. Take DMM reading and then multiply
by 30 to get breather RPM.
NOTE: Oil: Viscosity, temperature, pressure and age (miles and hours) can affect breather operational speeds.
5. If crankcase breather spins slower then minimum rpm specification, do the following:
• Verify engine oil level, condition, miles and hours since last oil change are within specification.
• Verify engine oil pressure is in specification.
• Inspect crankcase breather / oil separator for excessive rotational resistance, sludge, or other
abnormalities.
• Verify good oil flow from the breather oil jet in lower housing.
1574 2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS
Expected Outcome
Determine if crankcase breather spins above minimum rpm.
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1575
Overview
Verify operation of the Engine Coolant Heater.
Special Tools
Digital Multimeter (DMM)
Equipment Condition
None
Test Setup
Engine must be cold to perform this test.
Procedure
Figure 631 External Plug Shown with Lid Removed for Clarity
Expected Outcome
Resistance checks will be within specification and coolant heater will heat when plugged in.
Follow-On Procedure
None
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1577
Overview
This test consists of a Battery Pack Test, Starter System Test Procedure, and Charging System Test Procedure
that run consecutively. Not all tests may need to be run, but must be run in order. Perform this test after being
directed from Starting and Charging System Operational Checkout Procedure or fault codes.
3
5
4
0000453143
Figure 632 EXP-1000-HD-NAV Handheld Battery and Electrical Diagnostic Tool with Wi-Fi
1. MAIN MENU selection area
2. Arrow keys
3. Alphanumeric keys
4. POWER key
5. Voltmeter
The EXP-1000-HD-NAV Handheld Battery and Electrical Diagnostic Tool with Wi-Fi can communicate to the
Battery Management Information System (BMIS). BMIS is a web-based application that collects test data and
can produce reports.
1578 2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS
Special Tools
• EXP-1000-HD-NAV, Handheld Battery and Electrical Diagnostic Tool with Wi-Fi
• Inductive Amp Clamp A018
Equipment Condition
1. Batteries and Electrical System Inspection (page 1666) has been performed.
2. Battery terminals clean.
3. Batteries fully charged.
4. Transmission in Park or Neutral
5. Parking brake set.
6. Wheel chocks installed.
7. Left side skirt removed to access batteries, if required.
Test Setup
WARNING:
To prevent property damage, personal injury, and / or death, shift transmission to Park or
Neutral, set parking brake, and install wheel chocks before doing diagnostic or service
procedures.
WARNING:
To prevent personal injury or death, always wear approved safe eye protection when
performing vehicle diagnostic or service procedures.
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1579
NOTE: Keep all generated testing information to be submitted later for warranty claim, if warranty
applies.
1. All vehicle accessory loads OFF and ignition key OFF.
0000453043
2. Connect Main Clamps connector to EXP-1000-HD-NAV tool. See tags on Main Clamps cable for
additional information.
NOTE: Attach Lead Stud Adapters if battery has threaded studs. Do not attach Main Clamps to
battery threaded studs.
0000453083
3. Connect red clamp to battery positive (+) post closest to the starter wire and connect black clamp to
battery negative (–) post closest to the chassis ground wire.
4. Rock clamps back and forth. Both clamps must be firmly connected before testing. If CHECK
CONNECTION message appears, clean terminals and / or reconnect clamps.
0000452963
5. Enter last eight digits or full Vehicle Identification Number (VIN) and press NEXT. Pressing alphanumeric
keys more than once will scroll thru the possible numbers and letters for that key.
6. Select battery pack configuration. Select DUAL PACK if vehicle has auxiliary batteries.
7. Select number of batteries in pack.
8. If required, select correct BATTERY VOLTS.
CAUTION:
Each battery in the battery pack should be the same type, chemistry and rating.
9. Select BATTERY TYPE. See battery label. For Fleetrite / Navistar battery description, enter battery part
number into Parts Catalog web site Search field and click Part Number. Usually Group 31.
11. Select battery RATINGS UNITS. See battery label. For Fleetrite / Navistar batteries, go to Navistar Parts
Catalog to find rating. Enter last eight digits of VIN in the Chassis / VIN Number field of the Navistar Service
Portal and click View. Select the Components tab, and the feature code for the battery system. Select
Batteries, components.
12. Enter BATTERY RATING. Scroll to correct rating and press NEXT to begin test.
13. Measure ambient battery temperature by aiming IR temperature sensor at battery case. Press NEXT and
the Battery Pack Test will start.
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1583
14. If RESULTS display GOOD PACK, press NEXT to continue and skip steps 15 through 21. If RESULTS
display CHECK BATTERY PACK, press NEXT and go to step 15.
15. At PACK OPTIONS select BREAK PACK DOWN and NEXT.
NOTE: The EXP-1000-HD-NAV tool has a two minute timer that resets every time an alphanumeric or
arrow key is pressed. If the EXP-1000-HD-NAV is disconnected from battery power after the two minute
timer, the tool will power off in approximately 5 seconds. Pressing any alphanumeric or arrow key will
reset the timer and give the user two minutes to transfer Main Clamps.
16. Before transferring Main Clamps to another battery, press any alphanumeric or arrow key to reset the 2
minute timer. Attach EXP-1000-HD-NAV Main Clamps to one battery while disconnecting other batteries.
Disconnect battery cables from each battery, then select NEXT to continue.
NOTE: Attach Lead Stud Adapters if battery has threaded studs. Do not attach Main Clamps to battery
threaded studs.
17. Before transferring Main Clamps to another battery, press any alphanumeric or arrow key to reset the 2
minute timer. Connect to and test each battery when prompted.
1584 2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS
18. After testing last battery, use arrow keys to scroll through individual battery test RESULTS across multiple
screens.
24. After testing, scroll through RESULTS of CRANKING and BATTERY tests across multiple screens using
arrow keys.
25. Starting System RESULTS and Recommended Action(s):
0000453023
Figure 641 Inductive Amp Clamp and Main Clamps Attached to EXP-1000-HD-NAV
CAUTION:
Use care when handling the amp clamp. Internal magnet may break if dropped.
26. At AMP CLAMP screen select AVAILABLE.
27. Attach Amp Clamp cable to EXP-1000-HD–NAV tool. Do not attach Amp Clamp to vehicle at this time.
28. Start engine, if not already running.
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1587
0000453103
NOTE: Do not press NEXT until reading and doing the following:
29. At AMP CLAMP ZERO screen, hold the Amp Clamp approximately 1 inch from the wire to be tested, then
press NEXT.
1588 2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS
0000453123
30. When prompted, install amp clamp around the positive cable between the alternator and the battery, closer
to the battery, then press NEXT.
31. At TESTING screen, follow prompts to turn electrical loads ON and OFF and to raise and lower engine
speed.
32. When prompted, turn OFF loads, and engine. Press NEXT to get RESULTS.
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1589
33. After testing, scroll through RESULTS of charging, cranking and battery tests across multiple screens using
arrow keys. Excessive alternator diode ripple usually means one or more diodes have failed in the alternator
or there is stator damage.
Expected Outcome
Technician will determine condition of battery pack, starting system, and charging system.
Follow-On Procedure
None.
1590 2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS
Overview
Verify operation of Intake Air Heater (IAH) system components and circuits. The IAH is commanded on by the
Engine Control Module (ECM) when Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) is below threshold temperature. The
ECM controls the IAH relay with the IAH control and ACT GND circuits.
WARNING:
To prevent personal injury or death, wear safety glasses with side shields.
CAUTION:
Performing multiple IAH Tests with Navistar® Engine Diagnostics will cause element to
overheat. Overheating element will cause damage.
Special Tools
• Electronic Service Tool (EST) with Navistar® Engine Diagnostics
• Interface Cable (RP1210B-compliant, supporting J1939 and J1708)
• Digital Multimeter (DMM)
• Breakout Harness ZTSE6025
Equipment Condition
None
Test Setup
1. Connect Electronic Service Tool (EST) to vehicle Diagnostic Connector (page 1345).
2. Log in to Navistar® Engine Diagnostics.
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1591
Procedure
1. Check IAH electrical connections for damage and corrosion. Repair as needed.
2. Measure voltage at heater element terminal connected to the relay output, while IAH heater is activated.
Activate IAH heater using Electronic Service Tool (EST) with Navistar® Engine Diagnostics. Select: Tests >
KOEO Tests > Intake Air Heater Test. Is voltage within 0.5 V of battery voltage (B+)?
• Yes: Replace IAH heater element.
• No: Go to Step 3.
3. Measure voltage at IAH relay supply terminal (from Junction post). Is voltage within 0.5 V of B+?
• Yes: Go to Step 4.
• No: Repair IAH relay power circuit, from B+ at starter motor post.
4. Disconnect IAH control circuit connector. Connect Breakout Harness 6025 and leave relay disconnected.
Activate IAH heater and measure voltage between pins 1 and 2. Is voltage within 0.5 V of B+?
• Yes: Connect IAH control circuit connector. Go to Step 5.
• No: Go to Step 6.
5. Activate IAH system and measure voltage between IAH relay output terminal and ground. Is voltage within
0.5 V of B+?
• Yes: Repair or replace relay output bus bar.
• No: Replace IAH relay.
6. Activate IAH heater and measure voltage between pin 2 and ground. Is voltage within 0.5 V of B+?
• Yes: Repair ACT GND circuit.
1592 2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS
Expected Outcome
Determine if IAH system components and circuits are operate properly.
Follow-On Procedure
None
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1593
Overview
Verify operation of the Engine Oil Pan Heater.
Special Tools
Digital Multimeter (DMM)
Equipment Condition
None
Test Setup
Ensure engine is cold performing this test.
Procedure
Figure 647 Oil Pan Heater Plug (Shown with Cover Removed for Clarity)
1. Measure resistance at external plug for oil pan / coolant heater (Figure 647).
• Reading should be approximately 12 ohms. If unit is equipped with both a coolant and oil pan heater,
they are wired on the same plug and reading should be approximately 8.5 ohms. If reading is within
specifications, go to step 3.
• If reading is not within specifications, go to step 2.
2. Disconnect cord from oil pan heater (Figure 646) on left side of engine oil pan. Measure resistance at
terminals on heater itself.
• If reading is approximately 12 ohms, cord needs to be replaced.
• If reading is not approximately 12 ohms, install cord and go to step 3.
3. Connect standard extension cord between wall outlet and (Figure 647).
4. Wait 2 to 3 minutes, and check to see if engine oil pan heater is heating up by feeling the area where cord
attaches.
Expected Outcome
Resistance checks will be within specification and oil pan heater will heat when plugged in.
Follow-On Procedure
None
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1595
Special Tools
Vernier caliper
Equipment Condition
None
Test Setup
Remove fuel injectors. See Engine Service Manual.
1596 2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS
Procedure
1. Extend vernier caliper depth probe and place it inside injector cup. Main scale rests against bottom of injector
cup and depth probe extends into cylinder.
2. Hold caliper while an assistant slowly bars over engine by hand to TDC.
3. Continue slowly barring engine until piston moves past TDC. Piston will push depth probe to shortest
measurement.
Cylinder # 1 2 3 4 5 6
Measurement 1
Measurement 2
Measurement 3
Total
Total / 3 =
Average
Expected Outcome
Determine if one or more cylinders piston height difference is 0.007 in (0.18 mm) or more when compared to
other cylinder averages.
1598 2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS
Overview
Determine if leaks are present in the air intake system. Pressurized smoke will pass through the air intake
system to help locate difficult to find leaks.
During smoke test, tiny “pinhole” leaks may be seen at some sealing surfaces. This is normal and does not
indicate a component has failed.
WARNING:
To prevent personal injury or death, allow engine to cool before removing components
or testing.
NOTE: Do not exceed 5 psi (34 kPa) system pressure when using Navistar® Leak Detector 19–700–01.
Operating the system at higher pressures will obscure test results, and make leaks more difficult to locate.
Lower system pressures will allow smoke trails to be more visible.
Special Tools
Navistar® Leak Locator Kit 19–700–01
Equipment Condition
Navistar® Leak Locator filled with smoke fluid 19–700–01–02, connected to power supply, and connected to air
supply (see Navistar® Leak Locator Operation Manual).
Test Setup
1. Remove air cleaner assembly.
2. Install Navistar® fixed graduated intake adapter into air intake piping with clamp previously removed
from air cleaner assembly.
3. Connect Navistar® Leak Locator supply line to intake adapter.
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1599
Procedure
Expected Outcome
Intake air system clamps, hoses, components, and piping are free of major leaks.
Follow-On Procedure
1. Disconnect Navistar® Leak Locator supply line from Powersmoke™ adapter.
2. Deflate and remove Powersmoke™ adapter per Navistar® Leak Locator Operation Manual.
3. Install air cleaner assembly.
1600 2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS
Overview
Verify proper operation of the deaeration tank cap.
WARNING:
To avoid possible injury or death, use care when working around hot coolant.
WARNING:
To prevent personal injury or death, do the following when removing the radiator cap or
deaeration cap:
• Allow engine to cool for 15 minutes.
• Wrap a thick cloth around radiator cap or deaeration cap.
• Loosen cap slowly a quarter to half turn counterclockwise to vent pressure.
• Pause for a moment to avoid being scalded by steam.
• Continue to turn the cap counterclockwise to remove.
Special Tools
ZTSE2384 Radiator Pressure Testing Kit or 09–040–01 Coolant Cap Pressure Tester
Equipment Condition
None
1602 2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS
Test Setup
Procedure
1. Determine rated pressure of deaeration tank cap.
2. Test dearation cap following the tool instructions for the tester being used.
3. Replace cap if not within specification.
Expected Outcome
Cap will hold rated pressure.
Follow-on Procedure
None
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1603
Overview
Determine engine cooling system integrity by pressurizing system and looking for leaks or pressure decay.
WARNING:
To prevent personal injury or death, wear safety glasses with side shields.
WARNING:
To prevent personal injury or death, do the following when removing radiator cap or
deaeration cap:
• Allow engine to cool for 15 minutes or more.
• Wrap a thick cloth around the deaeration cap.
• Loosen cap slowly a quarter to half turn to vent pressure.
• Pause for a moment to avoid being scalded by steam.
• Continue to turn cap counter-clockwise to remove.
WARNING:
Special Tools
Coolant Management Tool KL5007NAV.
Equipment Condition
1. Remove splash guards (as necessary).
2. Cooling system full.
1604 2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS
Test Setup
1. Replace deaeration cap with Cap Adapter (Figure 653) (Item 5) from Coolant Management Tool.
2. Connect Pressure Module (Figure 653) (Item 3) to Cap Adapter (Figure 653) (Item 5).
3. Apply shop air to Pressure Module (Figure 653) (Item 3).
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1605
Procedure
Expected Outcome
Engine cooling system holds steady air pressure.
1606 2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS
Follow-on Procedure
Replace splash guards (if removed).
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1607
Overview
Determine if cooling system over heats or forces coolant out of overflow tube on deaeration tank.
WARNING:
To prevent personal injury or death, be aware of hot coolant may be expelled from the
deaeration tank during this test.
Special Tools
• Electronic Service Tool (EST) with Navistar® Engine Diagnostics
• Interface cable (RP1210B-compliant supporting J1939 and J1708)
Equipment Condition
None
Test Setup
1. Key-On, Engine-Off (KOEO).
2. Connect Electronic Service Tool (EST) to vehicle Diagnostic Connector (page 1345).
3. Log in to Navistar® Engine Diagnostics.
Procedure
1. Use Navistar® Engine Diagnostics to view Engine Coolant Temperature 1 (ECT1).
2. Start engine. Turn engine Off before any over temperature or overheat occurs.
3. Raise engine speed to high idle. Check for coolant overflowing from deaeration tank.
4. Run engine to operating temperature and attempt to reproduce concern.
5. Monitor ECT1 and stop engine if temperature exceeds normal operating temperature. Check for coolant
overflowing out of deaeration tank overflow hose.
Expected Outcome
Coolant will not exceed normal operating temperature, and coolant will not be expelled from overflow hose on
deaeration tank.
Follow-On Procedure
None
1608 2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS
Overview
Determine if engine thermostat opens when engine reaches operating temperature by monitoring upper radiator
hose temperature.
Special Tools
• Electronic Service Tool (EST) with Navistar® Engine Diagnostics
• Interface cable (RP1210B-compliant supporting J1939 and J1708)
• Infrared Thermometer ZTSE4799
Equipment Condition
1. Allow engine to cold soak.
2. Perform Coolant Level Inspection (page 1637).
Test Setup
1. Key-On, Engine-Off (KOEO).
2. Connect Electronic Service Tool (EST) to vehicle Diagnostic Connector (page 1345) and log in.
Procedure
1. Using Navistar® Engine Diagnostics, select > Sessions > Default > Temperature tab.
2. Start engine.
3. Monitor upper radiator hose temperature using Infrared Thermometer.
4. Run engine to operating temperature. Upper radiator hose temperature should be less than ECT1 while
thermostat is closed. As ECT1 reaches approximately 190°F (88°C), a working thermostat will begin to
open, and the upper radiator hose should heat up.
Does upper radiator hose temperature increase to ECT1 ±25°F after engine warms up past thermostat opening
temperature specification?
• No: ECT1 value continues to rise and upper radiator hose remains cooler. Replace thermostat and retest.
• No: ECT1 never reaches 190°F (88°C). Replace thermostat and retest.
• Yes: thermostat is working properly.
Expected Outcome
Upper radiator hose temperature will increase to within ±25°F of ECT1 after engine warms up past thermostat
opening temperature specification.
Follow-On Procedure
None
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1609
Overview
This test is used to check the engine cooling fan for proper operation.
Special Tools
• Breakout Harness ZTSE4908
• Digital Multimeter (DMM)
Equipment Condition
None
Test Setup
Remove Engine Fan Relay
Procedure
1. Key-Off.
2. Using DMM, measure resistance between relay terminals 30 and 87.
• If resistance is > 1000 ohms, continue.
• If resistance is < 1000 ohms, replace relay
3. Connect Breakout Harness ZTSE4908 to relay vehicle harness connector and leave Engine Fan Relay
disconnected.
4. Key-On.
1610 2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS
5. Use DMM to measure voltage between Breakout Harness ZTSE4908 pin-85 and PWR.
• If voltage is < 0.5 volts, continue.
• If voltage is > 0.5 volts, repair short to GND in Engine Fan Control (EFC) circuit between ECM pin C-58 and
Engine Fan Relay.
6. Use DMM to measure voltage between Breakout Harness ZTSE4908 pin-87 and a known good ground.
• If voltage is < 0.5 volts, perform Engine Fan Clutch tests. See appropriate truck service manual.
• If voltage is > 0.5 volts, repair short in vehicle wiring harness between engine fan power feed and engine
fan switched power circuits.
Expected outcome
Engine Fan Relay is not stuck closed, no circuit shorts are present, and fan clutch is not mechanically stuck on.
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1611
Overview
Determine if the air compressor is leaking air into the cooling system.
Special Tools
None
Equipment Condition
None
Test Setup
Procedure
Expected Outcome
No coolant will leak from oil return hose.
Follow-on Procedure
None
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1613
Overview
To determine if cooling system over heats or forces coolant out of overflow tube on deaeration tank due to a
faulty air compressor.
Special Tools
None
Equipment Condition
None
Test Setup
Disconnect discharge tube from air compressor housing.
Procedure
1. Start engine and run until reaching normal operating temperature.
2. Raise engine speed to high idle. Check for coolant overflow out of deaeration tank.
3. Run engine to above 225°F / radiator intake temperature above 200°F.
4. Check for coolant overflow out of deaeration tank overflow hose.
Expected Outcome
Air Compressor will not cause coolant to be expelled from overflow hose on deaeration tank.
Follow-on Procedure
None
1614 2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS
Overview
Check for combustion gasses and/or compressed air in the cooling system.
Special Tools
Combustion in Cooling System Test Kit – 09-889-01
Equipment Condition
None
Test set-up
1. Remove cap from deaeration tank and if necessary, fill coolant to proper level.
2. Install Cap Adapter (item 2) and Combustion Tester (item 3) onto deaeration tank (item 1) (Figure 658).
3. Fill test beaker (item 1) (Figure 659) to half way mark with clean tap water and place on a stable surface.
4. Insert combustion tester tube (item 2) (Figure 659) into water.
Procedure
1. Start Engine
2. Run engine to operating temperature.
3. Observe tester tube in water for air bubbles escaping.
4. Slowly increase engine speed to high idle while observing tester tube in water for air bubbles escaping.
5. Return engine speed to low idle and turn engine off.
Expected Outcome
There will not be a steady flow of air bubbles escaping from tester tube.
Follow-On Procedure
None
1616 2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS
Overview
Tests Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) cooler for coolant leakage.
Special Tools
• Coolant Management Tool KL5007NAV
• EGR Cooler Leak Detection Kit KL20030NAV
Equipment Condition
None
Test Setup
1. Chock wheels and disconnect battery.
2. Drain cooling system using Coolant Management Tool KL5007NAV.
3. Remove passenger side inner fender.
4. Remove alternator.
5. Remove alternator mounting bracket.
6. Remove coolant supply and coolant return tubes from front of Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) cooler.
7. Make sure all connection points on EGR cooler and tools are clean and free of debris.
Figure 660 Deaeration Fitting with EGR Leak Detection Kit KL20030NAV
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1617
8. Attach plug 20020-1 from EGR Cooler Leak Detection Kit KL20030NAV onto deaeration fitting Figure
(Figure 660).
Figure 661 Coolant Ports and Coolant Port Plug Assembly 20020-2
9. Attach coolant port plug assembly 20020-2 into coolant ports, Figure (Figure 661).
10. Attach a pressure regulator with a shut-off valve to air hose fitting (an extension hose may be necessary
to reach, Figure (Figure 662)). Ensure air hose and fittings are free of any leaks, as they will appear as
false EGR cooler leaks.
11. While pressure testing the EGR Cooler, spray sealing surfaces / connections of tool and EGR Cooler to
ensure tool, hoses, and fittings are leak free.
Procedure
1. Pressurize Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) cooler to 55 psi (379 kPa) and shut off air valve.
2. Monitor pressure gauge for 10 minutes.
Expected Outcome
EGR cooler should hold pressure. Pressure should not drop more than 5 psi in 10 minutes.
Follow-On Procedure
None
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1619
Overview
Verifies that the instrument cluster gauge is functioning properly. The gauge reading and sensor signal value
are compared to ensure proper operation and proper reading for the operator to monitor.
Special Tools
• Electronic Service Tool (EST) with Navistar® Engine Diagnostics
• Interface cable (RP1210B-compliant, supporting J1939 and J1708)
Equipment Condition
None
Test Setup
1. Key-On, Engine-Off (KOEO).
2. Connect Electronic Service Tool (EST) to vehicle Diagnostic Connector (page 1345).
3. Log in to Navistar® Engine Diagnostics.
4. Check for any active or inactive code(s) relating to coolant temperature (repair these first).
Procedure
1. Start engine.
1620 2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS
2. Monitor and compare ECT1 sensor signal (Figure 663) and instrument cluster engine coolant temperature
gauge.
3. Bring ECT up to operating temperature and continue to monitor readings for consistency.
Expected Outcome
Instrument Cluster Temperature Gauge and Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT1) sensor signal value will read
approximately the same.
Follow-On Procedure
None
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1621
Overview
Verifies internal integrity of engine oil cooler. This test uses special tools and compressed air to ensure coolant
and lube oil do not mix in the assembly.
WARNING:
To prevent personal injury or death, wear safety glasses with side shields.
CAUTION:
To prevent damage to oil cooler assembly, regulate compressed air to 30 psi (207 kPa).
Special Tools
• Oil Cooler Test Plate ZTSE4654
• Air Pressure Regulator
• Spray Bottle and Soapy Water
Equipment Condition
1. Remove any truck mounted components to gain access to engine oil cooler assembly.
2. Remove engine oil cooler (refer to Engine Service Manual).
1622 2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS
Test Setup
1. Attach oil cooler test plate (Item 4) to engine oil cooler assembly (Item 3).
2. Install port valve in oil cooler test plate (Item 4) in coolant port; close valve.
3. Fill oil ports up to 1 / 4 - in. from the top with soapy water.
4. Attach regulated shop air to port valve (Item 2). Do not exceed 30 psi (207 kPa).
Procedure
1. Open port valve to allow regulated air to enter oil cooler housing.
2. Observe oil cooler housing ports for bubbles.
3. Spray oil cooler housing and test plate with soapy water to ensure air is not leaking.
4. Close valve, and remove and vent compressed air.
5. Disassemble test plate and drain water.
6. Use compressed air to dry inside and outside of oil cooler assembly (if re-using).
1624 2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS
Expected Outcome
Oil cooler assembly will not have bubbles in oil ports or on outside of cooler assembly.
Follow-on Procedure
None
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1625
Overview
Verifies the electronic signal for Engine Oil Pressure (EOP) sensor by comparing a mechanical oil pressure
gauge to EOP sensor output.
Special Tools
• Electronic Service Tool (EST) with Navistar® Engine Diagnostics
• Interface cable (RP1210B-compliant supporting J1939 and J1708)
• Pressure Test Kit ZTSE4409
Equipment Condition
None
Test Setup
1. Key-On, Engine-Off (KOEO).
2. Connect Electronic Service Tool (EST) to vehicle Diagnostic Connector (page 1345).
1626 2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS
4. Connect Pressure Test Kit ZTSE4409 to test port on Engine Oil Pressure (EOP) sensor (Figure 666) as
shown above (if engine is equipped with an air compressor, an in-line adapter should be used here).
Procedure
1. Start the engine.
2. At low idle, monitor mechanical gauge for engine oil pressure reading; compare this reading to EOP value
in Navistar® Engine Diagnostics.
3. Increase engine speed to high idle.
4. At high idle, monitor mechanical gauge for engine oil pressure reading; compare this reading to EOP value
in Navistar® Engine Diagnostics.
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1627
Expected Outcome
The Engine Oil Pressure (EOP) reading on mechanical gauge and EOP sensor signal value in Navistar® Engine
Diagnostics should be within specification and approximately the same.
Follow-on Procedure
None
1628 2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS
Overview
Verifies the electronic signal to and from the readout of the instrument cluster engine oil pressure gauge
approximately matches the actual mechanical reading. This test uses a mechanical gauge and Navistar®
Engine Diagnostics to simultaneously read Engine Oil Pressure (EOP).
Special Tools
• Electronic Service Tool (EST) with Navistar® Engine Diagnostics
• Interface cable (RP1210B-compliant supporting J1939 and J1708)
• Pressure Test Kit ZTSE4409
Equipment Condition
None
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1629
Test Setup
Procedure
1. Start the engine.
1630 2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS
2. At low idle, monitor the mechanical gauge for the engine oil pressure reading. Compare this reading to the
value displayed in Navistar® Engine Diagnostics, as well as the value displayed on the instrument panel
gauge.
3. Increase engine speed to high idle.
4. At high idle, monitor the mechanical gauge for the engine oil pressure reading. Compare this reading to the
value displayed in Navistar® Engine Diagnostics, as well as the value displayed on the instrument cluster
gauge.
Expected Outcome
The mechanical gauge, Navistar® Engine Diagnostics, and the instrument cluster gauge will all read
approximately the same, indicating the sensor and gauge are working correctly.
Follow-On Procedure
None
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1631
Overview
Verify the fuel system is clean and free of damage.
WARNING:
To prevent personal injury or death, do not smoke and keep fuel away from flames and
sparks.
Special Tools
None
Equipment Condition
None
Procedure
1. Visually inspect the condition and routing of fuel lines and connections.
• If fuel lines or connections are damaged or routed incorrectly, repair or replace as necessary.
• If fuel lines and connections are in good condition and routed correctly, go to step 2.
2. Remove fuel pump and fuel strainer. Inspect fuel strainer, fuel pump, and O-ring seals for cleanliness and
damage.
• If fuel pump, fuel strainer, or O-ring seals are dirty or damaged, replace as required.
• If fuel pump, fuel strainer, or O-ring seals are clean and not damaged, go to step 3.
3. Remove fuel filter and inspect for: sediments, gasoline, kerosene, waxing, or icing.
• If fuel filter is dirty or damaged, replace fuel filter.
• If fuel filter is clean, go to next test.
4. Inspection is complete.
Expected Outcome
Fuel lines, fuel filter, fuel strainer, and fuel connections are clean and not damaged.
1632 2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS
Overview
Drain fuel filter assembly and check fuel quality.
WARNING:
To prevent personal injury or death, do not smoke and keep fuel away from flames and
sparks.
NOTE: Ultra Low Sulfur Diesel (ULSD) fuel is required for MaxxForce® Diesel Engines used with advanced
aftertreatment systems.
CAUTION:
Special Tools
Clear fuel container
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1633
Procedure
Expected Outcome
Fuel is free of water, waxing, icing, sediment, gasoline, kerosene, or Diesel Exhaust Fluid (DEF).
1634 2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS
Overview
Verify instrument panel fuel gauge indicates the correct fuel level in fuel tanks.
WARNING:
To prevent personal injury or death, do not smoke and keep fuel away from flames and
sparks.
Special Tools
None
Equipment Condition
None
Procedure
1. Inspect interior of fuel tanks and ensure fuel level is equal in both tanks.
2. Check instrument panel fuel gauge and verify that indicated fuel level is consistent with actual fuel level.
Expected Outcome
Fuel gauge should function properly and indicate correct fuel level in fuel tanks.
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1635
Overview
Determine if engine oil is to proper level, quality is correct, and oil is not aerated.
Special Tools
None
Equipment Condition
None
Procedure
1. Use oil level gauge (dipstick) (A) to check engine oil level.
• If engine oil level is below specification, inspect engine for leaks, oil consumption, or improper servicing.
Repair cause of low engine oil, and fill to proper level.
1636 2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS
• If engine oil level is above specification, inspect for fuel dilution (fuel smell), coolant contamination, or
improper servicing. If engine oil level is above specification, drain to proper level and diagnose cause
of dilution, contamination, or improper servicing.
2. Inspect engine oil level gauge for bubbles (aeration) in engine oil.
Expected Outcome
Determine if engine oil is to proper level, quality is correct, and if oil is aerated.
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1637
Overview
The following procedure is to inspect that coolant in the deaeration tank is at appropriate level and free of
contamination.
Special Tools
None
Equipment Condition
None
Procedure
Expected Outcome
Coolant level should be within specification and free of contaminants.
1638 2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS
Overview
Check coolant for proper freeze point, and for contamination.
Special Tools
Coolant and Battery Refractometer ZTSE4796
Equipment Condition
• Park the vehicle on level ground.
• If engine was running, allow engine to cool for 15 minutes or more.
Procedure
1. Wrap a thick cloth around the deaeration cap.
2. Loosen cap slowly a quarter to half turn to vent pressure.
3. After pressure has been released, remove the cap.
4. Check coolant appearance for signs of contamination.
5. Take a sample from the deaeration tank.
6. Examine sample for lube oil and Diesel Exhaust Fluid (DEF).
• Oil contamination will result in a dark sludge.
• DEF contamination will give the coolant a dark yellow/brown color with a strong ammonia smell.
7. If coolant is not contaminated, check freeze point.
Expected Outcome
Coolant should be free of contamination, and at the correct freeze point.
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1639
Overview
Determine if engine coolant is in the exhaust system.
Special Tools
Radiator Pressure Test Kit ZTSE2384
Procedure
1. Park the vehicle on level ground. If engine was running, allow engine to cool for 15 minutes or more.
2. Wrap a thick cloth around the deaeration cap. Slowly turn cap counter-clockwise one-quarter to one-half
turn to vent pressure. After pressure has been released, remove the cap.
3. Install the Radiator Pressure Test Kit ZTSE2384 (with appropriate adapter if needed) onto the deaeration
tank.
4. Disconnect the exhaust pipe at the Exhaust Back Pressure Valve (EBPV) (see Engine Service Manual).
5. Pressurize cooling system to rated pressure for a minimum of 15 minutes.
6. Inspect exhaust pipe and brake housing for engine coolant.
Expected Outcome
Exhaust system will not have engine coolant present.
1640 2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS
Overview
Inspect Interstage Cooler (ISC) and the High-Pressure (HP) turbocharger intake elbow for evidence of coolant.
WARNING:
To prevent personal injury or death, allow engine to cool before removing components.
WARNING:
Special Tools
Radiator Pressure Test Kit ZTSE2384
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1641
Equipment Condition
1. Install the Radiator Pressure Test Kit ZTSE2384, with appropriate adapter if needed, on the deaeration
tank.
2. Pressurize cooling system to 15 psi (103 kPa).
3. Remove HP turbocharger intake elbow clamp (Figure 672) (Item 2).
4. Remove intake elbow (Figure 672) (4) from HP Turbocharger compressor housing (1) and ISC (3) (see
Engine Service Manual).
1642 2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS
Procedure
Check intake elbow (Figure 673) (A) and ISC (B) for wet coolant and the residue of coolant.
Expected Outcome
No evidence of coolant or coolant residue will be found in the ISC or the HP-Turbocharger intake elbow.
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1643
Overview
Check engine cooling system for proper level and leaks.
Special Tools
Radiator Pressure Test Kit ZTSE2384
Equipment Condition
None
Procedure
1. Park vehicle on level ground. If engine was running, allow engine to cool for 15 minutes or more.
2. Wrap a thick cloth around the deaeration cap. Loosen cap slowly a quarter to half turn to vent pressure.
After pressure has been released, remove the cap.
3. Check coolant level. Compare coolant level to level indicators on the deaeration tank. If coolant level is low,
add coolant.
4. Install Radiator Pressure Test Kit ZTSE2384 and Surge Tank Cap Adaptor on deaeration tank.
5. Pressurize cooling system for a minimum of 15 minutes.
6. Check both sides of vehicle for coolant, leaks, and coolant on the ground. Inspect cooling package, hoses,
water pump, and engine for coolant leaks.
7. If coolant is leaking, determine what component is leaking.
Expected Outcome
Coolant should be at the correct level. There should be no visible coolant leaks, and cooling system should hold
pressure.
1644 2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS
Overview
Inspect the High-Pressure (HP) Turbocharger and intake elbow for evidence of coolant.
Special Tools
Radiator Pressure Test Kit ZTSE238
Equipment Condition
1. Install the Radiator Pressure Test Kit ZTSE2384, with appropriate adapter if needed, on the deaeration
tank.
2. Pressurize cooling system to 15 psi (103 kPa).
3. Remove intake elbow (Figure 674) (Item 4) from HP Turbocharger compressor housing (Figure 674)
(Item 1) and ISC (Figure 674) (Item 3) (see Engine Service Manual).
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1645
Procedure
Inspect HP Turbocharger housing intake (Figure 675) (Item A) and intake elbow (Figure 675) (Item B) for coolant
and coolant residue.
Expected Outcome
No evidence of coolant or coolant residue will be found in the HP Turbocharger housing intake and intake elbow.
1646 2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS
Overview
Inspect the High-Pressure Charge Air Cooler (CAC), Interstage Cooler (ISC), and CAC piping for leaking, worn,
or damaged parts.
Special Tools
None
Equipment Condition
None
Procedure
1. On right side of engine inspect High-Pressure Charge Air Cooler (HPCAC) (Figure 676) (D), associated
hoses (Figure 676) (B), and clamps (Figure 676) (C) for leaks and worn or damaged parts.
2. Inspect HPCAC (Figure 677) (D), Interstage Cooler (ISC) (Figure 677) (A), associated hoses (Figure 677)
(B), clamps (Figure 677) (C) and connections (Figure 677) (E) for leaks, worn or damaged parts.
Expected Outcome
HPCAC, ISC, hoses, clamps and connections are free of leaks, excessive wear, or damage.
1648 2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS
Overview
Inspect air filter and air intake system for boost leaks, restrictions, and damage.
Special Tools
None
Equipment Condition
None
Procedure
1. Inspect for a dirty, damaged, incorrectly installed or non-Origional Equipment Manufactures (OEM) air filter.
• If air filter is clean, undamaged, correctly installed and is an OEM part: go to next step.
• If air filter is dirty, damaged or is non-OEM: replace air filter.
2. With Air filter removed, inspect the mesh screen below the filter and the Mass Airflow (MAF) sensor. Ensure
the screen and MAF sensor are not damaged or covered with debris.
• Repair torn, leaking, restricted or damaged components.
3. Inspect engine air intake piping, hoses, clamps, air filter housing, screen under air filter, Charge Air Cooler
(CAC), and Interstage Cooler (ISC) (if equipped) for leaks, damage, or restrictions
• Repair torn, leaking, restricted or damaged components.
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1649
4. Ensure ETV boot is not split at clamp, and clamp is installed 0.16 in (4 mm) away from end of boot.
Expected Outcome
Air intake components are free of leaks, damage and restrictions. Intake air restriction should be less than 25
in Hg (84.7 kPa) at full load and at rated speed.
1650 2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS
Overview
This test is used to check for signs of coolant leakage into front gear train.
Special Tools
None
Equipment Condition
1. Remove necessary components for removal of front cover.
2. Remove front cover.
Procedure
1. Inspect gasket (Figure 679) (Item B), sealing surface (Figure 679) (Item C), and coolant passages (Figure
679) (Item D).
2. Check front cover (Figure 679) (Item A) and crankcase with straight edge and feeler gauge.
Expected Outcome
Gasket is in good condition, and there is no evidence of coolant leakage. Cover straightness is within
specification.
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1651
Overview
Inspect exhaust aftertreatment system and sensors for leaks and damage.
Black staining in the exhaust tailpipe can occur and is normal. Do not replace the Diesel Particulate Filter (DPF)
for black staining in the tailpipe.
Special Tools
None
Equipment Condition
None
Procedure
1. Inspect DOC, DPF, exhaust system piping, and clamps (engine and vehicle) for restrictions, leaks, and
damage.
2. Inspect aftertreatment temperature sensors, connections and wiring for damage.
3. Inspect Diesel Particulate Filter Differential Pressure (DPFDP) sensor and tubes for damage or restrictions.
1652 2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS
4. Inspect AFTFI fuel supply lines (B) and coolant supply and return lines (A) for leaks, kinks, bends, or other
damage.
Expected Outcome
Determine if exhaust system and sensors (engine and vehicle) have restrictions, leaks, or damage; and
determine if AFTFI fuel supply or coolant supply return lines have leaks, kinks, bends, or damage.
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1653
Overview
Inspect Diesel Particulate Filter (DPF) channels for restriction, contamination, soot leakage, and filter damage.
Inspect exterior for container damage.
Special Tools
None
Equipment Condition
Index and mark components to show direction of exhaust flow. Mark Diesel Particulate Filter (DPF) to ensure
proper installation after filter has been cleaned or replaced.
1. DPF may need to be removed for inspection. There are several variations of exhaust systems depending
on the specific truck series. All variations have the similar components, and removal / installation
procedures are similar for the different variations. Follow procedures in the Exhaust Aftertreatment
System Service Manual.
1654 2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS
Procedure
Figure 682 New Diesel Particulate Filter (DPF) - face is clear and all channels are visible
Expected Outcome
Diesel Particulate Filter (DPF) should be free of contamination, soot leakage, and filter damage. DPF channels
should be free of restrictions.
1656 2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS
Overview
Inspect Diesel Oxidation Catalyst (DOC) for restriction, contamination, soot leakage, and melted or deformed
cells.
Special Tools
None
Equipment Condition
Before removal, mark the DOC to show the direction of exhaust flow. Marking the DOC ensures proper
installation after the DOC has been cleaned or replaced.
1. The Diesel Oxidation Catalyst (DOC) may need to be removed to be inspected. There are several
variations of exhaust systems depending on the specific truck series. All of the variations have the
same components and the removal/installation procedures are similar for the different variations. Follow
procedures in the Exhaust Aftertreatment System Service Manual.
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1657
Procedure
1. Inspect DOC.
2. If black soot or gray ash is visible on the face of the DOC, the system is working properly. The DOC can be
reused.
3. If inspection shows separation between the substrate and housing (Item A), the DOC can be reused.
4. If DOC cells are melted or deformed, determine the cause of excessive exhaust gas temperatures.
5. Repair cause of excessive exhaust gas temperatures. Replace the DOC. Follow procedure in the Exhaust
Aftertreatment System Service Manual.
Expected Outcome
DOC should be free of restriction, contamination, soot leakage, and melted or deformed cells.
1658 2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS
Overview
Inspect oil in oil pan for coolant contamination.
NOTE: Oil cooler coolant leakage to oil will occur only when coolant pressure is higher than oil pressure.
Diagnosis and repairs will not be authorized based solely on oil analysis.
Special Tools
None
Procedure
1. Remove engine oil level gauge (dipstick) and inspect for coolant contamination. An overfilled crankcase can
be due to coolant in the engine oil.
2. Remove drain plug from oil pan and obtain an oil sample.
3. Inspect oil sample for signs of coolant.
Expected Outcome
Determine if engine oil is contaminated with coolant or not.
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1659
Overview
Check oil pressure regulator for damage, binding, or sticking.
Special Tools
None
Equipment Condition
Remove regulator valve spring and piston (see Engine Service Manual).
1660 2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS
Procedure
1. Check regulator valve spring (Figure 685) (Item A) for collapsed, damaged, and broken coils.
2. Check regulator piston (Figure 685) (Item B) and bore (Figure 685) (Item C) for scoring.
Expected Outcome
Oil pressure regulator will have no broken parts, will not bind or stick, and surfaces will show no signs of scoring
or excessive wear.
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1661
Overview
Inspect cylinder sleeves for holes or cracks caused by cavitation (gas-filled bubbles formed in the coolant).
Special Tools
None
Equipment Condition
Remove cylinder head. See Engine Service Manual.
Procedure
1. Inspect piston crowns for signs of coolant leaks. Lack of carbon on piston crowns indicates possible coolant
leak into the cylinder.
2. Using engine barring tool ZTSE6072, rotate crankshaft to put one cylinders 1 and 6 to Bottom Dead Center
(BDC).
3. Inspect cylinder sleeves 1 and 6 for coolant, coolant staining, pinholes, and cracks in cylinder sleeve.
4. Repeat steps 2 and 3 for cylinders pairs 2-5 and 3-4.
Expected Outcome
Carbon deposits should be present on piston crowns, indicating cylinder sleeves are free of holes and cracks.
1662 2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS
Overview
Inspect for internal engine damage and excessive engine oil leaks.
WARNING:
To prevent personal injury or death, wear safety glasses with side shields. Limit
compressed air pressure to 30 psi (207 kPa).
Special Tools
Air pressure regulator assembly
Equipment Condition
1. Drain engine oil.
2. Remove oil pan (see Engine Service Manual).
Procedure
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1663
3. Check for six missing or broken piston cooling tubes (Figure 688) (Item C).
4. Use regulated shop air to check for loose connecting rod or main bearings, camshaft bushings, or excessive
flow from regulator valve return port.
Expected Outcome
Technician will determine if internal engine damage is present, or if excessive engine oil is leaking.
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1665
Overview
Check High-Pressure (HP) Turbocharger for excessive radial play.
Special Tools
None
Equipment Condition
Remove compressor housing from High Pressure (HP) Turbocharger.
Procedure
Inspect high pressure turbocharger compressor housing and compressor wheel for signs of contact including
damage to the compressor wheel and/or scaring to the compressor housing.
Expected Outcome
High-Pressure (HP) Turbocharger compressor wheel does not have excessive play, and does not contact the
inside of the compressor wheel housing, and is free from damage.
1666 2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS
Overview
Inspection of batteries, cables, starter, alternator, and associated wiring. Components and connections should
be tight and not corroded. Alternator drive belt should be in good condition, have proper tension and associated
drive pulleys should be operating properly.
Special Tools
None.
Equipment Condition
• Hood open
• Battery covers removed
• Fuse panel and power distribution covers removed
Procedure
WARNING:
To prevent property damage, personal injury, and / or death, shift transmission to Park or
Neutral, set parking brake, and install wheel chocks before doing diagnostic or service
procedures.
WARNING:
To prevent personal injury or death, always wear approved safe eye protection when
performing vehicle diagnostic or service procedures.
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1667
D
E
0000414074
A B
E
F
0000414024
Expected Outcome
Determine if batteries, cables, starter, alternator, and associated wiring are tight and not corroded, and if
alternator drive belt is in good condition, has proper tension and associated drive pulleys are operating properly.
Follow-On Procedure
None.
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1671
Aftertreatment
Snap Acceleration Test
Overview
Tests Diesel Particulate Filter (DPF) for cracks, internal damage, and basic functionality without removing it from
vehicle.
Special Tools
None
Equipment Condition
None
Test Setup
None
Procedure
1. Shift transmission to neutral, and set parking brake.
2. Start and idle engine.
3. Rapidly snap accelerator to full throttle (this can be done multiple times).
4. During the engine accelerations, visually monitor the exhaust pipe for heavy black smoke. Use assistant if
necessary.
Expected Outcome
There will not be heavy clouds of black smoke exiting the exhaust pipe. Black smoke is an indication of a failure
in the Aftertreatment (AFT) system, specifically the DPF.
Follow-On Procedure
None
1672 2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS
Overview
This test uses a special tool and a system test to determine if a faulty downstream injector is due to an electronic
control malfunction and / or wiring or a Downstream Injection (DSI) Assembly fault. Separating the command
circuit and DSI Assembly allows for proper diagnosis of the Downstream Injection System.
CAUTION:
Do NOT disconnect the Downstream Injection (DSI) Assembly harnesses or plug in the
NOID Light with the ignition Key-On. Doing so will give false test results.
Special Tools
• Electronic Service Tool (EST) with Navistar® Engine Diagnostics
• Interface cable (RP1210B compliant supporting J1939 and J1708)
• NOID Light – 15-909-01
Equipment Condition
None
Test Setup
1. Connect Electronic Service Tool (EST) to vehicle Diagnostic Connector (page 1345).
2. Log in to Navistar® Engine Diagnostics.
2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS 1673
3. Key OFF.
4. Disconnect Aftertreatment Fuel Doser (AFTFD) connector (Figure 692) (Item 2) from Downstream
Injection (DSI) Assembly (Figure 692) (Item 3).
5. Plug NOID Light (15-909-01) into AFTFD connector on engine wiring harness (Item 1).
Procedure
1. Key-On.
2. Perform KOEO DCU Actuator Test(page 1368).
• Select Tests > KOEO Aftertreatment Tests > Actuator - DCU Actuators.
• In the drop down menu select "AFT Fuel Pressure CTL".
1674 2 ENGINE SYSTEM TESTS AND INSPECTIONS
Expected Outcome
NOID Light will indicate if command signals and wiring are working properly for the Downstream Injection (DSI)
Assembly.
Follow-on Procedure
None
3 ENGINE SPECIFICATIONS 1675
Table of Contents
All Ratings
Key-On, Engine-Off Specifications
Barometric pressure (500 ft. above sea level) 99.01 kPa (14.36 psi) / 3.91 V
Fuel pump OFF, pressure bled down -2.34 to 2.34 psi (-16.10 to 16.10 kPa)
Fuel delivery pressure with fuel pump on and using a mechanical gauge. 60 to 100 psi (413 to 689 kPa)
35% = Closed
EGR Valve Control
90% = Open
35% = Closed
EGR Position
90% = Open
20 seconds maximum crank time per attempt. Wait 2 to 3 minutes before repeating.
Injection control pressure (min to start engine) 5 MPa (725 psi) / 0.95 V
EGR control 35 %
Fuel delivery pressure with fuel pump on and using a mechanical gauge.
60 to 100 psi (413 to 689 kPa)
1680 3 ENGINE SPECIFICATIONS
Engine coolant temperature (at thermostat opening) 85 °C (185 °F) ± 2.78 °C (5 °F)
1.26 V ± 0.4 V
Engine oil temperature should not go 5.5 °C (10 °F) above engine coolant temperature.
8138 Hz (max)
3 ENGINE SPECIFICATIONS 1683
Crankcase Pressure
High idle no load - max. using ZTSE4039 1.5 kPa (6 in. H2O)
Intake Air heater Current Draw Current draw 125 +/- 30 Amps
Full travel 13 mm
1684 3 ENGINE SPECIFICATIONS
MaxxForce® DT (7.6L)
215 hp @ 2200 rpm (12NUK)
EGR Control 35 % to 80 %
EGR Control 35 % to 80 %
Torque converter stall (automatic transmission) 2000 rpm or greater @ 5 seconds or less
Full load, ECM rated speed at highway, stabilized engine operating temperature
Torque converter stall (automatic transmission) 2000 rpm or greater @ 5 seconds or less
Full load, ECM rated speed at highway, stabilized engine operating temperature
Torque converter stall (automatic transmission) 2000 rpm or greater @ 5 seconds or less
Full load, ECM rated speed at highway, stabilized engine operating temperature
Torque converter stall (automatic transmission) 2000 rpm or greater @ 5 seconds or less
Full load, ECM rated speed at highway, stabilized engine operating temperature
Torque converter stall (automatic transmission) 2000 rpm or greater @ 5 seconds or less
Full load, ECM rated speed at highway, stabilized engine operating temperature
Torque converter stall (automatic transmission) 2000 rpm or greater @ 5 seconds or less
Full load, ECM rated speed at highway, stabilized engine operating temperature
Torque converter stall (automatic transmission) 2000 rpm or greater @ 5 seconds or less
Full load, ECM rated speed at highway, stabilized engine operating temperature
Torque converter stall (automatic transmission) 2000 rpm or greater @ 5 seconds or less
Full load, ECM rated speed at highway, stabilized engine operating temperature
MaxxForce® 9 (9.3L)
300 hp @ 2000 rpm (12NUU)
Torque converter stall (automatic transmission) 2000 rpm or greater @ 5 seconds or less
Full load, ECM rated speed at highway, stabilized engine operating temperature
Torque converter stall (automatic transmission) 2000 rpm or greater @ 5 seconds or less
Full load, ECM rated speed at highway, stabilized engine operating temperature
Torque converter stall (automatic transmission) 2000 rpm or greater @ 5 seconds or less
Full load, ECM rated speed at highway, stabilized engine operating temperature
MaxxForce® 10 (9.3L)
310 hp @ 2000 rpm (12NUX)
Torque converter stall (automatic transmission) 2000 rpm or greater @ 5 seconds or less
Full load, ECM rated speed at highway, stabilized engine operating temperature
Torque converter stall (automatic transmission) 2000 rpm or greater @ 5 seconds or less
Full load, ECM rated speed at highway, stabilized engine operating temperature
Torque converter stall (automatic transmission) 2000 rpm or greater @ 5 seconds or less
Full load, ECM rated speed at highway, stabilized engine operating temperature
Signal Values
1704 3 ENGINE SPECIFICATIONS
NOTE: Voltage measurements were taken with the ignition Key ON, Engine OFF (KOEO) and the breakout
connected between the Engine Control Module (ECM) and engine harness. See “APPENDIX A: PERFORMANCE
SPECIFICATIONS” (page 1677) for actuator output voltages, sensor values, and component specifications in a wide
range of conditions.
NOTE: Voltage measurements were taken with the ignition Key ON, Engine OFF (KOEO) and the breakout
connected between the Engine Control Module (ECM) and engine harness. See “APPENDIX A: PERFORMANCE
SPECIFICATIONS” (page 1677) for actuator output voltages, sensor values, and component specifications in a wide
range of conditions.
NOTE: Voltage measurements were taken with the ignition Key ON, Engine OFF (KOEO) and the breakout harness
connected between the gray valve cover connector and engine harness.
NOTE: Voltage measurements were taken with the ignition Key ON, Engine OFF (KOEO) and the 24-pin breakout
harness connected between the 24-pin connector and engine harness.
Table of Contents
Electrical Tools
24-Pin IP Engine Cable
The 24-pin IP Engine Cable is used to test the 24-pin connector circuits.
The Radiator Pressure Test Kit is used to check pressure caps and cooling systems. The pressure gauge
indicates if the pressure cap holds the correct pressure and whether the cooling system has leaks or holds
pressure.
1712 4 DIAGNOSTIC TOOLS AND ACCESSORIES
The 36-Pin Injector Driver Cable with breakout box overlay (pin identifier) sheet is used with the 180-Pin Breakout
Box to test the injector circuits to the ECM with no ECM connection.
The 42-pin Engine to Chassis Interface Cable with breakout box overlay (pin identifier) sheet is used with the
180-pin Breakout Box to test the 42-pin connector circuits.
4 DIAGNOSTIC TOOLS AND ACCESSORIES 1713
The 76-pin Engine and Chassis Cables (2 cables) with breakout box overlay (pin identifier) sheet are used with
the 180-Pin Breakout Box. These jumpers are used to test the circuits going to the engine and chassis 76-pin
connectors on the ECM.
1714 4 DIAGNOSTIC TOOLS AND ACCESSORIES
The 180-Pin Breakout Box allows testing of electronic control system components without disturbing connections
or piercing wire insulation to access various signal voltages in the electronic control system.
CAUTION:
To prevent damage to the breakout box, the breakout box is used for measurement only,
not to activate or control circuits. High current levels passing through the breakout box
will burn out the internal circuitry.
This box is universal and can adapt to any control system by means of a unique jumper harness. Each jumper
harness is a separate part, complete with a breakout box overlay (pin identifier) sheet.
The standard box layout is as follows:
• Two 90-pin connectors, which feed 90 banana plug probing points.
• Each 90-pin section of the box is basically a stand-alone box.
• The top row is all fuse protected circuits, the second row is all twisted pair circuits.
4 DIAGNOSTIC TOOLS AND ACCESSORIES 1715
The Amp Clamp ZTSE4575 is used to measure amperage draw for the Intake Air Heater (IAH).
1716 4 DIAGNOSTIC TOOLS AND ACCESSORIES
The DMM is used to troubleshoot electrical components, sensors, injector solenoids, relays, and wiring
harnesses. The DMM has a high input impedance that allows testing of sensors while the engine is running,
without loading the circuit being tested. This ensures the signal voltage measurement will not be affected by
the voltmeter.
4 DIAGNOSTIC TOOLS AND ACCESSORIES 1717
EXP-1000 HD by Midtronics
The EXP-1000 HD by Midtronics is used to measure amperage draw for the intake air heater.
1718 4 DIAGNOSTIC TOOLS AND ACCESSORIES
The EST is used to run Navistar® Engine Diagnostics for diagnosing and troubleshooting engine and vehicle
problems.
The EZ-Tech® Interface Kit cables are included with the EST.
The Electronic Engine Terminal Test Kit ZTSE4435C is used to access circuits in the connector harness and
allows for the use of a Digital Multimeter (DMM) without damaging the harness connectors. The probes may
also be used as a guide to determine whether the harness connector is retaining correct tension on the mating
terminal.
1720 4 DIAGNOSTIC TOOLS AND ACCESSORIES
Figure 704 Interface cable (RP1210B compliant supporting J1939 and J1708)
The Interface cable (RP1210B compliant supporting J1939 and J1708) is used to connect the EST to ECM. The
Interface cable (RP1210B compliant supporting J1939 and J1708) is an alternative to the NAVCoM Interface Kit.
The 3-Banana Plug Harness is used for sensor end diagnostics of sensor circuits.
4 DIAGNOSTIC TOOLS AND ACCESSORIES 1721
The 500-Ohm Resistor Harness is used for sensor end diagnostics of sensor circuits.
Breakout Harness ZTSE4484 is used to measure the voltage and resistance on circuits that go to the Engine
Injection Control Pressure Regulator (IPR).
1722 4 DIAGNOSTIC TOOLS AND ACCESSORIES
Breakout Harness ZTSE4485A is used to measure voltage and resistance on circuits that go to the Accelerator
Pedal Position (APP) sensor.
Breakout Harness ZTSE4602 is used to measure voltage and resistance on circuits that go to the Engine Oil
Temperature (EOT), Engine Coolant Temperature 1 (ECT1), and Aftertreatment Fuel Shutoff Valve (AFTFSV).
4 DIAGNOSTIC TOOLS AND ACCESSORIES 1723
Breakout Harness ZTSE4674 is used to measure voltage and resistance on circuits that go to the Engine Control
Module (ECM) and Actuator (ACT) PWR relays.
Breakout Harness ZTSE4735A is used to measure voltage and resistance on circuits connected to the Engine
Throttle Valve (ETV).
1724 4 DIAGNOSTIC TOOLS AND ACCESSORIES
Breakout Harness ZTSE4760A is used to measure voltage and resistance on circuits that go to the Diesel
Oxidation Catalyst Intake Temperature (DOCIT), Diesel Particulate Filter Intake Temperature (DPFIT), and
Diesel Particulate Filter Outlet Temperature (DPFOT) sensors.
Breakout Harness ZTSE4761A is used to measure voltage and resistance on circuits that go to the Diesel
Particulate Filter Differential Pressure (DPFDP) sensor.
Breakout Harness 4793 is used to measure voltage and resistance on circuits connected to the Under Valve
Cover (UVC) Wiring-Injector solenoids.
Breakout Harness ZTSE4830 is used to measure voltage and resistance on circuits connected to the
Aftertreatment Fuel Inlet Sensor (AFTFIS).
Breakout Harness ZTSE4831 is used to measure voltage and resistance on circuits connected to the
Turbocharger 2 Wastegate Control Actuator (TC2WC).
1726 4 DIAGNOSTIC TOOLS AND ACCESSORIES
Breakout Harness ZTSE4834 is used to measure voltage and resistance on circuits connected to the Air Control
Valve (ACV).
Breakout Harness ZTSE4850 is used to measure voltage and resistance on circuits connected to the Intake
Manifold Pressure (IMP), Injection Control Pressure (ICP), Engine Oil Pressure (EOP), Fuel Delivery Pressure
(FDP), and Exhaust Back Pressure (EBP) sensors.
4 DIAGNOSTIC TOOLS AND ACCESSORIES 1727
Breakout Harness ZTSE4908 is used to measure voltage and resistance on circuits to the Starter Relay and
Engine Fan (EFAN) relay.
Breakout Harness ZTSE4946 enables the technician to quickly connect a voltmeter and read voltage signals for
the Exhaust Gas Temperature (EGT) sensor.
1728 4 DIAGNOSTIC TOOLS AND ACCESSORIES
Breakout Harness ZTSE4948 is used to measure voltage and resistance on circuits that go to the Exhaust Gas
Recirculation (EGR) valve.
Breakout Harness ZTSE4950 is used to measure voltage and resistance on circuits connected to the Crankshaft
Position (CKP) sensor.
4 DIAGNOSTIC TOOLS AND ACCESSORIES 1729
Breakout Harness ZTSE4951 is used to measure voltage and resistance on circuits connected to the Camshaft
Position (CMP) sensor and the Crankcase Oil Separator Speed (CCOSS) sensor.
Breakout Harness ZTSE4952 is used to measure continuity of the Injection Control Pressure (ICP) sensor,
Engine Compression Brake (ECB), and the Engine Compression Brake Pressure (ECBP) sensor.
1730 4 DIAGNOSTIC TOOLS AND ACCESSORIES
Breakout Harness 4960 is used to measure voltage and resistance on circuits that go to the Mass Air Flow (MAF)
sensor.
Breakout Harness ZTSE4993 is used to measure voltage and resistance on circuits that go to the Intake Manifold
Temperature (IMT), Charge Air Cooler Outlet Temperature (CACOT) Sensor and High Pressure Turbo Intake
Temperature (HPCIT) sensor.
Breakout Harness ZTSE6002 is used to measure voltage and resistance on circuits that go to the Water In Fuel
(WIF) sensor.
Breakout Harness ZTSE6020 is used to measure voltage and resistance on circuits that go to the 24-pin Engine
/ IP connector.
Breakout Harness ZTSE6021 is used to measure voltage and resistance on circuits connected to the
Aftertreatment Fuel Doser (AFTFD).
1732 4 DIAGNOSTIC TOOLS AND ACCESSORIES
Breakout Harness ZTSE6023 is used to measure voltage and resistance on circuits that go to the Electronic
Fuel Pump (EFP).
Breakout Harness ZTSE6025 is used to measure voltage and resistance on circuits that go to the Intake Air
Heater (IAH) relay.
4 DIAGNOSTIC TOOLS AND ACCESSORIES 1733
Breakout Harness ZTSE6027 is used to measure voltage and resistance on circuits that go to the Aftertreatment
(AFT) Fuel Pressure (AFTFP) sensor.
1734 4 DIAGNOSTIC TOOLS AND ACCESSORIES
Mechanical Tools
Charge Air Cooler Test Kit
The Charge Air Cooler Test Kit is used to pressurize the charge air cooler and piping to check for leaks.
The Clean Fuel Tank Tool is used to provide a clean, alternative fuel source to aid in the diagnosis of the fuel
system.
4 DIAGNOSTIC TOOLS AND ACCESSORIES 1735
The Combustion in Cooling System Tester is used in testing for signs of combustion gas present in coolant
system.
The Crankcase Pressure Test Tool is used to measure combustion gas flow from the valve cover and may be
used with the magnehelic gauge or Slack Tube® manometer.
Use the pressure readings obtained with this adapter as the main source of engine condition. Use oil
consumption trend data if the pressure readings are over the specified limits. Neither changes in oil
consumption trends nor crankcase diagnostic pressure trends can establish a specific problem. These changes
only indicate that a problem exists.
1736 4 DIAGNOSTIC TOOLS AND ACCESSORIES
Digital Manometer
The Digital Manometer is used to measure low vacuum due to intake restriction or low crankcase pressure. A
variety of digital manometers are available for purchase locally. The Water Manometer kit (ZTSE2217A) is an
alternative to the Digital Manometer
4 DIAGNOSTIC TOOLS AND ACCESSORIES 1737
The EGR Cooler Leak Detection Test Kit is used to pressure test the Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) cooler
for leaks. KL 20020 NAV contains the plastic case with the EGR Cooler Leak Detection Test Kit for the 2007
MaxxForce® DT, 9, and 10. KL 20040 NAV is an add-on kit that contains the EGR Cooler Leak Detection Test
Kit for the 2010 MaxxForce® 7. KL 20030 NAV is an add-on kit that contains the EGR Cooler Leak Detection
Test Kit the 2010 MaxxForce® DT, 9, and 10. The three test kits can be purchased separately.
1738 4 DIAGNOSTIC TOOLS AND ACCESSORIES
The EGR mixing Bowl guide pins are used while installing the EGR mixing bowl to not damage the gasket.
The EGR valve puller is used to removed the EGR valve without damaging the valve.
4 DIAGNOSTIC TOOLS AND ACCESSORIES 1739
The Fuel Inlet Restriction and Aeration Tool is used to check for pressure and aerated fuel in the low-fuel pressure
system.
The Fuel / Oil Pressure Test Coupler is used with the fuel pressure test fitting for an easy connection to measure
fuel pressure.
1740 4 DIAGNOSTIC TOOLS AND ACCESSORIES
The Fuel Pressure Gauge is used to check for fuel pressure and aerated fuel in the low-fuel pressure system.
4 DIAGNOSTIC TOOLS AND ACCESSORIES 1741
The Fuel Pressure Test Kit includes a quick disconnect check valve and fittings that can be used to make a test
line to check fuel pressure at the high-pressure fuel rail.
The fuel test fitting is used to measure fuel inlet restriction or fuel pressure.
1742 4 DIAGNOSTIC TOOLS AND ACCESSORIES
When measuring fuel inlet restriction, the fitting is installed at the diagnostic port (inlet-side) of the fuel filter
housing.
When measuring fuel pressure, the fitting can be installed on the fuel rail instead of the Shrader valve.
The Fuel/Oil Pressure Test Coupler can then be connected to the fuel test fitting to measure fuel pressure or
fuel inlet restriction.
The High Pressure Test Gauge is used with the ICP Adapter Pressure Test Fitting (ZTSE4927) to measure
injection control pressure coming out of the high-pressure pump.
4 DIAGNOSTIC TOOLS AND ACCESSORIES 1743
The Pressure Test Kit is used to measure intake manifold (boost) pressure, fuel system inlet restriction, fuel
pressure, oil pressure, air cleaner intake restriction, and crankcase pressure.
• 0 to 200 kPa (0 to 30 psi) measures intake manifold pressure.
• 0-30 in Hg vacuum /0 to 200 kPa (0 to 30 psi) compound gauge measures fuel system inlet restriction and
intake manifold pressure.
0-30 in H2O 0 to 7.5 kPa (0 to 1 psi) maximum pressure magnehelic gauge measures crankcase pressure
and air inlet restriction.
• 60 to 1100 kPa (0 to 160 psi) gauge may be used to check the fuel pressure and oil pressure.
1744 4 DIAGNOSTIC TOOLS AND ACCESSORIES
The CAC Block Off Kit is used to pressure test the interstage cooler (if available) and check for leaks.
4 DIAGNOSTIC TOOLS AND ACCESSORIES 1745
The Oil Cooler Test Plate is used to test the integrity of the oil cooler.
1746 4 DIAGNOSTIC TOOLS AND ACCESSORIES
The High Pressure Test Gauge is used with the ICP Adapter Pressure Test Fitting (ZTSE4927) to measure
injection control pressure coming out of the high-pressure pump.
The ICP Adapter Pressure Test Fitting is used with the High Pressure Test Gauge (ZTSE4954) to measure
injection control pressure coming out of the high-pressure pump.
The Inline Shut-off Valve is used to make a test line to check for aerated oil, specifically at the EOT sensor port.
The Shut-Off valve can also be used to make a test line assembly to check for aerated fuel.
1748 4 DIAGNOSTIC TOOLS AND ACCESSORIES
The IPR Plug Tester is used to check the high-pressure pump for inability to reach maximum injection control
pressure.
The Pressure Vacuum Module is used for pressure and vacuum measurements. A variety of pressure vacuum
modules are available for purchase locally.
4 DIAGNOSTIC TOOLS AND ACCESSORIES 1749
The Turbo Lifting Bracket is used to aid in the removal of the turbo assembly.
1750 4 DIAGNOSTIC TOOLS AND ACCESSORIES
The Slack Tube® Manometer is a U-shaped tube with a scale mounted between the legs of the tube. When the
portability of the Pressure Test Kit is not required, this manometer is used to measure low vacuum for intake
restriction, low pressure for crankcase, or exhaust back pressure.
Filling
Fill the manometer with water before checking pressure. Use only distilled water. Add some colored water
vegetable dye so the scale can be read more easily. With both legs of the manometer open to the atmosphere,
fill the tube until the top of the fluid column is near the zero mark on the scale. Shake the tube to eliminate any
air bubbles.
Installing, Reading, and Cleaning
1. Support the manometer vertically. Make sure the fluid level is in line with the zero indicator on the graduated
scale.
2. Connect one leg of the manometer to the source of the pressure or vacuum. Leave the other leg open to
atmospheric pressure.
3. Start the engine and allow it to reach normal operating temperature. Then run the engine to high idle. The
manometer can be read after 10 seconds.
4 DIAGNOSTIC TOOLS AND ACCESSORIES 1751
4. Record the average position of the fluid level when it is above and below the zero indicator. Add the two
figures together. The sum of the two is the total column of fluid (distance A). This represents the crankcase
pressure in inches of water (in-H2O).
At times, both columns of the manometer will not travel the same distance. This is no concern if the leg is
not connected to the pressure or the vacuum source is open to the atmosphere.
5. Compare the manometer reading with engine specifications.
6. When the test is done, clean the tube thoroughly using soap and water. Avoid liquid soaps and solvents.
1752 4 DIAGNOSTIC TOOLS AND ACCESSORIES
The UV Leak Detection Kit is used with fuel dye to quickly identify leaks. The fuel dye combines with fuel
and migrates out at the leak. The ultraviolet lamp illuminates the leaking fuel dye, which appears fluorescent
yellow-green in color.
4 DIAGNOSTIC TOOLS AND ACCESSORIES 1753
The Vacuum Analyzer and Fuel Pump Tester is used to test the operation of the fuel pump.
1754 4 DIAGNOSTIC TOOLS AND ACCESSORIES
5 COMPONENT LOCATOR 1755
Table of Contents
Table of Contents
Engine Identification
Engine Serial Number
Figure 766 U.S. Environmental Protection Agency (EPA) exhaust emission label (example)
The U.S. Environmental Protection Agency (EPA) exhaust emission label is attached on top of the valve cover.
The EPA label typically includes the following:
• Model year
• Engine family, model, and displacement
• Advertised brake horsepower and torque rating
• Emission family and control systems
• Valve lash specifications
• Engine serial number
• EPA, EURO, and reserved fields for specific applications
6 ENGINE SYSTEMS OVERVIEW 1767
Engine Description
Standard Features
MaxxForce® DT, 9, and 10 diesel engines are designed for increased durability, reliability, and ease of
maintenance.
The cylinder head has four valves per cylinder with centrally located fuel injectors directing fuel over the pistons.
This configuration provides improved performance and reduces emissions.
The camshaft is supported by four insert bushings pressed into the crankcase. The camshaft gear is driven from
the front of the engine. A thrust flange is located between the camshaft and the drive gear. The overhead valve
train includes mechanical roller lifters, push rods, rocker arms, and dual valves that open using a valve bridge.
MaxxForce® DT engines use one-piece aluminum alloy pistons. MaxxForce® 9 and 10 engines use one-piece
steel pistons. All pistons have zero pin offset and centered combustion bowls; therefore, pistons can be installed
safely without orientation: there is NO front-of-engine arrow or “CAMSIDE” marking on the piston crown to
indicate a necessary piston direction.
The one piece crankcase uses replaceable wet cylinder sleeves that are sealed by a single crevice seal ring.
Some applications include a crankcase ladder which is designed to support heavier loads and reduce engine
noise.
The crankshaft has seven main bearings with fore and aft thrust controlled at the rear bearing. One fractured
cap connecting rod is attached at each crankshaft journal. A piston pin moves freely inside the connecting rod
and piston. Piston pin retaining rings secure the piston pin in the piston. The rear oil seal carrier is part of the
flywheel housing.
A lube oil pump is mounted on the front cover and is driven by the crankshaft. Pressurized oil is supplied to
engine components and the high-pressure injection system. All MaxxForce® DT, 9, and 10 engines use an
engine oil cooler and spin-on engine oil filter.
The coolant supply housing serves as the mounting bracket for the refrigerant compressor. Mounting capabilities
for a dual refrigerant compressor are available as an option. The pad mounting design of the alternator and
refrigerant compressor brackets provide easy removal and improved durability.
The electric low-pressure fuel supply pump draws fuel from the fuel tank through the fuel filter assembly. The
assembly includes a strainer, filter, drain valve, Water in Fuel (WIF) sensor, and Fuel Delivery Pressure (FDP)
sensor. If equipped, an optional fuel heater element is installed in the fuel filter assembly. Conditioned fuel is
pumped through the intake manifold and cylinder head to the fuel injectors.
The WIF sensor detects water in the fuel system. When water reaches the level of the sensor located in the fuel
filter assembly, the instrument panel's amber FUEL FILTER lamp will illuminate. The collected water must be
removed immediately. Water is drained by opening the drain valve on the fuel filter assembly.
The fuel injection system is electro-hydraulic. The system includes an under-valve-cover high-pressure oil
manifold, fuel injectors, and a high-pressure oil pump. The injectors are installed in the cylinder head, under the
high-pressure oil manifold.
MaxxForce® DT, 9, and 10 engines use dual turbochargers with an air-to-air High Pressure Charge Air Cooler
(HPCAC) after the second stage. An interstage cooler is used after the first stage for applications with 245 hp
and above.
The Intake Air Heater (IAH) system warms the incoming air to aid cold engine starting and to reduce white smoke
and engine noise. The IAH system will initially illuminate the WAIT TO START lamp located on the instrument
panel. When the lamp turns off, the engine can be started.
The Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) system circulates cooled exhaust into the intake air stream in the intake
manifold. This cools the combustion process and reduces the formation of NOX engine emissions.
1770 6 ENGINE SYSTEMS OVERVIEW
A closed crankcase breather system uses an engine mounted oil separator to return oil to the crankcase and
vent crankcase pressure into the intake system.
The Down Stream Injection (DSI) system aides in controlling emissions by injecting fuel into the exhaust stream.
The fuel causes an exothermic reaction which increases the temperature of the exhaust gas. This increase in
temperature allows for more efficient conversion of soot into ash within the Diesel Particulate Filter (DPF). Along
with DSI, the Diesel Oxidation Catalyst (DOC) aids in creating the required exothermic reaction. DSI consists
of the Doser Control Unit (DCU), Downstream Injection (DSI) assembly, hydrocarbon injector assembly, fuel
lines, and coolant lines. The Electronic Control Module (ECM) communicates with the DCU to control the timing
and quantity of fuel sprayed from the hydrocarbon injector assembly. The ECM signals the Air Control Valve
assembly to control the position of the Exhaust Back Pressure Valve (EBPV) to increase or decrease the exhaust
gas back pressure and temperature to allow the DOC and DPF to function efficiently.
The EBPV acts as an aftertreatment device to manage exhaust temperature. The resulting rise in back pressure,
increases exhaust temperature.
6 ENGINE SYSTEMS OVERVIEW 1771
Optional Features
Optional features include the following:
• Air compressor
• Hydraulic pump
• Engine brake
• Exhaust Back Pressure Valve (EBPV)
An air compressor is available for applications that require air brakes or air suspension.
A hydraulic power steering pump can be used with or without the air compressor.
Engine brake and EBPV systems are available for applications that could benefit from added speed reduction
capability.
Figure 768 Low and high-pressure turbocharger components (below 245 hp shown)
1. High-pressure turbine housing 7. Breather outlet tube 13. High-pressure turbine inlet
2. High-pressure turbocharger 8. High-pressure turbo oil drain 14. Low-pressure turbine housing
outlet tube 15. Low-pressure bearing housing
3. Turbo wastegate actuator 9. Low-pressure turbo oil drain 16. Low-pressure compressor
4. Turbocharger 2 Wastegate tube housing
Control (TC2WC) valve 10. Turbo oil supply tube assembly 17. Air crossover duct
5. Turbo air inlet duct 11. Low-pressure turbine outlet
6. Low-pressure compressor 12. High-pressure compressor
housing housing
The high-pressure turbocharger is connected to the exhaust manifold through the high-pressure turbine inlet.
The high-pressure turbocharger is equipped with a wastegate that regulates the turbocharger boost by controlling
the amount of exhaust gases that pass through the high-pressure turbine. When demand for power is low, such
as during cruising speed, the turbocharger wastegate opens allowing part of the exhaust gas flow to bypass the
high-pressure turbine.
The low-pressure turbine is attached directly to the output of the high-pressure turbine. The exhaust gas enters
the low-pressure turbocharger through the low-pressure turbine housing and exits through the low-pressure
turbine outlet.
1776 6 ENGINE SYSTEMS OVERVIEW
EGR Flow
When EGR is commanded, the EGR valve opens and allows exhaust gas from the exhaust manifold to flow into
the EGR cooler for cooling. This cooled exhaust gas is directed through the EGR crossover duct into a port in
the intake manifold and directed to the air and EGR mixer duct where it is mixed with filtered intake air.
EGR Valve
The EGR valve consists of three major components, a valve, an actuator motor, and an Integrated Circuit (IC).
The EGR valve is installed in the air and EGR mixer duct assembly on the intake side of the engine.
The EGR valve uses a DC motor to control position of the valve assembly. The motor pushes directly on the
valve stem to open. The valve assembly has two poppets on a common shaft.
The IC has three hall effect position sensors to monitor valve movement.
The ECM commands EGR valve position based on engine speed and load conditions. The EGR control valve
provides feedback to the ECM on current valve position.
6 ENGINE SYSTEMS OVERVIEW 1781
The crankcase ventilation system uses an engine mounted oil separator to return oil to the crankcase. The
excess crankcase pressure is vented back into the intake system.
Oil extracted blow-by gases flow from the valve cover through the crankcase breather inlet tube into the breather
housing assembly.
A high-speed centrifugal oil separator, driven by engine oil pressure, separates and directs oil to the side of
housing assembly. The separated oil drains into the oil separator turbine housing, through the crankcase, and
into the oil pan. The oil separator is located inside and towards the top of the housing assembly.
The turbine housing also provides oil drainage from the low-pressure and high-pressure turbochargers. The
low-pressure and high-pressure turbo oil drain tubes direct turbocharger drain oil into the turbine housing. The
oil drains out of the turbine housing, through the crankcase, and into the oil pan.
Blow-by gases are directed through the breather outlet tube and into the turbocharger air inlet duct.
The AFT System, part of the larger exhaust system, processes engine exhaust to meet emissions requirements.
The AFT system traps particulate matter (soot) and prevents it from leaving the tailpipe.
1784 6 ENGINE SYSTEMS OVERVIEW
Sensors
Sensors output an electronic signal based on temperature or pressure. The signals are used by the control
system to regulate the aftertreatment function.
The sensors measure the temperature and pressure at the center of the exhaust flow.
The hydrocarbon injector assembly is cooled with engine coolant from the EGR cooler assembly.
6 ENGINE SYSTEMS OVERVIEW 1787
ICP System
The ICP (Injection Control Pressure) system is a closed loop system that uses the ICP sensor to continuously
provide feedback to the ECM. The ECM commands the IPR duty cycle to adjust pressure to match engine
requirements.
6 ENGINE SYSTEMS OVERVIEW 1791
The IPR valve receives a Pulse Width Modulated (PWM) signal from the ECM. This controls the on and off time
the IPR valve is energized. The on/off time is controlled by the ECM to meet calibrated desired values.
The IPR valve is mounted in the body of the high-pressure pump. The IPR valve maintains desired ICP by
dumping excess oil back into the crankcase sump.
As demand for ICP increases, the ECM increases the current to the IPR valve solenoid. When demand for ICP
decreases, the duty cycle to the IPR valve decreases and more oil is allowed to flow back to the crankcase
sump.
When the ICP electrical signal is out-of-range, the ECM sets a fault code.
When ICP signals are out-of-range, the ECM ignores them and goes into open loop operation. The IPR valve
will operate from programmed default values.
The ICP sensor is installed in the high-pressure oil manifold under the valve cover.
1792 6 ENGINE SYSTEMS OVERVIEW
Fuel Injector
Injector Needle
The injector needle opens inward when fuel pressure overcomes the Valve Opening Pressure (VOP). Fuel is
atomized at high-pressure through the nozzle tip.
Fill Stage
During the fill stage, both coils are de-energized and the spool valve is closed. High-pressure oil from the
high-pressure oil manifold is stopped at the spool valve.
Low-pressure fuel fills the four ports and enters through the edge filter on its way to the chamber beneath the
plunger. The needle control spring holds the needle onto its seat to prevent fuel from entering the combustion
chamber.
1794 6 ENGINE SYSTEMS OVERVIEW
Injection
1. A pulse-width controlled current energizes the OPEN coil. Magnetic force moves the spool valve open.
High-pressure oil flows past the spool valve and onto the top of the intensifier piston. Oil pressure
overcomes the force of the intensifier piston spring and the intensifier starts to move down. An increase
in fuel pressure under the plunger seats the fuel inlet check ball, and fuel pressure starts to build on the
needle.
2. The pulse-width controlled current to the OPEN coil is shut off, but the spool valve remains open.
High-pressure oil from the high-pressure oil manifold continues to flow past the spool valve. The
intensifier piston and plunger continue to move and fuel pressure increases in the barrel. When fuel
pressure rises above the VOP, the needle lifts off its seat and injection begins.
End of Injection
1. When the ECM determines that the correct injector on-time has been reached (the correct amount of fuel
has been delivered), the ECM sends a pulse-width controlled current to the CLOSE coil of the injector.
The current energizes the CLOSE coil and magnetic force closes the spool valve. High-pressure oil is
stopped against the spool valve.
2. The pulse-width controlled current to close the coil is shut off, but the spool valve remains closed. Oil
above the intensifier piston flows past the spool valve through the exhaust ports. The intensifier piston
and plunger return to their initial positions. Fuel pressure decreases until the needle control spring forces
the needle back on its seat.
6 ENGINE SYSTEMS OVERVIEW 1795
The electric fuel pump draws fuel through the fuel lines from the fuel tank. Fuel enters the fuel filter assembly
and passes through the 100 micron strainer.
An optional 250 watt electric heating element is available to warm incoming fuel to prevent waxing and optimize
cold weather performance. The heater is installed in the fuel filter assembly, below the electric fuel pump.
Fuel flows from the strainer through the electric fuel pump to the fuel filter for further conditioning.
If water is in the fuel, the fuel filter element repels the water. The water is collected at the bottom of the main
filter element cavity in the fuel filter assembly.
Fuel flows through the 5 micron filter element and the standpipe. The filter element removes debris from the
fuel. The standpipe prevents fuel from draining from the fuel rail during service.
6 ENGINE SYSTEMS OVERVIEW 1797
When the maximum amount of water is collected in the element cavity, the WIF sensor sends a signal to the
Electronic Control Module (ECM). The ECM turns on the amber Water In Fuel lamp located on the instrument
panel.
A water drain valve is located on the fuel filter assembly and can be opened to drain contaminants (usually
water) from the assembly.
A fuel pressure regulator valve is built into the fuel filter assembly. The regulator valve is calibrated to relieve
excessive fuel pressure. Excess fuel is sent through a fuel return line back to the fuel tank. Return fuel is not
filtered.
Fuel continuously flows from the top of the filter element cavity, through a 0.2 mm air bleed orifice (filter center
tube feature), and into the return fuel line. This aids in removing trapped air from the element cavity as a result
of servicing.
When the fuel filter is removed, a drain-to-tank port valve is opened. Fuel present in the filter assembly then
drains out and back to the tank to provide improved cleanliness during servicing. When fuel lines are removed,
a check valve eliminates spillage and ensures fuel line cleanliness.
The Fuel Delivery Pressure (FDP) sensor detects low fuel pressure caused by a fuel restriction or dirty fuel filter.
The FDP sensor sends a signal to the ECM when pressure is below programmed values for various engine
conditions. The ECM turns on an amber FUEL FILTER lamp located on the instrument panel.
Filtered fuel flows from the fuel filter assembly into the fuel rail. The fuel rail is an integral part of the intake
manifold. Fuel flows into six cylinder head passages to each fuel injector.
When the fuel injectors are activated, fuel flows from the fuel passages through the injector inlet ports and into
the fuel injectors.
6 ENGINE SYSTEMS OVERVIEW 1799
1. Unfiltered oil 10. Dual stage turbocharger 18. Piston cooling tube (6)
2. Cooled unfiltered oil 11. Oil cooler 19. Main filtered oil gallery
3. Filtered oil 12. Oil filter 20. Camshaft
4. Crankcase breather assembly 13. Oil cooler module assembly 21. Crankcase
5. Oil pump 14. Oil pressure regulator relief 22. Vertical gallery
6. Front cover valve 23. Cylinder head
7. Reservoir for high-pressure oil 15. Regulator relief valve drain to 24. Valve cover
pump sump 25. Rocker arm assembly oil gallery
8. Unfiltered oil gallery 16. Oil pan assembly 26. Air compressor (optional)
9. Pick-up tube 17. Crankshaft
Oil Flow
Unfiltered oil is drawn from the oil pan through the pickup tube and front cover passage by the crankshaft driven
oil pump. Pressurized oil is forced through a front cover passage, into the crankcase gallery, and to the oil
system module assembly. Oil flow into the oil cooler is controlled by the thermal bypass valve.
The thermal bypass valve allows unfiltered oil to bypass the oil cooler when the oil temperature is cold, and flow
directly to the oil filter. As the oil temperature begins to warm, the thermal bypass valve begins to open. This
allows unfiltered oil to flow into the oil cooler and oil filter.
When the oil temperature is hot, the thermal bypass valve is fully open. This allows all unfiltered oil to flow
through the oil cooler before entering the oil filter.
Unfiltered oil moves through plates in the oil cooler heat exchanger. Engine coolant flows around the plates to
cool the surrounding oil.
Oil that exits or bypasses the oil cooler mixes and enters the spin-on oil filter. Oil flows from outside the filter
element towards the inside to remove debris. When the filter is restricted, the oil filter bypass (located in the oil
6 ENGINE SYSTEMS OVERVIEW 1801
filter can) opens and allows oil to bypass the filter to maintain engine lubrication. The filter bypass valve opens
when pressure reaches 60 psi (414 kPa).
After passing through the filter, the oil travels past the oil pressure regulator. The regulator directs excess oil
back to the oil pan to maintain oil pressure at a maximum of 57 psi (393 kPa).
Clean regulated oil enters the main oil gallery of the engine to lubricate the crankshaft, camshaft, and tappets.
The crankshaft has cross-drillings that direct oil to the connecting rods.
Oil is also provided to the high-pressure reservoir through a passage in the front cover.
Piston cooling jets continuously direct cooled oil to the bottom of the piston crowns.
Oil is provided to the cylinder head from the rear cam bearing through a passage at the rear of the crankcase.
Oil flows through a passage in the cylinder head and rear rocker shaft support, then enters the hollow rocker
shaft, which lubricates the rocker arms.
The crankcase breather assembly oil separator is driven by unfiltered oil pressure taken from the right side of
the crankcase. Oil flows from the crankcase into the breather assembly oil separator. Passages direct the oil
through a pressed brass nozzle that controls oil flow into the drive oil separator wheel. Oil drains into the base
and mixes with oil from the breather system. The collected oil drains into the crankcase and then into the oil pan.
The turbocharger is lubricated with filtered oil from a supply tube assembly that connects the oil cooler module
assembly to the center housing of each turbocharger. Oil drains back to the crankcase through drain tubes
connected to the base of the breather housing assembly.
The optional air compressor is lubricated with filtered engine oil through a flexible hose. The hose is connected to
a tee on the left side of the crankcase near the Engine Oil Pressure (EOP) sensor. Oil drains into the front cover
and to the oil pan. Oil can also drain from the bottom of the air compressor through a tube into the crankcase.
The front gear train is splash lubricated with oil that drains from the high-pressure reservoir and the optional air
compressor.
1802 6 ENGINE SYSTEMS OVERVIEW
• EGR cooler
• Coolant surge tank
• Coolant heater (if equipped)
The water pump pushes coolant into the crankcase, low temperature radiator, and EGR cooler.
Coolant flows to the crankcase and through the water jackets from front to rear. Coolant flows around the cylinder
liners to absorb heat from combustion. Coolant may also pass by the optional engine coolant heater.
Swirling coolant flow in the cylinder liner jackets directs coolant through passages in the cylinder head gasket
and upwards into the cylinder head.
Coolant flows through the cylinder head water jackets towards the thermostat cavity at the front of the cylinder
head. When the thermostat is closed, coolant is directed through the bypass port, crankcase, front cover, and
into the water pump. When the thermostat is open, the bypass port is blocked, and coolant is directed through
the radiator.
Coolant passes through the radiator and is cooled by moving air from the coolant fan. Coolant returns to the
engine through the inlet elbow and front cover.
The air compressor is cooled with engine coolant supplied by a hose from the left side of the crankcase. Coolant
passes through the air compressor and returns to the cylinder head through a passage in the crankcase.
The oil cooler module assembly receives coolant from a passage in the crankcase. Coolant passes between
the oil cooler plates and returns through a tube connected to the coolant supply housing.
The EGR cooler receives coolant from the water pump through a supply tube at the rear of the front cover.
Coolant passing through the EGR cooler, flows through the cooler plates, cools the exhaust gas, and exits
through a tube to the rear of the front cover that returns coolant to the pump inlet. The hydrocarbon injector
assembly receives and returns coolant to the EGR cooler.
The EGR coolant supply tube also branches off to the low temperature radiator and to the interstage cooler
(above 245 hp), if equipped. For engines with ratings above 245 hp, the coolant is routed through the low
temperature thermostat, then through the low temperature radiator to the interstage cooler. Coolant is regulated
by the low temperature radiator thermostat. Warm coolant is directed to the low temperature radiator and into
the interstage cooler. Cold coolant bypasses the low temperature radiator and moves directly into the interstage
cooler.
The interstage cooler uses coolant to lower the charged air temperature that exits from the turbocharger
low-pressure compressor and enters the turbocharger high-pressure compressor.
The surge tank provides expansion space for coolant and deaerates the cooling system. The following four
vents provide coolant to the tank:
• Engine vent (top of coolant supply housing)
• EGR vent (top of EGR cooler)
• Main radiator vent (top of radiator)
• Interstage cooler vent (top of interstage cooler)
The surge tank returns coolant through the surge line, back to the water pump inlet.
Cab heat is provided by the heater core, which receives warmed coolant from the coolant supply housing.
1804 6 ENGINE SYSTEMS OVERVIEW
Thermostat Operation
Coolant travels through two ports after it passes through the thermostat. One port directs coolant to the radiator
when the engine is at operating temperature. The other port directs coolant to the water pump until the engine
reaches operating temperature. The thermostat begins to open at 190°F (88°C) and is fully open at 205°F
(96°C).
When engine coolant is below 190°F (88°C), the thermostat is closed, blocking flow to the radiator. Coolant is
forced to flow through a bypass port back to the water pump.
1806 6 ENGINE SYSTEMS OVERVIEW
When coolant temperature reaches the nominal opening temperature of 190°F (88°C), the thermostat opens
allowing some coolant to flow to the radiator. When coolant temperature exceeds 205°F (96°C), the lower seat
blocks the bypass port directing full coolant flow to the radiator.
6 ENGINE SYSTEMS OVERVIEW 1807
Engines equipped with Interstage Cooler (ISC) will also have a Low Temperature Radiator (LTR) and LTR
thermostat. The LTR thermostat is a wax element thermostat in a housing with one inlet port and two outlet
ports. During cold engine operation (thermostat closed), coolant is directed to the ISC directly, through the
bypass port. At normal operating temperature (thermostat open), coolant is directed to the LTR first and then to
the ISC. The thermostat begins to open at 194°F (90°C) and is fully open at 209°F (98°C). The LTR thermostat
is installed on the chassis near the LTR.
1808 6 ENGINE SYSTEMS OVERVIEW
Microprocessor
The ECM microprocessor stores operating instructions (control strategies) and value tables (calibration
parameters). The ECM compares stored instructions and values with conditioned input values to determine
the correct strategy for all engine operations.
Actuator Control
The ECM controls the actuators by applying a low level signal (low side driver) or a high level signal (high side
driver). When switched on, the drivers complete a ground or power circuit to an actuator.
Actuators are controlled in one of the following ways, depending upon type of actuator:
• Duty cycle (percent time on / off)
• Controlled pulse width
• Switched on or off
Actuators
The ECM controls engine operation with the following:
• Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) valve
• Intake Air Heater (IAH) relay
• Engine Throttle Valve (ETV) and position sensor
• Turbocharger 2 Wastegate Control (TC2WC) valve (turbocharger wastegate actuator)
• Exhaust Back Pressure Valve (EBPV)
• Engine Compression Brake (ECB) valve
• Injection Pressure Regulator (IPR) valve
1810 6 ENGINE SYSTEMS OVERVIEW
Thermistor Sensors
A thermistor sensor varies electrical resistance with changes in temperature. Resistance in the thermistor
decreases as temperature increases and increases as temperature decreases. Thermistors have a resistor
that limits current in the ECM to a voltage signal matched with a temperature value.
The top half of the voltage divider is the current limiting resistor inside the ECM. A thermistor sensor has two
electrical connectors, signal return and ground. The output of a thermistor sensor is a nonlinear analog signal.
Thermistor type sensors include the following:
• Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) sensor
• Engine Oil Temperature (EOT) sensor
• Inlet Air Temperature (IAT) sensor
• Intake Manifold Temperature (IMT) sensor
• Charge Air Cooler Outlet Temperature (CACOT) sensor
• Turbocharger 2 Compressor Inlet Temperature (TC2CIT) sensor
ECT Sensor
The ECM monitors the ECT signal and uses this information for the instrument panel temperature gauge, coolant
compensation, Engine Warning Protection System (EWPS), and IAH operation. The ECT is a backup, if the EOT
is out-of-range. The ECT sensor is installed in the coolant supply housing (refrigerant compressor bracket).
6 ENGINE SYSTEMS OVERVIEW 1817
EOT Sensor
The ECM monitors the EOT signal and uses this information to control fuel quantity and timing. The EOT signal
allows the ECM to compensate for differences in oil viscosity for temperature changes. The EOT sensor is
installed in the rear of the front cover, to the left of the high-pressure pump assembly.
IAT Sensor
The IAT sensor is integral to the Mass Air Flow (MAF) sensor. The ECM monitors the IAT signal to control
injector timing and fuel rate during cold starts. The ECM also uses the IAT signal to control EGR position and
engine throttle control.
IMT Sensor
The IMT sensor monitors the air temperature in the intake manifold. The ECM monitors the IMT signal for EGR
operation. The IMT sensor is installed in the intake manifold, to the right of the IMP sensor.
CACOT Sensor
The CACOT sensor monitors the temperature of the air leaving the CAC. The ECM monitors the CACOT signal
to evaluate the effectiveness and condition of the CAC.
TC2CIT Sensor
The TC2CIT sensor monitors the temperature of the air entering the Turbocharger 2 compressor. The ECM
monitors the TC2CIT signal to evaluate the effectiveness and condition of the interstage cooler.
Variable capacitance sensors measure pressure. The pressure measured is applied to a ceramic diaphragm.
Pressure forces the ceramic material closer to a thin metal disk. This action changes the capacitance and
subsequently the voltage output of the sensor.
This type of sensor has three wires: VREF, ground, and a signal wire.
The sensor receives the VREF and returns an analog signal voltage to the ECM. The ECM compares the voltage
with pre-programmed values to determine pressure.
The operational range of a variable capacitance sensor is linked to the thickness of the ceramic disk. The thicker
the ceramic disk, the more pressure the sensor can measure.
Variable capacitance sensors include the following:
• Fuel Delivery Pressure (FDP) sensor
• Engine Oil Pressure (EOP) sensor
• Exhaust Back Pressure (EBP) sensor
• Mass Air Flow (MAF) sensor
• Intake Manifold Pressure (IMP) sensor
FDP Sensor
The ECM uses the FDP sensor signal to monitor engine fuel pressure and give an indication when the fuel filter
needs to be changed. The FDP sensor is installed in the fuel filter assembly on the intake side of the crankcase.
EOP Sensor
The ECM monitors the EOP signal, and uses this information for the instrument panel pressure gauge and
EWPS. The EOP sensor is installed in the intake side of the crankcase, below the fuel filter assembly.
EBP Sensor
The ECM monitors the exhaust pressure to control the EGR and intake throttle systems. The EBP sensor is
installed in a tube mounted on the coolant supply housing (refrigerant compressor bracket).
6 ENGINE SYSTEMS OVERVIEW 1819
MAF Sensor
The MAF sensor is used for closed loop control of the EGR valve and ETV. The ECM monitors the MAF signal
to control the EGR and intake throttle systems. The MAF sensor also sends air temperature information to the
ECM. The MAF sensor is installed in the intake air duct or air cleaner housing.
IMP Sensor
The ECM monitors the IMP signal to control the EGR and intake throttle systems. The IMP sensor is installed
in the intake manifold, left of the IMT sensor.
1820 6 ENGINE SYSTEMS OVERVIEW
A magnetic pickup sensor contains a permanent magnet core that is surrounded by a coil of wire. The sensor
generates a voltage signal through the collapse of a magnetic field that is created by a moving metal trigger.
The movement of the trigger then creates an AC voltage in the sensor coil.
Magnetic pickup sensors used include the following:
• Crankshaft Position (CKP) sensor
• Camshaft Position (CMP) sensor
• Vehicle Speed Sensor (VSS)
CKP Sensor
The CKP sensor provides the ECM with a signal that indicates crankshaft speed and position. As the crankshaft
turns, the CKP sensor detects a 60-tooth timing disk on the crankshaft. Teeth 59 and 60 are missing. By
comparing the CKP signal with the CMP signal, the ECM calculates engine rpm and timing requirements. The
CKP sensor is installed in the top left side of the flywheel housing.
CMP Sensor
The CMP sensor provides the ECM with a signal that indicates camshaft position. As the cam rotates, the sensor
identifies the position of the cam by locating a peg on the cam. The CMP sensor is installed in the front cover,
above and to the right of the water pump pulley.
VSS
The VSS provides the ECM with transmission tail shaft speed by sensing the rotation of a 16-tooth gear on the
rear of the transmission. The detected sine wave signal (AC), received by the ECM, is used with tire size and
axle ratio to calculate vehicle speed. The VSS is on the left side of the transmission.
6 ENGINE SYSTEMS OVERVIEW 1821
High-pressure Sensors
High-pressure sensors convert pressure to a linear analog voltage output of 0 to 5 volts. Pressure to be
measured exerts force on a diaphragm with a strain gauge bonded to it. This diaphragm stretches and
compresses to change mechanical motion into an electrical signal.
This type of sensor has three wires: VREF, ground, and a signal wire.
The sensor is powered by VREF from the ECM and is grounded through the ECM to a common sensor ground.
The ECM compares the voltage with pre-programmed values to determine pressure.
High-pressure sensors include the following:
• Diesel Particulate Filter Differential Pressure (DPFDP) sensor
• Engine Compression Brake Pressure (ECBP) sensor
• Injection Control Pressure (ICP) sensor
DPFDP Sensor
The DPFDP sensor provides a feedback signal to the ECM indicating the pressure difference between the inlet
and outlet of the Diesel Particulate Filter (DPF). During a catalyst regeneration, the ECM monitors this sensor
along with three Aftertreatment System thermistor sensors, the EGR System, and the Engine Throttle Valve
(ETV).
ECBP
The ECM monitors the ECBP signal to determine oil pressure in the brake gallery of the high-pressure oil
manifold. The ECBP sensor is under the valve cover, forward of the No. 2 fuel injector in the high-pressure
oil manifold.
ICP
The ECM monitors the ICP sensor to determine injection control pressure for engine operation. The ICP sensor
is used to control the IPR valve. It provides feedback to the ECM for Closed Loop IPR control. The ICP sensor
is located under the valve cover, forward of the No. 6 fuel injector in the high-pressure oil manifold.
1822 6 ENGINE SYSTEMS OVERVIEW
Potentiometer
A potentiometer is a variable voltage divider that senses the position of a mechanical component. A reference
voltage is applied to one end of the potentiometer. Mechanical rotary or linear motion moves the wiper along
the resistance material, changing voltage at each point along the resistive material. Voltage is proportional to
the amount of mechanical movement.
APP
The APP provides the ECM with a feedback signal (linear analog voltage) that indicates the operator's demand
for power. There are two potentiometers within the APP sensor. The APP is installed in the cab on the accelerator
pedal.
6 ENGINE SYSTEMS OVERVIEW 1823
Switches
Switch sensors indicate position, level, or status. They operate open or closed, regulating the flow of current. A
switch sensor can be a voltage input switch or a grounding switch. A voltage input switch supplies the ECM with
a voltage when it is closed. A grounding switch grounds the circuit when closed, causing a zero voltage signal.
Grounding switches are usually installed in series with a current limiting resistor.
Switches include the following:
• Driveline Disengagement Switch (DDS)
• Engine Coolant Level (ECL)
• Water In Fuel (WIF)
DDS
The DDS determines if a vehicle is in gear. For manual transmissions, the clutch switch serves as the DDS. For
automatic transmissions, the neutral indicator switch or datalink communication functions as the DDS.
ECL
ECL is part of the Engine Warning Protection System (EWPS). The ECL switch is used in plastic deaeration
tanks. When a magnetic switch is open, the tank is full.
If engine coolant is low, the switch closes and the red ENGINE lamp on the instrument panel is illuminated.
WIF
A Water In Fuel (WIF) sensor in the fuel filter assembly is used to detect water in the fuel. The resistance of the
WIF sensor circuit changes when the water level in the fuel filter assembly reaches the sensor. The ECM then
sends a message to illuminate the amber water in fuel lamp, alerting the operator. The WIF is installed in the
side of the fuel filter assembly.
1824 6 ENGINE SYSTEMS OVERVIEW
The Engine Throttle Valve (ETV) is controlled to limit inlet air. As part of the air management system, the ETV is
controlled by the ECM (closed loop) based on input from the Mass Air Flow (MAF) sensor for proper emissions
control.
The ETV is also used to help control inlet air during a Diesel Particulate Filter (DPF) regeneration process of the
aftertreatment system. It maintains vehicle and engine performance during regenerations.
6 ENGINE SYSTEMS OVERVIEW 1825
The exhaust brake is available for all ratings and aids in the deceleration rate of vehicles.
The exhaust brake is an exhaust back pressure brake system that provides improved braking performance. The
operator can enable the brake function by toggling an instrument panel mounted switch ON or OFF.
1826 6 ENGINE SYSTEMS OVERVIEW
Engine Brake
ECBP
The ECM monitors the ECBP signal during engine normal and braking operation to determine if the engine
brake system is working without fault. The ECBP sensor provides a feedback signal to the ECM indicating
brake control pressure. The ECBP sensor is installed in the high-pressure oil manifold, under the valve cover.
ECB
The ECB valve controls pressure entering the brake oil gallery from the injector oil gallery. This activates
the brake actuator pistons and opens the exhaust valves. The ECB valve is installed in the center of the
high-pressure oil manifold.
EBP
The EBP sensor is an input to the ECM for control of the Turbocharger 2 Wastegate Control (TC2WC) valve. The
TC2WC valve controls the turbocharger wastegate actuator. The EBP sensor is mounted on a tube plumbed to
the exhaust manifold on the exhaust side of the engine.
Operation
During engine brake operation, The ECB valve opens to supply high-pressure oil to each brake actuator piston.
These brake actuator pistons hold the exhaust valves partially open.
During normal engine operation, oil in the high-pressure manifold goes to the fuel injectors only. The engine
compression brake valve, mounted in the high-pressure oil manifold, is closed to prevent oil from entering the
brake gallery.
Figure 800 Engine compression brake valve and brake actuator – OFF
1. High-pressure oil manifold 4. Engine compression brake valve 7. Valve lash (actuator retracted)
2. High-pressure oil gallery 5. Brake actuator piston assembly 8. Oil inlet
3. Brake oil gallery 6. Exhaust valve bridge
6 ENGINE SYSTEMS OVERVIEW 1829
The ECM monitors the following criteria to make sure certain conditions are met:
• Anti-lock Brake System (ABS) (inactive)
• RPM (greater than 1200)
• APP (less than 5%)
• EOT (greater than or equal to 140°F [60°C])
• Operator input switches (On / Off)
If On is selected, and the preceding criteria are met, the engine brake will activate.
When the engine brake is activated, the ECM provides the power to activate the Engine Compression Brake
(ECB) valve to allow oil from the injector oil gallery to flow to the brake oil gallery. High oil pressure activates the
brake actuator pistons to open the exhaust valves.
Vehicle momentum is absorbed by the resulting compression release of the engine power cylinders when pistons
are near the top of their stroke.
During an ABS event, the engine brake is deactivated. The engine brake is reactivated once the ABS event is
over.
The ECM removes the power source from the ECB valve to deactivate the engine brake. Residual brake gallery
pressure initially bleeds from the actuator bore. When brake gallery pressure bleeds down the brake pressure
relief valve opens, and oil drains back to sump.
1830 6 ENGINE SYSTEMS OVERVIEW
Operation Modes
The engine brake system provides three programmable modes of operation based on terrain, driving conditions,
or driver preference.
Coast Mode
When the coast mode is programmed, the brake system will activate only when the driver applies the vehicle
service brake. The coast mode allows the vehicle to coast without automatic brake system activation.
Latched Mode
When the latch mode is programmed, the brake system will activate when the driver releases the accelerator
pedal. The brake system will deactivate when the driver depresses the accelerator or clutch pedals. The brake
system will also deactivate when the engine speed is below a pre-programmed rpm.
Cruise Mode
When the cruise mode is programmed, the brake system performs similar to latch mode under normal driving
conditions. When cruise control is used the brake system will activate when the vehicle travels down a grade.
The brake system helps the cruise control system maintain the set vehicle speed.
7 ENGINE AND VEHICLE FEATURES 1831
Table of Contents
Standard Features
Electronic Governor Control
The governor controls engine rpm within a safe and stable operating range.
The low idle governor prevents engine rpm from dropping below a stable speed to prevent stalling when various
loads are demanded on the engine.
The high idle governor prevents engine rpm from going above a safe speed that would cause engine damage.
Service Diagnostics
NOTE: Model year 2010 vehicles no longer utilize DTC identification by number. DTCs are now identified
using the SPN and FMI identifiers only. These two identifiers, known as the Suspect Parameter Number (SPN)
and the Failure Mode Indicator (FMI), are displayed in the Electronic Service Tool (EST) with Navistar® Engine
Diagnostics in the DTC Window for model year 2010 vehicles and DTC for pre-2010 vehicles.
The EST provides diagnostic information using the SAE J1939 datalink. The recommended EST is the EZ-Tech®
with Navistar® Engine Diagnostics provided by Navistar®.
Faults from sensors, actuators, electronic components, and engine systems are detected by the ECM and sent
to the EST as codes. Effective engine diagnostics require and rely on codes.
Identification is accomplished using two fault code identifiers. These two identifiers, known as the Suspect
Parameter Number (SPN) and the Failure Mode Indicator (FMI) are displayed in the DTC window on model year
2010 or newer. On pre-2010 vehicles DTC may still be displayed in the ETC window.
• Suspect Parameter Number (SPN) The Suspect Parameter Number (SPN) identifies the individual
component causing the DTC.
• Failure Mode Indicator (FMI) The Failure Mode Indicator (FMI) identifies the fault or condition effecting the
individual component.
1834 7 ENGINE AND VEHICLE FEATURES
Aftertreatment System
The engine and vehicle exhaust piping includes an Aftertreatment System to capture soot and other particulates
before they exit the exhaust pipe. The soot is captured by the Diesel Particulate Filter (DPF) and is periodically
converted to ash by a Regeneration (Regen) process.
• Clutch pedal is depressed or clutch pedal switch fault is detected (manual transmissions, if equipped with a
clutch switch)
• Shift selector is moved from neutral (automatic transmissions). Shift selector must be in neutral for CAP to
work
• Power Takeoff (PTO) switch, also used for electric hand throttle, is turned on and actively controls engine
speed
• Accelerator pedal is depressed or Accelerator Pedal Sensor (APS) fault is detected
• Idle Shutdown Timer (IST) is enabled
• Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) sensor fault is detected
• Intake Air Temperature (IAT) ambient temperature sensor fault is detected
Optional Features
Road Speed Limiting (RSL)
Road Speed Limiting (RSL) is a feature designed to regulate the maximum vehicle speed as controlled by the
accelerator pedal.
Customer programmable parameters within the ECM provide vehicle speed governor related options that can
be adjusted to suit the customer’s needs. A parameter is used to set the maximum accelerator controlled vehicle
speed.
Additional programming flexibility is included to allow a trade-off to be made between performance and fuel
economy.
Cruise Control
The ECM controls the cruise control feature. The cruise control system functions similarly for all electronic
engines. Maximum and minimum allowable cruise control speeds will vary based on model. To operate cruise
control, see appropriate truck model Operator's Manual.
Traction Control
Traction control is a system that identifies when a wheel is going faster than the other wheels during acceleration.
When a traction control condition occurs, a datalink message is sent to the ECM to limit fuel for the purpose of
reducing engine torque.
Vehicles must have a transmission and an Antilock Braking System (ABS) that supports traction control.
Exhaust Brake
The exhaust brake increases exhaust back-pressure to aid in the deceleration rate of the vehicle. This option is
placed in the exhaust piping after the turbochargers. This option cannot be combined with the engine brake.
Engine Brake
The engine brake is a compression release brake system to aid in the deceleration rate of the vehicle. This
option is built into the high-pressure oil manifold under the engine valve cover. This option cannot be combined
with the exhaust brake.
GOVERNMENT REGULATION: State and local regulations may limit engine idle time. The
vehicle owner or operator is responsible for compliance with those regulations.
The IST allows the Engine Control Module (ECM) to shut down the engine during extended engine idle times.
Thirty seconds before IST-defined engine shutdown, a vehicle instrument panel indicator activates. There are
two types of indicators:
• Amber flashing idle shutdown indicator for multiplex electrical systems
• Red flashing indicator with audible alarm for non-multiplex electrical systems
This continues until the engine shuts down or the low idle shutdown timer is reset
Fuel Heater
The fuel heater is installed in the fuel filter assembly. The heater warms the supply fuel to prevent waxing during
cold conditions.
8 ABBREVIATIONS AND ACRONYMS 1839
Table of Contents
C – Celsius
CAC – Charge Air Cooler
CACOT – Charge Air Cooler Outlet Temperature
CAN – Controller Area Network
CAN-H – Controller Area Network High
CAN-L – Controller Area Network Low
CAP – Cold Ambient Protection
CARB – California Air Resources Board
cc – Cubic centimeter
CCA – Cold Cranking Ampere
CCV – Coolant Control Valve
CCOSS – Crankcase Oil Separator Speed
CCPS – Crankcase Pressure Sensor
CCS – Cruise Control Switches
CDR – Crankcase Depression Regulator
cfm – Cubic feet per minute
cfs – Cubic feet per second
CFV – Coolant Flow Valve
CID – Cubic Inch Displacement
CKP – Crankshaft Position
CKP-H – Crankshaft Position High
CKP-L – Crankshaft Position Low
CKPO – Crankshaft Position Out
cm – Centimeter
CMP – Camshaft Position
CMP-H – Camshaft Position High
CMP-L – Camshaft Position Low
CMPO – Camshaft Position Out
CMV – Coolant Mixer Valve
CO – Carbon Monoxide
COO – Cruise On / Off switch
CPU – Central Processing Unit
CSFI – Cold Start Fuel Igniter
CSFS – Cold Start Fuel Solenoid
CSR – Cold Start Relay
CSS – Cold Start Solenoid
CTC – Coolant Temperature Compensation
Cyl – Cylinder
8 ABBREVIATIONS AND ACRONYMS 1843
DB – Decibel
DC – Direct Current
DCA – Diesel Coolant Additive
DCU – Doser Control Unit
DDI – Digital Direct Fuel Injection
DDS – Driveline Disengagement Switch
DLC – Data Link Connector
DME – Dimethyl Ether
DMM – Digital Multimeter
DOC – Diesel Oxidation Catalyst
DOCIT – Diesel Oxidation Catalyst Inlet Temperature
DOCOT – Diesel Oxidation Catalyst Outlet Temperature
DPF – Diesel Particulate Filter
DPFDP – Diesel Particulate Filter Differential Pressure
DPFIT – Diesel Particulate Filter Inlet Temperature
DPFOT – Diesel Particulate Filter Outlet Temperature
DSI – Down Stream Injection
DT – Diesel Turbocharged
DTC – Diagnostic Trouble Code
DTCs – Diagnostic Trouble Codes
DTRM – Diesel Thermo Recirculation Module
F – Fahrenheit
FCV – Fuel Coolant Valve
FDP – Fuel Delivery Pressure
FEL – Family Emissions Limit
fhp – Friction horsepower
FMI – Failure Mode Indicator
FPC – Fuel Pump Control
FPCV – Fuel Pressure Control Valve
fpm – Feet per minute
FPM – Fuel Pump Monitor
fps – Feet per second
FRP – Fuel Rail Pressure
ft – Feet
FVCV – Fuel Volume Control Valve
H2O – Water
HC – Hydrocarbons
HCI – Hydrocarbon Injection
HEST – High Exhaust System Temperature
HFCM – Horizontal Fuel Conditioning Module
Hg – Mercury
hp – Horsepower
HPCAC – High-Pressure Charge Air Cooler
HPCR – High-Pressure Common Rail
HPFP – High-Pressure Fuel Pump
hr – Hour
HS – Humidity Sensor
Hyd – Hydraulic
kg – Kilogram
km – Kilometer
km/h – Kilometers per hour
km/l – Kilometers per liter
KOEO – Key-On Engine-Off
KOER – Key-On Engine-Running
kPa – Kilopascal
L – Liter
L/h – Liters per hour
L/m – Liters per minute
L/s – Liters per second
lb – Pound
lb – Pounds of force
lb/s – Pounds per second
lb ft – Pounds of force per foot
lb in – Pounds of force per inch
lbm – Pounds of mass
LPCAC – Low-pressure Charge Air Cooler
LSD – Low Sulfur Diesel
m – Meter
m/s – Meters per second
MAF – Mass Air Flow
MAF GND – Mass Air Flow Ground
MAG – Magnetic
MAP – Manifold Absolute Pressure
MAP / IAT – Manifold Absolute Pressure / Intake Air Temperature
MAT – Manifold Air Temperature
mep – Mean effective pressure
mi – Mile
MIL – Malfunction Indicator Lamp
mm – Millimeter
mpg – Miles per gallon
mph – Miles per hour
MPR – Main Power Relay
MSDS – Material Safety Data Sheet
MSG – Micro Strain Gauge
MSM – Multiplex System Module
MY – Model Year
qt – Quart
V – Volt
VBAT or B+ – Battery Voltage
VC – Volume Control
VEPS – Vehicle Electronics Programming System
VGT – Variable Geometry Turbo
VIGN – Ignition Voltage
VIN – Vehicle Identification Number
VOP – Valve Opening Pressure
VRE – Vehicle Retarder Enable
VREF – Reference Voltage
VREF1 – Reference Voltage Engine
VREF2 – Reference Voltage Chassis
VREF3 – Reference Voltage Chassis
VREF4 – Reference Voltage Aftertreatment
VSO – Vehicle Speed Output
VSO or VSS_CAL – Vehicle Speed Output
VSS – Vehicle Speed Sensor
VSS_CAL or VSO – Vehicle Speed Output
VSS-H – Vehicle Speed Sensor High
VSS-L – Vehicle Speed Sensor Low
XCS – Transfercase
XMSN – Transmission
1850 8 ABBREVIATIONS AND ACRONYMS
9 TERMINOLOGY 1851
Table of Contents
Terms. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1853
1852 9 TERMINOLOGY
9 TERMINOLOGY 1853
Terms
Accelerator Pedal Position (APP) sensor – A potentiometer sensor that indicates the position of the throttle
pedal.
Accessory work – The work per cycle required to drive engine accessories (normally, only those essential to
engine operation).
Actuator – A device that performs work in response to an input signal.
Actuator Control – The ECM controls the actuators by applying a low-level signal (low-side driver) or a high-level
signal (high side driver). When switched on, both drivers complete a ground or power circuit to an actuator.
Aeration – The entrainment of air or combustion gas in coolant, lubricant, or fuel.
Aftercooler – See Charge Air Cooler.
Aftertreatment (AFT) system – A part of the exhaust system that processes engine exhaust to meet emission
requirements and traps particulate matter (soot) to prevent it from leaving the tailpipe.
Aftertreatment Fuel Doser (AFTFD) – A part of the Downstream Injection (DSI) unit that sends pressurized
fuel to the Aftertreatment Fuel Injector (AFI) to inject fuel into the exhaust pipe.
Aftertreatment Fuel Inlet Sensor (AFTFIS) – A sensor that monitors fuel temperature in the DSI system and
provides constant feedback to the ECM.
Aftertreatment Fuel Pressure 2 Sensor (AFTP2) – A sensor that monitors fuel pressure in the DSI system
and provides constant feedback to the ECM.
Aftertreatment Fuel Shutoff Valve (AFTFSV) – A valve used to prevent fuel flow to the Aftertreatment Fuel
Injector (AFI), and prevents all uncontrolled fuel delivery for the Aftertreatment system during an AFTFD valve
malfunction.
Air Control Valve (ACV) – Contains the EBPV control port and the TC1TOP port. Although these components
are integral to the ACV, each circuit is controlled by the ECM. The ACV controls compressed air for each EBPV.
Ambient Air Temperature (AAT) sensor – A sensor that sends an ambient air temperature signal to the ECM.
Ambient temperature – The environmental air temperature in which a unit is operating. In general, the
temperature is measured in the shade (no solar radiation) and represents the air temperature for other engine
cooling performance measurement purposes. Air entering the radiator may or may not be the same ambient
due to possible heating from other sources or recirculation. (SAE J1004 SEP81)
American Trucking Association (ATA) Datalink – A serial datalink specified by the American Trucking
Association and the SAE.
Ampere (amp) – The standard unit for measuring the strength of an electrical current. The flow rate of a charge
in a conductor or conducting medium of one coulomb per second. (SAE J1213 NOV82)
Analog – A continuously variable voltage.
Analog to digital converter (A/D) – A device in the ECM that converts an analog signal to a digital signal.
Barometric Absolute Pressure (BAP) sensor – A sensor built into the ECM that provides barometric pressure
information to the ECM.
Boost pressure – 1. The pressure of the charge air leaving the turbocharger.
2. Inlet manifold pressure that is greater than atmospheric pressure. Obtained by turbocharging.
Bottom Dead Center (BDC) – The lowest position of the piston during the stroke.
1854 9 TERMINOLOGY
Brake Horsepower (bhp) – The power output from an engine, not the indicated horsepower. The power output
of an engine, sometimes-called flywheel horsepower, is less than the indicated horsepower by the amount of
friction horsepower consumed in the engine.
Brake Horsepower (bhp) net – Net brake horsepower is measured with all engine components. The power of
an engine when configured as a fully equipped engine. (SAE J1349 JUN90)
Brake On/Off (BOO) switch – A switch located on the brake pedal lever, that provides a brake pedal position
signal to the ECM.
Brake Pressure Switch (BPS) – A switch located in the brake pressure line that provides a brake pedal position
signal to the ECM.
Calibration – ECM programming strategy to solve engine performance equations and make decisions.
Calibration values are stored in ROM and put into the processor during programming to allow the engine to
operate within certain parameters.
Camshaft Position (CMP) sensor – A magnetic pickup sensor that provides the ECM with a camshaft speed
and position signal.
Carbon Monoxide (CO) – A colorless, odorless, highly poisonous gas that is formed by the incomplete
combustion of carbon burning diesel engine. It is present in the exhaust gases of diesel engines.
Catalyst – A substance that produces a chemical reaction without undergoing a chemical change itself.
Catalytic converter – An antipollution device in the exhaust system that contains a catalyst for chemically
converting some pollutants in the exhaust gases (carbon monoxide, unburned hydrocarbons, and oxides of
nitrogen) into harmless compounds.
Cavitation – A dynamic condition in a fluid system that forms gas-filled bubbles (cavities) in the fluid.
Cetane number – 1. The auto-ignition quality of diesel fuel.
2. A rating applied to diesel fuel similar to octane rating for gasoline.
3. A measure of how readily diesel fuel starts to burn (self-ignites) at high compression temperature.
Diesel fuel with a high cetane number self-ignites shortly after injection into the combustion chamber. Therefore,
it has a short ignition delay time. Diesel fuel with a low cetane number resists self-ignition. Therefore, it has a
longer ignition delay time.
Charge air – Dense, pressurized, heated air discharged from the turbocharger.
Charge Air Cooler (CAC) – A heat exchanger mounted in the charge air path between the turbocharger and
engine intake manifold. The charge air cooler reduces the charge air temperature by transferring heat from the
charge air to a cooling medium (usually air).
Charge Air Cooler Outlet Temperature (CACOT) sensor – A thermistor sensor that monitors the temperature
of charge air entering the intake air duct.
Closed crankcase – A crankcase ventilation that recycles crankcase gases through a breather, then back to
the clean air intake.
Closed loop operation – A system that uses sensors to provide feedback to the ECM. The ECM uses the
sensor input to continuously monitor variables and adjust actuators to match engine requirements.
Cloud point – The point when wax crystals occur in fuel, making fuel cloudy or hazy. Usually below -12°C
(10°F).
Cold cranking ampere rating (battery rating) – The sustained constant current (in amperes) needed to
produce a minimum terminal voltage under a load of 7.2 volts per battery after 30 seconds.
9 TERMINOLOGY 1855
Cold Start Fuel Igniter (CSFI) – The CSFI heats the intake air by vaporizing and igniting fuel in the air inlet duct.
Cold Start Fuel Solenoid (CSFS) – As the engine is cranked, the ECM energizes the CSFS valve, introducing
fuel into the CSFI, which ignites and warms the air being drawn into the engine.
Cold Start Relay (CSR) – The CSR provides voltage to the CSFI, and is controlled by the ECM.
Controller Area Network (CAN) – A J1939 high-speed communication link.
Coolant – A fluid used to transport heat from one point to another.
Coolant Flow Valve (CFV) – The CFV is ECM controlled and redirects coolant through the fuel cooler, based
on EFT, when directed.
Coolant level switch – A switch sensor used to monitor coolant level.
Coolant Mixer Valve (CMV) – Controls coolant flow through the low-temperature radiator.
Continuous Monitor Test – An ECM function that continuously monitors the inputs and outputs to ensure that
readings are within set limits.
Crankcase – The housing that encloses the crankshaft, connecting rods, and allied parts.
Crankcase breather – A vent for the crankcase to release excess interior air pressure.
Crankcase Oil Separator Speed (CCOSS) sensor – The CCOSS sensor sends the ECM information about
the speed of the crankcase oil separator internal components.
Crankcase pressure – The force of air inside the crankcase against the crankcase housing.
Crankshaft Position (CKP) sensor – A magnetic pickup sensor that determines crankshaft position and speed.
Cruise Control Switches (CCS) – A set of switches used for cruise control, Power TakeOff (PTO), and remote
hand throttle system.
Current – The flow of electrons passing through a conductor. Measured in amperes.
Cylinder Balance – An ECM control strategy to even-out the power contributions of each power cylinder.
Damper – A device that reduces the amplitude of torsional vibration. (SAE J1479 JAN85)
Deaeration – The removal or purging of gases (air or combustion gas) entrained in coolant or lubricating oil.
Deaeration tank – A separate tank in the coolant system used for one or more of the following functions:
• Deaeration
• Coolant reservoir (fluid expansion and afterboil)
• Coolant retention
• Filling
• Fluid level indication (visible)
Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) – 2010 model year vehicles no longer utilize DTC identification by number.
DTCs are now identified using the Suspect Parameter Number (SPN) and Failure Mode Indicator (FMI) identifiers
only.
Diamond Logic Builder (DLB) – The diagnostics software for chassis related components and systems.
Diesel Oxidation Catalyst (DOC) – A DOC is part of the diesel exhaust Aftertreatment system. DOCs
are devices that use a chemical process to break down pollutants in the exhaust stream into less harmful
components. More specifically, DOCs utilize rare metals such as palladium and platinum to reduce hydrocarbon
based Soluble Organic Fraction (SOF) and carbon monoxide content of diesel exhaust by simple oxidation.
1856 9 TERMINOLOGY
The DOC can be used during an active regeneration to create higher exhaust temperatures, thereby reducing
soot in the DPF.
Diesel Oxidation Catalyst Inlet Temperature sensor (DOCIT) – A sensor that provides DOC inlet temperature
signal to the ECM.
Diesel Particulate Filter (DPF) – A diesel particulate filter, sometimes called a DPF, is a device designed to
remove diesel particulate matter or soot from the exhaust gas of a diesel engine.
Diesel Particulate Filter Differential Pressure (DPFDP) sensor – A sensor that measures pressure difference
between the inlet and outlet of the DPF and provides feedback to the ECM.
Diesel Particulate Filter Inlet Temperature sensor (DPFIT) – A sensor that provides DOC inlet temperature
signal to the ECM.
Diesel Particulate Filter Outlet Temperature sensor (DPFOT) – A sensor that provides DOC outlet
temperature signal to the ECM.
Digital Multimeter (DMM) – An electronic meter that uses a digital display to indicate a measured value.
Preferred for use on microprocessor systems because it has a very high internal impedance and will not load
down the circuit being measured.
Disable – A computer decision that deactivates a system and prevents operation of the system.
Displacement – The stroke of the piston multiplied by the area of the cylinder bore multiplied by the number of
cylinders in the engine.
Down Stream Injection (DSI) – The DSI system injects fuel into the exhaust system to increase temperature
of the exhaust gases, and is necessary for DPF regeneration.
Driver (high side) – A transistor within an electronic module that controls the power to an actuator circuit.
Driver (low side) – A transistor within an electronic module that controls the ground to an actuator circuit.
Dual Stage Turbocharger – An assembly of two turbochargers (low-pressure and high-pressure) in series to
provide a wide range of charge air pressures efficiently.
Duty cycle – A control signal that has a controlled on/off time measurement from 0 to 100%. Normally used to
control solenoids.
EGR Cooler – A cooler that allows heat to dissipate from the exhaust gasses before they enter the intake
manifold.
Engine Compression Brake (ECB) valve – The ECB valve controls pressure entering the brake oil gallery
from the high-pressure oil rail gallery. This activates the brake actuator pistons and opens the exhaust valves.
Engine Compression Brake 1 (ECB1) solenoid – The ECB1 solenoid controls pressure entering the brake oil
gallery from the high-pressure oil rail gallery.
Engine Compression Brake 2 (ECB2) solenoid – The ECB2 solenoid controls pressure entering the brake oil
gallery from the high-pressure oil rail gallery.
Engine Compression Brake Pressure (ECBP) sensor – A high-pressure sensor that provides a feedback
signal to the ECM indicating brake control pressure.
Engine Control Module (ECM) – An electronic processor that monitors and controls the engine.
Engine Coolant Level (ECL) sensor – A switch sensor that monitors coolant level.
Engine Coolant Temperature 1 (ECT1) sensor – A thermistor sensor that detects engine coolant temperature.
Engine Coolant Temperature 2 (ECT2) sensor – A thermistor sensor that detects engine coolant temperature.
9 TERMINOLOGY 1857
Engine Fuel Temperature (EFT) sensor – A thermistor sensor that measures fuel temperature.
Engine lamp – An instrument panel lamp that comes on when DTCs are set. DTCs can be read as flash codes
(red and amber instrument panel lamps).
Engine OFF tests – Tests that are done with the ignition switch ON and the engine OFF.
Engine Oil Pressure (EOP) sensor – A variable capacitance sensor that measures oil pressure.
Engine Oil Temperature (EOT) sensor – A thermistor sensor that measures oil temperature.
Engine rating – Engine rating includes Rated hp and Rated rpm.
Engine RUNNING tests – Tests done with the engine running.
Engine Throttle Valve (ETV) and Engine Throttle Position Sensor – The ETV valve is used to control airflow
during a regeneration process of the aftertreatment system. The ETV valve is also used to ensure a smooth
engine shut down by restricting airflow to the engine at shut down.
Engine Warning Protection System (EWPS) – Safeguards the engine from undesirable operating conditions
to prevent engine damage and to prolong engine life.
Exhaust Back Pressure (EBP) – The pressure present in the exhaust system during the exhaust period.
Exhaust Back Pressure Valve (EBPV) – A valve that regulates back pressure in the exhaust system.
Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) – A system used to recirculate a portion of the exhaust gases into the power
cylinder in order to reduce oxides of nitrogen.
Exhaust Gas Recirculation Temperature (EGRT) sensor – A thermistor sensor that detects the exhaust gas
temperature entering the EGR cooler.
Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) valve – The EGRV controls the flow of exhaust gases to the intake manifold.
The EGRV is integrated with an EGR Position (EGRP) sensor.
Exhaust Gas Temperature (EGT) – The temperature of exhaust gases.
Exhaust manifold – Exhaust gases flow through the exhaust manifold to the turbocharger exhaust inlet and
are directed to the EGR cooler.
Exhaust Manifold Pressure (EMP) sensor – A variable capacitance sensor used to indicate air pressure in
the exhaust manifold.
Exhaust Manifold Temperature (EMT) sensor – A thermistor style sensor used to indicate air temperature in
the exhaust manifold.
Failure Mode Indicator (FMI) – Identifies the fault or condition effecting the individual component.
Fault detection/management – An alternate control strategy that reduces adverse effects that can be caused
by a system failure. If a sensor fails, the ECM substitutes a good sensor signal or assumed sensor value in its
place. A lit amber instrument panel lamp signals that the vehicle needs service.
Filter restriction – A blockage, usually from contaminants, that prevents the flow of fluid through a filter.
Flash code – See Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC).
Fuel Cooler Control Valve – A valve used to redirect coolant through the fuel cooler.
Fuel Delivery Pressure (FDP) sensor – A variable capacitance sensor that monitors fuel pressure coming from
the fuel tank and sends a signal to the ECM.
Fuel inlet restriction – A blockage, usually from contaminants, that prevents the flow of fluid through the fuel
inlet line.
1858 9 TERMINOLOGY
Fuel pressure – The force fuel exerts on the fuel system as it is pumped through the fuel system.
Fuel Pressure Control Valve (FPCV) – The FPCV controls the fuel pressure to the fuel rails and is controlled
by the ECM. FPCV control depends on fuel pressure and fuel temperature.
Fuel Rail Pressure (FRP) – The amount of pressure in the fuel rail.
Fuel Rail Pressure (FRP) sensor – A variable capacitance sensor that monitors fuel pressure in the fuel rail
and sends a signal to the ECM.
Fuel strainer – A pre-filter in the fuel system that keeps larger contaminants from entering the fuel system.
Fuel Volume Control Valve (FVCV) – The FVCV regulates the volume of flow sent to the HPFP. The FVCV
allows a sufficient quantity of fuel to be delivered to the HPFP depending on engine load, speed, injector quantity,
fuel temperature, and number of injections per cycle.
Fully equipped engine – A fully equipped engine is an engine equipped with only those accessories necessary
to perform its intended service. A fully equipped engine does not include components that are used to power
auxiliary systems. If these components are integral with the engine or, for any reason are included on the test
engine, the power absorbed may be determined and added to the net brake power. (SAE J1995 JUN90)
Fusible link (fuse link) – A fusible link is a special section of low tension cable designed to open the circuit
when subjected to an extreme current overload. (SAE J1156 APR86)
Gradeability – The maximum percent grade, which the vehicle can transverse for a specified time at a specified
speed. The gradeability limit is the grade upon which the vehicle can just move forward. (SAE J227a)
Gross Combined Weight Rating (GCWR) – Maximum combined weight of towing vehicle (including
passengers and cargo) and the trailer. The GCWR indicates the maximum loaded weight that the vehicle is
allowed to tow.
Gross brake horsepower – The power of a complete basic engine, with air cleaner, without fan, and alternator,
and air compressor not charging.
H-Bridge Circuit – An H-Bridge (bipolar) circuit operates like putting a power source on one side of a motor and
connecting the other side of the motor to a ground. This turns the motor. By shifting the leads on the motor, it
will turn in the opposite direction.
Hall effect – The development of a transverse electric potential gradient in a current-carrying conductor or
semiconductor when a magnetic field is applied.
Hall effect sensor – Transducer that varies its output voltage in response to changes in a magnetic field.
Commonly used to time the speed of wheels and shafts.
High-pressure Fuel Pump (HPFP) assembly – The HPFP is a volumetric pump that supplies fuel at
high-pressure. The HPFP is mounted in the rear valley on the top of the engine and is driven by the camshaft.
High-pressure Piezo Common Rail (HPCR) – The HPFP pumps fuel through separate tubes to each fuel rail.
Each fuel rail has four fuel tubes, one for each injector, that maintain constant pressure from the high-pressure
pump to each injector.
High-speed digital inputs – Inputs to the ECM from a sensor that generates varying frequencies (engine speed
and vehicle speed sensors).
Horsepower (hp) – Horsepower is the unit of work done in a given period of time, equal to 33,000 pounds
multiplied by one foot per minute. 1hp = 33,000 lb x 1 ft /1 min.
Humidity Sensor (HS) – A sensor that measures the moisture content of filtered air entering the intake system.
Hydrocarbons – Organic compounds consisting of hydrogen and carbon (fuel and oil).
9 TERMINOLOGY 1859
Hydrocarbon Injector – Injects fuel into the exhaust system to increase temperature of the exhaust gases.
Idle Shutdown Timer (IST) – An engine calibration that allows the ECM to shut down the engine during extended
engine idle times.
Injection Control Pressure (ICP) sensor – Provides a feedback signal to the ECM indicating injection control
pressure.
Injection Pressure Regulator (IPR) valve – A valve that is used to maintain desired injection control pressure.
Inlet Air Temperature (IAT) sensor – A thermistor sensor that monitors intake air temperature.
Intake Air Heater (IAH) – The IAH is primarily used to assist in starting the engine during cold weather. In
addition, it helps to reduce white smoke emissions by heating the incoming air.
Intake manifold – Engine component that evenly supplies air to each intake port in the cylinder head(s).
Intake Manifold Pressure (IMP) sensor – A variable capacitance sensor used to indicate air pressure in the
intake manifold.
Intake Manifold Temperature (IMT) sensor – A thermistor sensor used to indicate air temperature in the intake
manifold.
Internal Transfer Pump (ITP) – The ITP is part of the HPFP assembly and driven off the same shaft as the
HPFP assembly. The ITP supplies fuel at a slightly higher pressure and flow to the HPFP though the Fuel Volume
Control Valve (FVCV). The ITP also provides fuel for cooling and lubrication of the HPFP. Fuel is rerouted as
pump return flow through the HPFP cooling and lubrication valve. Pressure is maintained at the inlet of the
HPFP piston pump by an ITP regulator.
Interstage Cooler (ISC) – Uses cooled coolant to lower the charged air temperature that exits from the
turbocharger low-pressure compressor and enters the turbocharger high-pressure compressor.
Low speed digital inputs – Switched sensor inputs that generate an on/off (high/low) signal to the ECM. The
input to the ECM from the sensor could be from a high input source switch (usually 5 or 12 volts) or from a
grounding switch that grounds the signal from a current limiting resistor in the ECM that creates a low signal (0
volts).
Low temperature radiator thermostat – Coolant flow to the low temperature radiator is regulated by the low
temperature radiator thermostat.
Lubricity – Lubricity is the ability of a substance to reduce friction between solid surfaces in relative motion
under loaded conditions.
Lug (engine) – A condition when the engine is run at an overly low RPM for the load being applied.
Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) – An indicator lamp in the Electronic Instrument Cluster that will illuminate
when a detected emissions fault occurs.
Manifold Absolute Pressure (MAP) – Boost pressure in the manifold that is a result of the turbocharger.
Manifold Absolute Pressure (MAP) sensor – A variable capacitance sensor that measures boost pressure.
Manometer – A double-leg liquid-column gauge, or a single inclined gauge, used to measure the difference
between two fluid pressures. Typically, a manometer records in inches of water.
Mass Air Flow – The intake airflow in an engine.
Mass Air Flow (MAF) sensor – The MAF sensor is used for closed loop control of the EGR valve and ITV. The
ECM monitors the MAF signal so that the ECM can control the EGR and intake throttle systems.
Magnehelic Gauge – A gauge that measures pressure in inches of water.
1860 9 TERMINOLOGY
Magnetic Pickup Sensor – A magnetic pickup sensor generates an alternating frequency that indicates speed.
Magnetic pickups have a two-wire connection for signal and ground. This sensor has a permanent magnetic
core surrounded by a wire coil. The signal frequency is generated by the rotation of the gear teeth that disturb
the magnetic field.
Metering unit valve assembly – The Metering unit valve assembly provides a metered amount of fuel to the
Aftertreatment Fuel Injector (AFI).
Microprocessor – An integrated circuit in a microcomputer that controls information flow.
Micro Strain Gauge (MSG) Sensor – A MSG sensor measures pressure. Pressure exerts force on a pressure
vessel that stretches and compresses to change resistance of strain gauges bonded to the surface of the
pressure vessel. Internal sensor electronics convert the changes in resistance to a ratiometric voltage output.
Nitrogen Oxides (NOx) – Nitrogen oxides form by a reaction between nitrogen and oxygen at high temperatures
and pressures in the combustion chamber.
Normally closed – Refers to a switch that remains closed when no control force is acting on it.
Normally open – Refers to a switch that remains open when no control force is acting on it.
Ohm (Ω) – The unit of electrical resistance. One ohm is the value of resistance through which a potential of one
volt will maintain a current of one ampere. (SAE J1213 NOV82)
On demand test – A self-test the technician initiates using the EST that is run from a program in the software.
Output Circuit Check (OCC) – An on-demand test done during an Engine OFF self-test to check the continuity
of selected actuators.
Output Shaft Speed (OSS) sensor – A sensor mounted to the rear of the transmission that supplies a vehicle
speed signal to the ECM. The ECM uses this signal to control PTO, road speed limiting, and cruise control.
Automatic transmissions use this signal for shift scheduling.
Oxides of Nitrogen (NOx) – Nitrogen oxides formed by a reaction between nitrogen and oxygen at high
temperatures.
Oxygen Sensor (O2S) – A sensor that monitors oxygen levels in the exhaust.
pH – A measure of the acidity or alkalinity of a solution.
Particulate matter – Particulate matter includes mostly burned particles of fuel and engine oil.
Piezometer – An instrument for measuring fluid pressure.
Power – Power is a measure of the rate at which work (force x distance) is done during a specific time. Compare
with Torque.
Power TakeOff (PTO) – Accessory output, usually from the transmission, used to power a hydraulic pump for
a special auxiliary feature (garbage packing, lift equipment, etc).
Pulse Width Modulation (PWM) – Succession of digital electrical pulses, rather than an analog signal. Efficient
method of providing power between fully on and fully off.
Radiator Shutter Enable (RSE) – A feature that uses various input signals to open or close radiator shutters
by energizing or de-energizing a solenoid that controls an air or hydraulic cylinder.
Random Access Memory (RAM) – Computer memory that stores information. Information can be written to and
read from RAM. Input information (current engine speed or temperature) can be stored in RAM to be compared
to values stored in Read Only Memory (ROM). All memory in RAM is lost when the ignition switch is turned off.
Rated gross horsepower – Engine gross horsepower at rated speed as declared by the manufacturer. (SAE
J1995 JUN90)
9 TERMINOLOGY 1861
Rated horsepower – Maximum brake horsepower output of an engine as certified by the engine manufacturer.
The power of an engine when configured as a basic engine. (SAE J1995 JUN90)
Rated net horsepower – Engine net horsepower at rated speed as declared by the manufacturer. (SAE J1349
JUN90)
Rated speed – The speed, as determined by the manufacturer, at which the engine is rated. (SAE J1995
JUN90)
Rated torque – Maximum torque produced by an engine as certified by the manufacturer.
Ratiometric Voltage – In a Micro Strain Gauge (MSG) sensor, pressure to be measured exerts force on a
pressure vessel that stretches and compresses to change resistance of strain gauges bonded to the surface
of the pressure vessel. Internal sensor electronics convert the changes in resistance to a ratiometric voltage
output.
Reference voltage (VREF) – A 5 volt reference supplied by the ECM to operate the engine sensors.
Regeneration – Oxidation of accumulated soot (carbon-based particulates) in the Diesel Particulate Filter (DPF).
The soot is reduced to ash and stored in the PDF.
Remote Accelerator Pedal Position (RAPP) – A feature that allows the operator to set and maintain a constant
engine speed from outside the vehicle cab. This feature may also be known as Remote Engine Speed Control
(RESC). Control over engine speed is accomplished by using remote mounted switches to turn on the RESC
and select the desired engine speed.
Remote Engine Speed Control (RESC) – See Remote Accelerator Pedal Position.
Reserve capacity – Time in minutes that a fully charged battery can be discharged to 10.5 volts at 25 amperes.
Return Fuel System – The return fuel system moves unused fuel from the fuel injectors to the fuel cooler.
Excess fuel out of the FVCV and the FPCV mix with fuel from the fuel injectors on the way to the fuel cooler.
Navistar® Engine Diagnostics – Diagnostics software for engine related components and systems.
Signal Conditioner – The signal conditioner in the internal microprocessor converts analog signals to digital
signals, squares up sine wave signals, or amplifies low-intensity signals to a level that the ECM microprocessor
can process.
Signal ground – The common ground wire to the ECM for the sensors.
Speed Control Command Switches (SCCS) – A set of switches used for cruise control, Power TakeOff (PTO),
and remote hand throttle system.
Starter Motor Control (SMC) – An ECM function that prevents starter engagement while the engine is running
(above a set calibrated rpm), when the automatic transmission is in gear, or when the manual transmission
clutch pedal is not depressed.
Steady state condition – An engine operating at a constant speed and load and at stabilized temperatures and
pressures. (SAE J215 JAN80)
Strategy – A plan or set of operating instructions that the microprocessor follows for a desired goal. Strategy
is the computer program itself, including all equations and decision making logic. Strategy is always stored in
ROM and cannot be changed during calibration.
Stroke – The movement of the piston from Top Dead Center (TDC) to Bottom Dead Center (BDC).
Substrate – Material that supports the wash coating or catalytic materials.
1862 9 TERMINOLOGY
Suspect Parameter Number (SPN) – A 19-bit number used to identify the item for which diagnostics are being
reported. The SPN is used for multiple purposes, some that are specific to diagnostics are as follows;
• Identify the least repairable subsystem that has failed.
• Identify subsystems or assemblies that may not have hard failures but may be exhibiting abnormal operating
performance.
• Identify a particular event or condition that will be reported.
• Report a component and non-standard failure mode.
System restriction (air) – The static pressure differential that occurs at a given airflow from air entrance through
air exit in a system. Usually measured in inches (millimeters) of water. (SAE J1004 SEP81)
Tachometer output signal – Engine speed signal for remote tachometers.
Thermistor – A semiconductor device. A sensing element that changes resistance as the temperature changes.
Thermistor Sensor – Changes electrical resistance with changes in temperature. Resistance in the thermistor
decreases as temperature increases, and increases as temperature decreases. Thermistors work with a resistor
that limits current to form a voltage signal matched with a temperature value.
Thrust load – A thrust load pushes or reacts through a bearing in a direction parallel to the shaft.
Top Dead Center (TDC) – The uppermost position of the piston during the stroke.
Torque – A force having a twisting or turning effect. For a single force, the cross product of a vector from some
reference point to the point of application of the force within the force itself. Also known as moment of force or
rotation moment. Torque is a measure of the ability of an engine to do work.
Truck Computer Analysis of Performance and Economy (TCAPE) – A computer program that simulates the
performance and fuel economy of trucks.
Turbocharger – A turbine driven compressor mounted on the exhaust manifold. The turbocharger increases
the pressure, temperature and density of intake air to charge air.
Turbocharger 1 Turbine Outlet Pressure (TC1TOP) sensor – A variable capacitance sensor that monitors
exhaust back-pressure after the turbochargers.
Turbocharger 2 Compressor Inlet (TC2CIS) sensor – The TC2CIS sensor includes a thermistor sensor that
monitors the temperature of charge air entering the HP turbocharger. This sensor also monitors boost pressure
for the LP turbocharger.
Turbocharger 2 Compressor Inlet Temperature (TC2CIT) sensor – The TC2CIT sensor is a thermistor-based
sensor that monitors the temperature of charge air entering the HP turbocharger.
Turbocharger Outlet Temperature (TCOT) sensor – A sensor that provides a turbocharger outlet temperature
signal to the ECM.
Turbocharger 2 Wastegate Control (TC2WC) solenoid – Controls the turbocharger 2 wastegate by regulating
the amount of charge air pressure supplied to the wastegate actuator. The TC2WC solenoid is controlled by
signals from the ECM in response to engine speed, required fuel quantity, boost, exhaust back-pressure, and
altitude.
Variable capacitance sensor – A variable capacitance sensor measures pressure. The pressure forces a
ceramic material closer to a thin metal disc in the sensor, changing the capacitance of the sensor.
Vehicle Electronic System Programming System – The computer system used to program electronically
controlled vehicles.
Vehicle Retarder Enable/Engage – Output from the ECM to a vehicle retarder.
9 TERMINOLOGY 1863
Vehicle Speed Output (VSO) – A vehicle speed signal sent to the EGC through the J1939 network.
Vehicle Speed Sensor (VSS) – Normally a magnetic pickup sensor mounted in the tailshaft housing of the
transmission, used to indicate ground speed.
Viscosity – The internal resistance to the flow of any fluid.
Viscous fan – A fan drive that is activated when a thermostat, sensing high air temperature, forces fluid through
a special coupling. The fluid activates the fan.
Volt (v) – A unit of electromotive force that will move a current of one ampere through a resistance of one Ohm.
Voltage – Electrical potential expressed in volts.
Voltage drop – Reduction in applied voltage from the current flowing through a circuit or portion of the circuit
current multiplied by resistance.
Voltage ignition – Voltage supplied by the ignition switch when the key is ON.
Washcoat – A layer of alumina applied to the substrate in a monolith-type converter.
Water In Fuel (WIF) sensor – A switch sensor that measures the amount of water in the fuel.
1864 9 TERMINOLOGY